Part Number Hot Search : 
C16C745 D4NK8 60800 N7426U BCM5208 AN7710SP HPR120 SD103AW
Product Description
Full Text Search
 

To Download PC9S12P128J0CFT Datasheet File

  If you can't view the Datasheet, Please click here to try to view without PDF Reader .  
 
 


  Datasheet File OCR Text:
 MC9S12P128 Reference Manual
Covers also MC9S12P-Family MC9S12P96 MC9S12P64 MC9S12P32
S12 Microcontrollers
MC9S12P128RMV1 Rev. 1.12 16 October 2009
freescale.com
To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our documents on the World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information available, refer to: http://freescale.com/ A full list of family members and options is included in the appendices. The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in this document. This document contains information for all constituent modules, with the exception of the CPU. For CPU information please refer to CPU12-1 in the CPU12 & CPU12X Reference Manual.
Revision History
Date April 2008 July 2008 December 2008 March 2009 Revision Level 1.07 1.08 1.09 1.10 PRELIMINARY Minor Corrections Added typ. IDD values Completed Electricals Minor Corrections Final Electricals Corrected section 1.11.3.4 Memory Corrected 1.7.3.16 - 1.7.3.19 SPI pin description Removed reference to MMCCTL1 register from Table 13-5 Removed item 4b from Table A-6 and A-7 Changed Version ID in Table 1-5 from $FF to $00 Added Register Summary Appendix D Updated FTMRC Blockguide . See Revision History Chapter 13 Updated CPMU Blockguide . See Revision History Chapter 7 Description
June 2009
1.11
October 2009
1.12
Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3 Chapter 4 Chapter 5 Chapter 6
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description197 Chapter 8 249 Chapter 9 Chapter 10 Chapter 11 Chapter 12 Chapter 13 Chapter 14 Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3). Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) . . . . . .303 Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description . . 327 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1). . . . . . . . . . . 423 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description . . . . . . . . . . 471
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499 Appendix B Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531 Appendix C Package Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533 Appendix D Detailed Register Address Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 3
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 4 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 1Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.1 1.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 1.2.1 MC9S12P Family Comparison . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 1.2.2 Chip-Level Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Module Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 1.3.1 S12 16-Bit Central Processor Unit (CPU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 1.3.2 On-Chip Flash with ECC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 1.3.3 On-Chip SRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 1.3.4 Main External Oscillator (XOSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 1.3.5 Internal RC Oscillator (IRC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 1.3.6 Internal Phase-Locked Loop (IPLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 1.3.7 System Integrity Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 1.3.8 Timer (TIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 1.3.9 Pulse Width Modulation Module (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 1.3.10 Controller Area Network Module (MSCAN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 1.3.11 Serial Communication Interface Module (SCI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 1.3.12 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 1.3.13 Analog-to-Digital Converter Module (ATD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 1.3.14 On-Chip Voltage Regulator (VREG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 1.3.15 Background Debug (BDM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 1.3.16 Debugger (DBG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Device Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Part ID Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 1.7.1 Device Pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 1.7.2 Pin Assignment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 1.7.3 Detailed Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 1.7.4 Power Supply Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 System Clock Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.9.1 Chip Configuration Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 1.9.2 Low Power Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Resets and Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 1.11.1 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 1.11.2 Interrupt Vectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 1.11.3 Effects of Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 COP Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 ATD External Trigger Input Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 5
1.3
1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7
1.8 1.9
1.10 1.11
1.12 1.13
1.14 S12CPMU Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 2.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 2.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 2.3.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 2.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 2.3.3 Port A Data Register (PORTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 2.3.4 Port B Data Register (PORTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 2.3.5 Port A Data Direction Register (DDRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 2.3.6 Port B Data Direction Register (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 2.3.7 PIM Reserved Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 2.3.8 Port E Data Register (PORTE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 2.3.9 Port E Data Direction Register (DDRE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 2.3.10 Ports A, B, E, BKGD pin Pull-up Control Register (PUCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 2.3.11 Ports A, B, E Reduced Drive Register (RDRIV) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 2.3.12 ECLK Control Register (ECLKCTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 2.3.13 PIM Reserved Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 2.3.14 IRQ Control Register (IRQCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 2.3.15 PIM Reserved Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 2.3.16 Port T Data Register (PTT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 2.3.17 Port T Input Register (PTIT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 2.3.18 Port T Data Direction Register (DDRT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 2.3.19 Port T Reduced Drive Register (RDRT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 2.3.20 Port T Pull Device Enable Register (PERT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 2.3.21 Port T Polarity Select Register (PPST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 2.3.22 PIM Reserved Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 2.3.23 Port T Routing Register (PTTRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 2.3.24 Port S Data Register (PTS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 2.3.25 Port S Input Register (PTIS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 2.3.26 Port S Data Direction Register (DDRS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 2.3.27 Port S Reduced Drive Register (RDRS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 2.3.28 Port S Pull Device Enable Register (PERS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 2.3.29 Port S Polarity Select Register (PPSS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 2.3.30 Port S Wired-Or Mode Register (WOMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 2.3.31 PIM Reserved Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 2.3.32 Port M Data Register (PTM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 2.3.33 Port M Input Register (PTIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 2.3.34 Port M Data Direction Register (DDRM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 2.3.35 Port M Reduced Drive Register (RDRM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 2.3.36 Port M Pull Device Enable Register (PERM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 6 Freescale Semiconductor
2.2 2.3
2.4
2.5
2.3.37 Port M Polarity Select Register (PPSM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 2.3.38 Port M Wired-Or Mode Register (WOMM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 2.3.39 PIM Reserved Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 2.3.40 Port P Data Register (PTP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 2.3.41 Port P Input Register (PTIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 2.3.42 Port P Data Direction Register (DDRP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 2.3.43 Port P Reduced Drive Register (RDRP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 2.3.44 Port P Pull Device Enable Register (PERP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 2.3.45 Port P Polarity Select Register (PPSP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 2.3.46 Port P Interrupt Enable Register (PIEP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 2.3.47 Port P Interrupt Flag Register (PIFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 2.3.48 PIM Reserved Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 2.3.49 Port J Data Register (PTJ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 2.3.50 Port J Input Register (PTIJ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 2.3.51 Port J Data Direction Register (DDRJ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 2.3.52 Port J Reduced Drive Register (RDRJ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 2.3.53 Port J Pull Device Enable Register (PERJ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 2.3.54 Port J Polarity Select Register (PPSJ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 2.3.55 Port J Interrupt Enable Register (PIEJ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 2.3.56 Port J Interrupt Flag Register (PIFJ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 2.3.57 Port AD Data Register (PT0AD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 2.3.58 Port AD Data Register (PT1AD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 2.3.59 Port AD Data Direction Register (DDR0AD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 2.3.60 Port AD Data Direction Register (DDR1AD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 2.3.61 Port AD Reduced Drive Register (RDR0AD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 2.3.62 Port AD Reduced Drive Register (RDR1AD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 2.3.63 Port AD Pull Up Enable Register (PER0AD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 2.3.64 Port AD Pull Up Enable Register (PER1AD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 2.3.65 PIM Reserved Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 2.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 2.4.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 2.4.3 Pins and Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 2.4.4 Pin interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Initialization Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 2.5.1 Port Data and Data Direction Register writes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Chapter 3S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
3.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 3.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 3.1.2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 3.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 3.1.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 3.1.5 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 7
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 3.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 3.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 3.4.1 MCU Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 3.4.2 Memory Map Scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Implemented Memory in the System Memory Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 3.5.1 Implemented Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 3.5.2 Chip Bus Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 3.5.3 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 3.6.1 CALL and RTC Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Chapter 4 Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
4.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 4.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 4.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 4.1.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 4.1.4 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 4.3.1 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 4.4.1 S12S Exception Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 4.4.2 Interrupt Prioritization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 4.4.3 Reset Exception Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 4.4.4 Exception Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 4.5.1 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 4.5.2 Interrupt Nesting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 4.5.3 Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
4.2 4.3 4.4
4.5
Chapter 5 Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
5.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 5.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 5.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 5.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 5.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 5.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 5.3.3 Family ID Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
5.2 5.3
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 8 Freescale Semiconductor
5.4
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 5.4.1 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 5.4.2 Enabling and Activating BDM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 5.4.3 BDM Hardware Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 5.4.4 Standard BDM Firmware Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 5.4.5 BDM Command Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 5.4.6 BDM Serial Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 5.4.7 Serial Interface Hardware Handshake Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 5.4.8 Hardware Handshake Abort Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 5.4.9 SYNC -- Request Timed Reference Pulse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 5.4.10 Instruction Tracing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 5.4.11 Serial Communication Time Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Chapter 6 S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 6.1.1 Glossary Of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 6.1.2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 6.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 6.1.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 6.1.5 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 6.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 6.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 6.4.1 S12SDBG Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 6.4.2 Comparator Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 6.4.3 Match Modes (Forced or Tagged) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 6.4.4 State Sequence Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 6.4.5 Trace Buffer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 6.4.6 Tagging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 6.4.7 Breakpoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 6.5.1 State Machine scenarios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 6.5.2 Scenario 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 6.5.3 Scenario 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 6.5.4 Scenario 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 6.5.5 Scenario 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 6.5.6 Scenario 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 6.5.7 Scenario 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 6.5.8 Scenario 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 6.5.9 Scenario 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 6.5.10 Scenario 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 6.5.11 Scenario 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 9
6.2 6.3
6.4
6.5
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
7.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 7.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 7.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 7.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 7.2.1 RESET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 7.2.2 EXTAL and XTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 7.2.3 TEMPSENSE -- temperature sensor output voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 7.2.4 VDDR -- Regulator Power Input Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 7.2.5 VDDA, VSSA -- Regulator Reference Supply Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 7.2.6 VSS, VSSPLL-- Ground Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 7.2.7 VDDX, VSSX-- Pad Supply Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 7.2.8 API_EXTCLK -- API external clock output pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 7.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 7.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 7.4.1 Phase Locked Loop with Internal Filter (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 7.4.2 Startup from Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 7.4.3 Stop Mode using PLL Clock as Bus Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 7.4.4 Full Stop Mode using Oscillator Clock as Bus Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 7.4.5 External Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 7.4.6 System Clock Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 7.5.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 7.5.2 Description of Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 7.5.3 Power-On Reset (POR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 7.5.4 Low-Voltage Reset (LVR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 7.6.1 Description of Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
7.6 7.7
Chapter 8 Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 8.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 8.1.2 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 8.1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 8.1.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 8.2.1 RXCAN -- CAN Receiver Input Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 8.2.2 TXCAN -- CAN Transmitter Output Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
8.2
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 10 Freescale Semiconductor
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.2.3 CAN System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 8.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 8.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 8.3.3 Programmer's Model of Message Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 8.4.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 8.4.2 Message Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 8.4.3 Identifier Acceptance Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 8.4.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 8.4.5 Low-Power Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 8.4.6 Reset Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 8.4.7 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 8.5.1 MSCAN initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 8.5.2 Bus-Off Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Chapter 9 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 9.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 9.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 9.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305 Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 9.2.1 Detailed Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 9.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 9.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 9.4.1 Analog Sub-Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 9.4.2 Digital Sub-Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
9.2 9.3
9.4
9.5 9.6
Chapter 10 Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
10.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 10.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 10.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 10.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 10.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 10.2.1 PWM5 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 5 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 10.2.2 PWM4 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 4 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 11
10.3
10.4
10.5 10.6
10.2.3 PWM3 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 3 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 10.2.4 PWM2 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 2 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 10.2.5 PWM1 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 1 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 10.2.6 PWM0 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 0 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 10.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 10.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350 10.4.1 PWM Clock Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350 10.4.2 PWM Channel Timers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
Chapter 11 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 11.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 11.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362 11.1.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362 11.1.4 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 11.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 11.2.1 TXD -- Transmit Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 11.2.2 RXD -- Receive Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 11.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 11.3.1 Module Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 11.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 11.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 11.4.1 Infrared Interface Submodule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 11.4.2 LIN Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 11.4.3 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 11.4.4 Baud Rate Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378 11.4.5 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379 11.4.6 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 11.4.7 Single-Wire Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 11.4.8 Loop Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 11.5 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 11.5.1 Reset Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 11.5.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 11.5.3 Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 11.5.4 Recovery from Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 11.5.5 Recovery from Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 12 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
12.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 12.1.1 Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 12.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 12.1.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 12.1.4 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 12.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399 12.2.1 MOSI -- Master Out/Slave In Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399 12.2.2 MISO -- Master In/Slave Out Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399 12.2.3 SS -- Slave Select Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 12.2.4 SCK -- Serial Clock Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 12.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 12.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 12.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 12.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409 12.4.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410 12.4.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 12.4.3 Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412 12.4.4 SPI Baud Rate Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 12.4.5 Special Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 12.4.6 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 12.4.7 Low Power Mode Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
Chapter 13 128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
13.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423 13.1.1 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424 13.1.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 13.1.3 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 13.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426 13.3 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427 13.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427 13.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430 13.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448 13.4.1 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448 13.4.2 IFR Version ID Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448 13.4.3 Flash Command Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448 13.4.4 Allowed Simultaneous P-Flash and D-Flash Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453 13.4.5 Flash Command Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453 13.4.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 467 13.4.7 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468 13.4.8 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468 13.5 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 13
13.5.1 Unsecuring the MCU using Backdoor Key Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468 13.5.2 Unsecuring the MCU in Special Single Chip Mode using BDM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469 13.5.3 Mode and Security Effects on Flash Command Availability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470 13.6 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
Chapter 14 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471 14.1.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471 14.1.2 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472 14.1.3 Block Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473 14.2 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 14.2.1 IOC7 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 7 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 14.2.2 IOC6 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 6 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 14.2.3 IOC5 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 5 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 14.2.4 IOC4 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 4 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 14.2.5 IOC3 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 3 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 14.2.6 IOC2 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 2 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475 14.2.7 IOC1 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 1 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476 14.2.8 IOC0 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 0 Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476 14.3 Memory Map and Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476 14.3.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476 14.3.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476 14.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492 14.4.1 Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493 14.4.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494 14.4.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494 14.4.4 Pulse Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495 14.4.5 Event Counter Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495 14.4.6 Gated Time Accumulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495 14.5 Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496 14.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496 14.6.1 Channel [7:0] Interrupt (C[7:0]F) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496 14.6.2 Pulse Accumulator Input Interrupt (PAOVI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496 14.6.3 Pulse Accumulator Overflow Interrupt (PAOVF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496 14.6.4 Timer Overflow Interrupt (TOF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.1 General A.1.1 A.1.2 A.1.3 A.1.4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499 Parameter Classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499 Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499 Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500 Current Injection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 14 Freescale Semiconductor
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5 A.6 A.7 A.8 A.9 A.10 A.11
A.1.5 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500 A.1.6 ESD Protection and Latch-up Immunity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501 A.1.7 Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502 A.1.8 Power Dissipation and Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503 A.1.9 I/O Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506 A.1.10 Supply Currents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508 ATD Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510 A.2.1 ATD Operating Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510 A.2.2 Factors Influencing Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511 A.2.3 ATD Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512 NVM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 516 A.3.1 Timing Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 516 A.3.2 NVM Reliability Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 520 Phase Locked Loop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521 A.4.1 Jitter Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521 A.4.2 Electrical Characteristics for the PLL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523 Electrical Characteristics for the IRC1M . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523 Electrical Characteristics for the Oscillator (OSCLCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524 Reset Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524 Electrical Specification for Voltage Regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525 Chip Power-up and Voltage Drops . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525 MSCAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527 SPI Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527 A.11.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527 A.11.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529
Appendix B Ordering Information Appendix C Package Information
C.1 80 QFP Package Mechanical Outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534 C.2 48 QFN Package Mechanical Outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537 C.3 64 LQFP Package Mechanical Outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
Appendix D Detailed Register Address Map
D.1 Detailed Register Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 15
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 16 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 1 Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.1 Introduction
The MC9S12P family is an optimized, automotive, 16-bit microcontroller product line focused on lowcost, high-performance, and low pin-count. This family is intended to bridge between high-end 8-bit microcontrollers and high-performance 16-bit microcontrollers, such as the MC9S12XS family. The MC9S12P family is targeted at generic automotive applications requiring CAN or LIN/J2602 communication. Typical examples of these applications include body controllers, occupant detection, door modules, seat controllers, RKE receivers, smart actuators, lighting modules, and smart junction boxes. The MC9S12P family uses many of the same features found on the MC9S12XS family, including error correction code (ECC) on flash memory, a separate data-flash module for diagnostic or data storage, a fast analog-to-digital converter (ATD) and a frequency modulated phase locked loop (IPLL) that improves the EMC performance. The MC9S12P family deliver all the advantages and efficiencies of a 16-bit MCU while retaining the low cost, power consumption, EMC, and code-size efficiency advantages currently enjoyed by users of Freescale's existing 8-bit and 16-bit MCU families. Like the MC9S12XS family, the MC9S12P family run 16-bit wide accesses without wait states for all peripherals and memories. The MC9S12P family is available in 80-pin QFP, 64-pin LQFP, and 48-pin QFN package options and aims to maximize pin compatibility with the MC9S12XS family. In addition to the I/O ports available in each module, further I/O ports are available with interrupt capability allowing wake-up from stop or wait modes.
1.2
Features
This section describes the key features of the MC9S12P family.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 17
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.2.1
MC9S12P Family Comparison
Table 1 provides a summary of different members of the MC9S12P family and their proposed features. This information is intended to provide an understanding of the range of functionality offered by this microcontroller family.
Table 1. MC9S12P Family
Feature CPU Flash memory (ECC) Data flash (ECC) RAM MSCAN SCI SPI Timer PWM ADC Frequency modulated PLL External oscillator (4 - 16 MHz Pierce with loop control) Internal 1 MHz RC oscillator Supply voltage Execution speed 2 Kbytes 4 Kbytes 1 1 1 8 ch x 16-bit 6 ch x 8-bit 10 ch x 12-bit Yes Yes 32 Kbytes 64 Kbytes 4 Kbytes 6 Kbytes MC9S12P32 MC9S12P64 CPU12-V1 96 Kbytes 128 Kbytes MC9S12P96 MC9S12P128
Yes 3.15 V - 5.5 V Static(1) - 32 MHz
Package 80 QFP, 64 LQFP, 48 QFN 1. P or D Flash erasing or programming requires a minimum bus frequency of 1MHz
1.2.2
Chip-Level Features
On-chip modules available within the family include the following features: * S12 CPU core * Up to 128 Kbyte on-chip flash with ECC * 4 Kbyte data flash with ECC * Up to 6 Kbyte on-chip SRAM * Phase locked loop (IPLL) frequency multiplier with internal filter * 4-16 MHz amplitude controlled Pierce oscillator * 1 MHz internal RC oscillator * Timer module (TIM) supporting input/output channels that provide a range of 16-bit input capture, output compare, counter, and pulse accumulator functions
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 18 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
* * * * * * *
Pulse width modulation (PWM) module with 6 x 8-bit channels 10-channel, 12-bit resolution successive approximation analog-to-digital converter (ATD) One serial peripheral interface (SPI) module One serial communication interface (SCI) module supporting LIN communications One multi-scalable controller area network (MSCAN) module (supporting CAN protocol 2.0A/B) On-chip voltage regulator (VREG) for regulation of input supply and all internal voltages Autonomous periodic interrupt (API)
1.3
Module Features
The following sections provide more details of the modules implemented on the MC9S12P family.
1.3.1
S12 16-Bit Central Processor Unit (CPU)
S12 CPU is a high-speed 16-bit processing unit: * Full 16-bit data paths supports efficient arithmetic operation and high-speed math execution * Includes many single-byte instructions. This allows much more efficient use of ROM space. * Extensive set of indexed addressing capabilities, including: -- Using the stack pointer as an indexing register in all indexed operations -- Using the program counter as an indexing register in all but auto increment/decrement mode -- Accumulator offsets using A, B, or D accumulators -- Automatic index predecrement, preincrement, postdecrement, and postincrement (by -8 to +8)
1.3.2
On-Chip Flash with ECC
On-chip flash memory on the MC9S12P features the following: * Up to 128 Kbyte of program flash memory -- 32 data bits plus 7 syndrome ECC (error correction code) bits allow single bit error correction and double fault detection -- Erase sector size 512 bytes -- Automated program and erase algorithm -- User margin level setting for reads -- Protection scheme to prevent accidental program or erase * 4 Kbyte data flash space -- 16 data bits plus 6 syndrome ECC (error correction code) bits allow single bit error correction and double fault detection -- Erase sector size 256 bytes -- Automated program and erase algorithm -- User margin level setting for reads
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 19
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.3.3
*
On-Chip SRAM
Up to 6 Kbytes of general-purpose RAM
1.3.4
*
Main External Oscillator (XOSC)
Loop control Pierce oscillator using a 4 MHz to 16 MHz crystal -- Current gain control on amplitude output -- Signal with low harmonic distortion -- Low power -- Good noise immunity -- Eliminates need for external current limiting resistor -- Transconductance sized for optimum start-up margin for typical crystals
1.3.5
*
Internal RC Oscillator (IRC)
Trimmable internal reference clock. -- Frequency: 1 MHz -- Trimmed accuracy over -40C to +125C ambient temperature range: 1.5%
1.3.6
*
Internal Phase-Locked Loop (IPLL)
Phase-locked-loop clock frequency multiplier -- No external components required -- Reference divider and multiplier allow large variety of clock rates -- Automatic bandwidth control mode for low-jitter operation -- Automatic frequency lock detector -- Configurable option to spread spectrum for reduced EMC radiation (frequency modulation) -- Reference clock sources: - External 4-16 MHz resonator/crystal (XOSC) - Internal 1 MHz RC oscillator (IRC)
1.3.7
* * * * * *
System Integrity Support
Power-on reset (POR) System reset generation Illegal address detection with reset Low-voltage detection with interrupt or reset Real time interrupt (RTI) Computer operating properly (COP) watchdog -- Configurable as window COP for enhanced failure detection
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 20 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
*
-- Initialized out of reset using option bits located in flash memory Clock monitor supervising the correct function of the oscillator
1.3.8
* * *
Timer (TIM)
8 x 16-bit channels for input capture or output compare 16-bit free-running counter with 7-bit precision prescaler 1 x 16-bit pulse accumulator
1.3.9
*
Pulse Width Modulation Module (PWM)
6 channel x 8-bit or 3 channel x 16-bit pulse width modulator -- Programmable period and duty cycle per channel -- Center-aligned or left-aligned outputs -- Programmable clock select logic with a wide range of frequencies
1.3.10
*
Controller Area Network Module (MSCAN)
* * *
* * * * *
1 Mbit per second, CAN 2.0 A, B software compatible -- Standard and extended data frames -- 0-8 bytes data length -- Programmable bit rate up to 1 Mbps Five receive buffers with FIFO storage scheme Three transmit buffers with internal prioritization Flexible identifier acceptance filter programmable as: -- 2 x 32-bit -- 4 x 16-bit -- 8 x 8-bit Wakeup with integrated low pass filter option Loop back for self test Listen-only mode to monitor CAN bus Bus-off recovery by software intervention or automatically 16-bit time stamp of transmitted/received messages
1.3.11
* * * *
Serial Communication Interface Module (SCI)
Full-duplex or single-wire operation Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format Selectable IrDA 1.4 return-to-zero-inverted (RZI) format with programmable pulse widths 13-bit baud rate selection
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 21
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
* * * *
Programmable character length Programmable polarity for transmitter and receiver Active edge receive wakeup Break detect and transmit collision detect supporting LIN
1.3.12
* * * * * *
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Configurable 8- or 16-bit data size Full-duplex or single-wire bidirectional Double-buffered transmit and receive Master or slave mode MSB-first or LSB-first shifting Serial clock phase and polarity options
1.3.13
*
Analog-to-Digital Converter Module (ATD)
*
10-channel, 12-bit analog-to-digital converter -- 3 us single conversion time -- 8-/10-/12-bit resolution -- Left or right justified result data -- Internal oscillator for conversion in stop modes -- Wakeup from low power modes on analog comparison > or <= match -- Continuous conversion mode -- Multiple channel scans Pins can also be used as digital I/O
1.3.14
* * * * *
On-Chip Voltage Regulator (VREG)
Linear voltage regulator with bandgap reference Low-voltage detect (LVD) with low-voltage interrupt (LVI) Power-on reset (POR) circuit Low-voltage reset (LVR) High temperature sensor
1.3.15
* *
Background Debug (BDM)
Non-intrusive memory access commands Supports in-circuit programming of on-chip nonvolatile memory
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 22 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.3.16
* *
Debugger (DBG)
*
* *
Trace buffer with depth of 64 entries Three comparators (A, B and C) -- Comparators A compares the full address bus and full 16-bit data bus -- Exact address or address range comparisons Two types of comparator matches -- Tagged This matches just before a specific instruction begins execution -- Force This is valid on the first instruction boundary after a match occurs Four trace modes Four stage state sequencer
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 23
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.4
Block Diagram
VDDA VSSA VRH VRL AN[9:0]
Figure 1-1 shows a block diagram of the MC9S12P-Family devices
32K/64K/96K/128K bytes Flash 2K/4K/6K bytes RAM 4K bytes Data Flash
VDDR VSS3
ATD 12-bit 10-channel Analog-Digital Converter PTAD PTT PTP (Wake-Up Int) PTM PTJ (Wake-up Int) PTS
PAD[9:0] PT0 PT1 PT2 PT3 PT4 PT5 PT6 PT7 PP0 PP1 PP2 PP3 PP4 PP5 PP7 PM0 PM1 PM2 PM3 PM4 PM5
Voltage Regulator
TIM 16-bit 8 channel Timer
CPU12-V1
Debug Module Single-wire Background 3 address breakpoints Debug Module 1 data breakpoints 64 Byte Trace Buffer
IOC0 IOC1 IOC2 IOC3 IOC4 IOC5 IOC6 IOC7 PWM0 PWM1 PWM2 PWM3 PWM4 PWM5
BKGD EXTAL XTAL VSSPLLL RESET TEST PE0 PE1 PE2 PE3 PE4 PE5 PE6 PE7
PWM 8-bit 6channel Pulse Width Modulator
Amplitude Controlled Low Power Pierce Oscillator
PLL with Frequency Modulation option Reset Generation and Test Entry XIRQ IRQ
Clock Monitor COP Watchdog Periodic Interrupt Auton. Periodic Int.
Interrupt Module
CAN msCAN 2.0B SPI Synchronous Serial IF
PTE
ECLK
RXCAN TXCAN MISO SS MOSI SCK
ECLKX2
SCI Asynchronous Serial IF
RXD TXD
PA[7:0]
PB[7:0]
PTB
PTA
PS0 PS1 PS2 PS3
PJ0 PJ1 PJ2
3-5V IO Supply VDDX1/VSSX1 VDDX2/VSSX2
PJ6 PJ7
Figure 1-1. MC9S12P-Family Block Diagram
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 24 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.5
Device Memory Map
Table 1-2. Device Register Memory Map
Address 0x0000-0x0009 0x000A-0x000B 0x000C-0x000D 0x000E-0x000F 0x0010-0x0017 0x0018-0x0019 0x001A-0x001B 0x001C-0x001F 0x0020-0x002F 0x0030-0x0033 0x0034-0x003F 0x0040-0x006F 0x0070-0x009F 0x00A0-0x00C7 0x00C8-0x00CF 0x00D0-0x00D7 0x00D8-0x00DF 0x00E0-0x00FF 0x0100-0x0113 0x0114-0x011F 0x0120 0x0121-0x013F 0x0140-0x017F 0x0180-0x023F 0x0240-0x027F 0x0280-0x02BF 0x02C0-0x02EF 0x02F0-0x02FF 0x0300-0x03FF Module PIM (port integration module) MMC (memory map control) PIM (port integration module) Reserved MMC (memory map control) Reserved Device ID register PIM (port integration module) DBG (debug module) Reserved CPMU (clock and power management) TIM (timer module) ATD (analog-to-digital converter 12 bit 10-channel) PWM (pulse-width modulator 6 channels) SCI (serial communications interface) Reserved SPI (serial peripheral interface) Reserved FTMRC control registers Reserved INT (interrupt module) Reserved CAN Reserved PIM (port integration module) Reserved Reserved CPMU (clock and power management ) Reserved Size (Bytes) 10 2 2 2 8 2 2 4 16 4 12 48 48 40 8 8 8 32 20 12 1 31 64 192 64 64 48 16 256
Table 1-2 shows the device register memory map.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 25
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
NOTE Reserved register space shown in Table 1-2 is not allocated to any module. This register space is reserved for future use. Writing to these locations have no effect. Read access to these locations returns zero. Figure 1-2 shows S12P CPU and BDM local address translation to the global memory map. It indicates also the location of the internal resources in the memory map. Table 1-3. shows the mapping of D-Flash and unpaged P-Flash memory. The whole 256K global memory space is visible through the P-Flash window located in the 64k local memory map located at 0x8000 - 0xBFFF using the PPAGE register.
Table 1-3. MC9S12P -Family mapping for D-Flash and unpaged P-Flash
Local 64K memory map D-Flash 0x0400 - 0x13FF 0x1400 - 0x27FF(1) P-Flash 0x4000 - 0x7FFF Global 256K memory map 0x0_4400 - 0x0_53FF 0x3_1400 -0x3_27FF(2) 0x3_4000 - 0x3_7FFF
0xC000 - 0xFFFF 0x3_C000 - 0x3_FFFF 1. 0x2FFF for MC9S12P64 because of 4K RAM size 2. 0x3_2FFF for MC9S12P64 because of 4K RAM size
Table 1-4. Derivatives
Feature P-Flash size PF_LOW PPAGES RAMSIZE RAM_LOW MC9S12P32 32KB 0x3_8000 0x0E - 0x0F 2KB 0x0_3800 MC9S12P64 64KB 0x3_0000 0x0C - 0x0F 4KB 0x0_3000 MC9S12P96 96KB 0x2_8000 0x0A - 0x0F 6KB 0x0_2800 MC9S12P128 128KB 0x2_0000 0x08 - 0x0F
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 26 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Figure 1-2. MC9S12P-Family Global Memory Map CPU and BDM Local Memory Map
0x0000
REGISTERS
Global Memory Map
0x0_0000
REGISTERS
(PPAGE 0x00)
0x0400 D-Flash 0x1400 Unpaged P-Flash 0x0_4000 0x0_4400 0x0_5400 RAMSIZE RAM_LOW
Unimplemented Area
RAMSIZE
RAM
NVM Resources
D-Flash
(PPAGE 0x01)
RAM 0x4000
NVM Resources
PF_LOW=0x0_8000
(PPAGE 0x02-0x0B))
Unpaged P-Flash
P-Flash 10 *16K paged
0x8000
PF_LOW=0x3_0000 (PPAGE 0x0C)
P-Flash window
0 0 0 0 P3 P2 P1 P0
Unpaged P-Flash
PPAGE PF_LOW=0x3_4000
(PPAGE 0x0D)
0xC000
Unpaged P-Flash
PF_LOW=0x3_8000 Unpaged P-Flash
(PPAGE 0x0E)
PF_LOW=0x3_C000 0xFFFF Unpaged P-Flash
(PPAGE 0x0F)
0x3_FFFF
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 27
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.6
Part ID Assignments
The part ID is located in two 8-bit registers PARTIDH and PARTIDL (addresses 0x001A and 0x001B). The read-only value is a unique part ID for each revision of the chip. Table 1-5 shows the assigned part ID number and Mask Set number. The Version ID in Table 1-5. is a word located in a flash information row. The version ID number indicates a specific version of internal NVM controller.
Table 1-5. Assigned Part ID Numbers
Device MC9S12P128 MC9S12P96 MC9S12P64 Mask Set Number 0M01N 0M01N 0M01N Part ID(1) $3980 $3980 $3980 Version ID $FF $FF $FF $FF
MC9S12P32 0M01N $3980 1. The coding is as follows: Bit 15-12: Major family identifier Bit 11-6: Minor family identifier Bit 5-4: Major mask set revision number including FAB transfers Bit 3-0: Minor -- non full -- mask set revision
1.7
Signal Description
This section describes signals that connect off-chip. It includes a pinout diagram, a table of signal properties, and detailed discussion of signals. It is built from the signal description sections of the individual IP blocks on the device.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 28 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.7.1
Device Pinout
Figure 1-3. MC9S12P-Family 80 QFP pinout
Freescale Semiconductor
PB5 PB6 PB7 PE7 PE6 PE5 ECLK/PE4 VSSX2 VDDX2 RESET VDDR VSS3 VSSPLL EXTAL XTAL KWJ2/PJ2 PE3 PE2 IRQ/PE1 XIRQ/PE0
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
PWM3/KWP3/PP3 PWM2/KWP2/PP2 PWM1/KWP1/PP1 PWM0/KWP0/PP0 PWM0/IOC0/PT0 IOC1/PT1 IOC2/PT2 IOC3/PT3 KWJ0/PJ0 KWJ1/PJ1 PWM4/IOC4/PT4 API_EXTCLK/PWM5/IOC5/PT5 IOC6/PT6 IOC7/PT7 MODC/BKGD PB0 PB1 PB2 PB3 PB4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41
PP4/KWP4/PWM4 PP5/KPW5/PWM5 PP7/KPW7 VDDX1 VSSX1 PM0/RXCAN0 PM1/TXCAN0 PM2/MISO0 PM3/SS0 PM4/MOSI0 PM5/SCK0 PJ6/KWJ6 PJ7/KWJ7 TEST PS3 PS2 PS1/TXD0 PS0/RXD0 VSSA VRL
MC9S12P-Family 80 QFP
Pins shown in BOLD are not available on the 64 LQFP package
VRH VDDA PAD07/AN07 PAD06/AN06 PAD05/AN05 PAD04/AN04 PAD03/AN03 PAD02/AN02 PAD01/AN01 PAD00/AN00 PAD09/AN09 PAD08/AN08 PA7 PA6 PA5 PA4 PA3 PA2 PA1 PA0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 29
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Figure 1-4. MC9S12P-Family 64 LQFP pinout
PP5/PWM5/KWP5 PP7/KWP7 VDDX1 VSSX1 PM0/RXCAN0 PM1/TXCAN0 PM2/MISO0 PM3/SS0 PM4/MOSI0 PM5/SCK0 TEST PS3 PS2 PS1/TXD0 PS0/RXD0 VSSA/VRL 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
PWM3/KWP3/PP3 PWM2/KWP2/PP2 PWM1/KWP1/PP1 PWM0/KWP0/PP0 PWM0/IOC0/PT0 IOC1/PT1 IOC2/PT2 IOC3/PT3 KWJ0/PJ0 KWJ1/PJ1 PWM4/IOC4/PT4 API_EXTCLK/PWM5/IOC5/PT5 IOC6/PT6 IOC7/PT7 MODC/BKGD PB0
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
MC9S12P-Family 64 LQFP
Pins shown in BOLD are not available on the 48 QFN package
48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33
VRH VDDA PAD07/AN07 PAD06/AN06 PAD05/AN05 PAD04/AN04 PAD03/AN03 PAD02/AN02 PAD01/AN01 PAD00/AN00 PAD09/AN09 PAD08/AN08 PA3 PA2 PA1 PA0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 30 Freescale Semiconductor
PB5 PB6 PB7 PE7 ECLK/PE4 VSSX2 VDDX2 RESET VDDR VSS3 VSSPLL EXTAL XTAL KWJ2/PJ2 IRQ/PE1 XIRQ/PE0
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Figure 1-5. MC9S12P-Family 48 QFN pinout
VDDX1 VSSX1 PM0/RXCAN0 PM1/TXCAN0 PM2/MISO0 PM3/SS0 PM4/MOSI0 PM5/SCK0 TEST PS1/TXD0 PS0/RXD0 VSSA/VRL 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37
PWM3/KWP3/PP3 PWM2/KWP2/PP2 PWM1/KWP1/PP1 PWM0/IOC0/PT0 IOC1/PT1 IOC2/PT2 IOC3/PT3 PWM4/IOC4/PT4 API_EXTCLK/PWM5/IOC5/PT5 IOC6/PT6 IOC7/PT7 MODC/BKGD
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
MC9S12P-Family 48 QFN
36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25
VDDA/VRH PAD07/AN07 PAD06/AN06 PAD05/AN05 PAD04/AN04 PAD03/AN03 PAD02/AN02 PAD01/AN01 PAD00/AN00 PAD09/AN09 PAD08/AN08 PE0/XIRQ
1.7.2
Pin Assignment Overview
Table 1-6 provides a summary of which Ports are available for each package option. Routing of pin functions is summarized in Table 1-7.
Table 1-6. Port Availability by Package Option
Port Port AD/ADC Channels Port A pins Port B pins Port E pins inc. IRQ/XIRQ input only Port J Port M Port P Port S 80 QFP 10/10 8 8 8 5 6 7 4 64 LQFP 10/10 4 4 4 3 6 6 4 48 QFN 10/10 0 0 4 1 6 3 2
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 31
PE7 ECLK/PE4 VSSX2 VDDX2 RESET VDDR VSS3 VSSPLL EXTAL XTAL KWJ2/PJ2 IRQ/PE1
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Table 1-6. Port Availability by Package Option
Port Port T Sum of Ports I/O Power Pairs VDDX/VSSX 80 QFP 8 64 2/2 64 LQFP 8 49 2/2 48 QFN 8 34 2/2
Table 1-7. Peripheral - Port Routing Options(1)
PWM0 PT0 PT4 O O PWM4 PWM5
PT5 O 1. "O" denotes a possible rerouting under software control
Table 1-8 provides a pin out summary listing the availability and functionality of individual pins for each package option.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 32 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale Semiconductor S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 33
Table 1-8. Pin-Out Summary(1)
Package Pin QFP 80 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 LQFP 64 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 QFN 48 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Function 2nd Func. KWP3 KWP2 KWP1 KWP0 IOC0 IOC1 IOC2 IOC3 KWJ0 KWJ1 IOC4 IOC5 3rd Func. PWM3 PWM2 PWM1 PWM0 PWM0 -- -- -- -- -- PWM4 PWM5 or API_EX TCLK Power Supply Internal Pull Resistor Description CTRL VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX PERP/PPSP PERP/PPSP PERP/PPSP PERP/PPSP PERT/PPST PERT/PPST PERT/PPST PERT/PPST PERJ/PPSJ PERJ/PPSJ PERT/PPST PERT/PPST Reset State Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Up Up Disabled Disabled Port P I/O, interrupt, PWM channel Port P I/O, interrupt, PWM channel Port P I/O, interrupt, PWM channel Port P I/O, interrupt, PWM/ channel Port T I/O, TIM channel Port T I/O, TIM channel Port T I/O, TIM channel Port T I/O, TIM channel Port J I/O, interrupt Port J I/O, interrupt Port T I/O, PWM/TIM channel
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Pin PP3 PP2 PP1 PP0 PT0 PT1 PT2 PT3 PJ0 PJ1 PT4 PT5
Port T I/O, PWM/TIM channel, API output
13 14 15
13 14 15
10 11 12
PT6 PT7 BKGD
IOC6 IOC7 MODC --
VDDX VDDX VDDX
PERT/PPST PERT/PPST Always on
Disabled Disabled Up
Port T I/O, channel of TIM Port T I/O, channel of TIM Background debug
Table 1-8. Pin-Out Summary(1)
Package Pin QFP 80 16 17 18 19 S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 LQFP 64 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 QFN 48 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 Function 2nd Func. -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- ECLKX2 -- -- ECLK -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 3rd Func. -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Power Supply Internal Pull Resistor Description CTRL VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX -- -- VDDX -- -- -- VDDP LL -- -- -- NA PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR Reset State Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Up Port B I/O Port B I/O Port B I/O Port B I/O Port B I/O Port B I/O Port B I/O Port B I/O Port E I/O Port E I/O Port E I/O Port E I/O, bus clock output -- -- External reset -- -- -- NA -- -- -- Oscillator pin
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Freescale Semiconductor 34
Pin PB0 PB1 PB2 PB3 PB4 PB5 PB6 PB7 PE7 PE6 PE5 PE4 VSSX2 VDDX2 RESET VDDR VSS3 VSSPLL EXTAL
While RESET pin is low: down While RESET pin is low: down PUCR -- -- PULLUP Up -- --
Table 1-8. Pin-Out Summary(1)
Package Pin QFP 80 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 LQFP 64 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 QFN 48 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 Function 2nd Func. -- KWJ2 -- -- IRQ XIRQ -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- AN08 AN09 AN00 AN01 3rd Func. -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Power Supply Internal Pull Resistor Description CTRL VDDP LL VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDA VDDA VDDA VDDA NA PERJ/PPSJ PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PUCR PER1AD PER1AD PER1AD PER1AD Reset State NA Up Up Up Up Up Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Oscillator pin Port J I/O, interrupt Port E I/O Port E I/O Port E Input, maskable interrupt Port E Input, nonmaskable interrupt Port A I/O Port A I/O Port A I/O Port A I/O Port A I/O Port A I/O Port A I/O Port A I/O Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Freescale Semiconductor 35
Pin XTAL PJ2 PE3 PE2 PE1 PE0 PA0 PA1 PA2 PA3 PA4 PA5 PA6 PA7 PAD08 PAD09 PAD00 PAD01
Table 1-8. Pin-Out Summary(1)
Package Pin QFP 80 53 54 55 S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 LQFP 64 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 QFN 48 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 36 37 37 38 39 40 41 Function 2nd Func. AN02 AN03 AN04 AN05 AN06 AN07 -- -- -- -- RXD TXD 3rd Func. -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- KWJ7 KWJ6 SCK -- -- -- -- Power Supply Internal Pull Resistor Description CTRL VDDA VDDA VDDA VDDA VDDA VDDA -- -- -- -- VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX N.A. VDDX VDDX VDDX PER1AD PER1AD PER1AD PER1AD PER1AD PER1AD -- -- -- -- PERS/PPSS PERS/PPSS PERS/PPSS PERS/PPSS RESET pin PERJ/PPSJ PERJ/PPSJ PERM/PPSM Reset State Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled -- -- -- -- Up Up Up Up DOWN Up Up Disabled Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD Port AD I/O, analog input of ATD -- -- -- -- Port S I/O, RXD of SCI Port S I/O, TXD of SCI Port S I/O Port S I/O Test input Port J I/O, interrupt Port J I/O, interrupt Port M I/O, MISO of SPI
36 Pin PAD02 PAD03 PAD04 PAD05 PAD06 PAD07 VDDA VRH(2) VRL(3) VSSA PS0 PS1 PS2 PS3 TEST PJ7 PJ6 PM5 Freescale Semiconductor 66 67 68 69 70
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Table 1-8. Pin-Out Summary(1)
Package Pin QFP 80 71 72 73 74 S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 75 76 77 78 79 80 LQFP 64 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 QFN 48 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 Function 2nd Func. MOSI SS MISO TXCAN RXCAN -- -- KWP7 KWP5 KWP4 PWM5 PWM4 -- -- 3rd Func. -- -- -- Power Supply Internal Pull Resistor Description CTRL VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX VDDX -- -- VDDX VDDX VDDX PERM/PPSM PERM/PPSM PERM/PPSM PERM/PPSM PERM/PPSM -- -- PERP/PPSP PERP/PPSP PERP/PPSP Reset State Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled -- -- Disabled Disabled Disabled Port M I/O, MOSI of SPI Port M I/O, SCK of SPI Port M I/O, SS of SPI0 Port M I/O, TX of CAN Port M I/O, RX of CAN -- -- Port P I/O, interrupt Port P I/O, interrupt, PWM channel Port P I/O, interrupt, PWM channel
Freescale Semiconductor 37
Pin PM4 PM3 PM2 PM1 PM0 VSSX1 VDDX1 PP7 PP5 PP4
1. Table shows a superset of pin functions. Not all functions are available on all derivatives 2. VRH and VDDA share single pin on 48 pin package option 3. VRL and VSSA share single pin on 64 and 48 pin package option
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
NOTE For devices assembled in 48-pin and 64-pin packages all non-bonded out pins should be configured as outputs after reset in order to avoid current drawn from floating inputs. Refer to Table 1-8 for affected pins.
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.7.3
1.7.3.1
Detailed Signal Descriptions
EXTAL, XTAL -- Oscillator Pins
EXTAL and XTAL are the crystal driver and external clock pins. On reset all the device clocks are derived from the internal reference clock. XTAL is the oscillator output.
1.7.3.2
RESET -- External Reset Pin
The RESET pin is an active low bidirectional control signal. It acts as an input to initialize the MCU to a known start-up state, and an output when an internal MCU function causes a reset. The RESET pin has an internal pull-up device.
1.7.3.3
TEST -- Test Pin
NOTE The TEST pin must be tied to VSSX in all applications.
This input only pin is reserved for factory test. This pin has an internal pull-down device.
1.7.3.4
BKGD / MODC -- Background Debug and Mode Pin
The BKGD/MODC pin is used as a pseudo-open-drain pin for the background debug communication. It is used as a MCU operating mode select pin during reset. The state of this pin is latched to the MODC bit at the rising edge of RESET. The BKGD pin has an internal pull-up device.
1.7.3.5
PAD[9:0] / AN[9:0] -- Port AD Input Pins of ATD
PAD[9:0] are general-purpose input or output pins and analog inputs AN[9:0] of the analog-to-digital converter ATD.
1.7.3.6
PA[7:0] -- Port A I/O Pins
PA[7:0] are general-purpose input or output pins.
1.7.3.7
PB[7:0] -- Port B I/O Pins
PB[7:0] are general-purpose input or output pins.
1.7.3.8
PE7 -- Port E I/O Pin 7 / ECLKX2
PE7 is a general-purpose input or output pin. An internal pull-up is enabled during reset. It can be configured to output ECLKX2.
1.7.3.9
PE[6:5] -- Port E I/O Pin 6-5
PE[6:5] are a general-purpose input or output pins.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 38 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.7.3.10
PE4 / ECLK -- Port E I/O Pin 4
PE4 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured to drive the internal bus clock ECLK. ECLK can be used as a timing reference. The ECLK output has a programmable prescaler.
1.7.3.11
PE[3:2] -- Port E I/O Pin 3
PE[3:2] are a general-purpose input or output pins.
1.7.3.12
PE1 / IRQ -- Port E Input Pin 1
PE1 is a general-purpose input pin and the maskable interrupt request input that provides a means of applying asynchronous interrupt requests. This will wake up the MCU from stop or wait mode.
1.7.3.13
PE0 / XIRQ -- Port E Input Pin 0
PE0 is a general-purpose input pin and the non-maskable interrupt request input that provides a means of applying asynchronous interrupt requests. This will wake up the MCU from stop or wait mode. The XIRQ interrupt is level sensitive and active low. As XIRQ is level sensitive, while this pin is low the MCU will not enter STOP mode.
1.7.3.14
PJ[7:6, 2:0] / KWJ[7:6, 2:0] -- Port J I/O Pins 7-6, 2-0
PJ[7:6, 2:0] are a general-purpose input or output pins. They can be configured as keypad wakeup inputs.
1.7.3.15
PM[7:6] -- Port M I/O Pins 7-6
PM[7:6] are a general-purpose input or output pins.
1.7.3.16
PM5 / SCK -- Port M I/O Pin 5
PM5 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as the serial clock pin SCK of the serial peripheral interface (SPI).
1.7.3.17
PM4 / MOSI -- Port M I/O Pin 4
PM4 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as the master output (during master mode) or slave input pin (during slave mode) MOSI for the serial peripheral interface (SPI).
1.7.3.18
PM3 / SS -- Port M I/O Pin 3
PM3 is a general-purpose input or output pin.It can be configured as the slave select pin SS of the serial peripheral interface (SPI).
1.7.3.19
PM2 / MISO-- Port M I/O Pin 3
PM2 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as the master input (during master mode) or slave output pin (during slave mode) MISO for the serial peripheral interface (SPI)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 39
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.7.3.20
PM1 / TXCAN -- Port M I/O Pin 1
PM1 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as the transmit pin TXCAN of the scalable controller area network controller (CAN).
1.7.3.21
PM0 / RXCAN -- Port M I/O Pin 0
PM0 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as the receive pin RXCAN of the scalable controller area network controller (CAN).
1.7.3.22
PP[5:0] / KWP[5:0] / PWM[5:0] -- Port P I/O Pins 5-0
PP[5:0] are a general-purpose input or output pins. They can be configured as keypad wakeup inputs. They can be configured as pulse width modulator (PWM) channel 5-0 output
1.7.3.23
PP7 / KWP7 -- Port P I/O Pin 7
PP7 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as a keypad wakeup input.
1.7.3.24
PS3 -- Port S I/O Pin 3
PS3 is a general-purpose input or output pin.
1.7.3.25
PS2 -- Port S I/O Pin 2
PS2 is a general-purpose input or output pin.
1.7.3.26
PS1 / TXD -- Port S I/O Pin 1
PS1 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as the transmit pin TXD of serial communication interface (SCI).
1.7.3.27
PS0 / RXD -- Port S I/O Pin 0
PS0 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as the receive pin RXD of serial communication interface (SCI).
1.7.3.28
PT[7:6] / IOC[7:6] -- Port T I/O Pins 7-6
PT[7:6] are general-purpose input or output pins. They can be configured as timer (TIM) channel 7-6.
1.7.3.29
PT5 / IOC5 / PWM5 / API_EXTCLK -- Port T I/O Pin 5
PT5 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as timer (TIM) channel 5, pulse width modulator (PWM) output 5 or as the output of the API_EXTCLK.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 40 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.7.3.30
PT4 / IOC4 / PWM4 -- Port T I/O Pin 4
PT4 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as timer (TIM) channel 4 or pulse width modulator (PWM) output 4.
1.7.3.31
PT[3:1] / IOC[3:1] -- Port T I/O Pin [3:1]
PT[3:1] are a general-purpose input or output pins. They can be configured as timer (TIM) channels 3-1.
1.7.3.32
PT0 / IOC0 / PWM0 -- Port T I/O Pin 0
PT0 is a general-purpose input or output pin. It can be configured as timer (TIM) channel 0 or pulse width modulator (PWM) output 0.
1.7.4
Power Supply Pins
MC9S12P-Family power and ground pins are described below. Because fast signal transitions place high, short-duration current demands on the power supply, use bypass capacitors with high-frequency characteristics and place them as close to the MCU as possible. NOTE All VSS pins must be connected together in the application.
1.7.4.1
VDDX[2:1], VSSX[2:1] -- Power and Ground Pins for I/O Drivers
External power and ground for I/O drivers. Bypass requirements depend on how heavily the MCU pins are loaded. All VDDX pins are connected together internally. All VSSX pins are connected together internally.
1.7.4.2
VDDR -- Power Pin for Internal Voltage Regulator
Power supply input to the internal voltage regulator.
1.7.4.3
VSS3 -- Core Ground Pin
The voltage supply of nominally 1.8V is derived from the internal voltage regulator. The return current path is through the VSS3 pin. No static external loading of these pins is permitted.
1.7.4.4
VDDA, VSSA -- Power Supply Pins for ATD and Voltage Regulator
These are the power supply and ground input pins for the analog-to-digital converter and the voltage regulator.
1.7.4.5
VRH, VRL -- ATD Reference Voltage Input Pins
VRH and VRL are the reference voltage input pins for the analog-to-digital converter.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 41
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.7.4.6
VSSPLL -- Ground Pin for PLL
This pin provides ground for the oscillator and the phased-locked loop. The voltage supply of nominally 1.8V is derived from the internal voltage regulator.
1.7.4.7
Power and Ground Connection Summary
Table 1-9. Power and Ground Connection Summary
Mnemonic VDDR VDDX[2:1] VSSX[2:1] VDDA VSSA Nominal Voltage 5.0 V 5.0 V 0V 5.0 V 0V Description External power supply to internal voltage regulator External power and ground, supply to pin drivers Operating voltage and ground for the analog-to-digital converters and the reference for the internal voltage regulator, allows the supply voltage to the A/D to be bypassed independently. Reference voltages for the analog-to-digital converter. Internal power and ground generated by internal regulator for the internal core. Provides operating voltage and ground for the phased-locked loop. This allows the supply voltage to the PLL to be bypassed independently. Internal power and ground generated by internal regulator.
VRL VRH VSS3 VSSPLL
0V 5.0 V 0V 0V
1.8
System Clock Description
For the system clock description please refer to chapter Chapter 7, "S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description.
1.9
Modes of Operation
The MCU can operate in different modes. These are described in 1.9.1 Chip Configuration Summary. The MCU can operate in different power modes to facilitate power saving when full system performance is not required. These are described in 1.9.2 Low Power Operation. Some modules feature a software programmable option to freeze the module status whilst the background debug module is active to facilitate debugging.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 42 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.9.1
Chip Configuration Summary
The different modes and the security state of the MCU affect the debug features (enabled or disabled). The operating mode out of reset is determined by the state of the MODC signal during reset (see Table 110). The MODC bit in the MODE register shows the current operating mode and provides limited mode switching during operation. The state of the MODC signal is latched into this bit on the rising edge of RESET.
Table 1-10. Chip Modes
Chip Modes Normal single chip Special single chip MODC 1 0
1.9.1.1
Normal Single-Chip Mode
This mode is intended for normal device operation. The opcode from the on-chip memory is being executed after reset (requires the reset vector to be programmed correctly). The processor program is executed from internal memory.
1.9.1.2
Special Single-Chip Mode
This mode is used for debugging single-chip operation, boot-strapping, or security related operations. The background debug module BDM is active in this mode. The CPU executes a monitor program located in an on-chip ROM. BDM firmware waits for additional serial commands through the BKGD pin.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 43
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.9.2
Low Power Operation
The MC9S12P has two static low-power modes Pseudo Stop and Stop Mode. For a detailed description refer to S12CPMU section.
1.10
Security
The MCU security mechanism prevents unauthorized access to the Flash memory. Refer to Section 5.4.1 Security and Section 13.5 Security
1.11
Resets and Interrupts
Consult the S12 CPU manual and the S12SINT section for information on exception processing.
1.11.1
Resets
Table 1-11. lists all Reset sources and the vector locations. Resets are explained in detail in the Section Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 1-11. Reset Sources and Vector Locations
Vector Address $FFFE $FFFE $FFFE $FFFE $FFFC $FFFA Reset Source Power-On Reset (POR) Low Voltage Reset (LVR) External pin RESET Illegal Address Reset Clock monitor reset COP watchdog reset CCR Mask None None None None None None Local Enable None None None None OSCE Bit in CPMUOSC register CR[2:0] in CPMUCOP register
1.11.2
Interrupt Vectors
Table 1-12 lists all interrupt sources and vectors in the default order of priority. The interrupt module (see Section Chapter 4 Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)) provides an interrupt vector base register (IVBR) to relocate the vectors.
Table 1-12. Interrupt Vector Locations (Sheet 1 of 3)
Vector Address(1) Vector base + $F8 Vector base+ $F6 Vector base+ $F4 Vector base+ $F2 Interrupt Source Unimplemented instruction trap SWI XIRQ IRQ CCR Mask None None X Bit I bit Local Enable None None None IRQCR (IRQEN) Wake up Wakeup from STOP from WAIT Yes Yes Yes Yes
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 44 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Table 1-12. Interrupt Vector Locations (Sheet 2 of 3)
Vector Address(1) Vector base+ $F0 Vector base+ $EE Vector base + $EC Vector base+ $EA Vector base+ $E8 Vector base+ $E6 Vector base+ $E4 Vector base + $E2 Vector base+ $E0 Vector base+ $DE Vector base+ $DC Vector base + $DA Vector base + $D8 Vector base+ $D6 Vector base + $D4 Vector base + $D2 Vector base + $D0 Vector base + $CE Vector base + $CC to Vector base + $CA Vector base + $C8 Vector base + $C6 Vector base + $C4 to Vector base + $BC Vector base + $BA Vector base + $B8 Vector base + $B6 Vector base + $B4 Vector base + $B2 Vector base + $B0 FLASH error FLASH command CAN wake-up CAN errors CAN receive CAN transmit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit Oscillator status interrupt PLL lock interrupt I bit I bit Port J I bit ATD I bit Interrupt Source RTI timeout interrupt TIM timer channel 0 TIM timer channel 1 TIM timer channel 2 TIM timer channel 3 TIM timer channel 4 TIM timer channel 5 TIM timer channel 6 TIM timer channel 7 TIM timer overflow TIM Pulse accumulator A overflow TIM Pulse accumulator input edge SPI SCI CCR Mask I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit Local Enable CPMUINT (RTIE) TIE (C0I) TIE (C1I) TIE (C2I) TIE (C3I) TIE (C4I) TIE (C5I) TIE (C6I) TIE (C7I) TSRC2 (TOF) PACTL (PAOVI) PACTL (PAI) SPICR1 (SPIE, SPTIE) SCICR2 (TIE, TCIE, RIE, ILIE) Reserved ATDCTL2 (ASCIE) Reserved PIEJ (PIEJ7-PIEJ6, PIEJ2PIEJ0) Reserved CPMUINT (OSCIE) CPMUINT (LOCKIE) Reserved FERCNFG (SFDIE, DFDIE) FCNFG (CCIE) CANRIER (WUPIE) CANRIER (CSCIE, OVRIE) 8.4.7 Interrupts CANRIER (RXFIE) CANTIER (TXEIE[2:0]) No No No Yes No No No No Yes Yes Yes Yes Wake up Wakeup from STOP from WAIT 7.6 Interrupts No No No No No No No No No No No No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 45 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
Table 1-12. Interrupt Vector Locations (Sheet 3 of 3)
Vector Address(1) Vector base + $AE to Vector base + $90 Vector base + $8E Vector base+ $8C Vector base + $8A Vector base + $88 Vector base + $86 Vector base + $84 Vector base + $82 Vector base + $80 1. 16 bits vector address based Spurious interrupt -- Port P interrupt PWM emergency shutdown Low-voltage interrupt (LVI) Autonomous periodical interrupt (API) High temperature interrupt ATD compare interrupt I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit Interrupt Source CCR Mask Local Enable Wake up Wakeup from STOP from WAIT
Reserved PIEP (PIEP7,PIEP5-PIEP0) PWMSDN (PWMIE) CPMUCTRL (LVIE) CPMUAPICTRL (APIE) CPMUHTCL (HTIE) ATDCTL2 (ACMPIE) Reserved None Yes No No Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
1.11.3
Effects of Reset
When a reset occurs, MCU registers and control bits are initialized. Refer to the respective block sections for register reset states. On each reset, the Flash module executes a reset sequence to load Flash configuration registers.
1.11.3.1
Flash Configuration Reset Sequence Phase
On each reset, the Flash module will hold CPU activity while loading Flash module registers from the Flash memory. If double faults are detected in the reset phase, Flash module protection and security may be active on leaving reset. This is explained in more detail in the Flash module section 13.6 Initialization.
1.11.3.2
Reset While Flash Command Active
If a reset occurs while any Flash command is in progress, that command will be immediately aborted. The state of the word being programmed or the sector/block being erased is not guaranteed.
1.11.3.3
I/O Pins
Refer to the PIM section for reset configurations of all peripheral module ports.
1.11.3.4
Memory
The RAM arrays are not initialized out of reset.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 46 Freescale Semiconductor
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.12
COP Configuration
The COP time-out rate bits CR[2:0] and the WCOP bit in the CPMUCOP register at address 0x003C are loaded from the Flash register FOPT. See Table 1-13 and Table 1-14 for coding. The FOPT register is loaded from the Flash configuration field byte at global address 0x3_FF0E during the reset sequence.
Table 1-13. Initial COP Rate Configuration
NV[2:0] in FOPT Register 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 CR[2:0] in COPCTL Register 111 110 101 100 011 010 001 000
Table 1-14. Initial WCOP Configuration
NV[3] in FOPT Register 1 0 WCOP in COPCTL Register 0 1
1.13
ATD External Trigger Input Connection
The ATD module includes external trigger inputs ETRIG0 and ETRIG1. The external trigger allows the user to synchronize ATD conversion to external trigger events. Table 1-15 shows the connection of the external trigger inputs.
Table 1-15. ATD External Trigger Sources
External Trigger Input ETRIG0 ETRIG1 Connectivity PWM channel 1 PWM channel 3
Consult the ATD section for information about the analog-to-digital converter module. References to freeze mode are equivalent to active BDM mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 47
Device Overview MC9S12P-Family
1.14
S12CPMU Configuration
The bandgap reference voltage VBG and the output voltage of the temperature sensor VHT can be connected to the ATD channel SPECIAL17 (see Table 9-15.) using the VSEL (Voltage Access Select Bit) in CPMUHTCTL register (see Table 7-13.)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 48 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 2 Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Revision History
Rev. No. Date (Item No.) (Submitted By) V01.00 V01.01 V01.02 19 Mar 2008 05 May 2008 08 Jan 2009 Sections Affected Initial version Corrected mistakes in Port J register and field names Corrected PERxAD register descriptions. Minor corrections.
Substantial Change(s)
2.1
2.1.1
Introduction
Overview
The S12P Family Port Integration Module establishes the interface between the peripheral modules and the I/O pins for all ports. It controls the electrical pin properties as well as the signal prioritization and multiplexing on shared pins. This section covers: * Port A and B used as general purpose I/O * Port E associated with the IRQ, XIRQ interrupt inputs * Port T associated with 1 timer module * Port S associated with 1 SCI module * Port M associated with 1 MSCAN and 1 SPI module * Port P connected to the PWM - inputs can be used as an external interrupt source * Port J used as general purpose I/O - inputs can be used as an external interrupt source * Port AD associated with one 10-channel ATD module Most I/O pins can be configured by register bits to select data direction and drive strength, to enable and select pull-up or pull-down devices. NOTE This section assumes the availability of all features (80-pin package option). Some functions are not available on lower pin count package options. Refer to the pin-out summary section.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 49
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.1.2
Features
The Port Integration Module includes these distinctive registers: * Data registers and data direction registers for Ports A, B, E, T, S, M, P, J and AD when used as general purpose I/O * Control registers to enable/disable pull devices and select pull-ups/pull-downs on Ports T, S, M, P and J on per-pin basis * Control registers to enable/disable pull-up devices on Port AD on per-pin basis * Single control register to enable/disable pull-ups on Ports A, B, and E, on per-port basis and on BKGD pin * Control registers to enable/disable reduced output drive on Ports T, S, M, P, J and AD on per-pin basis * Single control register to enable/disable reduced output drive on Ports A, B, and E on per-port basis * Control registers to enable/disable open-drain (wired-or) mode on Ports S and M * Interrupt flag register for pin interrupts on Ports P and J * Control register to configure IRQ pin operation * Routing register to support module port relocation * Free-running clock outputs A standard port pin has the following minimum features: * Input/output selection * 5V output drive with two selectable drive strengths * 5V digital and analog input * Input with selectable pull-up or pull-down device Optional features supported on dedicated pins: * * Open drain for wired-or connections Interrupt inputs with glitch filtering
2.2
External Signal Description
This section lists and describes the signals that do connect off-chip. Table 2-1 shows all the pins and their functions that are controlled by the Port Integration Module. NOTE If there is more than one function associated with a pin, the priority is indicated by the position in the table from top (highest priority) to bottom (lowest priority).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 50 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-1. Pin Functions and Priorities
Port A B E Pin Name BKGD PA[7:0] PB[7:0] PE[7] PE[6:5] PE[4] Pin Function & Priority(1) MODC (2) BKGD GPIO GPIO ECLKX2 GPIO GPIO ECLK GPIO PE[3:2] PE[1] PE[0] T PT[7:6] PT5 GPIO IRQ GPI XIRQ GPI IOC[7:6] GPIO IOC5 (PWM5) VREG_API GPIO PT4 IOC4 (PWM4) GPIO PT[3:1] PT0 IOC[3:1] GPIO IOC0 (PWM0) GPIO S PS[3:2] PS1 PS0 GPIO TXD GPIO RXD GPIO I/O I Description MODC input during RESET Pin Function after Reset BKGD GPIO GPIO GPIO
I/O S12X_BDM communication pin I/O General purpose I/O General purpose O Free-running clock at core clock rate (ECLK x 2) I/O General purpose I/O General purpose O Free-running clock at bus clock rate or programmable downscaled bus clock
I/O General purpose I/O General purpose I I I I Maskable level- or falling edge-sensitive interrupt General purpose Non-maskable level-sensitive interrupt General purpose GPIO
I/O Timer Channels 7 - 6 I/O General purpose I/O Timer Channel 5 O O Pulse Width Modulator channel 5 VREG Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Clock
I/O General purpose I/O Timer Channel 4 O Pulse Width Modulator channel 4 I/O General purpose I/O Timer Channels 3 - 1 I/O General purpose I/O Timer Channel 0 O Pulse Width Modulator channel 0 GPIO I/O General purpose I/O General purpose O I Serial Communication Interface transmit pin Serial Communication Interface receive pin I/O General purpose I/O General purpose
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 51
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Port M
Pin Name PM5 PM4 PM3
Pin Function & Priority(1) SCK GPIO MOSI GPIO SS GPIO
I/O
Description
Pin Function after Reset GPIO
I/O Serial Peripheral Interface serial clock pin I/O General purpose I/O Serial Peripheral Interface master out/slave in pin I/O General purpose I/O Serial Peripheral Interface slave select output in master mode, input in slave mode or master mode. I/O General purpose I/O Serial Peripheral Interface master in/slave out pin I/O General purpose O I MSCAN transmit pin MSCAN receive I/O General purpose I/O General purpose I/O General purpose; with interrupt I/O Pulse Width Modulator channel 5; emergency shut-down I/O General purpose; with interrupt O Pulse Width Modulator channel 4 - 0 I/O General purpose; with interrupt I/O General purpose; with interrupt I/O General purpose; with interrupt I/O General purpose
PM2 PM1 PM0 P PP7 PP5 PP[4:0] J AD PJ[7:6] PJ[2:0] PAD[9:0]
MISO GPIO TXCAN GPIO RXCAN GPIO GPIO/KWP7 PWM5 GPIO/KWP5 PWM[4:0] GPIO/KWP[4:0] GPIO/KWJ[7:6] GPIO/KWJ[2:0] GPIO
GPIO
GPIO GPIO
AN[9:0] I ATD analog 1. Signals in brackets denote alternative module routing pins. 2. Function active when RESET asserted.
2.3
Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all Port Integration Module registers.
2.3.1
Memory Map
Table 2-2. Block Memory Map
Table 2-2 shows the register map of the Port Integration Module.
Offset or Address 0x0000 0x0001 0x0002 0x0003
Port A B
Register PORTA--Port A Data Register PORTB--Port B Data Register DDRA--Port A Data Direction Register DDRB--Port B Data Direction Register
Access R/W R/W R/W R/W
Reset Value 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
Section/Page 2.3.3/2-63 2.3.4/2-63 2.3.5/2-64 2.3.6/2-64
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 52 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-2. Block Memory Map (continued)
Port Offset or Address 0x0004 : 0x0007 E 0x0008 0x0009 0x000A : 0x000B A B E 0x000C 0x000D 0x000E : 0x001B E 0x001C 0x001D 0x001E 0x001F 0x0020 : 0x023F T 0x0240 0x0241 0x0242 0x0243 0x0244 0x0245 0x0246 0x0247 PIM Reserved Register Access R Reset Value 0x00 Section/Page 2.3.7/2-65
PORTE--Port E Data Register DDRE--Port E Data Direction Register Non-PIM address range
(2)
R/W(1) R/W1 -
0x00 0x00 -
2.3.8/2-65 2.3.9/2-66 -
PUCR--Pull-up Up Control Register RDRIV--Reduced Drive Register Non-PIM address range2
R/W1 R/W1 -
0x50 0x00 -
2.3.10/2-67 2.3.11/2-68 -
ECLKCTL--ECLK Control Register PIM Reserved IRQCR--IRQ Control Register PIM Reserved Non-PIM address range2
R/W1 R R/W1 R -
0xC0 / 0x80(3) 0x00 0x40 0x00 -
2.3.12/2-69 2.3.13/2-69 2.3.14/2-70 2.3.15/2-70 -
PTT--Port T Data Register PTIT--Port T Input Register DDRT--Port T Data Direction Register RDRT--Port T Reduced Drive Register PERT--Port T Pull Device Enable Register PPST--Port T Polarity Select Register PIM Reserved Port T Routing Register
R/W R R/W R/W R/W R/W R R/W
0x00
(4)
2.3.16/2-71 2.3.17/2-72 2.3.18/2-73 2.3.19/2-74 2.3.20/2-74 2.3.21/2-75 2.3.22/2-75 2.3.23/2-76
0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 53
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-2. Block Memory Map (continued)
Port S Offset or Address 0x0248 0x0249 0x024A 0x024B 0x024C 0x024D 0x024E 0x024F M 0x0250 0x0251 0x0252 0x0253 0x0254 0x0255 0x0256 0x0257 P 0x0258 0x0259 0x025A 0x025B 0x025C 0x025D 0x025E 0x025F 0x0260 : 0x0267 PTS--Port S Data Register PTIS--Port S Input Register DDRS--Port S Data Direction Register RDRS--Port S Reduced Drive Register PERS--Port S Pull Device Enable Register PTPS--Port S Polarity Select Register WOMS--Port S Wired-Or Mode Register PIM Reserved PTM--Port M Data Register PTIM--Port M Input Register DDRM--Port M Data Direction Register RDRM--Port M Reduced Drive Register PERM--Port M Pull Device Enable Register PPSM--Port M Polarity Select Register WOMM--Port M Wired-Or Mode Register PIM Reserved PTP--Port P Data Register PTIP--Port P Input Register DDRP--Port P Data Direction Register RDRP--Port P Reduced Drive Register PERP--Port P Pull Device Enable Register PTPP--Port P Polarity Select Register PIEP--Port P Interrupt Enable Register PIFP--Port P Interrupt Flag Register PIM Reserved Register Access R/W R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R R/W R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R R/W R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R Reset Value 0x00
4
Section/Page 2.3.24/2-77 2.3.25/2-77 2.3.26/2-78 2.3.27/2-79 2.3.28/2-79 2.3.29/2-80 2.3.30/2-80 2.3.39/2-86 2.3.32/2-81 2.3.33/2-82 2.3.34/2-83 2.3.35/2-84 2.3.36/2-85 2.3.37/2-85 2.3.38/2-86 2.3.39/2-86 2.3.40/2-87 2.3.41/2-88 2.3.42/2-88 2.3.43/2-89 2.3.44/2-90 2.3.45/2-90 2.3.46/2-91 2.3.47/2-91 2.3.48/2-92
0x00 0x00 0xFF 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
4
0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
4
0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 54 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-2. Block Memory Map (continued)
Port J Offset or Address 0x0268 0x0269 0x026A 0x026B 0x026C 0x026D 0x026E 0x026F AD 0x0270 0x0271 0x0272 0x0273 0x0274 0x0275 0x0276 0x0277 PTJ--Port J Data Register PTIJ--Port J Input Register DDRJ--Port J Data Direction Register RDRJ--Port J Reduced Drive Register PERJ--Port J Pull Device Enable Register PPSJ--Port J Polarity Select Register PIEJ--Port J Interrupt Enable Register PIFJ--Port J Interrupt Flag Register PT0AD--Port AD Data Register PT1AD--Port AD Data Register DDR0AD--Port AD Data Direction Register DDR1AD--Port AD Data Direction Register RDR0AD--Port AD Reduced Drive Register RDR1AD--Port AD Reduced Drive Register PER0AD--Port AD Pull Up Enable Register PER1AD--Port AD Pull Up Enable Register Register Access R/W R R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R R/W R R/W R R/W R R/W R Reset Value 0x00
4
Section/Page 2.3.49/2-92 2.3.50/2-93 2.3.51/2-93 2.3.52/2-94 2.3.53/2-94 2.3.54/2-95 2.3.55/2-95 2.3.56/2-96 2.3.57/2-96 2.3.58/2-97 2.3.59/2-97 2.3.60/2-98 2.3.61/2-98 2.3.62/2-99 2.3.62/2-99 2.3.64/2-100 2.3.65/2-100
0x00 0x00 0xFF 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
0x0278 PIM Reserved : 0x027F 1. Write access not applicable for one or more register bits. Refer to register description. 2. Refer to device memory map to determine related module. 3. Mode dependent. 4. Read always returns logic level on pins.
Register Name 0x0000 PORTA 0x0001 PORTB 0x0002 DDRA 0x0003 DDRB R W R W R W R W
Bit 7 PA7
6 PA6
5 PA5
4 PA4
3 PA3
2 PA2
1 PA1
Bit 0 PA0
PB7
PB6
PB5
PB4
PB3
PB2
PB1
PB0
DDRA7
DDRA6
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA2
DDRA1
DDRA0
DDRB7
DDRB6
DDRB5
DDRB4
DDRB3
DDRB2
DDRB1
DDRB0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 55
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Register Name 0x0004 R Reserved W 0x0005 R Reserved W 0x0006 R Reserved W 0x0007 R Reserved W 0x0008 PORTE 0x0009 DDRE R W R W
Bit 7 0
6 0
5 0
4 0
3 0
2 0
1 0
Bit 0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PE7
PE6
PE5
PE4
PE3
PE2
PE1
PE0
DDRE7
DDRE6
DDRE5
DDRE4
DDRE3
DDRE2
0
0
0x000A R 0x000B W Non-PIM Address Range 0x000C PUCR 0x000D RDRIV R W R W 0 0 BKPUE 0 0
Non-PIM Address Range
PUPEE
0
0
PUPBE
PUPAE
0
RDPE
0
0
RDPB
RDPA
0x000E- R 0x001B W Non-PIM Address Range 0x001C R ECLKCTL W 0x001D R Reserved W 0x001E IRQCR R W NECLK 0 NCLKX2 0 DIV16 0
Non-PIM Address Range
EDIV4 0
EDIV3 0
EDIV2 0
EDIV1 0
EDIV0 0
IRQE 0
IRQEN 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0x001F R Reserved W
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 56 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Register Name 0x0020- R 0x023F W Non-PIM Address Range 0x0240 PTT 0x0241 PTIT 0x0242 DDRT 0x0243 RDRT 0x0244 PERT 0x0245 PPST R W R W R W R W R W R W
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Non-PIM Address Range
PTT7 PTIT7
PTT6 PTIT6
PTT5 PTIT5
PTT4 PTIT4
PTT3 PTIT3
PTT2 PTIT2
PTT1 PTIT1
PTT0 PTIT0
DDRT7
DDRT6
DDRT5
DDRT4
DDRT3
DDRT2
DDRT1
DDRT0
RDRT7
RDRT6
RDRT5
RDRT4
RDRT3
RDRT2
RDRT1
RDRT0
PERT7
PERT6
PERT5
PERT4
PERT3
PERT2
PERT1
PERT0
PPST7 0
PPST6 0
PPST5 0
PPST4 0
PPST3 0
PPST2 0
PPST1 0
PPST0 0
0x0246 R Reserved W 0x0247 PTTRR 0x0248 PTS 0x0249 PTIS 0x024A DDRS 0x024B RDRS 0x024C PERS 0x024D PPSS R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
0
0
PTTRR5 0
PTTRR4 0
0
0
0
PTTRR0
0
0
PTS3 PTIS3
PTS2 PTIS2
PTS1 PTIS1
PTS0 PTIS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRS3
DDRS2
DDRS1
DDRS0
0
0
0
0
RDRS3
RDRS2
RDRS1
RDRS0
0
0
0
0
PERS3
PERS2
PERS1
PERS0
0
0
0
0
PPSS3
PPSS2
PPSS1
PPSS0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 57
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Register Name 0x024E WOMS R W
Bit 7 0
6 0
5 0
4 0
3 WOMS3 0
2 WOMS2 0
1 WOMS1 0
Bit 0 WOMS0 0
0x024F R Reserved W 0x0250 PTM 0x0251 PTIM 0x0252 DDRM 0x0253 RDRM 0x0254 PERM 0x0255 PPSM 0x0256 WOMM R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
0
0
0
0
0
0
PTM5 PTIM5
PTM4 PTIM4
PTM3 PTIM3
PTM2 PTIM2
PTM1 PTIM1
PTM0 PTIM0
0
0
0
0
DDRM5
DDRM4
DDRM3
DDRM2
DDRM1
DDRM0
0
0
RDRM5
RDRM4
RDRM3
RDRM2
RDRM1
RDRM0
0
0
PERM5
PERM4
PERM3
PERM2
PERM1
PERM0
0
0
PPSM5
PPSM4
PPSM3
PPSM2
PPSM1
PPSM0
0
0
WOMM5 0
WOMM4 0
WOMM3 0
WOMM2 0
WOMM1 0
WOMM0 0
0x0257 R Reserved W 0x0258 PTP 0x0259 PTIP 0x025A DDRP 0x025B RDRP 0x025C PERP 0x025D PPSP R W R W R W R W R W R W
0
0
PTP7 PTIP7
0
PTP5 PTIP5
PTP4 PTIP4
PTP3 PTIP3
PTP2 PTIP2
PTP1 PTIP1
PTP0 PTIP0
0
DDRP7
0
DDRP5
DDRP4
DDRP3
DDRP2
DDRP1
DDRP0
RDRP7
0
RDRP5
RDRP4
RDRP3
RDRP2
RDRP1
RDRP0
PERP7
0
PERP5
PERP4
PERP3
PERP2
PERP1
PERP0
PPSP7
0
PPSP5
PPSP4
PPSP3
PPSP2
PPSP1
PPSP0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 58 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Register Name 0x025E PIEP 0x025F PIFP R W R W
Bit 7
6 0
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PIEP7
PIEP5
PIEP4
PIEP3
PIEP2
PIEP1
PIEP0
PIFP7 0
0
PIFP5 0
PIFP4 0
PIFP3 0
PIFP2 0
PIFP1 0
PIFP0 0
0x0260 R Reserved W 0x0261 R Reserved W 0x0262 R Reserved W 0x0263 R Reserved W 0x0264 R Reserved W 0x0265 R Reserved W 0x0266 R Reserved W 0x0267 R Reserved W 0x0268 PTJ 0x0269 PTIJ 0x026A DDRJ 0x026B RDRJ 0x026C PERJ R W R W R W R W R W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PTJ7 PTIJ7
PTJ6 PTIJ6
0
0
0
PTJ2 PTIJ2
PTJ1 PTIJ1
PTJ0 PTIJ0
0
0
0
DDRJ7
DDRJ6
0
0
0
DDRJ2
DDRJ1
DDRJ0
RDRJ7
RDRJ6
0
0
0
RDRJ2
RDRJ1
RDRJ0
PERJ7
PERJ6
0
0
0
PERJ2
PERJ1
PERJ0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 59
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Register Name 0x026D PPSJ 0x026E PIEJ 0x026F PIFJ 0x0270 PT0AD 0x0271 PT1AD R W R W R W R W R W
Bit 7 PPSJ7
6 PPSJ6
5 0
4 0
3 0
2 PPSJ2
1 PPSJ1
Bit 0 PPSJ0
PIEJ7
PIEJ6
0
0
0
PIEJ2
PIEJ1
PIEJ0
PIFJ7 0
PIFJ6 0
0
0
0
PIFJ2 0
PIFJ1
PIFJ0
0
0
0
PT0AD1
PT0AD0
PT1AD7 0
PT1AD6 0
PT1AD5 0
PT1AD4 0
PT1AD3 0
PT1AD2 0
PT1AD1
PT1AD0
0x0272 R DDR0AD W
DDR0AD1
DDR0AD0
0x0273 R DDR1AD W DDR1AD7 0x0274 R RDR0AD W 0
DDR1AD6 0
DDR1AD5 0
DDR1AD4 0
DDR1AD3 0
DDR1AD2 0
DDR1AD1
DDR1AD0
RDR0AD1
RDR0AD0
0x0275 R RDR1AD W RDR1AD7 0x0276 R PER0AD W 0
RDR1AD6 0
RDR1AD5 0
RDR1AD4 0
RDR1AD3 0
RDR1AD2 0
RDR1AD1
RDR1AD0
PER0AD1
PER0AD0
0x0277 R PER1AD W PER1AD7 0x0278 R Reserved W 0x0279 R Reserved W 0x027A R Reserved W 0x027B R Reserved W 0
PER1AD6 0
PER1AD5 0
PER1AD4 0
PER1AD3 0
PER1AD2 0
PER1AD1 0
PER1AD0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 60 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Register Name 0x027C R Reserved W 0x027D R Reserved W 0x027E R Reserved W 0x027F R Reserved W
Bit 7 0
6 0
5 0
4 0
3 0
2 0
1 0
Bit 0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
2.3.2
Register Descriptions
The following table summarizes the effect of the various configuration bits, i.e. data direction (DDR), output level (IO), reduced drive (RDR), pull enable (PE), pull select (PS) on the pin function and pull device activity. The configuration bit PS is used for two purposes: 1. Configure the sensitive interrupt edge (rising or falling), if interrupt is enabled. 2. Select either a pull-up or pull-down device if PE is active.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 61
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-3. Pin Configuration Summary
DDR 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 IO x x x x x x x 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 RDR x x x x x x x 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 PE 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 x x x x x x x PS(1) x 0 1 0 1 0 1 x x x x 0 1 0 1 IE(2) 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Input Input Input Input Input Input Input Output, full drive to 0 Output, full drive to 1 Output, reduced drive to 0 Output, reduced drive to 1 Output, full drive to 0 Output, full drive to 1 Output, reduced drive to 0 Output, reduced drive to 1 Function Pull Device Disabled Pull Up Pull Down Disabled Disabled Pull Up Pull Down Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Interrupt Disabled Disabled Disabled Falling edge Rising edge Falling edge Rising edge Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Falling edge Rising edge Falling edge Rising edge
1 1 1 x 1. Always "0" on Port A, B, E, and AD. 2. Applicable only on Port P and J.
NOTE All register bits in this module are completely synchronous to internal clocks during a register read. NOTE Figure of port data registers also display the alternative functions if applicable on the related pin as defined in Table 2-1. Names in brackets denote the availability of the function when using a specific routing option. NOTE Figures of module routing registers also display the module instance or module channel associated with the related routing bit.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 62 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.3
Port A Data Register (PORTA)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0000
7
R PA7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PA6 PA5 PA4 PA3 PA2 PA1 PA0
Figure 2-1. Port A Data Register (PORTA)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
Table 2-4. PORTA Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 PA Description Port A general purpose input/output data--Data Register The associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read.
2.3.4
Port B Data Register (PORTB)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0001
7
R PB7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PB6 PB5 PB4 PB3 PB2 PB1 PB0
Figure 2-2. Port B Data Register (PORTB)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
Table 2-5. PORTB Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 PB Description Port B general purpose input/output data--Data Register The associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 63
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.5
Port A Data Direction Register (DDRA)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0002
7
R DDRA7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0
Figure 2-3. Port A Data Direction Register (DDRA)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-6. DDRA Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 DDRA Description Port A Data Direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
2.3.6
Port B Data Direction Register (DDRB)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0003
7
R DDRB7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRB6 DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0
Figure 2-4. Port B Data Direction Register (DDRB)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-7. DDRB Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 DDRB Description Port B Data Direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 64 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.7
PIM Reserved Register
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0004 to 0x0007
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-5. PIM Reserved Register
1. Read: Always reads 0x00 Write: Unimplemented
2.3.8
Port E Data Register (PORTE)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0008
7
R PE7 W Altern. Function Reset ECLKX2 0 -- 0 -- 0 ECLK 0 -- 0 -- 0 PE6 PE5 PE4 PE3 PE2
PE1
PE0
IRQ --(2)
XIRQ --2
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-6. Port E Data Register (PORTE)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime 2. These registers are reset to zero. Two bus clock cycles after reset release the register values are updated with the associated pin values.
Table 2-8. PORTE Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 PE Description Port E general purpose input/output data--Data Register, ECLKX2 output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The ECLKX2 output function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled. 6-5, 3-2 PE Port E general purpose input/output data--Data Register The associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 65
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-8. PORTE Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 4 PE Description Port E general purpose input/output data--Data Register, ECLK output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The ECLK output function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled. 1 PE 0 PE Port E general purpose input data and interrupt--Data Register, IRQ input. This pin can be used as general purpose and IRQ input. Port E general purpose input data and interrupt--Data Register, XIRQ input. This pin can be used as general purpose and XIRQ input.
2.3.9
Port E Data Direction Register (DDRE)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0009
7
R DDRE7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRE6 DDRE5 DDRE4 DDRE3 DDRE2
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-7. Port E Data Direction Register (DDRE)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-9. DDRE Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-2 DDRE Description Port E Data Direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 66 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.10
Ports A, B, E, BKGD pin Pull-up Control Register (PUCR)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x000C
7
R W Reset
0 BKPUE 0 1
0 PUPEE 0 1
0
0 PUPBE PUPAE 0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-8. Ports ABEK, BKGD pin Pull-up Control Register (PUCR)
1. Read:Anytime in single-chip modes. Write:Anytime, except BKPUE which is writable in Special Single-Chip Mode only.
Table 2-10. PUCR Register Field Descriptions
Field 6 BKPUE Description BKGD pin pull-up Enable--Enable pull-up device on pin This bit configures whether a pull-up device is activated, if the pin is used as input. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. 1 Pull-up device enabled 0 Pull-up device disabled 4 PUPEE Port E Pull-up Enable--Enable pull-up devices on all port input pins except pins 5 and 6 This bit configures whether a pull-up device is activated on all associated port input pins. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. Pins 5 and 6 have pull-down devices enabled only during reset. This bit has no effect on these pins. 1 Pull-up device enabled 0 Pull-up device disabled 1 PUPBE Port B Pull-up Enable--Enable pull-up devices on all port input pins This bit configures whether a pull-up device is activated on all associated port input pins. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. 1 Pull-up device enabled 0 Pull-up device disabled 0 PUPAE Port A Pull-up Enable--Enable pull-up devices on all port input pins This bit configures whether a pull-up device is activated on all associated port input pins. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. 1 Pull-up device enabled 0 Pull-up device disabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 67
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.11
Ports A, B, E Reduced Drive Register (RDRIV)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x000D
7
R W Reset
0
0
0 RDPE
0
0 RDPB RDPA 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-9. Ports ABEK Reduced Drive Register (RDRIV)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-11. RDRIV Register Field Descriptions
Field 4 RDPE Description Port E reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output port This bit configures the drive strength of all associated port output pins as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled 1 RDPE Port B reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output port This bit configures the drive strength of all associated port output pins as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled 0 RDPA Port A reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output port This bit configures the drive strength of all associated port output pins as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 68 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.12
ECLK Control Register (ECLKCTL)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7
Address 0x001C
R NECLK W Mode Dependent 0 NCLKX2 DIV16 EDIV4 EDIV3 EDIV2 EDIV1 EDIV0
Reset:
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Special single-chip Normal single-chip
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-10. ECLK Control Register (ECLKCTL)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-12. ECLKCTL Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 NECLK Description No ECLK--Disable ECLK output This bit controls the availability of a free-running clock on the ECLK pin. This clock has a fixed rate of equivalent to the internal bus clock. 1 ECLK disabled 0 ECLK enabled 6 NCLKX2 No ECLKX2--Disable ECLKX2 output This bit controls the availability of a free-running clock on the ECLKX2 pin. This clock has a fixed rate of twice the internal bus clock. 1 ECLKX2 disabled 0 ECLKX2 enabled 5 DIV16 Free-running ECLK pre-divider--Divide by 16 This bit enables a divide-by-16 stage on the selected EDIV rate. 1 Divider enabled: ECLK rate = EDIV rate divided by 16 0 Divider disabled: ECLK rate = EDIV rate 4-0 EDIV Free-running ECLK Divider--Configure ECLK rate These bits determine the rate of the free-running clock on the ECLK pin. 00000 ECLK rate = bus clock rate 00001 ECLK rate = bus clock rate divided by 2 00010 ECLK rate = bus clock rate divided by 3,... 11111 ECLK rate = bus clock rate divided by 32
2.3.13
PIM Reserved Register
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12
Freescale Semiconductor
69
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Address 0x001D
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Access: User read(1)
0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-11. PIM Reserved Register
1. Read: Always reads 0x00 Write: Unimplemented
2.3.14
IRQ Control Register (IRQCR)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x001E
7
R IRQE W Reset 0 1 IRQEN
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-12. IRQ Control Register (IRQCR)
1. Read: See individual bit descriptions below. Write: See individual bit descriptions below.
Table 2-13. IRQCR Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 IRQE IRQ select edge sensitive only-- Special mode: Read or write anytime. Normal mode: Read anytime, write once. 1 IRQ pin configured to respond only to falling edges. Falling edges on the IRQ pin will be detected anytime IRQE=1 and will be cleared only upon a reset or the servicing of the IRQ interrupt. 0 IRQ pin configured for low level recognition 6 IRQEN IRQ enable-- Read or write anytime. 1 IRQ pin is connected to interrupt logic 0 IRQ pin is disconnected from interrupt logic Description
2.3.15
PIM Reserved Register
This register is reserved for factory testing of the PIM module and is not available in normal operation. Writing to this register when in special modes can alter the pin functionality.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 70 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Address 0x001F
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Access: User read(1)
0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-13. PIM Reserved Register
1. Read: Always reads 0x00 Write: Unimplemented
2.3.16
Port T Data Register (PTT)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0240
7
R PTT7 W Altern. Function IOC7 -- -- Reset 0 IOC6 -- -- 0 IOC5 (PWM5) VREG_API 0 IOC4 (PWM4) -- 0 IOC3 -- -- 0 IOC2 -- -- 0 IOC1 -- -- 0 IOC0 (PWM0) -- 0 PTT6 PTT5 PTT4 PTT3 PTT2 PTT1 PTT0
Figure 2-14. Port T Data Register (PTT)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 71
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-14. PTT Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 3-1 PTT Description Port T general purpose input/output data--Data Register, TIM output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The TIM output function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if the related channel is enabled. 5 PTT Port T general purpose input/output data--Data Register, TIM output, routed PWM output, VREG_API output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The TIM output function takes precedence over the routed PWM, VREG_API function and the general purpose I/O function if the related channel is enabled. * The routed PWM function takes precedence over VREG_API and the general purpose I/O function if the related channel is enabled. * The VREG_API takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled. 4,0 PTT Port T general purpose input/output data--Data Register, TIM output, routed PWM output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The TIM output function takes precedence over the routed PWM and the general purpose I/O function if the related channel is enabled. * The routed PWM function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if the related channel is enabled.
2.3.17
Port T Input Register (PTIT)
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0241
7
R W Reset
PTIT7
PTIT6
PTIT5
PTIT4
PTIT3
PTIT2
PTIT1
PTIT0
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
= Unimplemented or Reserved 1. Read: Anytime Write:Never, writes to this register have no effect.
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-15. Port T Input Register (PTIT)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 72 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-15. PTIT Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 PTIT Description Port T input data-- A read always returns the buffered input state of the associated pin. It can be used to detect overload or short circuit conditions on output pins.
2.3.18
Port T Data Direction Register (DDRT)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0242
7
R DDRT7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRT6 DDRT5 DDRT4 DDRT3 DDRT2 DDRT1 DDRT0
Figure 2-16. Port T Data Direction Register (DDRT)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-16. DDRT Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 3-1 DDRT Description Port T data direction-- This bit determines whether the pin is an input or output. The TIM forces the I/O state to be an output for a timer port associated with an enabled output compare. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 5 DDRT Port T data direction-- This bit determines whether the pin is an input or output. The TIM forces the I/O state to be an output for a timer port associated with an enabled output compare. Else the routed PWM forces the I/O state to be an output for an enabled channel. Else the VREG_API forces the I/O state to be an output if enabled. In these cases the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 4,0 DDRT Port T data direction-- This bit determines whether the pin is an input or output. The TIM forces the I/O state to be an output for a timer port associated with an enabled output compare. Else the routed PWM forces the I/O state to be an output for an enabled channel. In these cases the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 73
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.19
Port T Reduced Drive Register (RDRT)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0243
7
R RDRT7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RDRT6 RDRT5 RDRT4 RDRT3 RDRT2 RDRT1 RDRT0
Figure 2-17. Port T Reduced Drive Register (RDRT)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-17. RDRT Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 RDRT Description Port T reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output pin This bit configures the drive strength of the associated output pin as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled
2.3.20
Port T Pull Device Enable Register (PERT)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0244
7
R PERT7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PERT6 PERT5 PERT4 PERT3 PERT2 PERT1 PERT0
Figure 2-18. Port T Pull Device Enable Register (PERT)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-18. PERT Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 PERT Description Port T pull device enable--Enable pull device on input pin This bit controls whether a pull device on the associated port input pin is active. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. The polarity is selected by the related polarity select register bit. 1 Pull device enabled 0 Pull device disabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 74 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.21
Port T Polarity Select Register (PPST)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0245
7
R PPST7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PPST6 PPST5 PPST4 PPST3 PPST2 PPST1 PPST0
Figure 2-19. Port T Polarity Select Register (PPST)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-19. PPST Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 PPST Description Port T pull device select--Configure pull device polarity on input pin This bit selects a pull-up or a pull-down device if enabled on the associated port input pin. 1 A pull-down device is selected 0 A pull-up device is selected
2.3.22
PIM Reserved Register
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0246
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-20. PIM Reserved Register
1. Read: Always reads 0x00 Write: Unimplemented
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 75
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.23
Port T Routing Register (PTTRR)
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0247
7
R W Routing Option Reset
0
0 PTTRR5 PTTRR4
0
0
0 PTTRR0
-- 0
-- 0
PWM5 0
PWM4 0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
PWM0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 2-21. Port T Routing Register (PTTRR)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
This register configures the re-routing of PWM channels on alternative pins on Port T.
Table 2-20. Port T Routing Register Field Descriptions
Field 5 PTTRR Description Port T data direction-- This register controls the routing of PWM channel 5. 1 PWM5 routed to PT5 0 PWM5 routed to PP5 4 PTTRR Port T data direction-- This register controls the routing of PWM channel 4. 1 PWM4 routed to PT4 0 PWM4 routed to PP4 0 PTTRR Port T data direction-- This register controls the routing of PWM channel 0. 1 PWM0 routed to PT0 0 PWM0 routed to PP0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 76 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.24
Port S Data Register (PTS)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0248
7
R W Altern. Function Reset
0
0
0
0 PTS3 PTS2 PTS1 PTS0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
TXD 0
RXD 0
Figure 2-22. Port S Data Register (PTS)
1. Read: Anytime The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
Table 2-21. PTS Register Field Descriptions
Field 3-2 PTS Description Port S general purpose input/output data--Data Register When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. Port S general purpose input/output data--Data Register, SCI TXD output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The SCI function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled. 0 PTS Port S general purpose input/output data--Data Register, SCI RXD input When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The SCI function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled.
1 PTS
2.3.25
Port S Input Register (PTIS)
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0249
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
PTIS3
PTIS2
PTIS1
PTIS0
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
= Unimplemented or Reserved
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-23. Port S Input Register (PTIS)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 77
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
1. Read: Anytime Write:Never, writes to this register have no effect.
Table 2-22. PTIS Register Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 PTIS Description Port S input data-- A read always returns the buffered input state of the associated pin. It can be used to detect overload or short circuit conditions on output pins.
2.3.26
Port S Data Direction Register (DDRS)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x024A
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0 DDRS3 DDRS2 0 DDRS1 0 DDRS0 0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-24. Port S Data Direction Register (DDRS)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-23. DDRS Register Field Descriptions
Field 3-2 DDRS Description Port S data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 1 DDRS Port S data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. Depending on the configuration of the enabled SCI the I/O state will be forced to be input or output. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 0 DDRS Port S data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. Depending on the configuration of the enabled SCI the I/O state will be forced to be input or output. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 78 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.27
Port S Reduced Drive Register (RDRS)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x024B
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0 RDRS3 RDRS2 0 RDRS1 0 RDRS0 0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-25. Port S Reduced Drive Register (RDRS)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-24. RDRS Register Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 RDRS Description Port S reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output pin This bit configures the drive strength of the associated output pin as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled
2.3.28
Port S Pull Device Enable Register (PERS)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x024C
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0 PERS3 PERS2 1 PERS1 1 PERS0 1
0
0
0
0
1
Figure 2-26. Port S Pull Device Enable Register (PERS)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-25. PERS Register Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 PERS Description Port S pull device enable--Enable pull device on input pin or wired-or output pin This bit controls whether a pull device on the associated port input pin is active. If a pin is used as output this bit has only effect if used in wired-or mode. The polarity is selected by the related polarity select register bit. 1 Pull device enabled 0 Pull device disabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 79
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.29
Port S Polarity Select Register (PPSS)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x024D
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0 PPSS3 PPSS2 0 PPSS1 0 PPSS0 0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-27. Port S Polarity Select Register (PPSS)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-26. PPSS Register Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 PPSS Description Port S pull device select--Configure pull device polarity on input pin This bit selects a pull-up or a pull-down device if enabled on the associated port input pin. 1 A pull-down device is selected 0 A pull-up device is selected
2.3.30
Port S Wired-Or Mode Register (WOMS)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x024E
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0 WOMS3 WOMS2 0 WOMS1 0 WOMS0 0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-28. Port S Wired-Or Mode Register (WOMS)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-27. WOMS Register Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 WOMS Description Port S wired-or mode--Enable open-drain functionality on output pin This bit configures an output pin as wired-or (open-drain) or push-pull. In wired-or mode a logic "0" is driven active low while a logic "1" remains undriven. This allows a multipoint connection of several serial modules. The bit has no influence on pins used as input. 1 Output buffer operates as open-drain output. 0 Output buffer operates as push-pull output.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 80 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.31
PIM Reserved Register
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x024F
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved 1. Read: Always reads 0x00 Write: Unimplemented
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-29. PIM Reserved Register
2.3.32
Port M Data Register (PTM)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0250
7
R W Altern. Function Reset
0
0 PTM5 PTM4 PTM3 PTM2 PTM1 PTM0
-- 0
-- 0
SCK 0
MOSI 0
SS 0
MISO 0
TXCAN 0
RXCAN 0
Figure 2-30. Port M Data Register (PTM)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
Table 2-28. PTM Register Field Descriptions
Field 5 PTM Description Port M general purpose input/output data--Data Register, SPI SCK input/output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The SPI function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled. 4 PTM Port M general purpose input/output data--Data Register, SPI MOSI input/output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The SPI function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 81
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-28. PTM Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 3 PTM Description Port M general purpose input/output data--Data Register, SPI SS input/output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The SPI function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled. 2 PTM Port M general purpose input/output data--Data Register, SPI MISO input/output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The SPI function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled. 1 PTM Port M general purpose input/output data--Data Register, CAN TXCAN output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The CAN function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled. 0 PTM Port M general purpose input/output data--Data Register, CAN RXCAN input When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The CAN function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if enabled.
2.3.33
Port M Input Register (PTIM)
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0251
7
R W Reset
0
0
PTIM5
PTIM4
PTIM3
PTIM2
PTIM1
PTIM0
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
= Unimplemented or Reserved 1. Read: Anytime Write:Never, writes to this register have no effect.
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-31. Port M Input Register (PTIM)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 82 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-29. PTIM Register Field Descriptions
Field 5-0 PTIM Description Port M input data-- A read always returns the buffered input state of the associated pin. It can be used to detect overload or short circuit conditions on output pins.
2.3.34
Port M Data Direction Register (DDRM)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0252
7
R W Reset
0
0 DDRM5 DDRM4 0 DDRM3 0 DDRM2 0 DDRM1 0 DDRM0 0
0
0
0
Figure 2-32. Port M Data Direction Register (DDRM)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-30. DDRM Register Field Descriptions
Field 5 DDRM Description Port M data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. Depending on the configuration of the enabled SPI the I/O state will be forced to be input or output. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 4 DDRM Port M data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. Depending on the configuration of the enabled SPI the I/O state will be forced to be input or output. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 3 DDRM Port M data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. Depending on the configuration of the enabled SPI the I/O state will be forced to be input or output. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 83
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-30. DDRM Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 2 DDRM Description Port M data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. Depending on the configuration of the enabled SPI the I/O state will be forced to be input or output. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 1 DDRM Port M data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. The enabled CAN forces the I/O state to be an output. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 0 DDRM Port M data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. The enabled CAN forces the I/O state to be an input. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
2.3.35
Port M Reduced Drive Register (RDRM)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0253
7
R W Reset
0
0 RDRM5 RDRM4 0 RDRM3 0 RDRM2 0 RDRM1 0 RDRM0 0
0
0
0
Figure 2-33. Port M Reduced Drive Register (RDRM)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-31. RDRM Register Field Descriptions
Field 5-0 RDRM Description Port M reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output pin This bit configures the drive strength of the associated output pin as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 84 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.36
Port M Pull Device Enable Register (PERM)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0254
7
R W Reset
0
0 PERM5 PERM4 0 PERM3 0 PERM2 0 PERM1 0 PERM0 0
0
0
0
Figure 2-34. Port M Pull Device Enable Register (PERM)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-32. PERM Register Field Descriptions
Field 5-0 PERM Description Port M pull device enable--Enable pull device on input pin or wired-or output pin This bit controls whether a pull device on the associated port input pin is active. If a pin is used as output this bit has only effect if used in wired-or mode. The polarity is selected by the related polarity select register bit. 1 Pull device enabled 0 Pull device disabled
2.3.37
Port M Polarity Select Register (PPSM)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0255
7
R W Reset
0
0 PPSM5 PPSM4 0 PPSM3 0 PPSM2 0 PPSM1 0 PPSM0 0
0
0
0
Figure 2-35. Port M Polarity Select Register (PPSM)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-33. PPSM Register Field Descriptions
Field 5-0 PPSM Description Port M pull device select--Configure pull device polarity on input pin This bit selects a pull-up or a pull-down device if enabled on the associated port input pin. If CAN is active the selection of a pull-down device on the RXCAN input will have no effect. 1 A pull-down device is selected 0 A pull-up device is selected
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 85
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.38
Port M Wired-Or Mode Register (WOMM)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0256
7
R W Reset
0
0 WOMM5 WOMM4 0 WOMM3 0 WOMM2 0 WOMM1 0 WOMM0 0
0
0
0
Figure 2-36. Port M Wired-Or Mode Register (WOMM)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-34. WOMM Register Field Descriptions
Field 5-0 WOMM Description Port M wired-or mode--Enable open-drain functionality on output pin This bit configures an output pin as wired-or (open-drain) or push-pull. In wired-or mode a logic "0" is driven active low while a logic "1" remains undriven. This allows a multipoint connection of several serial modules. The bit has no influence on pins used as input. 1 Output buffer operates as open-drain output. 0 Output buffer operates as push-pull output.
2.3.39
PIM Reserved Register
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0257
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved 1. Read: Always reads 0x00 Write: Unimplemented
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-37. PIM Reserved Register
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 86 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.40
Port P Data Register (PTP)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0258
7
R PTP7 W Altern. Function Reset -- 0
0 PTP5 PTP4 PTP3 PTP2 PTP1 PTP0
-- 0
PWM5 0
PWM4 0
PWM3 0
PWM2 0
PWM1 0
PWM0 0
Figure 2-38. Port P Data Register (PTP)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
Table 2-35. PTP Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 PTP Description Port P general purpose input/output data--Data Register, pin interrupt input/output The associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * Pin interrupts can be generated if enabled in input or output mode. 5 PTP Port P general purpose input/output data--Data Register, PWM input/output, pin interrupt input/output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The PWM function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if the related channel or the emergency shut-down feature is enabled. * Pin interrupts can be generated if enabled in input or output mode. 4-0 PTP Port P general purpose input/output data--Data Register, PWM output, pin interrupt input/output When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * The PWM function takes precedence over the general purpose I/O function if the related channel is enabled. * Pin interrupts can be generated if enabled in input or output mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 87
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.41
Port P Input Register (PTIP)
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0259
7
R W Reset
PTIP7
0
PTIP5
PTIP4
PTIP3
PTIP2
PTIP1
PTIP0
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
= Unimplemented or Reserved 1. Read: Anytime Write:Never, writes to this register have no effect.
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-39. Port P Input Register (PTIP)
Table 2-36. PTIP Register Field Descriptions
Field 7,5-0 PTIP Description Port P input data-- A read always returns the buffered input state of the associated pin. It can be used to detect overload or short circuit conditions on output pins.
2.3.42
Port P Data Direction Register (DDRP)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x025A
7
R DDRP7 W Reset 0
0 DDRP5 0 0 DDRP4 0 DDRP3 0 DDRP2 0 DDRP1 0 DDRP0 0
Figure 2-40. Port P Data Direction Register (DDRP)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-37. DDRP Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 DDRP Description Port P data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 88 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Table 2-37. DDRP Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 5 DDRP Description Port P data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. The PWM forces the I/O state to be an output for an enabled channel. If the emergency shut-down feature is enabled this pin is an input. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input 4-0 DDRP Port P data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. The PWM forces the I/O state to be an output for an enabled channel. In this case the data direction bit will not change. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
2.3.43
Port P Reduced Drive Register (RDRP)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x025B
7
R RDRP7 W Reset 0
0 RDRP5 0 0 RDRP4 0 RDRP3 0 RDRP2 0 RDRP1 0 RDRP0 0
Figure 2-41. Port P Reduced Drive Register (RDRP)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-38. RDRP Register Field Descriptions
Field 7,5-0 RDRP Description Port P reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output pin This bit configures the drive strength of the associated output pin as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 89
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.44
Port P Pull Device Enable Register (PERP)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x025C
7
R PPSP7 W Reset 0
0 PPSP5 0 0 PPSP4 0 PPSP3 0 PPSP2 0 PPSP1 0 PPSP0 0
Figure 2-42. Port P Pull Device Enable Register (PERP)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-39. PERP Register Field Descriptions
Field 7,5-0 PERP Description Port P pull device enable--Enable pull device on input pin This bit controls whether a pull device on the associated port input pin is active. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. The polarity is selected by the related polarity select register bit. 1 Pull device enabled 0 Pull device disabled
2.3.45
Port P Polarity Select Register (PPSP)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x025D
7
R PPSP7 W Reset 0
0 PPSP5 0 0 PPSP4 0 PPSP3 0 PPSP2 0 PPSP1 0 PPSP0 0
Figure 2-43. Port P Polarity Select Register (PPSP)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-40. PPSP Register Field Descriptions
Field 7,5-0 PPSP Description Port P pull device select--Configure pull device and pin interrupt edge polarity on input pin This bit selects a pull-up or a pull-down device if enabled on the associated port input pin. This bit also selects the polarity of the active pin interrupt edge. 1 A pull-down device is selected; rising edge selected 0 A pull-up device is selected; falling edge selected
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 90 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.46
Read: Anytime.
Port P Interrupt Enable Register (PIEP)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x025E
7
R PIEP7 W Reset 0
0 PIEP5 0 0 PIEP4 0 PIEP3 0 PIEP2 0 PIEP1 0 PIEP0 0
Figure 2-44. Port P Interrupt Enable Register (PIEP)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-41. PIEP Register Field Descriptions
Field 7,5-0 PIEP Description Port P interrupt enable-- This bit enables or disables on the edge sensitive pin interrupt on the associated pin. 1 Interrupt is enabled 0 Interrupt is disabled (interrupt flag masked)
2.3.47
Port P Interrupt Flag Register (PIFP)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x025F
7
R PIFP7 W Reset 0
0 PIFP5 0 0 PIFP4 0 PIFP3 0 PIFP2 0 PIFP1 0 PIFP0 0
Figure 2-45. Port P Interrupt Flag Register (PIFP)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-42. PIFP Register Field Descriptions
Field 7,5-0 PIFP Description Port P interrupt flag-- The flag bit is set after an active edge was applied to the associated input pin. This can be a rising or a falling edge based on the state of the polarity select register. Writing a logic "1" to the corresponding bit field clears the flag. 1 Active edge on the associated bit has occurred (an interrupt will occur if the associated enable bit is set) 0 No active edge occurred
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 91
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.48
PIM Reserved Registers
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0260-0x267
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved 1. Read: Always reads 0x00 Write: Unimplemented
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-46. PIM Reserved Registers
2.3.49
Port J Data Register (PTJ)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0268
7
R PTJ7 W Reset 0 0 PTJ6
0
0
0 PTJ2 PTJ1 0 PTJ0 0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-47. Port J Data Register (PTJ)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
Table 2-43. PTJ Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 2-0 PTJ Description Port J general purpose input/output data--Data Register, pin interrupt input/output The associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read. * Pin interrupts can be generated if enabled in input or output mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 92 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.50
Port J Input Register (PTIJ)
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0269
7
R W Reset
PTIJ7
PTIJ6
0
0
0
PTIJ2
PTIJ1
PTIJ0
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
= Unimplemented or Reserved 1. Read: Anytime Write:Never, writes to this register have no effect.
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-48. Port J Input Register (PTIJ)
Table 2-44. PTIJ Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 2-0 PTIJ Description Port J input data-- A read always returns the buffered input state of the associated pin. It can be used to detect overload or short circuit conditions on output pins.
2.3.51
Port J Data Direction Register (DDRJ)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x026A
7
R DDRJ7 W Reset 0 0 DDRJ6
0
0
0 DDRJ2 DDRJ1 0 DDRJ0 0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-49. Port J Data Direction Register (DDRJ)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-45. DDRJ Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 2-0 DDRJ Description Port J data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 93
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.52
Port J Reduced Drive Register (RDRJ)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x026B
7
R RDRJ7 W Reset 0 0 RDRJ6
0
0
0 RDRJ2 RDRJ1 0 RDRJ0 0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-50. Port J Reduced Drive Register (RDRJ)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-46. RDRJ Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 2-0 RDRJ Description Port J reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output pin This bit configures the drive strength of the associated output pin as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled
2.3.53
Port J Pull Device Enable Register (PERJ)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x026C
7
R PERJ7 W Reset 1 1 PERJ6
0
0
0 PERJ2 PERJ1 1 PERJ0 1
0
0
0
1
Figure 2-51. Port J Pull Device Enable Register (PERJ)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-47. PERJ Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 2-0 PERJ Description Port J pull device enable--Enable pull device on input pin This bit controls whether a pull device on the associated port input pin is active. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. The polarity is selected by the related polarity select register bit. 1 Pull device enabled 0 Pull device disabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 94 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.54
Port J Polarity Select Register (PPSJ)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x026D
7
R PPSJ7 W Reset 0 0 PPSJ6
0
0
0 PPSJ2 PPSJ1 0 PPSJ0 0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-52. Port J Polarity Select Register (PPSJ)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-48. PPSJ Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 2-0 PPSJ Description Port J pull device select--Configure pull device and pin interrupt edge polarity on input pin This bit selects a pull-up or a pull-down device if enabled on the associated port input pin. This bit also selects the polarity of the active pin interrupt edge. 1 A pull-down device is selected; rising edge selected 0 A pull-up device is selected; falling edge selected
2.3.55
Read: Anytime.
Port J Interrupt Enable Register (PIEJ)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x026E
7
R PIEJ7 W Reset 0 0 PIEJ6
0
0
0 PIEJ2 PIEJ1 0 PIEJ0 0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-53. Port J Interrupt Enable Register (PIEJ)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-49. PIEJ Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 2-0 PIEJ Description Port J interrupt enable-- This bit enables or disables on the edge sensitive pin interrupt on the associated pin. 1 Interrupt is enabled 0 Interrupt is disabled (interrupt flag masked)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 95
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.56
Port J Interrupt Flag Register (PIFJ)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x026F
7
R PIFJ7 W Reset 0 0 PIFJ6
0
0
0 PIFJ2 PIFJ1 0 PIFJ0 0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-54. Port J Interrupt Flag Register (PIFJ)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-50. PIFJ Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6, 2-0 PIFJ Description Port J interrupt flag-- The flag bit is set after an active edge was applied to the associated input pin. This can be a rising or a falling edge based on the state of the polarity select register. Writing a logic "1" to the corresponding bit field clears the flag. 1 Active edge on the associated bit has occurred (an interrupt will occur if the associated enable bit is set) 0 No active edge occurred
2.3.57
Port AD Data Register (PT0AD)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0270
7
R W Altern. Function Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0 PT0AD1 PT0AD0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
-- 0
AN9 0
AN8 0
Figure 2-55. Port AD Data Register (PT0AD)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
Table 2-51. PT0AD Register Field Descriptions
Field 1-0 PT0AD Description Port AD general purpose input/output data--Data Register, ATD AN analog input When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 96 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.58
Port AD Data Register (PT1AD)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0271
7
R PT1AD7 W Altern. Function Reset AN7 0 AN6 0 AN5 0 AN4 0 AN3 0 AN2 0 AN1 0 AN0 0 PT1AD6 PT1AD5 PT1AD4 PT1AD3 PT1AD2 PT1AD1 PT1AD0
Figure 2-56. Port AD Data Register (PT1AD)
1. Read: Anytime. The data source is depending on the data direction value. Write: Anytime
Table 2-52. PT1AD Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 PT1AD Description Port AD general purpose input/output data--Data Register, ATD AN analog input When not used with the alternative function, the associated pin can be used as general purpose I/O. In general purpose output mode the register bit value is driven to the pin. If the associated data direction bit is set to 1, a read returns the value of the port register bit, otherwise the buffered pin input state is read.
2.3.59
Port AD Data Direction Register (DDR0AD)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0272
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0 DDR0AD1 DDR0AD0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-57. Port AD Data Direction Register (DDR0AD)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-53. DDR0AD Register Field Descriptions
Field 1-0 DDR0AD Description Port AD data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. To use the digital input function the ATD Digital Input Enable Register (ATDDIEN) has to be set to logic level "1". 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 97
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.60
Port AD Data Direction Register (DDR1AD)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0273
7
R DDR1AD7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDR1AD6 DDR1AD5 DDR1AD4 DDR1AD3 DDR1AD2 DDR1AD1 DDR1AD0
Figure 2-58. Port AD Data Direction Register (DDR1AD)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-54. DDR1AD Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 DDR1AD Description Port AD data direction-- This bit determines whether the associated pin is an input or output. To use the digital input function the ATD Digital Input Enable Register (ATDDIEN) has to be set to logic level "1". 1 Associated pin is configured as output 0 Associated pin is configured as input
2.3.61
Port AD Reduced Drive Register (RDR0AD)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0274
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0 RDR0AD1 RDR0AD0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-59. Port AD Reduced Drive Register (RDR0AD)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-55. RDR0AD Register Field Descriptions
Field 1-0 RDR0AD Description Port AD reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output pin This bit configures the drive strength of the associated output pin as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 98 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.62
Port AD Reduced Drive Register (RDR1AD)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0275
7
R RDR1AD7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RDR1AD6 RDR1AD5 RDR1AD4 RDR1AD3 RDR1AD2 RDR1AD1 RDR1AD0
Figure 2-60. Port AD Reduced Drive Register (RDR1AD)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-56. RDR1AD Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 RDR1AD Description Port AD reduced drive--Select reduced drive for output pin This bit configures the drive strength of the associated output pin as either full or reduced. If a pin is used as input this bit has no effect. The reduced drive function is independent of which function is being used on a particular pin. 1 Reduced drive selected (approx. 1/5 of the full drive strength) 0 Full drive strength enabled
2.3.63
Port AD Pull Up Enable Register (PER0AD)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0276
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0 PER0AD1 PER0AD0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-61. Port AD Pull Up Enable Register (PER0AD)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-57. PER0AD Register Field Descriptions
Field 1-0 PER0AD Description Port AD pull-up enable--Enable pull-up device on input pin This bit controls whether a pull device on the associated port input pin is active. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. 1 Pull device enabled 0 Pull device disabled
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 99
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.3.64
Port AD Pull Up Enable Register (PER1AD)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0277
7
R PER1AD7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PER1AD6 PER1AD5 PER1AD4 PER1AD3 PER1AD2 PER1AD1 PER1AD0
Figure 2-62. Port AD Pull Up Enable Register (PER1AD)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 2-58. PER1AD Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 PER1AD Description Port AD pull-up enable--Enable pull-up device on input pin This bit controls whether a pull device on the associated port input pin is active. If a pin is used as output this bit has no effect. 1 Pull device enabled 0 Pull device disabled
2.3.65
PIM Reserved Registers
Access: User read(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Address 0x0278-0x27F
7
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved 1. Read: Always reads 0x00 Write: Unimplemented
u = Unaffected by reset
Figure 2-63. PIM Reserved Registers
2.4
2.4.1
Functional Description
General
Each pin except PE0, PE1, and BKGD can act as general purpose I/O. In addition each pin can act as an output or input of a peripheral module.
2.4.2
Registers
A set of configuration registers is common to all ports with exception of the ATD port (Table 2-59). All registers can be written at any time, however a specific configuration might not become active.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 100 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
For example selecting a pull-up device: This device does not become active while the port is used as a push-pull output.
Table 2-59. Register availability per port(1)
Port A B E T S M P J Data yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes Input yes yes yes yes yes Data Reduced Direction Drive yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes Pull Enable yes Polarity Select yes yes yes yes yes WiredOr Mode yes yes Interrupt Enable yes yes Interrupt Flag yes yes Routing yes yes -
AD yes yes yes yes 1. Each cell represents one register with individual configuration bits
2.4.2.1
Data register (PORTx, PTx)
This register holds the value driven out to the pin if the pin is used as a general purpose I/O. Writing to this register has only an effect on the pin if the pin is used as general purpose output. When reading this address, the buffered state of the pin is returned if the associated data direction register bit is set to "0". If the data direction register bits are set to logic level "1", the contents of the data register is returned. This is independent of any other configuration (Figure 2-64).
2.4.2.2
Input register (PTIx)
This register is read-only and always returns the buffered state of the pin (Figure 2-64).
2.4.2.3
Data direction register (DDRx)
This register defines whether the pin is used as an general purpose input or an output. If a peripheral module controls the pin the contents of the data direction register is ignored (Figure 2-64). Independent of the pin usage with a peripheral module this register determines the source of data when reading the associated data register address (2.4.2.1/2-101). NOTE Due to internal synchronization circuits, it can take up to 2 bus clock cycles until the correct value is read on port data or port input registers, when changing the data direction register.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 101
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
PTI
0 1
PT
0 1
PIN
DDR
data out
0 1
Module
output enable module enable
Figure 2-64. Illustration of I/O pin functionality
2.4.2.4
Reduced drive register (RDRx)
If the pin is used as an output this register allows the configuration of the drive strength independent of the use with a peripheral module.
2.4.2.5
Pull device enable register (PERx)
This register turns on a pull-up or pull-down device on the related pins determined by the associated polarity select register (2.4.2.6/2-102). The pull device becomes active only if the pin is used as an input or as a wired-or output. Some peripheral module only allow certain configurations of pull devices to become active. Refer to the respective bit descriptions.
2.4.2.6
Polarity select register (PPSx)
This register selects either a pull-up or pull-down device if enabled. It becomes only active if the pin is used as an input. A pull-up device can be activated if the pin is used as a wired-or output.
2.4.2.7
Wired-or mode register (WOMx)
If the pin is used as an output this register turns off the active high drive. This allows wired-or type connections of outputs.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 102 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.4.2.8
Interrupt enable register (PIEx)
If the pin is used as an interrupt input this register serves as a mask to the interrupt flag to enable/disable the interrupt.
2.4.2.9
Interrupt flag register (PIFx)
If the pin is used as an interrupt input this register holds the interrupt flag after a valid pin event.
2.4.2.10
Module routing register (PTTRR)
This register allows software re-configuration of the pinouts of the different package options for specific peripherals: * PTTRR supports the re-routing of the PWM channels to alternative ports
2.4.3
Pins and Ports
NOTE Please refer to the device pinout section to determine the pin availability in the different package options.
2.4.3.1
BKGD pin
The BKGD pin is associated with the BDM module. During reset, the BKGD pin is used as MODC input.
2.4.3.2
Port A, B
Port A pins PA[7:0] and Port B pins PB[7:0] can be used for general purpose I/O.
2.4.3.3
Port E
Port E is associated with the free-running clock outputs ECLK, ECLKX2 and interrupt inputs IRQ and XIRQ. Port E pins PE[6:5,3:2] can be used for either general purpose I/O or with the alternative functions. Port E pin PE[7] an be used for either general purpose I/O or as the free-running clock ECLKX2 output running at the core clock rate. Port E pin PE[4] an be used for either general purpose I/O or as the free-running clock ECLK output running at the bus clock rate or at the programmed divided clock rate. Port E pin PE[1] can be used for either general purpose input or as the level- or falling edge-sensitive IRQ interrupt input. IRQ will be enabled by setting the IRQEN configuration bit (2.3.14/2-70) and clearing the I-bit in the CPU condition code register. It is inhibited at reset so this pin is initially configured as a simple input with a pull-up.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 103
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
Port E pin PE[0] can be used for either general purpose input or as the level-sensitive XIRQ interrupt input. XIRQ can be enabled by clearing the X-bit in the CPU condition code register. It is inhibited at reset so this pin is initially configured as a high-impedance input with a pull-up.
2.4.3.4
Port T
This port is associated with TIM and PWM. Port T pins PT[5:4,0] can be used for either general purpose I/O, or with the routed PWM or with the channels of the standard Timer subsystem. Port T pins PT[7:6,3:1] can be used for either general purpose I/O, or with the channels of the standard Timer subsystem.
2.4.3.5
Port S
This port is associated with SCI. Port S pins PS[1:0] can be used either for general purpose I/O, or with the SCI subsystem. Port S pins PS[3:2] can be used for general purpose I/O.
2.4.3.6
Port M
This port is associated with CAN and SPI. Port M pins PM[1:0] can be used for either general purpose I/O, or with the CAN subsystem. Port M pins PM[5:2] can be used for general purpose I/O, or with the SPI subsystem.
2.4.3.7
Port P
This port is associated with the PWM. Port P pins PP[7,5:0] can be used for either general purpose I/O with pin interrupt capability, or with the PWM subsystem.
2.4.3.8
Port J
Port J pins PJ[7:6,2:0] can be used for general purpose I/O with pin-interrupt capability.
2.4.3.9
Port AD
This port is associated with the ATD. Port AD pins PAD[9:0] can be used for either general purpose I/O, or with the ATD subsystem.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 104 Freescale Semiconductor
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
2.4.4
Pin interrupts
Ports P and J offer pin interrupt capability. The interrupt enable as well as the sensitivity to rising or falling edges can be individually configured on per-pin basis. All bits/pins in a port share the same interrupt vector. Interrupts can be used with the pins configured as inputs or outputs. An interrupt is generated when a bit in the port interrupt flag register and its corresponding port interrupt enable bit are both set. The pin interrupt feature is also capable to wake up the CPU when it is in STOP or WAIT mode. A digital filter on each pin prevents pulses (Figure 2-66) shorter than a specified time from generating an interrupt. The minimum time varies over process conditions, temperature and voltage (Figure 2-65 and Table 2-60).
Glitch, filtered out, no interrupt flag set
Valid pulse, interrupt flag set
uncertain
tpign tpval Figure 2-65. Interrupt Glitch Filter on Port P and J (PPS=0)
Table 2-60. Pulse Detection Criteria Mode Pulse STOP Unit
Ignored Uncertain Valid tpulse 3 3 < tpulse < 4 tpulse 4 bus clocks bus clocks bus clocks tpulse tpign tpign < tpulse < tpval tpulse tpval
STOP(1)
1. These values include the spread of the oscillator frequency over temperature, voltage and process.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 105
Port Integration Module (S12PPIMV1)
tpulse
Figure 2-66. Pulse Illustration
A valid edge on an input is detected if 4 consecutive samples of a passive level are followed by 4 consecutive samples of an active level directly or indirectly. The filters are continuously clocked by the bus clock in RUN and WAIT mode. In STOP mode the clock is generated by an RC-oscillator in the Port Integration Module. To maximize current saving the RC oscillator runs only if the following condition is true on any pin individually: Sample count <= 4 and interrupt enabled (PIE=1) and interrupt flag not set (PIF=0).
2.5
2.5.1
Initialization Information
Port Data and Data Direction Register writes
It is not recommended to write PORTx/PTx and DDRx in a word access. When changing the register pins from inputs to outputs, the data may have extra transitions during the write access. Initialize the port data register before enabling the outputs.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 106 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 3 S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
Table 3-1. Revision History Table
Table 3-2.
Rev. No. Date (Item No.) (Submitted By) Sections Affected Substantial Change(s)
01.03
18.APR.2008
Section 3.3.2.3, "Program Page Corrected the address offset of the PPAGE register (on page 3-112) Index Register (PPAGE)" Section 3.5.1, "Implemented Memory Map" Removed "Table 1-9. MC9S12P Derivatives" Removed references to the MMCCTL1 register
01.04 01.04
27.Jun.2008 11.Jul.2008
3.1
Introduction
The S12PMMC module controls the access to all internal memories and peripherals for the CPU12 and S12SBDM module. It regulates access priorities and determines the address mapping of the on-chip ressources. Figure 3-1 shows a block diagram of the S12PMMC module.
3.1.1
Glossary
Table 3-3. Glossary Of Terms
Term Definition Address within the CPU12's Local Address Map (Figure 3-10) Address within the Global Address Map (Figure 3-10) Bus access to an even address. Bus access to an odd address. Normal Single-Chip Mode Special Single-Chip Mode Address ranges which are not mapped to any on-chip ressource. Program Flash Data Flash Non-volatile Memory; P-Flash or D-Flash NVM Information Row. Refer to FTMRC Block Guide
Local Addresses Global Addresse Aligned Bus Access Misaligned Bus Access NS SS Unimplemented Address Ranges P-Flash D-Plash NVM IFR
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 107
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
3.1.2
Overview
The S12PMMC connects the CPU12's and the S12SBDM's bus interfaces to the MCU's on-chip ressources (memories and peripherals). It arbitrates the bus accesses and detemines all of the MCU's memory maps. Furthermore, the S12PMMC is responsible for constraining memory accesses on secured devices and for selecting the MCU's functional mode.
3.1.3
Features
The main features of this block are: * Paging capability to support a global 256 KByte memory address space * Bus arbitration between the masters CPU12, S12SBDM to different resources. * MCU operation mode control * MCU security control * Separate memory map schemes for each master CPU12, S12SBDM * Generation of system reset when CPU12 accesses an unimplemented address (i.e., an address which does not belong to any of the on-chip modules) in single-chip modes
3.1.4
Modes of Operation
The S12PMMC selects the MCU's functional mode. It also determines the devices behavior in secured and unsecured state.
3.1.4.1
Functional Modes
Two funtional modes are implementes on devices of the S12P product family: * Normal Single Chip (NS) The mode used for running applications. * Special Single Chip Mode (SS) A debug mode which causes the device to enter BDM Active Mode after each reset. Peripherals may also provide special debug features in this mode.
3.1.4.2
Security
S12P devives can be secured to prohibit external access to the on-chip P-Flash. The S12PMMC module determines the access permissions to the on-chip memories in secured and unsecured state.
3.1.5
Block Diagram
Figure 3-1 shows a block diagram of the S12PMMC.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 108 Freescale Semiconductor
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
BDM
CPU
MMC Address Decoder & Priority DBG
Target Bus Controller
D-Flash
P-Flash
RAM
Peripherals
Figure 3-1. S12PMMC Block Diagram
3.2
External Signal Description
The S12PMMC uses two external pins to determine the devices operating mode: RESET and MODC (Figure 3-4) See Device User Guide (DUG) for the mapping of these signals to device pins.
Table 3-4. External System Pins Associated With S12PMMC
Pin Name RESET (See DUG) MODC (See DUG) Pin Functions RESET MODC Description The RESET pin is used the select the MCU's operating mode. The MODC pin is captured at the rising edge of the RESET pin. The captured value determines the MCU's operating mode.
3.3
3.3.1
Memory Map and Registers
Module Memory Map
A summary of the registers associated with the S12PMMC block is shown in Figure 3-2. Detailed descriptions of the registers and bits are given in the subsections that follow.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 109
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
Address 0x000B
Register Name MODE R W
Bit 7 MODC
6 0
5 0
4 0
3 0
2 0
1 0
Bit 0 0
0x0011
DIRECT
R W
DP15 0
DP14 0
DP13 0
DP12 0
DP11
DP10
DP9
DP8
0x0015
PPAGE
R W
PIX3
PIX2
PIX1
PIX0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 3-2. MMC Register Summary
3.3.2
Register Descriptions
This section consists of the S12PMMC control register descriptions in address order.
3.3.2.1
Mode Register (MODE)
Address: 0x000B
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R MODC W Reset MODC1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1. External signal (see Table 3-4). = Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 3-3. Mode Register (MODE)
Read: Anytime. Write: Only if a transition is allowed (see Figure 3-4). The MODC bit of the MODE register is used to select the MCU's operating mode.
Table 3-5. MODE Field Descriptions
Field 7 MODC Description Mode Select Bit -- This bit controls the current operating mode during RESET high (inactive). The external mode pin MODC determines the operating mode during RESET low (active). The state of the pin is registered into the respective register bit after the RESET signal goes inactive (see Figure 3-4). Write restrictions exist to disallow transitions between certain modes. Figure 3-4 illustrates all allowed mode changes. Attempting non authorized transitions will not change the MODE bit, but it will block further writes to the register bit except in special modes. Write accesses to the MODE register are blocked when the device is secured.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 110 Freescale Semiconductor
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
RESET 1 0
Normal Single-Chip (NS) 1
1
Special Single-Chip (SS) 0
Figure 3-4. Mode Transition Diagram when MCU is Unsecured
3.3.2.2
Direct Page Register (DIRECT)
Address: 0x0011
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R DP15 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DP14 DP13 DP12 DP11 DP10 DP9 DP8
Figure 3-5. Direct Register (DIRECT)
Read: Anytime Write: anytime in special SS, writr-one in NS. This register determines the position of the 256 Byte direct page within the memory map.It is valid for both global and local mapping scheme.
Table 3-6. DIRECT Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 DP[15:8] Description Direct Page Index Bits 15-8 -- These bits are used by the CPU when performing accesses using the direct addressing mode. These register bits form bits [15:8] of the local address (see Figure 3-6).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 111
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
Global Address [17:0]
Bit17 Bit16 Bit15 DP [15:8]
Bit8
Bit7
Bit0
CPU Address [15:0]
Figure 3-6. DIRECT Address Mapping Example 3-1. This example demonstrates usage of the Direct Addressing Mode
MOVB #0x80,DIRECT ;Set DIRECT register to 0x80. Write once only. ;Global data accesses to the range 0xXX_80XX can be direct. ;Logical data accesses to the range 0x80XX are direct. ;Load the Y index register from 0x8000 (direct access). ;< operator forces direct access on some assemblers but in ;many cases assemblers are "direct page aware" and can ;automatically select direct mode.
LDY
<00
3.3.2.3
Program Page Index Register (PPAGE)
Address: 0x0015
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0 PIX3 PIX2 1 PIX1 1 PIX0 0
0
0
0
0
1
Figure 3-7. Program Page Index Register (PPAGE)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime These four index bits are used to map 16KB blocks into the Flash page window located in the local (CPU or BDM) memory map from address 0x8000 to address 0xBFFF (see Figure 3-8). This supports accessing up to 256 KB of Flash (in the Global map) within the 64KB Local map. The PPAGE index register is effectively used to construct paged Flash addresses in the Local map format. The CPU has special access to read and write this register directly during execution of CALL and RTC instructions.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 112 Freescale Semiconductor
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
Global Address [17:0]
Bit17
Bit14 Bit13
Bit0
PPAGE Register [3:0]
Address [13:0] Address: CPU Local Address or BDM Local Address
Figure 3-8. PPAGE Address Mapping
NOTE Writes to this register using the special access of the CALL and RTC instructions will be complete before the end of the instruction execution.
Table 3-7. PPAGE Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 PIX[3:0] Description Program Page Index Bits 3-0 -- These page index bits are used to select which of the 256 P-Flash or ROM array pages is to be accessed in the Program Page Window.
The fixed 16KB page from 0x0000 to 0x3FFF is the page number 0x0C. Parts of this page are covered by Registers, D-Flash and RAM space. See SoC Guide for details. The fixed 16KB page from 0x4000-0x7FFF is the page number 0x0D. The reset value of 0x0E ensures that there is linear Flash space available between addresses 0x0000 and 0xFFFF out of reset. The fixed 16KB page from 0xC000-0xFFFF is the page number 0x0F.
3.4
Functional Description
The S12PMMC block performs several basic functions of the S12P sub-system operation: MCU operation modes, priority control, address mapping, select signal generation and access limitations for the system. Each aspect is described in the following subsections.
3.4.1
* *
MCU Operating Modes
Normal single chip mode This is the operation mode for running application codeThere is no external bus in this mode. Special single chip mode
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 113
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
This mode is generally used for debugging operation, boot-strapping or security related operations. The active background debug mode is in control of the CPU code execution and the BDM firmware is waiting for serial commands sent through the BKGD pin.
3.4.2
3.4.2.1
Memory Map Scheme
CPU and BDM Memory Map Scheme
The BDM firmware lookup tables and BDM register memory locations share addresses with other modules; however they are not visible in the memory map during user's code execution. The BDM memory resources are enabled only during the READ_BD and WRITE_BD access cycles to distinguish between accesses to the BDM memory area and accesses to the other modules. (Refer to BDM Block Guide for further details). When the MCU enters active BDM mode, the BDM firmware lookup tables and the BDM registers become visible in the local memory map in the range 0xFF00-0xFFFF (global address 0x3_FF00 0x3_FFFF) and the CPU begins execution of firmware commands or the BDM begins execution of hardware commands. The resources which share memory space with the BDM module will not be visible in the memory map during active BDM mode. Please note that after the MCU enters active BDM mode the BDM firmware lookup tables and the BDM registers will also be visible between addresses 0xBF00 and 0xBFFF if the PPAGE register contains value of 0x0F. 3.4.2.1.1 Expansion of the Local Address Map
Expansion of the CPU Local Address Map The program page index register in S12PMMC allows accessing up to 256KB of P-Flash in the global memory map by using the four index bits (PPAGE[3:0]) to page 16x16 KB blocks into the program page window located from address 0x8000 to address 0xBFFF in the local CPU memory map. The page value for the program page window is stored in the PPAGE register. The value of the PPAGE register can be read or written by normal memory accesses as well as by the CALL and RTC instructions (see Section 3.6.1, "CALL and RTC Instructions). Control registers, vector space and parts of the on-chip memories are located in unpaged portions of the 64KB local CPU address space. The starting address of an interrupt service routine must be located in unpaged memory unless the user is certain that the PPAGE register will be set to the appropriate value when the service routine is called. However an interrupt service routine can call other routines that are in paged memory. The upper 16KB block of the local CPU memory space (0xC000-0xFFFF) is unpaged. It is recommended that all reset and interrupt vectors point to locations in this area or to the other unmapped pages sections of the local CPU memory map.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 114 Freescale Semiconductor
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
Expansion of the BDM Local Address Map PPAGE and BDMPPR register is also used for the expansion of the BDM local address to the global address. These registers can be read and written by the BDM. The BDM expansion scheme is the same as the CPU expansion scheme. The four BDMPPR Program Page index bits allow access to the full 256KB address map that can be accessed with 18 address bits. The BDM program page index register (BDMPPR) is used only when the feature is enabled in BDM and, in the case the CPU is executing a firmware command which uses CPU instructions, or by a BDM hardware commands. See the BDM Block Guide for further details. (see Figure 3-9).
BDM HARDWARE COMMAND
Global Address [17:0]
Bit17
Bit14 Bit13
Bit0
BDMPPR Register [3:0]
BDM Local Address [13:0]
BDM FIRMWARE COMMAND
Global Address [17:0]
Bit17
Bit14 Bit13
Bit0
BDMPPR Register [3:0]
CPU Local Address [13:0]
Figure 3-9. BDMPPR Address Mapping
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 115
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
CPU and BDM Local Memory Map 0x0000 0x0400 D-Flash 0x1400 Unpaged P-Flash REGISTERS
Global Memory Map 0x0_0000
REGISTERS Unimplemented Area RAMSIZE
(PPAGE 0x00)
RAM_LOW 0x0_4000 0x0_4400 0x0_5400 RAMSIZE
RAM NVM Resources D-Flash NVM Resources
(PPAGE 0x01)
RAM 0x4000
0x0_8000 (PPAGE 0x02-0x0B))
Unpaged P-Flash
P-Flash 10 *16K paged
0x8000 Unpaged P-Flash or P-Flash window 0 0 0 0 P3 P1 P2 P0 PPAGE
0x3_0000 (PPAGE 0x0C)
Unpaged P-Flash 0x3_4000
(PPAGE 0x0D)
0xC000
Unpaged P-Flash
0x3_8000 Unpaged P-Flash
(PPAGE 0x0E)
Unpaged P-Flash
0x3_C000 0xFFFF Unpaged P-Flash
(PPAGE 0x0F)
0x3_FFFF
Figure 3-10. Local to Global Address Mapping
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 116 Freescale Semiconductor
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
3.5
Implemented Memory in the System Memory Architecture
Each memory can be implemented in its maximum allowed size. But some devices have been defined for smaller sizes, which means less implemented pages. All non implemented pages are called unimplemented areas. * Registers has a fixed size of 1KB, accessible via xbus0. * SRAM has a maximum size of 11KB, accessible via xbus0. * D-Flash has a fixed size of 4KB accessible via xbus0. * P-Flash has a maximum size of 224KB, accessible via xbus0.
3.5.1
Implemented Memory Map
The global memory spaces reserved for the internal resources (RAM, D-Flash, and P-Flash) are not determined by the MMC module. Size of the individual internal resources are however fixed in the design of the device cannot be changed by the user. Please refer to the SoC Guide for further details. Figure 3-11 and Table 3-8 show the memory spaces occupied by the on-chip resources. Please note that the memory spaces have fixed top addresses.
Table 3-8. Global Implemented Memory Space
Internal Resource Registers System RAM D-Flash P-Flash Bottom Address 0x0_0000 RAM_LOW = 0x0_4000 minus RAMSIZE(1) 0x0_4400 Top Address 0x0_03FF 0x0_3FFF 0x0_53FF 0x3_FFFF
PF_LOW = 0x4_0000 minus FLASHSIZE(2) 1. RAMSIZE is the hexadecimal value of RAM SIZE in bytes 2. FLASHSIZE is the hexadecimal value of FLASH SIZE in bytes
In single-chip modes accesses by the CPU12 (except for firmware commands) to any of the unimplemented areas (see Figure 3-11) will result in an illegal access reset (system reset). BDM accesses to the unimplemented areas are allowed but the data will be undefined. No misaligned word access from the BDM module will occur; these accesses are blocked in the BDM module (Refer to BDM Block Guide).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 117
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
CPU and BDM Local Memory Map 0x0000 0x0400 D-Flash 0x1400 Unpaged P-Flash REGISTERS
Global Memory Map
0x0_0000
REGISTERS Unimplemented Area RAMSIZE
(PPAGE 0x00)
RAM_LOW RAM 0x0_4000 0x0_4400 0x0_5400 NVM Resources 0x0_8000 NVM Resources D-Flash RAMSIZE
(PPAGE 0x01)
RAM 0x4000
Unpaged P-Flash
0x8000
Unimplemented area
P-Flash window
0 0 0 0 P3 P1 P2 P0 PPAGE
PF_LOW 0xC000
PFSIZE
P-Flash Unpaged P-Flash
0xFFFF
0x3_FFFF
Figure 3-11. Implemented Global Address Mapping
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 118 Freescale Semiconductor
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
3.5.2
Chip Bus Control
The S12PMMC controls the address buses and the data buses that interface the bus masters (CPU12, S12SBDM) with the rest of the system (master buses). In addition the MMC handles all CPU read data bus swapping operations. All internal resources are connected to specific target buses (see Figure 3-12).
DBG
CPU S12X1
BDM
S12X0
MMC "Crossbar Switch"
XBUS0
P-Flash
D-Flash
BDM resources
SRAM
IPBI Peripherals
Figure 3-12. S12P platform
3.5.2.1
Master Bus Prioritization regarding Access Conflicts on Target Buses
The arbitration scheme allows only one master to be connected to a target at any given time. The following rules apply when prioritizing accesses from different masters to the same target bus: * CPU12 always has priority over BDM. * BDM has priority over CPU12 when its access is stalled for more than 128 cycles. In the later case the CPU will be stalled after finishing the current operation and the BDM will gain access to the bus.
3.5.3
Interrupts
The MMC does not generate any interrupts
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 119
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
3.6
3.6.1
Initialization/Application Information
CALL and RTC Instructions
CALL and RTC instructions are uninterruptable CPU instructions that automate page switching in the program page window. The CALL instruction is similar to the JSR instruction, but the subroutine that is called can be located anywhere in the local address space or in any Flash or ROM page visible through the program page window. The CALL instruction calculates and stacks a return address, stacks the current PPAGE value and writes a new instruction-supplied value to the PPAGE register. The PPAGE value controls which of the 256 possible pages is visible through the 16 Kbyte program page window in the 64 Kbyte local CPU memory map. Execution then begins at the address of the called subroutine. During the execution of the CALL instruction, the CPU performs the following steps: 1. Writes the current PPAGE value into an internal temporary register and writes the new instructionsupplied PPAGE value into the PPAGE register 2. Calculates the address of the next instruction after the CALL instruction (the return address) and pushes this 16-bit value onto the stack 3. Pushes the temporarily stored PPAGE value onto the stack 4. Calculates the effective address of the subroutine, refills the queue and begins execution at the new address This sequence is uninterruptable. There is no need to inhibit interrupts during the CALL instruction execution. A CALL instruction can be performed from any address to any other address in the local CPU memory space. The PPAGE value supplied by the instruction is part of the effective address of the CPU. For all addressing mode variations (except indexed-indirect modes) the new page value is provided by an immediate operand in the instruction. In indexed-indirect variations of the CALL instruction a pointer specifies memory locations where the new page value and the address of the called subroutine are stored. Using indirect addressing for both the new page value and the address within the page allows usage of values calculated at run time rather than immediate values that must be known at the time of assembly. The RTC instruction terminates subroutines invoked by a CALL instruction. The RTC instruction unstacks the PPAGE value and the return address and refills the queue. Execution resumes with the next instruction after the CALL instruction. During the execution of an RTC instruction the CPU performs the following steps: 1. Pulls the previously stored PPAGE value from the stack 2. Pulls the 16-bit return address from the stack and loads it into the PC 3. Writes the PPAGE value into the PPAGE register 4. Refills the queue and resumes execution at the return address This sequence is uninterruptable. The RTC can be executed from anywhere in the local CPU memory space. The CALL and RTC instructions behave like JSR and RTS instruction, they however require more execution cycles. Usage of JSR/RTS instructions is therefore recommended when possible and
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 120 Freescale Semiconductor
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
CALL/RTC instructions should only be used when needed. The JSR and RTS instructions can be used to access subroutines that are already present in the local CPU memory map (i.e. in the same page in the program memory page window for example). However calling a function located in a different page requires usage of the CALL instruction. The function must be terminated by the RTC instruction. Because the RTC instruction restores contents of the PPAGE register from the stack, functions terminated with the RTC instruction must be called using the CALL instruction even when the correct page is already present in the memory map. This is to make sure that the correct PPAGE value will be present on stack at the time of the RTC instruction execution.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 121
S12P Memory Map Control (S12PMMCV1)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 122 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 4 Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
Version Number 01.01 01.02 Revision Date 13 Jun 2006 13 Sep 2007 Effective Date Author Description of Changes removed references to XIRQ/IRQ and added D2D error and D2D interrupt instead updates for S12P family devices: - re-added XIRQ and IRQ references since this functionality is used on devices without D2D - added low voltage reset as possible source to the pin reset vector added clarification of "Wake-up from STOP or WAIT by XIRQ with X bit set" feature
01.03
21 Nov 2007
4.1
Introduction
The INT module decodes the priority of all system exception requests and provides the applicable vector for processing the exception to the CPU. The INT module supports: * I bit and X bit maskable interrupt requests * A non-maskable unimplemented op-code trap * A non-maskable software interrupt (SWI) or background debug mode request * Three system reset vector requests * A spurious interrupt vector Each of the I bit maskable interrupt requests is assigned to a fixed priority level.
4.1.1
Glossary
Table 4-2. Terminology
Term CCR ISR MCU Meaning Condition Code Register (in the CPU) Interrupt Service Routine Micro-Controller Unit
Table 4-2 contains terms and abbreviations used in the document.
4.1.2
* *
Features
Interrupt vector base register (IVBR) One spurious interrupt vector (at address vector base1 + 0x0080).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12
Freescale Semiconductor
123
Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
* * * * * * * *
2-58 I bit maskable interrupt vector requests (at addresses vector base + 0x0082-0x00F2). I bit maskable interrupts can be nested. One X bit maskable interrupt vector request (at address vector base + 0x00F4). One non-maskable software interrupt request (SWI) or background debug mode vector request (at address vector base + 0x00F6). One non-maskable unimplemented op-code trap (TRAP) vector (at address vector base + 0x00F8). Three system reset vectors (at addresses 0xFFFA-0xFFFE). Determines the highest priority interrupt vector requests, drives the vector to the bus on CPU request Wakes up the system from stop or wait mode when an appropriate interrupt request occurs.
4.1.3
* *
Modes of Operation
Run mode This is the basic mode of operation. Wait mode In wait mode, the clock to the INT module is disabled. The INT module is however capable of waking-up the CPU from wait mode if an interrupt occurs. Please refer to Section 4.5.3, "Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode" for details. Stop Mode In stop mode, the clock to the INT module is disabled. The INT module is however capable of waking-up the CPU from stop mode if an interrupt occurs. Please refer to Section 4.5.3, "Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode" for details. Freeze mode (BDM active) In freeze mode (BDM active), the interrupt vector base register is overridden internally. Please refer to Section 4.3.1.1, "Interrupt Vector Base Register (IVBR)" for details.
*
*
4.1.4
Block Diagram
Figure 4-1 shows a block diagram of the INT module.
1. The vector base is a 16-bit address which is accumulated from the contents of the interrupt vector base register (IVBR, used as upper byte) and 0x00 (used as lower byte).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 124 Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
Peripheral Interrupt Requests
Wake Up CPU
Priority Decoder
Non I bit Maskable Channels
I bit Maskable Channels Interrupt Requests
IVBR
Figure 4-1. INT Block Diagram
4.2
External Signal Description
The INT module has no external signals.
4.3
Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the INT module.
4.3.1
Register Descriptions
This section describes in address order all the INT registers and their individual bits.
4.3.1.1
Interrupt Vector Base Register (IVBR)
Address: 0x0120
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset 1 1 1
IVB_ADDR[7:0] 1 1 1 1 1
Figure 4-2. Interrupt Vector Base Register (IVBR)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 125
To CPU
Vector Address
Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
Table 4-3. IVBR Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-0 Interrupt Vector Base Address Bits -- These bits represent the upper byte of all vector addresses. Out of IVB_ADDR[7:0] reset these bits are set to 0xFF (i.e., vectors are located at 0xFF80-0xFFFE) to ensure compatibility to HCS12. Note: A system reset will initialize the interrupt vector base register with "0xFF" before it is used to determine the reset vector address. Therefore, changing the IVBR has no effect on the location of the three reset vectors (0xFFFA-0xFFFE). Note: If the BDM is active (i.e., the CPU is in the process of executing BDM firmware code), the contents of IVBR are ignored and the upper byte of the vector address is fixed as "0xFF". This is done to enable handling of all non-maskable interrupts in the BDM firmware.
4.4
Functional Description
The INT module processes all exception requests to be serviced by the CPU module. These exceptions include interrupt vector requests and reset vector requests. Each of these exception types and their overall priority level is discussed in the subsections below.
4.4.1
S12S Exception Requests
The CPU handles both reset requests and interrupt requests. A priority decoder is used to evaluate the priority of pending interrupt requests.
4.4.2
Interrupt Prioritization
The INT module contains a priority decoder to determine the priority for all interrupt requests pending for the CPU. If more than one interrupt request is pending, the interrupt request with the higher vector address wins the prioritization. The following conditions must be met for an I bit maskable interrupt request to be processed. 1. The local interrupt enabled bit in the peripheral module must be set. 2. The I bit in the condition code register (CCR) of the CPU must be cleared. 3. There is no SWI, TRAP, or X bit maskable request pending. NOTE All non I bit maskable interrupt requests always have higher priority than the I bit maskable interrupt requests. If the X bit in the CCR is cleared, it is possible to interrupt an I bit maskable interrupt by an X bit maskable interrupt. It is possible to nest non maskable interrupt requests, e.g., by nesting SWI or TRAP calls. Since an interrupt vector is only supplied at the time when the CPU requests it, it is possible that a higher priority interrupt request could override the original interrupt request that caused the CPU to request the vector. In this case, the CPU will receive the highest priority vector and the system will process this interrupt request first, before the original interrupt request is processed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 126 Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
If the interrupt source is unknown (for example, in the case where an interrupt request becomes inactive after the interrupt has been recognized, but prior to the CPU vector request), the vector address supplied to the CPU will default to that of the spurious interrupt vector. NOTE Care must be taken to ensure that all interrupt requests remain active until the system begins execution of the applicable service routine; otherwise, the exception request may not get processed at all or the result may be a spurious interrupt request (vector at address (vector base + 0x0080)).
4.4.3
Reset Exception Requests
The INT module supports three system reset exception request types (please refer to the Clock and Reset generator module for details): 1. Pin reset, power-on reset or illegal address reset, low voltage reset (if applicable) 2. Clock monitor reset request 3. COP watchdog reset request
4.4.4
Exception Priority
The priority (from highest to lowest) and address of all exception vectors issued by the INT module upon request by the CPU is shown in Table 4-4.
Table 4-4. Exception Vector Map and Priority
Vector Address(1) 0xFFFE 0xFFFC 0xFFFA (Vector base + 0x00F8) (Vector base + 0x00F6) (Vector base + 0x00F4) (Vector base + 0x00F2) Source Pin reset, power-on reset, illegal address reset, low voltage reset (if applicable) Clock monitor reset COP watchdog reset Unimplemented opcode trap Software interrupt instruction (SWI) or BDM vector request X bit maskable interrupt request (XIRQ or D2D error interrupt)(2) IRQ or D2D interrupt request(3)
(Vector base + 0x00F0-0x0082) Device specific I bit maskable interrupt sources (priority determined by the low byte of the vector address, in descending order) (Vector base + 0x0080) Spurious interrupt 1. 16 bits vector address based 2. D2D error interrupt on MCUs featuring a D2D initiator module, otherwise XIRQ pin interrupt 3. D2D interrupt on MCUs featuring a D2D initiator module, otherwise IRQ pin interrupt
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 127
Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
4.5
4.5.1
Initialization/Application Information
Initialization
After system reset, software should: 1. Initialize the interrupt vector base register if the interrupt vector table is not located at the default location (0xFF80-0xFFF9). 2. Enable I bit maskable interrupts by clearing the I bit in the CCR. 3. Enable the X bit maskable interrupt by clearing the X bit in the CCR.
4.5.2
Interrupt Nesting
The interrupt request scheme makes it possible to nest I bit maskable interrupt requests handled by the CPU. * I bit maskable interrupt requests can be interrupted by an interrupt request with a higher priority. I bit maskable interrupt requests cannot be interrupted by other I bit maskable interrupt requests per default. In order to make an interrupt service routine (ISR) interruptible, the ISR must explicitly clear the I bit in the CCR (CLI). After clearing the I bit, other I bit maskable interrupt requests can interrupt the current ISR. An ISR of an interruptible I bit maskable interrupt request could basically look like this: 1. Service interrupt, e.g., clear interrupt flags, copy data, etc. 2. Clear I bit in the CCR by executing the instruction CLI (thus allowing other I bit maskable interrupt requests) 3. Process data 4. Return from interrupt by executing the instruction RTI
4.5.3
4.5.3.1
Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode
CPU Wake Up from Stop or Wait Mode
Every I bit maskable interrupt request is capable of waking the MCU from stop or wait mode. To determine whether an I bit maskable interrupts is qualified to wake-up the CPU or not, the same conditions as in normal run mode are applied during stop or wait mode: * If the I bit in the CCR is set, all I bit maskable interrupts are masked from waking-up the MCU. Since there are no clocks running in stop mode, only interrupts which can be asserted asynchronously can wake-up the MCU from stop mode. The X bit maskable interrupt request can wake up the MCU from stop or wait mode at anytime, even if the X bit in CCR is set. If the X bit maskable interrupt request is used to wake-up the MCU with the X bit in the CCR set, the associated ISR is not called. The CPU then resumes program execution with the instruction following the
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 128 Freescale Semiconductor
Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
WAI or STOP instruction. This features works the same rules like any interrupt request, i.e. care must be taken that the X interrupt request used for wake-up remains active at least until the system begins execution of the instruction following the WAI or STOP instruction; otherwise, wake-up may not occur.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 129
Interrupt Module (S12SINTV1)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 130 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 5 Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1) Revision History
Revision Number
s12s_bdm.01.00.00 s12s_bdm.01.00.02 s12s_bdm.01.00.12 s12s_bdm.01.01.01
Date
08.Feb.2006 09.FEB.2006 10.May.2006 20.Sept.2007
Summary of Changes
First version of S12SBDMV1 Updated register address information & Block Version Removed CLKSW bit and description Added conditional text for S12P family
5.1
Introduction
This section describes the functionality of the background debug module (BDM) sub-block of the HCS12S core platform. The background debug module (BDM) sub-block is a single-wire, background debug system implemented in on-chip hardware for minimal CPU intervention. All interfacing with the BDM is done via the BKGD pin. The BDM has enhanced capability for maintaining synchronization between the target and host while allowing more flexibility in clock rates. This includes a sync signal to determine the communication rate and a handshake signal to indicate when an operation is complete. The system is backwards compatible to the BDM of the S12 family with the following exceptions: * TAGGO command not supported by S12SBDM * External instruction tagging feature is part of the DBG module * S12SBDM register map and register content modified * Family ID readable from firmware ROM at global address 0x3_FF0F (value for devices with HCS12S core is 0xC2) * Clock switch removed from BDM (CLKSW bit removed from BDMSTS register)
5.1.1
Features
The BDM includes these distinctive features: * Single-wire communication with host development system
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 131
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
* * * * * * * * * * * *
Enhanced capability for allowing more flexibility in clock rates SYNC command to determine communication rate GO_UNTIL command Hardware handshake protocol to increase the performance of the serial communication Active out of reset in special single chip mode Nine hardware commands using free cycles, if available, for minimal CPU intervention Hardware commands not requiring active BDM 14 firmware commands execute from the standard BDM firmware lookup table Software control of BDM operation during wait mode When secured, hardware commands are allowed to access the register space in special single chip mode, if the Flash erase tests fail. Family ID readable from firmware ROM at global address 0x3_FF0F (value for devices with HCS12S core is 0xC2) BDM hardware commands are operational until system stop mode is entered
5.1.2
Modes of Operation
BDM is available in all operating modes but must be enabled before firmware commands are executed. Some systems may have a control bit that allows suspending the function during background debug mode.
5.1.2.1
Regular Run Modes
All of these operations refer to the part in run mode and not being secured. The BDM does not provide controls to conserve power during run mode. * Normal modes General operation of the BDM is available and operates the same in all normal modes. * Special single chip mode In special single chip mode, background operation is enabled and active out of reset. This allows programming a system with blank memory.
5.1.2.2
Secure Mode Operation
If the device is in secure mode, the operation of the BDM is reduced to a small subset of its regular run mode operation. Secure operation prevents access to Flash other than allowing erasure. For more information please see Section 5.4.1, "Security".
5.1.2.3
Low-Power Modes
The BDM can be used until stop mode is entered. When CPU is in wait mode all BDM firmware commands as well as the hardware BACKGROUND command cannot be used and are ignored. In this case the CPU can not enter BDM active mode, and only hardware read and write commands are available. Also the CPU can not enter a low power mode (stop or wait) during BDM active mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 132 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
In stop mode the BDM clocks are stopped. When BDM clocks are disabled and stop mode is exited, the BDM clocks will restart and BDM will have a soft reset (clearing the instruction register, any command in progress and disable the ACK function). The BDM is now ready to receive a new command.
5.1.3
Block Diagram
A block diagram of the BDM is shown in Figure 5-1.
Host System Serial Interface Data Control Register Block Address TRACE BDMACT Instruction Code and Execution Bus Interface and Control Logic Data Control Clocks 16-Bit Shift Register
BKGD
ENBDM SDV Standard BDM Firmware LOOKUP TABLE Secured BDM Firmware LOOKUP TABLE
UNSEC
BDMSTS Register
Figure 5-1. BDM Block Diagram
5.2
External Signal Description
A single-wire interface pin called the background debug interface (BKGD) pin is used to communicate with the BDM system. During reset, this pin is a mode select input which selects between normal and special modes of operation. After reset, this pin becomes the dedicated serial interface pin for the background debug mode. The communication rate of this pin is based on the the settings for the VCO clock (CPMUSYNR). The BDM clock frequency is always VCO clock frequency divided by 8. After reset the BDM clock is based on the reset values of the CPMUSYNR register (4 MHz). When modifying the VCO clock please make sure that the communication rate is adapted accordingly and a communication time-out (BDM soft reset) has occurred.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 133
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
5.3
5.3.1
Memory Map and Register Definition
Module Memory Map
Table 5-1 shows the BDM memory map when BDM is active.
Table 5-1. BDM Memory Map
Global Address 0x3_FF00-0x3_FF0B 0x3_FF0C-0x3_FF0E 0x3_FF0F 0x3_FF10-0x3_FFFF Module BDM registers BDM firmware ROM Family ID (part of BDM firmware ROM) BDM firmware ROM Size (Bytes) 12 3 1 240
5.3.2
Register Descriptions
A summary of the registers associated with the BDM is shown in Figure 5-2. Registers are accessed by host-driven communications to the BDM hardware using READ_BD and WRITE_BD commands.
Global Address 0x3_FF00
Register Name Reserved R W
Bit 7 X
6 X
5 X
4 X
3 X
2 X
1 0
Bit 0 0
0x3_FF01
BDMSTS
R W
ENBDM X
BDMACT
0
SDV
TRACE
0
UNSEC
0
0x3_FF02
Reserved
R W
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
0x3_FF03
Reserved
R W
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
0x3_FF04
Reserved
R W
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
0x3_FF05
Reserved
R W
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
= Unimplemented, Reserved X = Indeterminate 0
= Implemented (do not alter) = Always read zero
Figure 5-2. BDM Register Summary
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 134 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
Global Address 0x3_FF06
Register Name BDMCCR R W
Bit 7 CCR7 0
6 CCR6 0
5 CCR5 0
4 CCR4 0
3 CCR3 0
2 CCR2 0
1 CCR1 0
Bit 0 CCR0 0
0x3_FF07
Reserved
R W
0x3_FF08
BDMPPR
R W
BPAE 0
0
0
0
BPP3 0
BPP2 0
BPP1 0
BPP0 0
0x3_FF09
Reserved
R W
0
0
0
0x3_FF0A
Reserved
R W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0x3_FF0B
Reserved
R W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented, Reserved X = Indeterminate 0
= Implemented (do not alter) = Always read zero
Figure 5-2. BDM Register Summary (continued)
5.3.2.1
BDM Status Register (BDMSTS)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Register Global Address 0x3_FF01
R W Reset Special Single-Chip Mode All Other Modes
ENBDM
BDMACT
0
SDV
TRACE
0
UNSEC
0
0(1) 0
1 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0(2) 0
0 0
= Unimplemented, Reserved
= Implemented (do not alter)
0 = Always read zero 1. ENBDM is read as 1 by a debugging environment in special single chip mode when the device is not secured or secured but fully erased (Flash). This is because the ENBDM bit is set by the standard firmware before a BDM command can be fully transmitted and executed. 2. UNSEC is read as 1 by a debugging environment in special single chip mode when the device is secured and fully erased, else it is 0 and can only be read if not secure (see also bit description).
Figure 5-3. BDM Status Register (BDMSTS)
Read: All modes through BDM operation when not secured Write: All modes through BDM operation when not secured, but subject to the following:
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 135
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
-- ENBDM should only be set via a BDM hardware command if the BDM firmware commands are needed. (This does not apply in special single chip mode). -- BDMACT can only be set by BDM hardware upon entry into BDM. It can only be cleared by the standard BDM firmware lookup table upon exit from BDM active mode. -- All other bits, while writable via BDM hardware or standard BDM firmware write commands, should only be altered by the BDM hardware or standard firmware lookup table as part of BDM command execution.
Table 5-2. BDMSTS Field Descriptions
Field 7 ENBDM Description Enable BDM -- This bit controls whether the BDM is enabled or disabled. When enabled, BDM can be made active to allow firmware commands to be executed. When disabled, BDM cannot be made active but BDM hardware commands are still allowed. 0 BDM disabled 1 BDM enabled Note: ENBDM is set by the firmware out of reset in special single chip mode. In special single chip mode with the device secured, this bit will not be set by the firmware until after the Flash erase verify tests are complete. BDM Active Status -- This bit becomes set upon entering BDM. The standard BDM firmware lookup table is then enabled and put into the memory map. BDMACT is cleared by a carefully timed store instruction in the standard BDM firmware as part of the exit sequence to return to user code and remove the BDM memory from the map. 0 BDM not active 1 BDM active Shift Data Valid -- This bit is set and cleared by the BDM hardware. It is set after data has been transmitted as part of a firmware or hardware read command or after data has been received as part of a firmware or hardware write command. It is cleared when the next BDM command has been received or BDM is exited. SDV is used by the standard BDM firmware to control program flow execution. 0 Data phase of command not complete 1 Data phase of command is complete TRACE1 BDM Firmware Command is Being Executed -- This bit gets set when a BDM TRACE1 firmware command is first recognized. It will stay set until BDM firmware is exited by one of the following BDM commands: GO or GO_UNTIL. 0 TRACE1 command is not being executed 1 TRACE1 command is being executed Unsecure -- If the device is secured this bit is only writable in special single chip mode from the BDM secure firmware. It is in a zero state as secure mode is entered so that the secure BDM firmware lookup table is enabled and put into the memory map overlapping the standard BDM firmware lookup table. The secure BDM firmware lookup table verifies that the on-chip Flash is erased. This being the case, the UNSEC bit is set and the BDM program jumps to the start of the standard BDM firmware lookup table and the secure BDM firmware lookup table is turned off. If the erase test fails, the UNSEC bit will not be asserted. 0 System is in a secured mode. 1 System is in a unsecured mode. Note: When UNSEC is set, security is off and the user can change the state of the secure bits in the on-chip Flash EEPROM. Note that if the user does not change the state of the bits to "unsecured" mode, the system will be secured again when it is next taken out of reset.After reset this bit has no meaning or effect when the security byte in the Flash EEPROM is configured for unsecure mode.
6 BDMACT
4 SDV
3 TRACE
1 UNSEC
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 136 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
Register Global Address 0x3_FF06
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset Special Single-Chip Mode All Other Modes
CCR7
CCR6
CCR5
CCR4
CCR3
CCR2
CCR1
CCR0
1 0
1 0
0 0
0 0
1 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
Figure 5-4. BDM CCR Holding Register (BDMCCR)
Read: All modes through BDM operation when not secured Write: All modes through BDM operation when not secured NOTE When BDM is made active, the CPU stores the content of its CCR register in the BDMCCR register. However, out of special single-chip reset, the BDMCCR is set to 0xD8 and not 0xD0 which is the reset value of the CCR register in this CPU mode. Out of reset in all other modes the BDMCCR register is read zero. When entering background debug mode, the BDM CCR holding register is used to save the condition code register of the user's program. It is also used for temporary storage in the standard BDM firmware mode. The BDM CCR holding register can be written to modify the CCR value.
5.3.2.2
BDM Program Page Index Register (BDMPPR)
7 6 0 5 0 4 0 3 BPP3 0 2 BPP2 0 1 BPP1 0 0 BPP0 0
Register Global Address 0x3_FF08
R W Reset
BPAE 0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented, Reserved
Figure 5-5. BDM Program Page Register (BDMPPR)
Read: All modes through BDM operation when not secured Write: All modes through BDM operation when not secured
Table 5-3. BDMPPR Field Descriptions
Field 7 BPAE Description BDM Program Page Access Enable Bit -- BPAE enables program page access for BDM hardware and firmware read/write instructions The BDM hardware commands used to access the BDM registers (READ_BD and WRITE_BD) can not be used for global accesses even if the BGAE bit is set. 0 BDM Program Paging disabled 1 BDM Program Paging enabled BDM Program Page Index Bits 3-0 -- These bits define the selected program page. For more detailed information regarding the program page window scheme, please refer to the S12S_MMC Block Guide.
3-0 BPP[3:0]
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 137
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
5.3.3
Family ID Assignment
The family ID is a 8-bit value located in the firmware ROM (at global address: 0x3_FF0F). The read-only value is a unique family ID which is 0xC2 for devices with HCS12S core.
5.4
Functional Description
The BDM receives and executes commands from a host via a single wire serial interface. There are two types of BDM commands: hardware and firmware commands. Hardware commands are used to read and write target system memory locations and to enter active background debug mode, see Section 5.4.3, "BDM Hardware Commands". Target system memory includes all memory that is accessible by the CPU. Firmware commands are used to read and write CPU resources and to exit from active background debug mode, see Section 5.4.4, "Standard BDM Firmware Commands". The CPU resources referred to are the accumulator (D), X index register (X), Y index register (Y), stack pointer (SP), and program counter (PC). Hardware commands can be executed at any time and in any mode excluding a few exceptions as highlighted (see Section 5.4.3, "BDM Hardware Commands") and in secure mode (see Section 5.4.1, "Security"). Firmware commands can only be executed when the system is not secure and is in active background debug mode (BDM).
5.4.1
Security
If the user resets into special single chip mode with the system secured, a secured mode BDM firmware lookup table is brought into the map overlapping a portion of the standard BDM firmware lookup table. The secure BDM firmware verifies that the on-chip Flash EEPROM are erased. This being the case, the UNSEC and ENBDM bit will get set. The BDM program jumps to the start of the standard BDM firmware and the secured mode BDM firmware is turned off and all BDM commands are allowed. If the Flash does not verify as erased, the BDM firmware sets the ENBDM bit, without asserting UNSEC, and the firmware enters a loop. This causes the BDM hardware commands to become enabled, but does not enable the firmware commands. This allows the BDM hardware to be used to erase the Flash. BDM operation is not possible in any other mode than special single chip mode when the device is secured. The device can only be unsecured via BDM serial interface in special single chip mode. For more information regarding security, please see the S12S_9SEC Block Guide.
5.4.2
Enabling and Activating BDM
The system must be in active BDM to execute standard BDM firmware commands. BDM can be activated only after being enabled. BDM is enabled by setting the ENBDM bit in the BDM status (BDMSTS) register. The ENBDM bit is set by writing to the BDM status (BDMSTS) register, via the single-wire interface, using a hardware command such as WRITE_BD_BYTE. After being enabled, BDM is activated by one of the following1: * Hardware BACKGROUND command
1. BDM is enabled and active immediately out of special single-chip reset.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 138 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
* *
CPU BGND instruction Breakpoint force or tag mechanism1
When BDM is activated, the CPU finishes executing the current instruction and then begins executing the firmware in the standard BDM firmware lookup table. When BDM is activated by a breakpoint, the type of breakpoint used determines if BDM becomes active before or after execution of the next instruction. NOTE If an attempt is made to activate BDM before being enabled, the CPU resumes normal instruction execution after a brief delay. If BDM is not enabled, any hardware BACKGROUND commands issued are ignored by the BDM and the CPU is not delayed. In active BDM, the BDM registers and standard BDM firmware lookup table are mapped to addresses 0x3_FF00 to 0x3_FFFF. BDM registers are mapped to addresses 0x3_FF00 to 0x3_FF0B. The BDM uses these registers which are readable anytime by the BDM. However, these registers are not readable by user programs. When BDM is activated while CPU executes code overlapping with BDM firmware space the saved program counter (PC) will be auto incremented by one from the BDM firmware, no matter what caused the entry into BDM active mode (BGND instruction, BACKGROUND command or breakpoints). In such a case the PC must be set to the next valid address via a WRITE_PC command before executing the GO command.
5.4.3
BDM Hardware Commands
Hardware commands are used to read and write target system memory locations and to enter active background debug mode. Target system memory includes all memory that is accessible by the CPU such as on-chip RAM, Flash, I/O and control registers. Hardware commands are executed with minimal or no CPU intervention and do not require the system to be in active BDM for execution, although, they can still be executed in this mode. When executing a hardware command, the BDM sub-block waits for a free bus cycle so that the background access does not disturb the running application program. If a free cycle is not found within 128 clock cycles, the CPU is momentarily frozen so that the BDM can steal a cycle. When the BDM finds a free cycle, the operation does not intrude on normal CPU operation provided that it can be completed in a single cycle. However, if an operation requires multiple cycles the CPU is frozen until the operation is complete, even though the BDM found a free cycle. The BDM hardware commands are listed in Table 5-4. The READ_BD and WRITE_BD commands allow access to the BDM register locations. These locations are not normally in the system memory map but share addresses with the application in memory. To distinguish between physical memory locations that share the same address, BDM memory resources are
1. This method is provided by the S12S_DBG module.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 139
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
enabled just for the READ_BD and WRITE_BD access cycle. This allows the BDM to access BDM locations unobtrusively, even if the addresses conflict with the application memory map.
Table 5-4. Hardware Commands
Command BACKGROUND ACK_ENABLE ACK_DISABLE READ_BD_BYTE READ_BD_WORD READ_BYTE READ_WORD WRITE_BD_BYTE WRITE_BD_WORD WRITE_BYTE WRITE_WORD Opcode (hex) 90 D5 D6 E4 EC E0 E8 C4 CC C0 C8 Data None None None Description Enter background mode if firmware is enabled. If enabled, an ACK will be issued when the part enters active background mode. Enable Handshake. Issues an ACK pulse after the command is executed. Disable Handshake. This command does not issue an ACK pulse.
16-bit address Read from memory with standard BDM firmware lookup table in map. 16-bit data out Odd address data on low byte; even address data on high byte. 16-bit address Read from memory with standard BDM firmware lookup table in map. 16-bit data out Must be aligned access. 16-bit address Read from memory with standard BDM firmware lookup table out of map. 16-bit data out Odd address data on low byte; even address data on high byte. 16-bit address Read from memory with standard BDM firmware lookup table out of map. 16-bit data out Must be aligned access. 16-bit address Write to memory with standard BDM firmware lookup table in map. 16-bit data in Odd address data on low byte; even address data on high byte. 16-bit address Write to memory with standard BDM firmware lookup table in map. 16-bit data in Must be aligned access. 16-bit address Write to memory with standard BDM firmware lookup table out of map. 16-bit data in Odd address data on low byte; even address data on high byte. 16-bit address Write to memory with standard BDM firmware lookup table out of map. 16-bit data in Must be aligned access.
NOTE: If enabled, ACK will occur when data is ready for transmission for all BDM READ commands and will occur after the write is complete for all BDM WRITE commands.
5.4.4
Standard BDM Firmware Commands
Firmware commands are used to access and manipulate CPU resources. The system must be in active BDM to execute standard BDM firmware commands, see Section 5.4.2, "Enabling and Activating BDM". Normal instruction execution is suspended while the CPU executes the firmware located in the standard BDM firmware lookup table. The hardware command BACKGROUND is the usual way to activate BDM. As the system enters active BDM, the standard BDM firmware lookup table and BDM registers become visible in the on-chip memory map at 0x3_FF00-0x3_FFFF, and the CPU begins executing the standard BDM firmware. The standard BDM firmware watches for serial commands and executes them as they are received. The firmware commands are shown in Table 5-5.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 140 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
Table 5-5. Firmware Commands
Command(1) READ_NEXT(2) READ_PC READ_D READ_X READ_Y READ_SP WRITE_NEXT WRITE_PC WRITE_D WRITE_X WRITE_Y WRITE_SP GO GO_UNTIL(3) TRACE1 TAGGO -> GO Opcode (hex) 62 63 64 65 66 67 42 43 44 45 46 47 08 0C 10 18 Data Description
16-bit data out Increment X index register by 2 (X = X + 2), then read word X points to. 16-bit data out Read program counter. 16-bit data out Read D accumulator. 16-bit data out Read X index register. 16-bit data out Read Y index register. 16-bit data out Read stack pointer. 16-bit data in 16-bit data in 16-bit data in 16-bit data in 16-bit data in 16-bit data in none none none none Increment X index register by 2 (X = X + 2), then write word to location pointed to by X. Write program counter. Write D accumulator. Write X index register. Write Y index register. Write stack pointer. Go to user program. If enabled, ACK will occur when leaving active background mode. Go to user program. If enabled, ACK will occur upon returning to active background mode. Execute one user instruction then return to active BDM. If enabled, ACK will occur upon returning to active background mode.
(Previous enable tagging and go to user program.) This command will be deprecated and should not be used anymore. Opcode will be executed as a GO command. 1. If enabled, ACK will occur when data is ready for transmission for all BDM READ commands and will occur after the write is complete for all BDM WRITE commands. 2. When the firmware command READ_NEXT or WRITE_NEXT is used to access the BDM address space the BDM resources are accessed rather than user code. Writing BDM firmware is not possible. 3. System stop disables the ACK function and ignored commands will not have an ACK-pulse (e.g., CPU in stop or wait mode). The GO_UNTIL command will not get an Acknowledge if CPU executes the wait or stop instruction before the "UNTIL" condition (BDM active again) is reached (see Section 5.4.7, "Serial Interface Hardware Handshake Protocol" last Note).
5.4.5
BDM Command Structure
Hardware and firmware BDM commands start with an 8-bit opcode followed by a 16-bit address and/or a 16-bit data word depending on the command. All the read commands return 16 bits of data despite the byte or word implication in the command name. 8-bit reads return 16-bits of data, of which, only one byte will contain valid data. If reading an even address, the valid data will appear in the MSB. If reading an odd address, the valid data will appear in the LSB. 16-bit misaligned reads and writes are generally not allowed. If attempted by BDM hardware command, the BDM will ignore the least significant bit of the address and will assume an even address from the remaining bits.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 141
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
For hardware data read commands, the external host must wait at least 150 bus clock cycles after sending the address before attempting to obtain the read data. This is to be certain that valid data is available in the BDM shift register, ready to be shifted out. For hardware write commands, the external host must wait 150 bus clock cycles after sending the data to be written before attempting to send a new command. This is to avoid disturbing the BDM shift register before the write has been completed. The 150 bus clock cycle delay in both cases includes the maximum 128 cycle delay that can be incurred as the BDM waits for a free cycle before stealing a cycle. For firmware read commands, the external host should wait at least 48 bus clock cycles after sending the command opcode and before attempting to obtain the read data. The 48 cycle wait allows enough time for the requested data to be made available in the BDM shift register, ready to be shifted out. For firmware write commands, the external host must wait 36 bus clock cycles after sending the data to be written before attempting to send a new command. This is to avoid disturbing the BDM shift register before the write has been completed. The external host should wait at least for 76 bus clock cycles after a TRACE1 or GO command before starting any new serial command. This is to allow the CPU to exit gracefully from the standard BDM firmware lookup table and resume execution of the user code. Disturbing the BDM shift register prematurely may adversely affect the exit from the standard BDM firmware lookup table. NOTE If the bus rate of the target processor is unknown or could be changing, it is recommended that the ACK (acknowledge function) is used to indicate when an operation is complete. When using ACK, the delay times are automated. Figure 5-6 represents the BDM command structure. The command blocks illustrate a series of eight bit times starting with a falling edge. The bar across the top of the blocks indicates that the BKGD line idles in the high state. The time for an 8-bit command is 8 x 16 target clock cycles.1
1. Target clock cycles are cycles measured using the target MCU's serial clock rate. See Section 5.4.6, "BDM Serial Interface" and Section 5.3.2.1, "BDM Status Register (BDMSTS)" for information on how serial clock rate is selected.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 142 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
8 Bits AT ~16 TC/Bit Hardware Read Command
16 Bits AT ~16 TC/Bit Address
150-BC Delay
16 Bits AT ~16 TC/Bit Data 150-BC Delay Next Command
Hardware Write
Command 48-BC DELAY
Address
Data
Next Command
Firmware Read
Command
Data 36-BC DELAY
Next Command
Firmware Write
Command 76-BC Delay
Data
Next Command
GO, TRACE
Command
Next Command
BC = Bus Clock Cycles TC = Target Clock Cycles
Figure 5-6. BDM Command Structure
5.4.6
BDM Serial Interface
The BDM communicates with external devices serially via the BKGD pin. During reset, this pin is a mode select input which selects between normal and special modes of operation. After reset, this pin becomes the dedicated serial interface pin for the BDM. The BDM serial interface is timed based on the VCO clock (please refer to the CPMU Block Guide for more details), which gets divided by 8. This clock will be referred to as the target clock in the following explanation. The BDM serial interface uses a clocking scheme in which the external host generates a falling edge on the BKGD pin to indicate the start of each bit time. This falling edge is sent for every bit whether data is transmitted or received. Data is transferred most significant bit (MSB) first at 16 target clock cycles per bit. The interface times out if 512 clock cycles occur between falling edges from the host. The BKGD pin is a pseudo open-drain pin and has an weak on-chip active pull-up that is enabled at all times. It is assumed that there is an external pull-up and that drivers connected to BKGD do not typically drive the high level. Since R-C rise time could be unacceptably long, the target system and host provide brief driven-high (speedup) pulses to drive BKGD to a logic 1. The source of this speedup pulse is the host for transmit cases and the target for receive cases. The timing for host-to-target is shown in Figure 5-7 and that of target-to-host in Figure 5-8 and Figure 5-9. All four cases begin when the host drives the BKGD pin low to generate a falling edge. Since the host and target are operating from separate clocks, it can take the target system up to one full clock cycle to recognize this edge. The target measures delays from this perceived start of the bit time while the host measures delays from the point it actually drove BKGD low to start the bit up to one target clock cycle
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 143
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
earlier. Synchronization between the host and target is established in this manner at the start of every bit time. Figure 5-7 shows an external host transmitting a logic 1 and transmitting a logic 0 to the BKGD pin of a target system. The host is asynchronous to the target, so there is up to a one clock-cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge to where the target recognizes this edge as the beginning of the bit time. Ten target clock cycles later, the target senses the bit level on the BKGD pin. Internal glitch detect logic requires the pin be driven high no later that eight target clock cycles after the falling edge for a logic 1 transmission. Since the host drives the high speedup pulses in these two cases, the rising edges look like digitally driven signals.
BDM Clock (Target MCU)
Host Transmit 1
Host Transmit 0 Perceived Start of Bit Time 10 Cycles Synchronization Uncertainty Target Senses Bit Earliest Start of Next Bit
Figure 5-7. BDM Host-to-Target Serial Bit Timing
The receive cases are more complicated. Figure 5-8 shows the host receiving a logic 1 from the target system. Since the host is asynchronous to the target, there is up to one clock-cycle delay from the hostgenerated falling edge on BKGD to the perceived start of the bit time in the target. The host holds the BKGD pin low long enough for the target to recognize it (at least two target clock cycles). The host must release the low drive before the target drives a brief high speedup pulse seven target clock cycles after the perceived start of the bit time. The host should sample the bit level about 10 target clock cycles after it started the bit time.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 144 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
BDM Clock (Target MCU) Host Drive to BKGD Pin Target System Speedup Pulse Perceived Start of Bit Time R-C Rise BKGD Pin
High-Impedance
High-Impedance
High-Impedance
10 Cycles 10 Cycles Host Samples BKGD Pin Earliest Start of Next Bit
Figure 5-8. BDM Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 1)
Figure 5-9 shows the host receiving a logic 0 from the target. Since the host is asynchronous to the target, there is up to a one clock-cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge on BKGD to the start of the bit time as perceived by the target. The host initiates the bit time but the target finishes it. Since the target wants the host to receive a logic 0, it drives the BKGD pin low for 13 target clock cycles then briefly drives it high to speed up the rising edge. The host samples the bit level about 10 target clock cycles after starting the bit time.
BDM Clock (Target MCU) Host Drive to BKGD Pin Target System Drive and Speedup Pulse Perceived Start of Bit Time BKGD Pin 10 Cycles 10 Cycles Host Samples BKGD Pin Earliest Start of Next Bit
High-Impedance Speedup Pulse
Figure 5-9. BDM Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 0)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 145
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
5.4.7
Serial Interface Hardware Handshake Protocol
BDM commands that require CPU execution are ultimately treated at the MCU bus rate. Since the BDM clock source can be modified when changing the settings for the VCO frequency (CPMUSYNR), it is very helpful to provide a handshake protocol in which the host could determine when an issued command is executed by the CPU. The BDM clock frequency is always VCO frequency divided by 8. The alternative is to always wait the amount of time equal to the appropriate number of cycles at the slowest possible rate the clock could be running. This sub-section will describe the hardware handshake protocol. The hardware handshake protocol signals to the host controller when an issued command was successfully executed by the target. This protocol is implemented by a 16 serial clock cycle low pulse followed by a brief speedup pulse in the BKGD pin. This pulse is generated by the target MCU when a command, issued by the host, has been successfully executed (see Figure 5-10). This pulse is referred to as the ACK pulse. After the ACK pulse has finished: the host can start the bit retrieval if the last issued command was a read command, or start a new command if the last command was a write command or a control command (BACKGROUND, GO, GO_UNTIL or TRACE1). The ACK pulse is not issued earlier than 32 serial clock cycles after the BDM command was issued. The end of the BDM command is assumed to be the 16th tick of the last bit. This minimum delay assures enough time for the host to perceive the ACK pulse. Note also that, there is no upper limit for the delay between the command and the related ACK pulse, since the command execution depends upon the CPU bus, which in some cases could be very slow due to long accesses taking place.This protocol allows a great flexibility for the POD designers, since it does not rely on any accurate time measurement or short response time to any event in the serial communication.
BDM Clock (Target MCU)
16 Cycles Target Transmits ACK Pulse High-Impedance 32 Cycles Speedup Pulse Minimum Delay From the BDM Command BKGD Pin Earliest Start of Next Bit High-Impedance
16th Tick of the Last Command Bit
Figure 5-10. Target Acknowledge Pulse (ACK)
NOTE If the ACK pulse was issued by the target, the host assumes the previous command was executed. If the CPU enters wait or stop prior to executing a hardware command, the ACK pulse will not be issued meaning that the BDM command was not executed. After entering wait or stop mode, the BDM command is no longer pending.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 146 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
Figure 5-11 shows the ACK handshake protocol in a command level timing diagram. The READ_BYTE instruction is used as an example. First, the 8-bit instruction opcode is sent by the host, followed by the address of the memory location to be read. The target BDM decodes the instruction. A bus cycle is grabbed (free or stolen) by the BDM and it executes the READ_BYTE operation. Having retrieved the data, the BDM issues an ACK pulse to the host controller, indicating that the addressed byte is ready to be retrieved. After detecting the ACK pulse, the host initiates the byte retrieval process. Note that data is sent in the form of a word and the host needs to determine which is the appropriate byte based on whether the address was odd or even.
Target BKGD Pin READ_BYTE Host Byte Address Target Host New BDM Command Host BDM Issues the ACK Pulse (out of scale) BDM Executes the READ_BYTE Command Target
(2) Bytes are Retrieved
BDM Decodes the Command
Figure 5-11. Handshake Protocol at Command Level
Differently from the normal bit transfer (where the host initiates the transmission), the serial interface ACK handshake pulse is initiated by the target MCU by issuing a negative edge in the BKGD pin. The hardware handshake protocol in Figure 5-10 specifies the timing when the BKGD pin is being driven, so the host should follow this timing constraint in order to avoid the risk of an electrical conflict in the BKGD pin. NOTE The only place the BKGD pin can have an electrical conflict is when one side is driving low and the other side is issuing a speedup pulse (high). Other "highs" are pulled rather than driven. However, at low rates the time of the speedup pulse can become lengthy and so the potential conflict time becomes longer as well. The ACK handshake protocol does not support nested ACK pulses. If a BDM command is not acknowledge by an ACK pulse, the host needs to abort the pending command first in order to be able to issue a new BDM command. When the CPU enters wait or stop while the host issues a hardware command (e.g., WRITE_BYTE), the target discards the incoming command due to the wait or stop being detected. Therefore, the command is not acknowledged by the target, which means that the ACK pulse will not be issued in this case. After a certain time the host (not aware of stop or wait) should decide to abort any possible pending ACK pulse in order to be sure a new command can be issued. Therefore, the protocol provides a mechanism in which a command, and its corresponding ACK, can be aborted.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 147
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
NOTE The ACK pulse does not provide a time out. This means for the GO_UNTIL command that it can not be distinguished if a stop or wait has been executed (command discarded and ACK not issued) or if the "UNTIL" condition (BDM active) is just not reached yet. Hence in any case where the ACK pulse of a command is not issued the possible pending command should be aborted before issuing a new command. See the handshake abort procedure described in Section 5.4.8, "Hardware Handshake Abort Procedure".
5.4.8
Hardware Handshake Abort Procedure
The abort procedure is based on the SYNC command. In order to abort a command, which had not issued the corresponding ACK pulse, the host controller should generate a low pulse in the BKGD pin by driving it low for at least 128 serial clock cycles and then driving it high for one serial clock cycle, providing a speedup pulse. By detecting this long low pulse in the BKGD pin, the target executes the SYNC protocol, see Section 5.4.9, "SYNC -- Request Timed Reference Pulse", and assumes that the pending command and therefore the related ACK pulse, are being aborted. Therefore, after the SYNC protocol has been completed the host is free to issue new BDM commands. For Firmware READ or WRITE commands it can not be guaranteed that the pending command is aborted when issuing a SYNC before the corresponding ACK pulse. There is a short latency time from the time the READ or WRITE access begins until it is finished and the corresponding ACK pulse is issued. The latency time depends on the firmware READ or WRITE command that is issued and on the selected bus clock rate. When the SYNC command starts during this latency time the READ or WRITE command will not be aborted, but the corresponding ACK pulse will be aborted. A pending GO, TRACE1 or GO_UNTIL command can not be aborted. Only the corresponding ACK pulse can be aborted by the SYNC command. Although it is not recommended, the host could abort a pending BDM command by issuing a low pulse in the BKGD pin shorter than 128 serial clock cycles, which will not be interpreted as the SYNC command. The ACK is actually aborted when a negative edge is perceived by the target in the BKGD pin. The short abort pulse should have at least 4 clock cycles keeping the BKGD pin low, in order to allow the negative edge to be detected by the target. In this case, the target will not execute the SYNC protocol but the pending command will be aborted along with the ACK pulse. The potential problem with this abort procedure is when there is a conflict between the ACK pulse and the short abort pulse. In this case, the target may not perceive the abort pulse. The worst case is when the pending command is a read command (i.e., READ_BYTE). If the abort pulse is not perceived by the target the host will attempt to send a new command after the abort pulse was issued, while the target expects the host to retrieve the accessed memory byte. In this case, host and target will run out of synchronism. However, if the command to be aborted is not a read command the short abort pulse could be used. After a command is aborted the target assumes the next negative edge, after the abort pulse, is the first bit of a new BDM command. NOTE The details about the short abort pulse are being provided only as a reference for the reader to better understand the BDM internal behavior. It is not recommended that this procedure be used in a real application.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 148 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
Since the host knows the target serial clock frequency, the SYNC command (used to abort a command) does not need to consider the lower possible target frequency. In this case, the host could issue a SYNC very close to the 128 serial clock cycles length. Providing a small overhead on the pulse length in order to assure the SYNC pulse will not be misinterpreted by the target. See Section 5.4.9, "SYNC -- Request Timed Reference Pulse". Figure 5-12 shows a SYNC command being issued after a READ_BYTE, which aborts the READ_BYTE command. Note that, after the command is aborted a new command could be issued by the host computer.
READ_BYTE CMD is Aborted by the SYNC Request (Out of Scale) BKGD Pin READ_BYTE Host Memory Address Target SYNC Response From the Target (Out of Scale) READ_STATUS Host Target New BDM Command Host Target
BDM Decode and Starts to Execute the READ_BYTE Command
New BDM Command
Figure 5-12. ACK Abort Procedure at the Command Level
NOTE Figure 5-12 does not represent the signals in a true timing scale Figure 5-13 shows a conflict between the ACK pulse and the SYNC request pulse. This conflict could occur if a POD device is connected to the target BKGD pin and the target is already in debug active mode. Consider that the target CPU is executing a pending BDM command at the exact moment the POD is being connected to the BKGD pin. In this case, an ACK pulse is issued along with the SYNC command. In this case, there is an electrical conflict between the ACK speedup pulse and the SYNC pulse. Since this is not a probable situation, the protocol does not prevent this conflict from happening.
At Least 128 Cycles BDM Clock (Target MCU) ACK Pulse Target MCU Drives to BKGD Pin Host Drives SYNC To BKGD Pin Host and Target Drive to BKGD Pin Host SYNC Request Pulse BKGD Pin 16 Cycles High-Impedance Electrical Conflict Speedup Pulse
Figure 5-13. ACK Pulse and SYNC Request Conflict
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 149
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
NOTE This information is being provided so that the MCU integrator will be aware that such a conflict could occur. The hardware handshake protocol is enabled by the ACK_ENABLE and disabled by the ACK_DISABLE BDM commands. This provides backwards compatibility with the existing POD devices which are not able to execute the hardware handshake protocol. It also allows for new POD devices, that support the hardware handshake protocol, to freely communicate with the target device. If desired, without the need for waiting for the ACK pulse. The commands are described as follows: * ACK_ENABLE -- enables the hardware handshake protocol. The target will issue the ACK pulse when a CPU command is executed by the CPU. The ACK_ENABLE command itself also has the ACK pulse as a response. * ACK_DISABLE -- disables the ACK pulse protocol. In this case, the host needs to use the worst case delay time at the appropriate places in the protocol. The default state of the BDM after reset is hardware handshake protocol disabled. All the read commands will ACK (if enabled) when the data bus cycle has completed and the data is then ready for reading out by the BKGD serial pin. All the write commands will ACK (if enabled) after the data has been received by the BDM through the BKGD serial pin and when the data bus cycle is complete. See Section 5.4.3, "BDM Hardware Commands" and Section 5.4.4, "Standard BDM Firmware Commands" for more information on the BDM commands. The ACK_ENABLE sends an ACK pulse when the command has been completed. This feature could be used by the host to evaluate if the target supports the hardware handshake protocol. If an ACK pulse is issued in response to this command, the host knows that the target supports the hardware handshake protocol. If the target does not support the hardware handshake protocol the ACK pulse is not issued. In this case, the ACK_ENABLE command is ignored by the target since it is not recognized as a valid command. The BACKGROUND command will issue an ACK pulse when the CPU changes from normal to background mode. The ACK pulse related to this command could be aborted using the SYNC command. The GO command will issue an ACK pulse when the CPU exits from background mode. The ACK pulse related to this command could be aborted using the SYNC command. The GO_UNTIL command is equivalent to a GO command with exception that the ACK pulse, in this case, is issued when the CPU enters into background mode. This command is an alternative to the GO command and should be used when the host wants to trace if a breakpoint match occurs and causes the CPU to enter active background mode. Note that the ACK is issued whenever the CPU enters BDM, which could be caused by a breakpoint match or by a BGND instruction being executed. The ACK pulse related to this command could be aborted using the SYNC command. The TRACE1 command has the related ACK pulse issued when the CPU enters background active mode after one instruction of the application program is executed. The ACK pulse related to this command could be aborted using the SYNC command.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 150 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
5.4.9
SYNC -- Request Timed Reference Pulse
The SYNC command is unlike other BDM commands because the host does not necessarily know the correct communication speed to use for BDM communications until after it has analyzed the response to the SYNC command. To issue a SYNC command, the host should perform the following steps: 1. Drive the BKGD pin low for at least 128 cycles at the lowest possible BDM serial communication frequency (The lowest serial communication frequency is determined by the settings for the VCO clock (CPMUSYNR). The BDM clock frequency is always VCO clock frequency divided by 8.) 2. Drive BKGD high for a brief speedup pulse to get a fast rise time (this speedup pulse is typically one cycle of the host clock.) 3. Remove all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance. 4. Listen to the BKGD pin for the sync response pulse. Upon detecting the SYNC request from the host, the target performs the following steps: 1. Discards any incomplete command received or bit retrieved. 2. Waits for BKGD to return to a logic one. 3. Delays 16 cycles to allow the host to stop driving the high speedup pulse. 4. Drives BKGD low for 128 cycles at the current BDM serial communication frequency. 5. Drives a one-cycle high speedup pulse to force a fast rise time on BKGD. 6. Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance. The host measures the low time of this 128 cycle SYNC response pulse and determines the correct speed for subsequent BDM communications. Typically, the host can determine the correct communication speed within a few percent of the actual target speed and the communication protocol can easily tolerate speed errors of several percent. As soon as the SYNC request is detected by the target, any partially received command or bit retrieved is discarded. This is referred to as a soft-reset, equivalent to a time-out in the serial communication. After the SYNC response, the target will consider the next negative edge (issued by the host) as the start of a new BDM command or the start of new SYNC request. Another use of the SYNC command pulse is to abort a pending ACK pulse. The behavior is exactly the same as in a regular SYNC command. Note that one of the possible causes for a command to not be acknowledged by the target is a host-target synchronization problem. In this case, the command may not have been understood by the target and so an ACK response pulse will not be issued.
5.4.10
Instruction Tracing
When a TRACE1 command is issued to the BDM in active BDM, the CPU exits the standard BDM firmware and executes a single instruction in the user code. Once this has occurred, the CPU is forced to return to the standard BDM firmware and the BDM is active and ready to receive a new command. If the TRACE1 command is issued again, the next user instruction will be executed. This facilitates stepping or tracing through the user code one instruction at a time.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 151
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
If an interrupt is pending when a TRACE1 command is issued, the interrupt stacking operation occurs but no user instruction is executed. Once back in standard BDM firmware execution, the program counter points to the first instruction in the interrupt service routine. Be aware when tracing through the user code that the execution of the user code is done step by step but all peripherals are free running. Hence possible timing relations between CPU code execution and occurrence of events of other peripherals no longer exist. Do not trace the CPU instruction BGND used for soft breakpoints. Tracing over the BGND instruction will result in a return address pointing to BDM firmware address space. When tracing through user code which contains stop or wait instructions the following will happen when the stop or wait instruction is traced: The CPU enters stop or wait mode and the TRACE1 command can not be finished before leaving the low power mode. This is the case because BDM active mode can not be entered after CPU executed the stop instruction. However all BDM hardware commands except the BACKGROUND command are operational after tracing a stop or wait instruction and still being in stop or wait mode. If system stop mode is entered (all bus masters are in stop mode) no BDM command is operational. As soon as stop or wait mode is exited the CPU enters BDM active mode and the saved PC value points to the entry of the corresponding interrupt service routine. In case the handshake feature is enabled the corresponding ACK pulse of the TRACE1 command will be discarded when tracing a stop or wait instruction. Hence there is no ACK pulse when BDM active mode is entered as part of the TRACE1 command after CPU exited from stop or wait mode. All valid commands sent during CPU being in stop or wait mode or after CPU exited from stop or wait mode will have an ACK pulse. The handshake feature becomes disabled only when system stop mode has been reached. Hence after a system stop mode the handshake feature must be enabled again by sending the ACK_ENABLE command.
5.4.11
Serial Communication Time Out
The host initiates a host-to-target serial transmission by generating a falling edge on the BKGD pin. If BKGD is kept low for more than 128 target clock cycles, the target understands that a SYNC command was issued. In this case, the target will keep waiting for a rising edge on BKGD in order to answer the SYNC request pulse. If the rising edge is not detected, the target will keep waiting forever without any time-out limit. Consider now the case where the host returns BKGD to logic one before 128 cycles. This is interpreted as a valid bit transmission, and not as a SYNC request. The target will keep waiting for another falling edge marking the start of a new bit. If, however, a new falling edge is not detected by the target within 512 clock cycles since the last falling edge, a time-out occurs and the current command is discarded without affecting memory or the operating mode of the MCU. This is referred to as a soft-reset. If a read command is issued but the data is not retrieved within 512 serial clock cycles, a soft-reset will occur causing the command to be disregarded. The data is not available for retrieval after the time-out has occurred. This is the expected behavior if the handshake protocol is not enabled. In order to allow the data to be retrieved even with a large clock frequency mismatch (between BDM and CPU) when the hardware
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 152 Freescale Semiconductor
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
handshake protocol is enabled, the time out between a read command and the data retrieval is disabled. Therefore, the host could wait for more then 512 serial clock cycles and still be able to retrieve the data from an issued read command. However, once the handshake pulse (ACK pulse) is issued, the time-out feature is re-activated, meaning that the target will time out after 512 clock cycles. Therefore, the host needs to retrieve the data within a 512 serial clock cycles time frame after the ACK pulse had been issued. After that period, the read command is discarded and the data is no longer available for retrieval. Any negative edge in the BKGD pin after the time-out period is considered to be a new command or a SYNC request. Note that whenever a partially issued command, or partially retrieved data, has occurred the time out in the serial communication is active. This means that if a time frame higher than 512 serial clock cycles is observed between two consecutive negative edges and the command being issued or data being retrieved is not complete, a soft-reset will occur causing the partially received command or data retrieved to be disregarded. The next negative edge in the BKGD pin, after a soft-reset has occurred, is considered by the target as the start of a new BDM command, or the start of a SYNC request pulse.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 153
Background Debug Module (S12SBDMV1)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 154 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 6 S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-1. Revision History
Revision Number
02.07 02.08 02.09
Revision Date
13.DEC.2007 09.MAY.2008 29.MAY.2008
Sections Affected
6.5 General 6.4.5.4
Summary of Changes
Added application information Spelling corrections. Revision history format changed. Added note for end aligned, PurePC, rollover case.
6.1
Introduction
The S12SDBG module provides an on-chip trace buffer with flexible triggering capability to allow nonintrusive debug of application software. The S12SDBG module is optimized for S12SCPU debugging. Typically the S12SDBG module is used in conjunction with the S12SBDM module, whereby the user configures the S12SDBG module for a debugging session over the BDM interface. Once configured the S12SDBG module is armed and the device leaves BDM returning control to the user program, which is then monitored by the S12SDBG module. Alternatively the S12SDBG module can be configured over a serial interface using SWI routines.
6.1.1
Glossary Of Terms
COF: Change Of Flow. Change in the program flow due to a conditional branch, indexed jump or interrupt. BDM: Background Debug Mode S12SBDM: Background Debug Module DUG: Device User Guide, describing the features of the device into which the DBG is integrated. WORD: 16 bit data entity Data Line: 20 bit data entity CPU: S12SCPU module DBG: S12SDBG module POR: Power On Reset Tag: Tags can be attached to CPU opcodes as they enter the instruction pipe. If the tagged opcode reaches the execution stage a tag hit occurs.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 155
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.1.2
Overview
The comparators monitor the bus activity of the CPU module. A match can initiate a state sequencer transition. On a transition to the Final State, bus tracing is triggered and/or a breakpoint can be generated. Independent of comparator matches a transition to Final State with associated tracing and breakpoint can be triggered immediately by writing to the TRIG control bit. The trace buffer is visible through a 2-byte window in the register address map and can be read out using standard 16-bit word reads. Tracing is disabled when the MCU system is secured.
6.1.3
*
Features
Three comparators (A, B and C) -- Comparators A compares the full address bus and full 16-bit data bus -- Comparator A features a data bus mask register -- Comparators B and C compare the full address bus only -- Each comparator features selection of read or write access cycles -- Comparator B allows selection of byte or word access cycles -- Comparator matches can initiate state sequencer transitions Three comparator modes -- Simple address/data comparator match mode -- Inside address range mode, Addmin Address Addmax -- Outside address range match mode, Address < Addmin or Address > Addmax Two types of matches -- Tagged -- This matches just before a specific instruction begins execution -- Force -- This is valid on the first instruction boundary after a match occurs Two types of breakpoints -- CPU breakpoint entering BDM on breakpoint (BDM) -- CPU breakpoint executing SWI on breakpoint (SWI) Trigger mode independent of comparators -- TRIG Immediate software trigger Four trace modes -- Normal: change of flow (COF) PC information is stored (see 6.4.5.2.1) for change of flow definition. -- Loop1: same as Normal but inhibits consecutive duplicate source address entries -- Detail: address and data for all cycles except free cycles and opcode fetches are stored -- Compressed Pure PC: all program counter addresses are stored 4-stage state sequencer for trace buffer control -- Tracing session trigger linked to Final State of state sequencer -- Begin and End alignment of tracing to trigger
*
*
*
* *
*
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 156 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.1.4
Modes of Operation
The DBG module can be used in all MCU functional modes. During BDM hardware accesses and whilst the BDM module is active, CPU monitoring is disabled. When the CPU enters active BDM Mode through a BACKGROUND command, the DBG module, if already armed, remains armed. The DBG module tracing is disabled if the MCU is secure, however, breakpoints can still be generated
Table 6-2. Mode Dependent Restriction Summary
BDM Enable x 0 0 1 1 BDM Active x 0 1 0 1 MCU Secure 1 0 0 0 0 Yes No Comparator Matches Enabled Yes Yes Breakpoints Possible Yes Only SWI Yes No Tagging Possible Yes Yes Yes No Tracing Possible No Yes Yes No
Active BDM not possible when not enabled
6.1.5
Block Diagram
TAGS BREAKPOINT REQUESTS
TAGHITS
SECURE MATCH0 TRANSITION
TO CPU
COMPARATOR MATCH CONTROL
CPU BUS
BUS INTERFACE
COMPARATOR A
COMPARATOR B
MATCH1
TAG & MATCH CONTROL LOGIC
STATE STATE SEQUENCER STATE
COMPARATOR C
MATCH2 TRACE CONTROL TRIGGER
TRACE BUFFER READ TRACE DATA (DBG READ DATA BUS)
Figure 6-1. Debug Module Block Diagram
6.2
External Signal Description
There are no external signals associated with this module.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 157
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.3
6.3.1
Memory Map and Registers
Module Memory Map
A summary of the registers associated with the DBG sub-block is shown in Figure 6-2. Detailed descriptions of the registers and bits are given in the subsections that follow.
Address 0x0020 Name DBGC1 R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 ARM
1
6 0 TRIG 0
5 0
4 BDM 0
3 DBGBRK 0
2 0
1
Bit 0 COMRV
0x0021
DBGSR
TBF
0
SSF2
SSF1
SSF0
0x0022
DBGTCR
0
TSOURCE 0
0
0
TRCMOD 0 0
0
TALIGN
0x0023
DBGC2
0
0
0
ABCM Bit 9 Bit 8
0x0024
DBGTBH
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
0x0025
DBGTBL
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0x0026
DBGCNT
R 1 TBF W R W R W 0 0
0
CNT
0x0027 0x0027
2
DBGSCRX DBGMFR
0 0
0 0
0 0
SC3 0
SC2 MC2
SC1 MC1
SC0 MC0
0x0028 0x0028 0x0028
3
4
R W R DBGBCTL W R DBGCCTL W DBGACTL DBGXAH R W R W R W R W R W
SZE SZE 0
SZ SZ 0
TAG TAG TAG 0
BRK BRK BRK 0
RW RW RW 0
RWE RWE RWE 0
NDB 0 0
COMPE COMPE COMPE
0x0029
0
0
Bit 17
Bit 16
0x002A
DBGXAM
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0x002B
DBGXAL
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0x002C
DBGADH
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0x002D
DBGADL
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Figure 6-2. Quick Reference to DBG Registers
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 158 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Address 0x002E
Name DBGADHM R W
Bit 7 Bit 15
6 14
5 13
4 12
3 11
2 10
1 9
Bit 0 Bit 8
0x002F
1 2 3 4
R Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 W This bit is visible at DBGCNT[7] and DBGSR[7] This represents the contents if the Comparator A control register is blended into this address. This represents the contents if the Comparator B control register is blended into this address This represents the contents if the Comparator C control register is blended into this address DBGADLM
1
Bit 0
Figure 6-2. Quick Reference to DBG Registers
6.3.2
Register Descriptions
This section consists of the DBG control and trace buffer register descriptions in address order. Each comparator has a bank of registers that are visible through an 8-byte window between 0x0028 and 0x002F in the DBG module register address map. When ARM is set in DBGC1, the only bits in the DBG module registers that can be written are ARM, TRIG, and COMRV[1:0]
6.3.2.1
Debug Control Register 1 (DBGC1)
Address: 0x0020
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
ARM 0
0 TRIG 0
0 0
BDM 0
DBGBRK 0
0 0 0
COMRV 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-3. Debug Control Register (DBGC1)
Read: Anytime Write: Bits 7, 1, 0 anytime Bit 6 can be written anytime but always reads back as 0. Bits 4:3 anytime DBG is not armed. NOTE When disarming the DBG by clearing ARM with software, the contents of bits[4:3] are not affected by the write, since up until the write operation, ARM = 1 preventing these bits from being written. These bits must be cleared using a second write if required.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 159
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-3. DBGC1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 ARM Description Arm Bit -- The ARM bit controls whether the DBG module is armed. This bit can be set and cleared by user software and is automatically cleared on completion of a debug session, or if a breakpoint is generated with tracing not enabled. On setting this bit the state sequencer enters State1. 0 Debugger disarmed 1 Debugger armed Immediate Trigger Request Bit -- This bit when written to 1 requests an immediate trigger independent of state sequencer status. When tracing is complete a forced breakpoint may be generated depending upon DBGBRK and BDM bit settings. This bit always reads back a 0. Writing a 0 to this bit has no effect. If the DBGTCR_TSOURCE bit is clear no tracing is carried out. If tracing has already commenced using BEGIN trigger alignment, it continues until the end of the tracing session as defined by the TALIGN bit, thus TRIG has no affect. In secure mode tracing is disabled and writing to this bit cannot initiate a tracing session. The session is ended by setting TRIG and ARM simultaneously. 0 Do not trigger until the state sequencer enters the Final State. 1 Trigger immediately Background Debug Mode Enable -- This bit determines if a breakpoint causes the system to enter Background Debug Mode (BDM) or initiate a Software Interrupt (SWI). If this bit is set but the BDM is not enabled by the ENBDM bit in the BDM module, then breakpoints default to SWI. 0 Breakpoint to Software Interrupt if BDM inactive. Otherwise no breakpoint. 1 Breakpoint to BDM, if BDM enabled. Otherwise breakpoint to SWI S12SDBG Breakpoint Enable Bit -- The DBGBRK bit controls whether the debugger will request a breakpoint on reaching the state sequencer Final State. If tracing is enabled, the breakpoint is generated on completion of the tracing session. If tracing is not enabled, the breakpoint is generated immediately. 0 No Breakpoint generated 1 Breakpoint generated Comparator Register Visibility Bits -- These bits determine which bank of comparator register is visible in the 8-byte window of the S12SDBG module address map, located between 0x0028 to 0x002F. Furthermore these bits determine which register is visible at the address 0x0027. See Table 6-4.
6 TRIG
4 BDM
3 DBGBRK
1-0 COMRV
Table 6-4. COMRV Encoding
COMRV 00 01 10 11 Visible Comparator Comparator A Comparator B Comparator C None Visible Register at 0x0027 DBGSCR1 DBGSCR2 DBGSCR3 DBGMFR
6.3.2.2
Debug Status Register (DBGSR)
Address: 0x0021
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset POR
TBF -- 0
0 0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0
SSF2 0 0
SSF1 0 0
SSF0 0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-4. Debug Status Register (DBGSR)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 160 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Read: Anytime Write: Never
Table 6-5. DBGSR Field Descriptions
Field 7 TBF Description Trace Buffer Full -- The TBF bit indicates that the trace buffer has stored 64 or more lines of data since it was last armed. If this bit is set, then all 64 lines will be valid data, regardless of the value of DBGCNT bits. The TBF bit is cleared when ARM in DBGC1 is written to a one. The TBF is cleared by the power on reset initialization. Other system generated resets have no affect on this bit This bit is also visible at DBGCNT[7] State Sequencer Flag Bits -- The SSF bits indicate in which state the State Sequencer is currently in. During a debug session on each transition to a new state these bits are updated. If the debug session is ended by software clearing the ARM bit, then these bits retain their value to reflect the last state of the state sequencer before disarming. If a debug session is ended by an internal event, then the state sequencer returns to state0 and these bits are cleared to indicate that state0 was entered during the session. On arming the module the state sequencer enters state1 and these bits are forced to SSF[2:0] = 001. See Table 6-6.
2-0 SSF[2:0]
Table 6-6. SSF[2:0] -- State Sequence Flag Bit Encoding
SSF[2:0] 000 001 010 011 100 101,110,111 Current State State0 (disarmed) State1 State2 State3 Final State Reserved
6.3.2.3
Debug Trace Control Register (DBGTCR)
Address: 0x0022
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
TSOURCE 0
0 0
0 0 0
TRCMOD 0
0 0
TALIGN 0
Figure 6-5. Debug Trace Control Register (DBGTCR)
Read: Anytime Write: Bit 6 only when DBG is neither secure nor armed.Bits 3,2,0 anytime the module is disarmed.
Table 6-7. DBGTCR Field Descriptions
Field 6 TSOURCE Description Trace Source Control Bit -- The TSOURCE bit enables a tracing session given a trigger condition. If the MCU system is secured, this bit cannot be set and tracing is inhibited. This bit must be set to read the trace buffer. 0 Debug session without tracing requested 1 Debug session with tracing requested
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 161
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-7. DBGTCR Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 3-2 TRCMOD Description Trace Mode Bits -- See 6.4.5.2 for detailed Trace Mode descriptions. In Normal Mode, change of flow information is stored. In Loop1 Mode, change of flow information is stored but redundant entries into trace memory are inhibited. In Detail Mode, address and data for all memory and register accesses is stored. In Compressed Pure PC mode the program counter value for each instruction executed is stored. See Table 6-8. Trigger Align Bit -- This bit controls whether the trigger is aligned to the beginning or end of a tracing session. 0 Trigger at end of stored data 1 Trigger before storing data
0 TALIGN
Table 6-8. TRCMOD Trace Mode Bit Encoding
TRCMOD 00 01 10 11 Description Normal Loop1 Detail Compressed Pure PC
6.3.2.4
Debug Control Register2 (DBGC2)
Address: 0x0023
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0 0
ABCM 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-6. Debug Control Register2 (DBGC2)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime the module is disarmed. This register configures the comparators for range matching.
Table 6-9. DBGC2 Field Descriptions
Field 1-0 ABCM[1:0] Description A and B Comparator Match Control -- These bits determine the A and B comparator match mapping as described in Table 6-10.
Table 6-10. ABCM Encoding
ABCM 00 01 10 Description Match0 mapped to comparator A match: Match1 mapped to comparator B match. Match 0 mapped to comparator A/B inside range: Match1 disabled. Match 0 mapped to comparator A/B outside range: Match1 disabled.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 162 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-10. ABCM Encoding
ABCM Description 11 Reserved(1) 1. Currently defaults to Comparator A, Comparator B disabled
6.3.2.5
Debug Trace Buffer Register (DBGTBH:DBGTBL)
Address: 0x0024, 0x0025
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W POR Other Resets
Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 X -- X -- X -- X -- X -- X -- X --
Bit 8 X --
Bit 7 X --
Bit 6 X --
Bit 5 X --
Bit 4 X --
Bit 3 X --
Bit 2 X --
Bit 1 X --
Bit 0 X --
Figure 6-7. Debug Trace Buffer Register (DBGTB)
Read: Only when unlocked AND unsecured AND not armed AND TSOURCE set. Write: Aligned word writes when disarmed unlock the trace buffer for reading but do not affect trace buffer contents.
Table 6-11. DBGTB Field Descriptions
Field 15-0 Bit[15:0] Description Trace Buffer Data Bits -- The Trace Buffer Register is a window through which the 20-bit wide data lines of the Trace Buffer may be read 16 bits at a time. Each valid read of DBGTB increments an internal trace buffer pointer which points to the next address to be read. When the ARM bit is set the trace buffer is locked to prevent reading. The trace buffer can only be unlocked for reading by writing to DBGTB with an aligned word write when the module is disarmed. The DBGTB register can be read only as an aligned word, any byte reads or misaligned access of these registers return 0 and do not cause the trace buffer pointer to increment to the next trace buffer address. Similarly reads while the debugger is armed or with the TSOURCE bit clear, return 0 and do not affect the trace buffer pointer. The POR state is undefined. Other resets do not affect the trace buffer contents.
6.3.2.6
Debug Count Register (DBGCNT)
Address: 0x0026
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset POR
TBF -- 0
0 -- 0 -- 0 -- 0 -- 0
CNT -- 0 -- 0 -- 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-8. Debug Count Register (DBGCNT)
Read: Anytime Write: Never
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 163
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-12. DBGCNT Field Descriptions
Field 7 TBF Description Trace Buffer Full -- The TBF bit indicates that the trace buffer has stored 64 or more lines of data since it was last armed. If this bit is set, then all 64 lines will be valid data, regardless of the value of DBGCNT bits. The TBF bit is cleared when ARM in DBGC1 is written to a one. The TBF is cleared by the power on reset initialization. Other system generated resets have no affect on this bit This bit is also visible at DBGSR[7] Count Value -- The CNT bits indicate the number of valid data 20-bit data lines stored in the Trace Buffer. Table 6-13 shows the correlation between the CNT bits and the number of valid data lines in the Trace Buffer. When the CNT rolls over to zero, the TBF bit in DBGSR is set and incrementing of CNT will continue in endtrigger mode. The DBGCNT register is cleared when ARM in DBGC1 is written to a one. The DBGCNT register is cleared by power-on-reset initialization but is not cleared by other system resets. Thus should a reset occur during a debug session, the DBGCNT register still indicates after the reset, the number of valid trace buffer entries stored before the reset occurred. The DBGCNT register is not decremented when reading from the trace buffer.
5-0 CNT[5:0]
Table 6-13. CNT Decoding Table
TBF 0 0 CNT[5:0] 000000 000001 000010 000100 000110 .. 111111 000000 000001 .. .. 111110 Description No data valid 1 line valid 2 lines valid 4 lines valid 6 lines valid .. 63 lines valid 64 lines valid; if using Begin trigger alignment, ARM bit will be cleared and the tracing session ends. 64 lines valid, oldest data has been overwritten by most recent data
1 1
6.3.2.7
Debug State Control Registers
There is a dedicated control register for each of the state sequencer states 1 to 3 that determines if transitions from that state are allowed, depending upon comparator matches or tag hits, and defines the next state for the state sequencer following a match. The three debug state control registers are located at the same address in the register address map (0x0027). Each register can be accessed using the COMRV bits in DBGC1 to blend in the required register. The COMRV = 11 value blends in the match flag register (DBGMFR).
Table 6-14. State Control Register Access Encoding
COMRV 00 01 10 11 Visible State Control Register DBGSCR1 DBGSCR2 DBGSCR3 DBGMFR
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 164 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.3.2.7.1
Address: 0x0027
7
Debug State Control Register 1 (DBGSCR1)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
SC3 0
SC2 0
SC1 0
SC0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-9. Debug State Control Register 1 (DBGSCR1)
Read: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 Write: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 and DBG is not armed. This register is visible at 0x0027 only with COMRV[1:0] = 00. The state control register 1 selects the targeted next state whilst in State1. The matches refer to the match channels of the comparator match control logic as depicted in Figure 6-1 and described in 6.3.2.8.1. Comparators must be enabled by setting the comparator enable bit in the associated DBGXCTL control register.
Table 6-15. DBGSCR1 Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 SC[3:0] Description These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State1, based upon the match event.
Table 6-16. State1 Sequencer Next State Selection
SC[3:0] 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 Description (Unspecified matches have no effect) Any match to Final State Match1 to State3 Match2 to State2 Match1 to State2 Match0 to State2....... Match1 to State3 Match1 to State3.........Match0 to Final State Match0 to State2....... Match2 to State3 Either Match0 or Match1 to State2 Reserved Match0 to State3 Reserved Reserved Reserved Either Match0 or Match2 to Final State........Match1 to State2 Reserved Reserved
The priorities described in Table 6-36 dictate that in the case of simultaneous matches, a match leading to final state has priority followed by the match on the lower channel number (0,1,2). Thus with SC[3:0]=1101 a simultaneous match0/match1 transitions to final state.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 165
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.3.2.7.2
Address: 0x0027
7
Debug State Control Register 2 (DBGSCR2)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
SC3 0
SC2 0
SC1 0
SC0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-10. Debug State Control Register 2 (DBGSCR2)
Read: If COMRV[1:0] = 01 Write: If COMRV[1:0] = 01 and DBG is not armed. This register is visible at 0x0027 only with COMRV[1:0] = 01. The state control register 2 selects the targeted next state whilst in State2. The matches refer to the match channels of the comparator match control logic as depicted in Figure 6-1 and described in 6.3.2.8.1. Comparators must be enabled by setting the comparator enable bit in the associated DBGXCTL control register.
Table 6-17. DBGSCR2 Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 SC[3:0] Description These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State2, based upon the match event.
Table 6-18. State2 --Sequencer Next State Selection
SC[3:0] 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 Description (Unspecified matches have no effect) Match0 to State1....... Match2 to State3. Match1 to State3 Match2 to State3 Match1 to State3....... Match0 Final State Match1 to State1....... Match2 to State3. Match2 to Final State Match2 to State1..... Match0 to Final State Either Match0 or Match1 to Final State Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Either Match0 or Match1 to Final State........Match2 to State3 Reserved Reserved Either Match0 or Match1 to Final State........Match2 to State1
The priorities described in Table 6-36 dictate that in the case of simultaneous matches, a match leading to final state has priority followed by the match on the lower channel number (0,1,2)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 166 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.3.2.7.3
Address: 0x0027
7
Debug State Control Register 3 (DBGSCR3)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
SC3 0
SC2 0
SC1 0
SC0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-11. Debug State Control Register 3 (DBGSCR3)
Read: If COMRV[1:0] = 10 Write: If COMRV[1:0] = 10 and DBG is not armed. This register is visible at 0x0027 only with COMRV[1:0] = 10. The state control register three selects the targeted next state whilst in State3. The matches refer to the match channels of the comparator match control logic as depicted in Figure 6-1 and described in 6.3.2.8.1. Comparators must be enabled by setting the comparator enable bit in the associated DBGXCTL control register.
Table 6-19. DBGSCR3 Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 SC[3:0] Description These bits select the targeted next state whilst in State3, based upon the match event.
Table 6-20. State3 -- Sequencer Next State Selection
SC[3:0] 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 Description (Unspecified matches have no effect) Match0 to State1 Match2 to State2........ Match1 to Final State Match0 to Final State....... Match1 to State1 Match1 to Final State....... Match2 to State1 Match1 to State2 Match1 to Final State Match2 to State2........ Match0 to Final State Match0 to Final State Reserved Reserved Either Match1 or Match2 to State1....... Match0 to Final State Reserved Reserved Either Match1 or Match2 to Final State....... Match0 to State1 Match0 to State2....... Match2 to Final State Reserved
The priorities described in Table 6-36 dictate that in the case of simultaneous matches, a match leading to final state has priority followed by the match on the lower channel number (0,1,2).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 167
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.3.2.7.4
Address: 0x0027
7
Debug Match Flag Register (DBGMFR)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
MC2 0
MC1 0
MC0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-12. Debug Match Flag Register (DBGMFR)
Read: If COMRV[1:0] = 11 Write: Never DBGMFR is visible at 0x0027 only with COMRV[1:0] = 11. It features 3 flag bits each mapped directly to a channel. Should a match occur on the channel during the debug session, then the corresponding flag is set and remains set until the next time the module is armed by writing to the ARM bit. Thus the contents are retained after a debug session for evaluation purposes. These flags cannot be cleared by software, they are cleared only when arming the module. A set flag does not inhibit the setting of other flags. Once a flag is set, further comparator matches on the same channel in the same session have no affect on that flag.
6.3.2.8
Comparator Register Descriptions
Each comparator has a bank of registers that are visible through an 8-byte window in the DBG module register address map. Comparator A consists of 8 register bytes (3 address bus compare registers, two data bus compare registers, two data bus mask registers and a control register). Comparator B consists of four register bytes (three address bus compare registers and a control register). Comparator C consists of four register bytes (three address bus compare registers and a control register). Each set of comparator registers can be accessed using the COMRV bits in the DBGC1 register. Unimplemented registers (e.g. Comparator B data bus and data bus masking) read as zero and cannot be written. The control register for comparator B differs from those of comparators A and C.
Table 6-21. Comparator Register Layout
0x0028 0x0029 0x002A 0x002B 0x002C 0x002D 0x002E 0x002F CONTROL ADDRESS HIGH ADDRESS MEDIUM ADDRESS LOW DATA HIGH COMPARATOR DATA LOW COMPARATOR DATA HIGH MASK DATA LOW MASK Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Comparators A,B and C Comparators A,B and C Comparators A,B and C Comparators A,B and C Comparator A only Comparator A only Comparator A only Comparator A only
6.3.2.8.1
Debug Comparator Control Register (DBGXCTL)
The contents of this register bits 7 and 6 differ depending upon which comparator registers are visible in the 8-byte window of the DBG module register address map.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 168 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Address: 0x0028
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
SZE 0
SZ 0
TAG 0
BRK 0
RW 0
RWE 0
NDB 0
COMPE 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-13. Debug Comparator Control Register DBGACTL (Comparator A)
Address: 0x0028
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
SZE 0
SZ 0
TAG 0
BRK 0
RW 0
RWE 0
0 0
COMPE 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-14. Debug Comparator Control Register DBGBCTL (Comparator B)
Address: 0x0028
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
TAG 0
BRK 0
RW 0
RWE 0
0 0
COMPE 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-15. Debug Comparator Control Register DBGCCTL (Comparator C)
Read: DBGACTL if COMRV[1:0] = 00 DBGBCTL if COMRV[1:0] = 01 DBGCCTL if COMRV[1:0] = 10 Write: DBGACTL if COMRV[1:0] = 00 and DBG not armed DBGBCTL if COMRV[1:0] = 01 and DBG not armed DBGCCTL if COMRV[1:0] = 10 and DBG not armed
Table 6-22. DBGXCTL Field Descriptions
Field 7 SZE (Comparators A and B) 6 SZ (Comparators A and B) Description Size Comparator Enable Bit -- The SZE bit controls whether access size comparison is enabled for the associated comparator. This bit is ignored if the TAG bit in the same register is set. 0 Word/Byte access size is not used in comparison 1 Word/Byte access size is used in comparison Size Comparator Value Bit -- The SZ bit selects either word or byte access size in comparison for the associated comparator. This bit is ignored if the SZE bit is cleared or if the TAG bit in the same register is set. 0 Word access size is compared 1 Byte access size is compared
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 169
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-22. DBGXCTL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 5 TAG Description Tag Select-- This bit controls whether the comparator match has immediate effect, causing an immediate state sequencer transition or tag the opcode at the matched address. Tagged opcodes trigger only if they reach the execution stage of the instruction queue. 0 Allow state sequencer transition immediately on match 1 On match, tag the opcode. If the opcode is about to be executed allow a state sequencer transition Break-- This bit controls whether a comparator match terminates a debug session immediately, independent of state sequencer state. To generate an immediate breakpoint the module breakpoints must be enabled using the DBGC1 bit DBGBRK. 0 The debug session termination is dependent upon the state sequencer and trigger conditions. 1 A match on this channel terminates the debug session immediately; breakpoints if active are generated, tracing, if active, is terminated and the module disarmed. Read/Write Comparator Value Bit -- The RW bit controls whether read or write is used in compare for the associated comparator. The RW bit is not used if RWE = 0. This bit is ignored if the TAG bit in the same register is set. 0 Write cycle is matched1Read cycle is matched Read/Write Enable Bit -- The RWE bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for the associated comparator.This bit is ignored if the TAG bit in the same register is set 0 Read/Write is not used in comparison 1 Read/Write is used in comparison
4 BRK
3 RW
2 RWE
Not Data Bus -- The NDB bit controls whether the match occurs when the data bus matches the comparator 1 register value or when the data bus differs from the register value. This bit is ignored if the TAG bit in the same NDB (Comparator A) register is set. This bit is only available for comparator A. 0 Match on data bus equivalence to comparator register contents 1 Match on data bus difference to comparator register contents 0 COMPE Determines if comparator is enabled 0 The comparator is not enabled 1 The comparator is enabled
Table 6-23 shows the effect for RWE and RW on the comparison conditions. These bits are ignored if the corresponding TAG bit is set since the match occurs based on the tagged opcode reaching the execution stage of the instruction queue.
Table 6-23. Read or Write Comparison Logic Table
RWE Bit 0 0 1 1 1 1 RW Bit x x 0 0 1 1 RW Signal 0 1 0 1 0 1 Comment RW not used in comparison RW not used in comparison Write data bus No match No match Read data bus
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 170 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.3.2.8.2
Address: 0x0029
7
Debug Comparator Address High Register (DBGXAH)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
Bit 17 0
Bit 16 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 6-16. Debug Comparator Address High Register (DBGXAH)
The DBGC1_COMRV bits determine which comparator address registers are visible in the 8-byte window from 0x0028 to 0x002F as shown in Table 6-24.
Table 6-24. Comparator Address Register Visibility
COMRV 00 01 10 11 Visible Comparator DBGAAH, DBGAAM, DBGAAL DBGBAH, DBGBAM, DBGBAL DBGCAH, DBGCAM, DBGCAL None
Read: Anytime. See Table 6-24 for visible register encoding. Write: If DBG not armed. See Table 6-24 for visible register encoding.
Table 6-25. DBGXAH Field Descriptions
Field 1-0 Bit[17:16] Description Comparator Address High Compare Bits -- The Comparator address high compare bits control whether the selected comparator compares the address bus bits [17:16] to a logic one or logic zero. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
6.3.2.8.3
Address: 0x002A
7
Debug Comparator Address Mid Register (DBGXAM)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
Bit 15 0
Bit 14 0
Bit 13 0
Bit 12 0
Bit 11 0
Bit 10 0
Bit 9 0
Bit 8 0
Figure 6-17. Debug Comparator Address Mid Register (DBGXAM)
Read: Anytime. See Table 6-24 for visible register encoding. Write: If DBG not armed. See Table 6-24 for visible register encoding.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 171
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-26. DBGXAM Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 Bit[15:8] Description Comparator Address Mid Compare Bits -- The Comparator address mid compare bits control whether the selected comparator compares the address bus bits [15:8] to a logic one or logic zero. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
6.3.2.8.4
Address: 0x002B
7
Debug Comparator Address Low Register (DBGXAL)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0
Bit 6 0
Bit 5 0
Bit 4 0
Bit 3 0
Bit 2 0
Bit 1 0
Bit 0 0
Figure 6-18. Debug Comparator Address Low Register (DBGXAL)
Read: Anytime. See Table 6-24 for visible register encoding. Write: If DBG not armed. See Table 6-24 for visible register encoding.
Table 6-27. DBGXAL Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 Bits[7:0] Description Comparator Address Low Compare Bits -- The Comparator address low compare bits control whether the selected comparator compares the address bus bits [7:0] to a logic one or logic zero. 0 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic zero 1 Compare corresponding address bit to a logic one
6.3.2.8.5
Address: 0x002C
7
Debug Comparator Data High Register (DBGADH)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
Bit 15 0
Bit 14 0
Bit 13 0
Bit 12 0
Bit 11 0
Bit 10 0
Bit 9 0
Bit 8 0
Figure 6-19. Debug Comparator Data High Register (DBGADH)
Read: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 Write: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 and DBG not armed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 172 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-28. DBGADH Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 Bits[15:8] Description Comparator Data High Compare Bits-- The Comparator data high compare bits control whether the selected comparator compares the data bus bits [15:8] to a logic one or logic zero. The comparator data compare bits are only used in comparison if the corresponding data mask bit is logic 1. This register is available only for comparator A. Data bus comparisons are only performed if the TAG bit in DBGACTL is clear. 0 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic zero 1 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic one
6.3.2.8.6
Address: 0x002D
7
Debug Comparator Data Low Register (DBGADL)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0
Bit 6 0
Bit 5 0
Bit 4 0
Bit 3 0
Bit 2 0
Bit 1 0
Bit 0 0
Figure 6-20. Debug Comparator Data Low Register (DBGADL)
Read: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 Write: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 and DBG not armed.
Table 6-29. DBGADL Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 Bits[7:0] Description Comparator Data Low Compare Bits -- The Comparator data low compare bits control whether the selected comparator compares the data bus bits [7:0] to a logic one or logic zero. The comparator data compare bits are only used in comparison if the corresponding data mask bit is logic 1. This register is available only for comparator A. Data bus comparisons are only performed if the TAG bit in DBGACTL is clear 0 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic zero 1 Compare corresponding data bit to a logic one
6.3.2.8.7
Address: 0x002E
7
Debug Comparator Data High Mask Register (DBGADHM)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
Bit 15 0
Bit 14 0
Bit 13 0
Bit 12 0
Bit 11 0
Bit 10 0
Bit 9 0
Bit 8 0
Figure 6-21. Debug Comparator Data High Mask Register (DBGADHM)
Read: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 Write: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 and DBG not armed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 173
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-30. DBGADHM Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 Bits[15:8] Description Comparator Data High Mask Bits -- The Comparator data high mask bits control whether the selected comparator compares the data bus bits [15:8] to the corresponding comparator data compare bits. Data bus comparisons are only performed if the TAG bit in DBGACTL is clear 0 Do not compare corresponding data bit Any value of corresponding data bit allows match. 1 Compare corresponding data bit
6.3.2.8.8
Address: 0x002F
7
Debug Comparator Data Low Mask Register (DBGADLM)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0
Bit 6 0
Bit 5 0
Bit 4 0
Bit 3 0
Bit 2 0
Bit 1 0
Bit 0 0
Figure 6-22. Debug Comparator Data Low Mask Register (DBGADLM)
Read: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 Write: If COMRV[1:0] = 00 and DBG not armed.
Table 6-31. DBGADLM Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 Bits[7:0] Description Comparator Data Low Mask Bits -- The Comparator data low mask bits control whether the selected comparator compares the data bus bits [7:0] to the corresponding comparator data compare bits. Data bus comparisons are only performed if the TAG bit in DBGACTL is clear 0 Do not compare corresponding data bit. Any value of corresponding data bit allows match 1 Compare corresponding data bit
6.4
Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the DBG module. If the part is in secure mode, the DBG module can generate breakpoints but tracing is not possible.
6.4.1
S12SDBG Operation
Arming the DBG module by setting ARM in DBGC1 allows triggering the state sequencer, storing of data in the trace buffer and generation of breakpoints to the CPU. The DBG module is made up of four main blocks, the comparators, control logic, the state sequencer, and the trace buffer. The comparators monitor the bus activity of the CPU. All comparators can be configured to monitor address bus activity. Comparator A can also be configured to monitor databus activity and mask out individual data bus bits during a compare. Comparators can be configured to use R/W and word/byte access qualification in the comparison. A match with a comparator register value can initiate a state sequencer transition to another state (see Figure 6-24). Either forced or tagged matches are possible. Using
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 174 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
a forced match, a state sequencer transition can occur immediately on a successful match of system busses and comparator registers. Whilst tagging, at a comparator match, the instruction opcode is tagged and only if the instruction reaches the execution stage of the instruction queue can a state sequencer transition occur. In the case of a transition to Final State, bus tracing is triggered and/or a breakpoint can be generated. A state sequencer transition to final state (with associated breakpoint, if enabled) can be initiated by writing to the TRIG bit in the DBGC1 control register. The trace buffer is visible through a 2-byte window in the register address map and must be read out using standard 16-bit word reads.
TAGHITS TAGS BREAKPOINT REQUESTS SECURE MATCH0 TRANSITION STATE STATE SEQUENCER STATE MATCH2 TRACE CONTROL TRIGGER TO CPU
COMPARATOR MATCH CONTROL
CPU BUS
BUS INTERFACE
COMPARATOR A
COMPARATOR B
MATCH1
TAG & MATCH CONTROL LOGIC
COMPARATOR C
TRACE BUFFER READ TRACE DATA (DBG READ DATA BUS)
Figure 6-23. DBG Overview
6.4.2
Comparator Modes
The DBG contains three comparators, A, B and C. Each comparator compares the system address bus with the address stored in DBGXAH, DBGXAM, and DBGXAL. Furthermore, comparator A also compares the data buses to the data stored in DBGADH, DBGADL and allows masking of individual data bus bits. All comparators are disabled in BDM and during BDM accesses. The comparator match control logic (see Figure 6-23) configures comparators to monitor the buses for an exact address or an address range, whereby either an access inside or outside the specified range generates a match condition. The comparator configuration is controlled by the control register contents and the range control by the DBGC2 contents. A match can initiate a transition to another state sequencer state (see 6.4.4"). The comparator control register also allows the type of access to be included in the comparison through the use of the RWE, RW, SZE, and SZ bits. The RWE bit controls whether read or write comparison is enabled for the associated comparator and the RW bit selects either a read or write access for a valid match. Similarly the SZE and
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 175
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
SZ bits allow the size of access (word or byte) to be considered in the compare. Only comparators A and B feature SZE and SZ. The TAG bit in each comparator control register is used to determine the match condition. By setting TAG, the comparator qualifies a match with the output of opcode tracking logic and a state sequencer transition occurs when the tagged instruction reaches the CPU execution stage. Whilst tagging the RW, RWE, SZE, and SZ bits and the comparator data registers are ignored; the comparator address register must be loaded with the exact opcode address. If the TAG bit is clear (forced type match) a comparator match is generated when the selected address appears on the system address bus. If the selected address is an opcode address, the match is generated when the opcode is fetched from the memory, which precedes the instruction execution by an indefinite number of cycles due to instruction pipelining. For a comparator match of an opcode at an odd address when TAG = 0, the corresponding even address must be contained in the comparator register. Thus for an opcode at odd address (n), the comparator register must contain address (n-1). Once a successful comparator match has occurred, the condition that caused the original match is not verified again on subsequent matches. Thus if a particular data value is verified at a given address, this address may not still contain that data value when a subsequent match occurs. Match[0, 1, 2] map directly to Comparators [A, B, C] respectively, except in range modes (see 6.3.2.4). Comparator channel priority rules are described in the priority section (6.4.3.4).
6.4.2.1
Single Address Comparator Match
With range comparisons disabled, the match condition is an exact equivalence of address bus with the value stored in the comparator address registers. Further qualification of the type of access (R/W, word/byte) and databus contents is possible, depending on comparator channel. 6.4.2.1.1 Comparator C
Comparator C offers only address and direction (R/W) comparison. The exact address is compared, thus with the comparator address register loaded with address (n) a word access of address (n-1) also accesses (n) but does not cause a match.
Table 6-32. Comparator C Access Considerations
Condition For Valid Match Read and write accesses of ADDR[n] Write accesses of ADDR[n] Comp C Address RWE ADDR[n](1) ADDR[n] 0 1 RW X 0 Examples LDAA ADDR[n] STAA #$BYTE ADDR[n] STAA #$BYTE ADDR[n] LDAA #$BYTE ADDR[n]
Read accesses of ADDR[n] ADDR[n] 1 1 1. A word access of ADDR[n-1] also accesses ADDR[n] but does not generate a match. The comparator address register must contain the exact address from the code.
6.4.2.1.2
Comparator B
Comparator B offers address, direction (R/W) and access size (word/byte) comparison. If the SZE bit is set the access size (word or byte) is compared with the SZ bit value such that only the specified size of
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 176 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
access causes a match. Thus if configured for a byte access of a particular address, a word access covering the same address does not lead to match. Assuming the access direction is not qualified (RWE=0), for simplicity, the size access considerations are shown in Table 6-33.
Table 6-33. Comparator B Access Size Considerations
Condition For Valid Match Word and byte accesses of ADDR[n] Word accesses of ADDR[n] only Byte accesses of ADDR[n] only Comp B Address RWE ADDR[n]
(1)
SZE 0 1 1
SZ8 X 0 1
Examples MOVB #$BYTE ADDR[n] MOVW #$WORD ADDR[n] MOVW #$WORD ADDR[n] LDD ADDR[n] MOVB #$BYTE ADDR[n] LDAB ADDR[n]
0 0 0
ADDR[n] ADDR[n]
1. A word access of ADDR[n-1] also accesses ADDR[n] but does not generate a match. The comparator address register must contain the exact address from the code.
Access direction can also be used to qualify a match for Comparator B in the same way as described for Comparator C in Table 6-32. 6.4.2.1.3 Comparator A
Comparator A offers address, direction (R/W), access size (word/byte) and data bus comparison. Table 6-34 lists access considerations with data bus comparison. On word accesses the data byte of the lower address is mapped to DBGADH. Access direction can also be used to qualify a match for Comparator A in the same way as described for Comparator C in Table 6-32.
Table 6-34. Comparator A Matches When Accessing ADDR[n]
SZE 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 SZ X X X X X X 0 0 0 0 1 1 DBGADHM, DBGADLM $0000 $FF00 $00FF $00FF $FFFF $FFFF $0000 $00FF $FF00 $FFFF $0000 $FF00 Byte Word Byte, data(ADDR[n])=DH Word, data(ADDR[n])=DH, data(ADDR[n+1])=X Word, data(ADDR[n])=X, data(ADDR[n+1])=DL Byte, data(ADDR[n])=X, data(ADDR[n+1])=DL Word, data(ADDR[n])=DH, data(ADDR[n+1])=DL Byte, data(ADDR[n])=DH, data(ADDR[n+1])=DL Word Word, data(ADDR[n])=X, data(ADDR[n+1])=DL Word, data(ADDR[n])=DH, data(ADDR[n+1])=X Word, data(ADDR[n])=DH, data(ADDR[n+1])=DL Byte Byte, data(ADDR[n])=DH Access DH=DBGADH, DL=DBGADL Comment No databus comparison Match data( ADDR[n]) Match data( ADDR[n+1]) Possible unintended match Match data( ADDR[n], ADDR[n+1]) Possible unintended match No databus comparison Match only data at ADDR[n+1] Match only data at ADDR[n] Match data at ADDR[n] & ADDR[n+1] No databus comparison Match data at ADDR[n]
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 177
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.4.2.1.4
Comparator A Data Bus Comparison NDB Dependency
Comparator A features an NDB control bit, which allows data bus comparators to be configured to either trigger on equivalence or trigger on difference. This allows monitoring of a difference in the contents of an address location from an expected value. When matching on an equivalence (NDB=0), each individual data bus bit position can be masked out by clearing the corresponding mask bit (DBGADHM/DBGADLM) so that it is ignored in the comparison. A match occurs when all data bus bits with corresponding mask bits set are equivalent. If all mask register bits are clear, then a match is based on the address bus only, the data bus is ignored. When matching on a difference, mask bits can be cleared to ignore bit positions. A match occurs when any data bus bit with corresponding mask bit set is different. Clearing all mask bits, causes all bits to be ignored and prevents a match because no difference can be detected. In this case address bus equivalence does not cause a match.
Table 6-35. NDB and MASK bit dependency
NDB 0 0 1 1 DBGADHM[n] / DBGADLM[n] 0 1 0 1 Comment Do not compare data bus bit. Compare data bus bit. Match on equivalence. Do not compare data bus bit. Compare data bus bit. Match on difference.
6.4.2.2
Range Comparisons
Using the AB comparator pair for a range comparison, the data bus can also be used for qualification by using the comparator A data registers. Furthermore the DBGACTL RW and RWE bits can be used to qualify the range comparison on either a read or a write access. The corresponding DBGBCTL bits are ignored. The SZE and SZ control bits are ignored in range mode. The comparator A TAG bit is used to tag range comparisons. The comparator B TAG bit is ignored in range modes. In order for a range comparison using comparators A and B, both COMPEA and COMPEB must be set; to disable range comparisons both must be cleared. The comparator A BRK bit is used to for the AB range, the comparator B BRK bit is ignored in range mode. When configured for range comparisons and tagging, the ranges are accurate only to word boundaries. 6.4.2.2.1 Inside Range (CompA_Addr address CompB_Addr)
In the Inside Range comparator mode, comparator pair A and B can be configured for range comparisons. This configuration depends upon the control register (DBGC2). The match condition requires that a valid match for both comparators happens on the same bus cycle. A match condition on only one comparator is not valid. An aligned word access which straddles the range boundary is valid only if the aligned address is inside the range.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 178 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.4.2.2.2
Outside Range (address < CompA_Addr or address > CompB_Addr)
In the Outside Range comparator mode, comparator pair A and B can be configured for range comparisons. A single match condition on either of the comparators is recognized as valid. An aligned word access which straddles the range boundary is valid only if the aligned address is outside the range. Outside range mode in combination with tagging can be used to detect if the opcode fetches are from an unexpected range. In forced match mode the outside range match would typically be activated at any interrupt vector fetch or register access. This can be avoided by setting the upper range limit to $3FFFF or lower range limit to $00000 respectively.
6.4.3
Match Modes (Forced or Tagged)
Match modes are used as qualifiers for a state sequencer change of state. The Comparator control register TAG bits select the match mode. The modes are described in the following sections.
6.4.3.1
Forced Match
When configured for forced matching, a comparator channel match can immediately initiate a transition to the next state sequencer state whereby the corresponding flags in DBGSR are set. The state control register for the current state determines the next state. Forced matches are typically generated 2-3 bus cycles after the final matching address bus cycle, independent of comparator RWE/RW settings. Furthermore since opcode fetches occur several cycles before the opcode execution a forced match of an opcode address typically precedes a tagged match at the same address.
6.4.3.2
Tagged Match
If a CPU taghit occurs a transition to another state sequencer state is initiated and the corresponding DBGSR flags are set. For a comparator related taghit to occur, the DBG must first attach tags to instructions as they are fetched from memory. When the tagged instruction reaches the execution stage of the instruction queue a taghit is generated by the CPU. This can initiate a state sequencer transition.
6.4.3.3
Immediate Trigger
Independent of comparator matches it is possible to initiate a tracing session and/or breakpoint by writing to the TRIG bit in DBGC1. If configured for begin aligned tracing, this triggers the state sequencer into the Final State, if configured for end alignment, setting the TRIG bit disarms the module, ending the session and issues a forced breakpoint request to the CPU. It is possible to set both TRIG and ARM simultaneously to generate an immediate trigger, independent of the current state of ARM.
6.4.3.4
Channel Priorities
In case of simultaneous matches the priority is resolved according to Table 6-36. The lower priority is suppressed. It is thus possible to miss a lower priority match if it occurs simultaneously with a higher priority. The priorities described in Table 6-36 dictate that in the case of simultaneous matches, the match pointing to final state has highest priority followed by the lower channel number (0,1,2).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 179
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-36. Channel Priorities
Priority Highest Source TRIG Channel pointing to Final State Match0 (force or tag hit) Match1 (force or tag hit) Lowest Match2 (force or tag hit) Action Enter Final State Transition to next state as defined by state control registers Transition to next state as defined by state control registers Transition to next state as defined by state control registers Transition to next state as defined by state control registers
6.4.4
State Sequence Control
ARM = 0 State 0 (Disarmed) ARM = 1 State1 ARM = 0 Session Complete (Disarm) Final State ARM = 0 State3 State2
Figure 6-24. State Sequencer Diagram
The state sequencer allows a defined sequence of events to provide a trigger point for tracing of data in the trace buffer. Once the DBG module has been armed by setting the ARM bit in the DBGC1 register, then state1 of the state sequencer is entered. Further transitions between the states are then controlled by the state control registers and channel matches. From Final State the only permitted transition is back to the disarmed state0. Transition between any of the states 1 to 3 is not restricted. Each transition updates the SSF[2:0] flags in DBGSR accordingly to indicate the current state. Alternatively writing to the TRIG bit in DBGSC1, provides an immediate trigger independent of comparator matches. Independent of the state sequencer, each comparator channel can be individually configured to generate an immediate breakpoint when a match occurs through the use of the BRK bits in the DBGxCTL registers. Thus it is possible to generate an immediate breakpoint on selected channels, whilst a state sequencer transition can be initiated by a match on other channels. If a debug session is ended by a match on a channel the state sequencer transitions through Final State for a clock cycle to state0. This is independent of tracing and breakpoint activity, thus with tracing and breakpoints disabled, the state sequencer enters state0 and the debug module is disarmed.
6.4.4.1
Final State
On entering Final State a trigger may be issued to the trace buffer according to the trace alignment control as defined by the TALIGN bit (see 6.3.2.3"). If the TSOURCE bit in DBGTCR is clear then the trace buffer
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 180 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
is disabled and the transition to Final State can only generate a breakpoint request. In this case or upon completion of a tracing session when tracing is enabled, the ARM bit in the DBGC1 register is cleared, returning the module to the disarmed state0. If tracing is enabled a breakpoint request can occur at the end of the tracing session. If neither tracing nor breakpoints are enabled then when the final state is reached it returns automatically to state0 and the debug module is disarmed.
6.4.5
Trace Buffer Operation
The trace buffer is a 64 lines deep by 20-bits wide RAM array. The DBG module stores trace information in the RAM array in a circular buffer format. The system accesses the RAM array through a register window (DBGTBH:DBGTBL) using 16-bit wide word accesses. After each complete 20-bit trace buffer line is read, an internal pointer into the RAM increments so that the next read receives fresh information. Data is stored in the format shown in Table 6-37 and Table 6-40. After each store the counter register DBGCNT is incremented. Tracing of CPU activity is disabled when the BDM is active. Reading the trace buffer whilst the DBG is armed returns invalid data and the trace buffer pointer is not incremented.
6.4.5.1
Trace Trigger Alignment
Using the TALIGN bit (see 6.3.2.3) it is possible to align the trigger with the end or the beginning of a tracing session. If end alignment is selected, tracing begins when the ARM bit in DBGC1 is set and State1 is entered; the transition to Final State signals the end of the tracing session. Tracing with Begin-Trigger starts at the opcode of the trigger. Using end alignment or when the tracing is initiated by writing to the TRIG bit whilst configured for begin alignment, tracing starts in the second cycle after the DBGC1 write cycle. 6.4.5.1.1 Storing with Begin Trigger Alignment
Storing with begin alignment, data is not stored in the Trace Buffer until the Final State is entered. Once the trigger condition is met the DBG module remains armed until 64 lines are stored in the Trace Buffer. If the trigger is at the address of the change-of-flow instruction the change of flow associated with the trigger is stored in the Trace Buffer. Using begin alignment together with tagging, if the tagged instruction is about to be executed then the trace is started. Upon completion of the tracing session the breakpoint is generated, thus the breakpoint does not occur at the tagged instruction boundary. 6.4.5.1.2 Storing with End Trigger Alignment
Storing with end alignment, data is stored in the Trace Buffer until the Final State is entered, at which point the DBG module becomes disarmed and no more data is stored. If the trigger is at the address of a change of flow instruction, the trigger event is not stored in the Trace Buffer. If all trace buffer lines have been used before a trigger event occurrs then the trace continues at the first line, overwriting the oldest entries.
6.4.5.2
Trace Modes
Four trace modes are available. The mode is selected using the TRCMOD bits in the DBGTCR register. Tracing is enabled using the TSOURCE bit in the DBGTCR register. The modes are described in the following subsections.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 181
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.4.5.2.1
Normal Mode
In Normal Mode, change of flow (COF) program counter (PC) addresses are stored. COF addresses are defined as follows: * Source address of taken conditional branches (long, short, bit-conditional, and loop primitives) * Destination address of indexed JMP, JSR, and CALL instruction * Destination address of RTI, RTS, and RTC instructions * Vector address of interrupts, except for BDM vectors LBRA, BRA, BSR, BGND as well as non-indexed JMP, JSR, and CALL instructions are not classified as change of flow and are not stored in the trace buffer. Stored information includes the full 18-bit address bus and information bits, which contains a source/destination bit to indicate whether the stored address was a source address or destination address. NOTE When a COF instruction with destination address is executed, the destination address is stored to the trace buffer on instruction completion, indicating the COF has taken place. If an interrupt occurs simultaneously then the next instruction carried out is actually from the interrupt service routine. The instruction at the destination address of the original program flow gets executed after the interrupt service routine. In the following example an IRQ interrupt occurs during execution of the indexed JMP at address MARK1. The BRN at the destination (SUB_1) is not executed until after the IRQ service routine but the destination address is entered into the trace buffer to indicate that the indexed JMP COF has taken place.
MARK1 MARK2 SUB_1 LDX JMP NOP BRN NOP DBNE LDAB STAB RTI #SUB_1 0,X ; IRQ interrupt occurs during execution of this ; ; JMP Destination address TRACE BUFFER ENTRY 1 ; RTI Destination address TRACE BUFFER ENTRY 3 ; ; Source address TRACE BUFFER ENTRY 4 ; IRQ Vector $FFF2 = TRACE BUFFER ENTRY 2 ;
*
ADDR1 IRQ_ISR
A,PART5 #$F0 VAR_C1
The execution flow taking into account the IRQ is as follows
MARK1 IRQ_ISR LDX JMP LDAB STAB RTI BRN NOP DBNE #SUB_1 0,X #$F0 VAR_C1 * A,PART5 ; ; ; ; ;
SUB_1 ADDR1
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 182 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.4.5.2.2
Loop1 Mode
Loop1 Mode, similarly to Normal Mode also stores only COF address information to the trace buffer, it however allows the filtering out of redundant information. The intent of Loop1 Mode is to prevent the Trace Buffer from being filled entirely with duplicate information from a looping construct such as delays using the DBNE instruction or polling loops using BRSET/BRCLR instructions. Immediately after address information is placed in the Trace Buffer, the DBG module writes this value into a background register. This prevents consecutive duplicate address entries in the Trace Buffer resulting from repeated branches. Loop1 Mode only inhibits consecutive duplicate source address entries that would typically be stored in most tight looping constructs. It does not inhibit repeated entries of destination addresses or vector addresses, since repeated entries of these would most likely indicate a bug in the user's code that the DBG module is designed to help find. 6.4.5.2.3 Detail Mode
In Detail Mode, address and data for all memory and register accesses is stored in the trace buffer. This mode is intended to supply additional information on indexed, indirect addressing modes where storing only the destination address would not provide all information required for a user to determine where the code is in error. This mode also features information bit storage to the trace buffer, for each address byte storage. The information bits indicate the size of access (word or byte) and the type of access (read or write). When tracing in Detail Mode, all cycles are traced except those when the CPU is either in a free or opcode fetch cycle. 6.4.5.2.4 Compressed Pure PC Mode
In Compressed Pure PC Mode, the PC addresses of all executed opcodes, including illegal opcodes are stored. A compressed storage format is used to increase the effective depth of the trace buffer. This is achieved by storing the lower order bits each time and using 2 information bits to indicate if a 64 byte boundary has been crossed, in which case the full PC is stored. Each Trace Buffer row consists of 2 information bits and 18 PC address bits NOTE: When tracing is terminated using forced breakpoints, latency in breakpoint generation means that opcodes following the opcode causing the breakpoint can be stored to the trace buffer. The number of opcodes is dependent on program flow. This can be avoided by using tagged breakpoints.
6.4.5.3
Trace Buffer Organization (Normal, Loop1, Detail modes)
ADRH, ADRM, ADRL denote address high, middle and low byte respectively. The numerical suffix refers to the tracing count. The information format for Loop1 and Normal modes is identical. In Detail mode, the address and data for each entry are stored on consecutive lines, thus the maximum number of entries is 32. In this case DBGCNT bits are incremented twice, once for the address line and once for the data line, on
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 183
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
each trace buffer entry. In Detail mode CINF comprises of R/W and size access information (CRW and CSZ respectively). Single byte data accesses in Detail Mode are always stored to the low byte of the trace buffer (DATAL) and the high byte is cleared. When tracing word accesses, the byte at the lower address is always stored to trace buffer byte1 and the byte at the higher address is stored to byte0.
Table 6-37. Trace Buffer Organization (Normal,Loop1,Detail modes)
Mode Entry Number 4-bits Field 2 CINF1,ADRH1 0 CINF2,ADRH2 0 PCH1 PCH2 8-bits Field 1 ADRM1 DATAH1 ADRM2 DATAH2 PCM1 PCM2 8-bits Field 0 ADRL1 DATAL1 ADRL2 DATAL2 PCL1 PCL2
Entry 1 Detail Mode Entry 2
Normal/Loop1 Modes
Entry 1 Entry 2
6.4.5.3.1
Information Bit Organization
The format of the bits is dependent upon the active trace mode as described below. Field2 Bits in Detail Mode
Bit 3 CSZ Bit 2 CRW Bit 1 Bit 0
ADDR[17] ADDR[16]
Figure 6-25. Field2 Bits in Detail Mode
In Detail Mode the CSZ and CRW bits indicate the type of access being made by the CPU.
Table 6-38. Field Descriptions
Bit 3 CSZ 2 CRW Description Access Type Indicator-- This bit indicates if the access was a byte or word size when tracing in Detail Mode 0 Word Access 1 Byte Access Read Write Indicator -- This bit indicates if the corresponding stored address corresponds to a read or write access when tracing in Detail Mode. 0 Write Access 1 Read Access Address Bus bit 17-- Corresponds to system address bus bit 17. Address Bus bit 16-- Corresponds to system address bus bit 16.
1 ADDR[17] 0 ADDR[16]
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 184 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Field2 Bits in Normal and Loop1 Modes
Bit 3 CSD Bit 2 CVA Bit 1 PC17 Bit 0 PC16
Figure 6-26. Information Bits PCH Table 6-39. PCH Field Descriptions
Bit 3 CSD Description Source Destination Indicator -- In Normal and Loop1 mode this bit indicates if the corresponding stored address is a source or destination address. This bit has no meaning in Compressed Pure PC mode. 0 Source Address 1 Destination Address Vector Indicator -- In Normal and Loop1 mode this bit indicates if the corresponding stored address is a vector address. Vector addresses are destination addresses, thus if CVA is set, then the corresponding CSD is also set. This bit has no meaning in Compressed Pure PC mode. 0 Non-Vector Destination Address 1 Vector Destination Address Program Counter bit 17-- In Normal and Loop1 mode this bit corresponds to program counter bit 17. Program Counter bit 16-- In Normal and Loop1 mode this bit corresponds to program counter bit 16.
2 CVA
1 PC17 0 PC16
6.4.5.4
Trace Buffer Organization (Compressed Pure PC mode)
Table 6-40. Trace Buffer Organization Example (Compressed PurePC mode)
2-bits Line Number Field 3 Line 1 Line 2 Line 3 Line 4 Line 5 Line 6 00 11 01 00 10 00 0 PC4 0 6-bits Field 2 6-bits Field 1 PC1 (Initial 18-bit PC Base Address) PC3 0 PC6 (New 18-bit PC Base Address) PC8 PC9 (New 18-bit PC Base Address) PC7 PC2 PC5 6-bits Field 0
Mode
Compressed Pure PC Mode
NOTE Configured for end aligned triggering in compressed PurePC mode, then after rollover it is possible that the oldest base address is overwritten. In this case all entries between the pointer and the next base address have lost their base address following rollover. For example in Table 6-40 if one line of rollover has occurred, Line 1, PC1, is overwritten with a new entry. Thus the entries on Lines 2 and 3 have lost their base address. For reconstruction of program flow the first base address following the pointer must be used, in the example, Line 4. The pointer points to the oldest entry, Line 2.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 185
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Field3 Bits in Compressed Pure PC Modes
Table 6-41. Compressed Pure PC Mode Field 3 Information Bit Encoding
INF1 0 0 1 1 INF0 0 1 0 1 TRACE BUFFER ROW CONTENT Base PC address TB[17:0] contains a full PC[17:0] value Trace Buffer[5:0] contain incremental PC relative to base address zero value Trace Buffer[11:0] contain next 2 incremental PCs relative to base address zero value Trace Buffer[17:0] contain next 3 incremental PCs relative to base address zero value
Each time that PC[17:6] differs from the previous base PC[17:6], then a new base address is stored. The base address zero value is the lowest address in the 64 address range The first line of the trace buffer always gets a base PC address, this applies also on rollover.
6.4.5.5
Reading Data from Trace Buffer
The data stored in the Trace Buffer can be read provided the DBG module is not armed, is configured for tracing (TSOURCE bit is set) and the system not secured. When the ARM bit is written to 1 the trace buffer is locked to prevent reading. The trace buffer can only be unlocked for reading by a single aligned word write to DBGTB when the module is disarmed. The Trace Buffer can only be read through the DBGTB register using aligned word reads, any byte or misaligned reads return 0 and do not cause the trace buffer pointer to increment to the next trace buffer address. The Trace Buffer data is read out first-in first-out. By reading CNT in DBGCNT the number of valid lines can be determined. DBGCNT does not decrement as data is read. Whilst reading an internal pointer is used to determine the next line to be read. After a tracing session, the pointer points to the oldest data entry, thus if no rollover has occurred, the pointer points to line0, otherwise it points to the line with the oldest entry. In compressed Pure PC mode on rollover the line with the oldest data entry may also contain newer data entries in fields 0 and 1. Thus if rollover is indicated by the TBF bit, the line status must be decoded using the INF bits in field3 of that line. If both INF bits are clear then the line contains only entries from before the last rollover. If INF0=1 then field 0 contains post rollover data but fields 1 and 2 contain pre rollover data. If INF1=1 then fields 0 and 1 contain post rollover data but field 2 contains pre rollover data. The pointer is initialized by each aligned write to DBGTBH to point to the oldest data again. This enables an interrupted trace buffer read sequence to be easily restarted from the oldest data entry. The least significant word of line is read out first. This corresponds to the fields 1 and 0 of Table 6-37. The next word read returns field 2 in the least significant bits [3:0] and "0" for bits [15:4]. Reading the Trace Buffer while the DBG module is armed returns invalid data and no shifting of the RAM pointer occurs.
6.4.5.6
Trace Buffer Reset State
The Trace Buffer contents and DBGCNT bits are not initialized by a system reset. Thus should a system reset occur, the trace session information from immediately before the reset occurred can be read out and the number of valid lines in the trace buffer is indicated by DBGCNT. The internal pointer to the current
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 186 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
trace buffer address is initialized by unlocking the trace buffer and points to the oldest valid data even if a reset occurred during the tracing session. To read the trace buffer after a reset, TSOURCE must be set, otherwise the trace buffer reads as all zeroes. Generally debugging occurrences of system resets is best handled using end trigger alignment since the reset may occur before the trace trigger, which in the begin trigger alignment case means no information would be stored in the trace buffer. The Trace Buffer contents and DBGCNT bits are undefined following a POR. NOTE An external pin RESET that occurs simultaneous to a trace buffer entry can, in very seldom cases, lead to either that entry being corrupted or the first entry of the session being corrupted. In such cases the other contents of the trace buffer still contain valid tracing information. The case occurs when the reset assertion coincides with the trace buffer entry clock edge.
6.4.6
Tagging
A tag follows program information as it advances through the instruction queue. When a tagged instruction reaches the head of the queue a tag hit occurs and can initiate a state sequencer transition. Each comparator control register features a TAG bit, which controls whether the comparator match causes a state sequencer transition immediately or tags the opcode at the matched address. If a comparator is enabled for tagged comparisons, the address stored in the comparator match address registers must be an opcode address. Using Begin trigger together with tagging, if the tagged instruction is about to be executed then the transition to the next state sequencer state occurs. If the transition is to the Final State, tracing is started. Only upon completion of the tracing session can a breakpoint be generated. Using End alignment, when the tagged instruction is about to be executed and the next transition is to Final State then a breakpoint is generated immediately, before the tagged instruction is carried out. R/W monitoring, access size (SZ) monitoring and data bus monitoring are not useful if tagging is selected, since the tag is attached to the opcode at the matched address and is not dependent on the data bus nor on the type of access. Thus these bits are ignored if tagging is selected. When configured for range comparisons and tagging, the ranges are accurate only to word boundaries. Tagging is disabled when the BDM becomes active.
6.4.7
Breakpoints
It is possible to generate breakpoints from channel transitions to final state or using software to write to the TRIG bit in the DBGC1 register.
6.4.7.1
Breakpoints From Comparator Channels
Breakpoints can be generated when the state sequencer transitions to the Final State. If configured for tagging, then the breakpoint is generated when the tagged opcode reaches the execution stage of the instruction queue.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 187
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
If a tracing session is selected by the TSOURCE bit, breakpoints are requested when the tracing session has completed, thus if Begin aligned triggering is selected, the breakpoint is requested only on completion of the subsequent trace (see Table 6-42). If no tracing session is selected, breakpoints are requested immediately. If the BRK bit is set, then the associated breakpoint is generated immediately independent of tracing trigger alignment.
Table 6-42. Breakpoint Setup For CPU Breakpoints
BRK 0 0 0 0 1 1 TALIGN 0 0 1 1 x x DBGBRK 0 1 0 1 1 0 Breakpoint Alignment Fill Trace Buffer until trigger then disarm (no breakpoints) Fill Trace Buffer until trigger, then breakpoint request occurs Start Trace Buffer at trigger (no breakpoints) Start Trace Buffer at trigger A breakpoint request occurs when Trace Buffer is full Terminate tracing and generate breakpoint immediately on trigger Terminate tracing immediately on trigger
6.4.7.2
Breakpoints Generated Via The TRIG Bit
If a TRIG triggers occur, the Final State is entered whereby tracing trigger alignment is defined by the TALIGN bit. If a tracing session is selected by the TSOURCE bit, breakpoints are requested when the tracing session has completed, thus if Begin aligned triggering is selected, the breakpoint is requested only on completion of the subsequent trace (see Table 6-42). If no tracing session is selected, breakpoints are requested immediately. TRIG breakpoints are possible with a single write to DBGC1, setting ARM and TRIG simultaneously.
6.4.7.3
Breakpoint Priorities
If a TRIG trigger occurs after Begin aligned tracing has already started, then the TRIG no longer has an effect. When the associated tracing session is complete, the breakpoint occurs. Similarly if a TRIG is followed by a subsequent comparator channel match, it has no effect, since tracing has already started. If a forced SWI breakpoint coincides with a BGND in user code with BDM enabled, then the BDM is activated by the BGND and the breakpoint to SWI is suppressed. 6.4.7.3.1 DBG Breakpoint Priorities And BDM Interfacing
Breakpoint operation is dependent on the state of the BDM module. If the BDM module is active, the CPU is executing out of BDM firmware, thus comparator matches and associated breakpoints are disabled. In addition, while executing a BDM TRACE command, tagging into BDM is disabled. If BDM is not active, the breakpoint gives priority to BDM requests over SWI requests if the breakpoint happens to coincide with a SWI instruction in user code. On returning from BDM, the SWI from user code gets executed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 188 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
Table 6-43. Breakpoint Mapping Summary
DBGBRK 0 1 X 1 1 BDM Bit (DBGC1[4]) X 0 X 1 1 BDM Enabled X X 1 0 1 BDM Active X 0 1 X 0 Breakpoint Mapping No Breakpoint Breakpoint to SWI No Breakpoint Breakpoint to SWI Breakpoint to BDM
BDM cannot be entered from a breakpoint unless the ENABLE bit is set in the BDM. If entry to BDM via a BGND instruction is attempted and the ENABLE bit in the BDM is cleared, the CPU actually executes the BDM firmware code, checks the ENABLE and returns if ENABLE is not set. If not serviced by the monitor then the breakpoint is re-asserted when the BDM returns to normal CPU flow. If the comparator register contents coincide with the SWI/BDM vector address then an SWI in user code could coincide with a DBG breakpoint. The CPU ensures that BDM requests have a higher priority than SWI requests. Returning from the BDM/SWI service routine care must be taken to avoid a repeated breakpoint at the same address. Should a tagged or forced breakpoint coincide with a BGND in user code, then the instruction that follows the BGND instruction is the first instruction executed when normal program execution resumes. NOTE When program control returns from a tagged breakpoint using an RTI or BDM GO command without program counter modification it returns to the instruction whose tag generated the breakpoint. To avoid a repeated breakpoint at the same location reconfigure the DBG module in the SWI routine, if configured for an SWI breakpoint, or over the BDM interface by executing a TRACE command before the GO to increment the program flow past the tagged instruction.
6.5
6.5.1
Application Information
State Machine scenarios
Defining the state control registers as SCR1,SCR2, SCR3 and M0,M1,M2 as matches on channels 0,1,2 respectively. SCR encoding supported by S12SDBGV1 are shown in black. SCR encoding supported only in S12SDBGV2 are shown in red. For backwards compatibility the new scenarios use a 4th bit in each SCR register. Thus the existing encoding for SCRx[2:0] is not changed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 189
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.5.2
Scenario 1
Figure 6-27. Scenario 1
A trigger is generated if a given sequence of 3 code events is executed.
SCR1=0011 State1 M1
SCR2=0010 State2 M2
SCR3=0111 State3 M0 Final State
Scenario 1 is possible with S12SDBGV1 SCR encoding
6.5.3
Scenario 2
Figure 6-28. Scenario 2a
A trigger is generated if a given sequence of 2 code events is executed.
SCR1=0011 State1 M1
SCR2=0101 State2 M2 Final State
A trigger is generated if a given sequence of 2 code events is executed, whereby the first event is entry into a range (COMPA,COMPB configured for range mode). M1 is disabled in range modes.
Figure 6-29. Scenario 2b
SCR1=0111 State1 M01
SCR2=0101 State2 M2 Final State
A trigger is generated if a given sequence of 2 code events is executed, whereby the second event is entry into a range (COMPA,COMPB configured for range mode)
Figure 6-30. Scenario 2c
SCR1=0010 State1 M2
SCR2=0011 State2 M0 Final State
All 3 scenarios 2a,2b,2c are possible with the S12SDBGV1 SCR encoding
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 190 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.5.4
Scenario 3
Figure 6-31. Scenario 3
A trigger is generated immediately when one of up to 3 given events occurs SCR1=0000 State1 M012 Final State
Scenario 3 is possible with S12SDBGV1 SCR encoding
6.5.5
Scenario 4
Trigger if a sequence of 2 events is carried out in an incorrect order. Event A must be followed by event B and event B must be followed by event A. 2 consecutive occurrences of event A without an intermediate event B cause a trigger. Similarly 2 consecutive occurrences of event B without an intermediate event A cause a trigger. This is possible by using CompA and CompC to match on the same address as shown.
Figure 6-32. Scenario 4a
SCR1=0100 State1 M1
M0 M2 M1
State2 M0
SCR2=0011
SCR3=0001
State 3
M1
Final State
This scenario is currently not possible using 2 comparators only. S12SDBGV2 makes it possible with 2 comparators, State 3 allowing a M0 to return to state 2, whilst a M2 leads to final state as shown.
Figure 6-33. Scenario 4b (with 2 comparators)
SCR1=0110 State1 M2
M0 M0 M2
State2 M01
SCR2=1100
M1 disabled in range mode Final State
SCR3=1110
State 3
M2
The advantage of using only 2 channels is that now range comparisons can be included (channel0)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 191
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
This however violates the S12SDBGV1 specification, which states that a match leading to final state always has priority in case of a simultaneous match, whilst priority is also given to the lowest channel number. For S12SDBG the corresponding CPU priority decoder is removed to support this, such that on simultaneous taghits, taghits pointing to final state have highest priority. If no taghit points to final state then the lowest channel number has priority. Thus with the above encoding from State3, the CPU and DBG would break on a simultaneous M0/M2.
6.5.6
Scenario 5
Figure 6-34. Scenario 5
Trigger if following event A, event C precedes event B. i.e. the expected execution flow is A->B->C.
SCR1=0011 State1 M1 M2
SCR2=0110 State2 M0 Final State
Scenario 5 is possible with the S12SDBGV1 SCR encoding
6.5.7
Scenario 6
Trigger if event A occurs twice in succession before any of 2 other events (BC) occurs. This scenario is not possible using the S12SDBGV1 SCR encoding. S12SDBGV2 includes additions shown in red. The change in SCR1 encoding also has the advantage that a State1->State3 transition using M0 is now possible. This is advantageous because range and data bus comparisons use channel0 only.
Figure 6-35. Scenario 6
SCR1=1001 State1 M0 M12
SCR3=1010 State3 M0 Final State
6.5.8
Scenario 7
Trigger when a series of 3 events is executed out of order. Specifying the event order as M1,M2,M0 to run in loops (120120120). Any deviation from that order should trigger. This scenario is not possible using the
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 192 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
S12SDBGV1 SCR encoding because OR possibilities are very limited in the channel encoding. By adding OR forks as shown in red this scenario is possible.
Figure 6-36. Scenario 7
M01
SCR1=1101 State1 M1
SCR2=1100 State2 M2
SCR3=1101 State3 M12 Final State
M0 M02 On simultaneous matches the lowest channel number has priority so with this configuration the forking from State1 has the peculiar effect that a simultaneous match0/match1 transitions to final state but a simultaneous match2/match1transitions to state2.
6.5.9
Scenario 8
Figure 6-37. Scenario 8a
Trigger when a routine/event at M2 follows either M1 or M0.
SCR1=0111 State1 M01
SCR2=0101 State2 M2 Final State
Trigger when an event M2 is followed by either event M0 or event M1
Figure 6-38. Scenario 8b
SCR1=0010 State1 M2
SCR2=0111 State2 M01 Final State
Scenario 8a and 8b are possible with the S12SDBGV1 and S12SDBGV2 SCR encoding
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 193
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
6.5.10
Scenario 9
Trigger when a routine/event at A (M2) does not follow either B or C (M1 or M0) before they are executed again. This cannot be realized with theS12SDBGV1 SCR encoding due to OR limitations. By changing the SCR2 encoding as shown in red this scenario becomes possible.
Figure 6-39. Scenario 9
SCR1=0111 State1 M01 M2
SCR2=1111 State2 M01 Final State
6.5.11
Scenario 10
Trigger if an event M0 occurs following up to two successive M2 events without the resetting event M1. As shown up to 2 consecutive M2 events are allowed, whereby a reset to State1 is possible after either one or two M2 events. If an event M0 occurs following the second M2, before M1 resets to State1 then a trigger is generated. Configuring CompA and CompC the same, it is possible to generate a breakpoint on the third consecutive occurrence of event M0 without a reset M1.
Figure 6-40. Scenario 10a
M1 SCR1=0010 State1 M2
SCR2=0100 State2 M2
SCR3=0010 State3 M0 Final State
M1
Figure 6-41. Scenario 10b
M0 SCR1=0010 State1 M2 SCR2=0011 State2 M1 SCR3=0000 State3 Final State
M0 Scenario 10b shows the case that after M2 then M1 must occur before M0. Starting from a particular point in code, event M2 must always be followed by M1 before M0. If after any M2, event M0 occurs before M1 then a trigger is generated.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 194 Freescale Semiconductor
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 195
S12S Debug Module (S12SDBGV2)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 196 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 7 S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description Revision History
Version Revision Effective Number Date Date
V01.00 V01.01 V01.02 V01.03 16 Jan.07 9 July 08 7 Oct. 08 16 Jan. 07 9 July 08 7 Oct. 08
Author
Initial release
Description of Changes
added IRCLK to Block Diagram clarified and detailed oscillator filter functionality added note, that startup time of external Oscillator tUPOSC must be considered, especially when entering Pseudo Stop Mode Modified reset phase descriptions to reference fVCORST instead of fPLLRST and correct typo of RESET pin sample point from 64 to 256 cycles in section: Description of Reset Operation
11 Dec. 08 11 Dec. 08
V01.04
17 Jun. 09 17 Jun. 09
7.1
Introduction
This specification describes the function of the Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU). * The optional Pierce oscillator (OSCLCP) provides a robust, low-noise and low-power external clock source. It is designed for optimal start-up margin with typical crystal oscillators. * The Voltage regulator (IVREG) operates from the range 3.13V to 5.5V. It provides all the required chip internal voltages and voltage monitors. * The Phase Locked Loop (PLL) provides a highly accurate frequency multiplier with internal filter. * The Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M) provides a stable 1MHz internal clock.
7.1.1
Features
The optional Pierce Oscillator (OSCLCP) contains circuitry to dynamically control current gain in the output amplitude. This ensures a signal with low harmonic distortion, low power and good noise immunity. * For crystals or resonators from 4MHz to 16MHz. * High noise immunity due to input hysteresis and spike filtering.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 197
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
* * * * *
Low RF emissions with peak-to-peak swing limited dynamically Transconductance (gm) sized for optimum start-up margin for typical crystals Dynamic gain control eliminates the need for external current limiting resistor Integrated resistor eliminates the need for external bias resistor. Low power consumption: Operates from internal 1.8V (nominal) supply, Amplitude control limits power
The Voltage Regulator (IVREG) has the following features: * Input voltage range form 3.13V to 5.5V * Low-voltage detect (LVD) with low-voltage interrupt (LVI) * Power-on reset (POR) * Low-voltage reset (LVR) The Phase Locked Loop (PLL) has the following features: * highly accurate and phase locked frequency multiplier * Configurable internal filter for best stability and lock time. * Frequency modulation for defined jitter and reduced emission * Automatic frequency lock detector * Interrupt request on entry or exit from locked condition * Reference clock either external (crystal) or internal square wave (1MHz IRC1M) based. * PLL stability is sufficient for LIN communication, even if using IRC1M as reference clock The Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M) has the following features: * Trimmable in frequency * Factory trimmed value for 1MHz in Flash Memory, can be overwritten by application if required Other features of the S12CPMU include * Clock monitor to detect loss of crystal * Autonomous periodical interrupt (API) * Bus Clock Generator -- Clock switch to select either PLL Clock or external crystal/resonator based Bus Clock -- PLL Clock divider to adjust system speed * System Reset generation from the following possible sources: -- Power-on reset (POR) -- Low-voltage reset (LVR) -- Illegal address access -- COP time out -- Loss of oscillation (clock monitor fail) -- External pin RESET
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 198 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
7.1.2
Modes of Operation
This subsection lists and briefly describes all operating modes supported by the S12CPMU.
7.1.2.1
Run Mode
The voltage regulator is in full performance mode (FPM). The Phase Locked Loop (PLL) is on. The Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M) is on. The API is available. * PLL Engaged Internal (PEI) -- This is the default mode after System Reset and Power-On Reset. -- The Bus Clock is based on the PLL Clock. -- After reset the PLL is configured for 64MHz VCOCLK operation Post divider is 0x03, so PLLCLK is VCOCLK divided by 4, that is 16MHz and Bus Clock is 8MHz. The PLL can be re-configured for other bus frequencies. -- The reference clock for the PLL (REFCLK) is based on internal reference clock IRC1M * PLL Engaged External (PEE) -- The Bus Clock is based on the PLL Clock. -- This mode can be entered from default mode PEI by performing the following steps: - Configure the PLL for desired bus frequency. - Program the reference divider (REFDIV[3:0] bits) to divide down Oscillator frequency if necessary. - Enable the external Oscillator (OSCE bit) * PLL Bypassed External (PBE) -- The Bus Clock is based on the Oscillator Clock. -- This mode can be entered from default mode PEI by performing the following steps: - Enable the external Oscillator (OSCE bit) - Wait for Oscillator to start up (UPOSC=1) - Select the Oscillator Clock as Bus Clock (PLLSEL=0). -- The PLL Clock is still on for spike filtering on Oscillator Clock.
7.1.2.2
Wait Mode
For S12CPMU Wait Mode is the same as Run Mode.
7.1.2.3
Stop Mode
This mode is entered by executing the CPU STOP instruction.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 199
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
The voltage regulator is in reduced power mode (RPM). The API is available. The Phase Locked Loop (PLL) is off. The Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M) is off. Core Clock, Bus Clock and BDM Clock are stopped. Depending on the setting of the PSTP and the OSCE bit, Stop Mode can be differentiated between Full Stop Mode (PSTP = 0 or OSCE=0) and Pseudo Stop Mode (PSTP = 1 and OSCE=1). * Full Stop Mode The oscillator (OSCLCP) is disabled. After wake from Full Stop Mode the Core Clock and Bus Clock are running on PLLCLK (PLLSEL=1). COP and RTI are running on IRCCLK (COPOSCSEL=0, RTIOSCSEL=0). * Pseudo Stop Mode The oscillator (OSCLCP) continues torun. If the respective enable bits are set the COP and RTI will continue to run. The clock configuration bits PLLSEL, COPOSCSEL, RTIOSCSEL are unchanged. NOTE When starting up the external Oscillator (either by programming OSCEN bit to 1 or on exit from full stop mode with OSCEN bit is already 1) the software must wait for a minimum time equivalent to the startup-time of the external Oscillator tUPOSC before entering Pseudo Stop Mode.
7.1.3
Block Diagram
Figure 7-1 shows a block diagram of the S12CPMU.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 200 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
MMC VDDR VSSPLL VSS VDDX VSSX VDDA VSSA RESET Clock Monitor Voltage Regulator 3.13 to 5.5V
Illegal Address Access VDD, VDDPLL, VDDF (core supplies) Low Voltage Detect VDDA Low Voltage Detect VDDX Power-On Detect LVRF PORF Reset Generator
UPOSC=0 sets PLLSEL bit COP time out
ILAF LVDS LVIE Low Voltage Interrupt
S12CPMU
Power-On Reset System Reset Oscillator status Interrupt OSCIE
monitor fail UPOSC adaptive spike filter IRCTRIM[9:0] Internal Reference Clock (IRC1M)
Loop EXTAL Controlled Pierce Oscillator XTAL (OSCLCP) 4MHz-16MHz REFDIV[3:0] Reference Divider
OSCCLK OSCFILT[4:0]
&
PLLSEL
CAN_OSCCLK (to MSCAN)
POSTDIV[4:0] Post Divider 1,2,..32 divide by 4 Core Clock PLLCLK divide Bus Clock by 2 IRCCLK (to LCD) divide by 8 HTDS HTIE BDM Clock
PSTP
OSCE
VCOFRQ[1:0] VCOCLK Lock detect REFCLK FBCLK Phase locked Loop with internal Filter (PLL) REFFRQ[1:0] LOCK Divide by 2*(SYNDIV+1) SYNDIV[5:0] Bus Clock RC Osc. ACLK
HT Interrupt
High Temperature Sense LOCKIE PLL Lock Interrupt
Autonomous API_EXTCLK Periodic Interrupt (API) APIE RTIE API Interrupt RTI Interrupt
UPOSC
UPOSC=0 clears IRCCLK COPCLK COP OSCCLK COP time out to Reset Generator IRCCLK
APICLK
Watchdog
RTICLK OSCCLK
Real Time Interrupt (RTI) PRE CPMURTI
COPOSCSEL
PCE
CPMUCOP
RTIOSCSEL
Figure 7-1. Block diagram of S12CPMU
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 201
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Figure 7-2 shows a block diagram of the OSCLCP.
OSCCLK
Peak Detector
Gain Control VDDPLL = 1.8 V
VSSPLL Rf
EXTAL
XTAL
Figure 7-2. OSCLCP Block Diagram
7.2
Signal Description
This section lists and describes the signals that connect off chip.
7.2.1
RESET
RESET is an active-low bidirectional pin. As an input it initializes the MCU asynchronously to a known start-up state. As an open-drain output it indicates that an MCU-internal reset has been triggered.
7.2.2
EXTAL and XTAL
These pins provide the interface for a crystal to control the internal clock generator circuitry. EXTAL is the external clock input or the input to the crystal oscillator amplifier. XTAL is the output of the crystal oscillator amplifier. The MCU internal OSCCLK is derived from the EXTAL input frequency. If OSCE=0, the EXTAL pin is pulled down by an internal resistor of approximately 200 k and the XTAL pin is pulled down by an internal resistor of approximately 700 k.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 202 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
NOTE Freescale recommends an evaluation of the application board and chosen resonator or crystal by the resonator or crystal supplier. Loop controlled circuit is not suited for overtone resonators and crystals.
7.2.3
TEMPSENSE -- temperature sensor output voltage
Depending on the VSEL value either the voltage level generated by the temperature sensor or the VREG bandgap voltage is driven to a special channel of the ATD Converter. See device level specification for connectivity.
7.2.4
VDDR -- Regulator Power Input Pin
VDDR is the power input of IVREG. All currents sourced into the regulator loads flow through this pin. A chip external decoupling capacitor (100 nF...220 nF, X7R ceramic) between VDDR and VSS can smooth ripple on VDDR.
7.2.5
VDDA, VSSA -- Regulator Reference Supply Pins
VDDA/VSSA, which are relatively quiet, are used to supply the analog parts of the regulator. Internal precision reference circuits are supplied from these signals. A chip external decoupling capacitor (100 nF...220 nF, X7R ceramic) between VDDA and VSSA can further improve the quality of this supply.
7.2.6
VSS, VSSPLL-- Ground Pins
VSS and VSSPLL must be grounded.
7.2.7
VDDX, VSSX-- Pad Supply Pins
This supply domain is monitored by the Low Voltage Reset circuit. An off-chip decoupling capacitor (100 nF...220 nF, X7R ceramic) between VDDX and VSSX can further improve the quality of this supply.
7.2.8
API_EXTCLK -- API external clock output pin
This pin provides the signal selected via APIES and is enabled with APIEA bit. See device specification to which pin it connects.
7.3
Memory Map and Registers
This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the S12CPMU.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 203
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
7.3.1
Module Memory Map
The S12CPMU registers are shown in Figure 7-3.
Addres s 0x0034 0x0035 0x0036 0x0037 0x0038
Name CPMU SYNR CPMU REFDIV CPMU POSTDIV CPMUFLG CPMUINT R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
VCOFRQ[1:0] REFFRQ[1:0] 0 0 0 0 0
SYNDIV[5:0] REFDIV[3:0] POSTDIV[4:0] LOCKIF LOCKIE 0 LOCK 0 ILAF 0 OSCIF OSCIE RTI OSCSEL 0 UPOSC 0
RTIF RTIE PLLSEL 0
PORF 0
LVRF 0 0
0x0039 CPMUCLKS 0x003A 0x003B CPMUPLL CPMURTI
PSTP 0
PRE 0
PCE 0
COP OSCSEL 0
FM1 RTR5 0 WRTMASK 0 0 0 Bit 5 VSEL 0 0
FM0 RTR4 0 0 0 0 Bit 4 0 0
RTDEC WCOP 0 0 0 Bit 7 0 0
RTR6 RSBCK 0 0 0 Bit 6 0 0 0
RTR3 0 0 0 0 Bit 3 HTE 0
RTR2 CR2 0 0 0 Bit 2 HTDS LVDS
RTR1 CR1 0 0 0 Bit 1 HTIE LVIE APIE 0
RTR0 CR0 0 0 0 Bit 0 HTIF LVIF APIF 0
0x003C CPMUCOP 0x003D 0x003E 0x003F 0x02F0 0x02F1 0x02F2
RESERVED R CPMUTEST0 W RESERVED R CPMUTEST1 W CPMU ARMCOP CPMU HTCTL CPMU LVCTL CPMU APICTL R W R W R W R W R W R W
APICLK APITR5 APIR15
APIES APITR2 APIR12
APIEA APITR1 APIR11
APIFE APITR0 APIR10
0x02F3 CPMUAPITR 0x02F4 CPMUAPIRH
APITR4 APIR14
APITR3 APIR13
APIR9
APIR8
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-3. CPMU Register Summary
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 204 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Addres s
Name R W
Bit 7 APIR7 0
6 APIR6 0 0
5 APIR5 0 0
4 APIR4 0 0
3 APIR3 0
2 APIR2 0
1 APIR1 0
Bit 0 APIR0 0
0x02F5 CPMUAPIRL 0x02F6
RESERVED R CPMUTEST3 W R W R W R W R W R W
0x02F7 CPMUHTTR 0x02F8 0x02F9 0x02FA CPMU IRCTRIMH CPMU IRCTRIML CPMUOSC
HTOE
HTTR3 0
HTTR2 0
HTTR1
HTTR0
TCTRIM[3:0]
IRCTRIM[9:8]
IRCTRIM[7:0] OSCE 0 0 OSCBW 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 OSCFILT[4:0] 0 0 0 0 PROT 0
0x02FB CPMUPROT 0x02FC
RESERVED R CPMUTEST2 W
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-3. CPMU Register Summary
7.3.2
Register Descriptions
This section describes all the S12CPMU registers and their individual bits. Address order is as listed in Figure 7-3.
7.3.2.1
S12CPMU Synthesizer Register (CPMUSYNR)
The CPMUSYNR register controls the multiplication factor of the PLL and selects the VCO frequency range.
0x0034
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R VCOFRQ[1:0] W Reset 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 SYNDIV[5:0]
Figure 7-4. S12CPMU Synthesizer Register (CPMUSYNR)
Read: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 205
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Write: If PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register), then write anytime. Else write has no effect. NOTE Writing to this register clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits.
If PLL has locked (LOCK=1)
f VCO = 2 x f REF x ( SYNDIV + 1 )
NOTE fVCO must be within the specified VCO frequency lock range. Bus frequency fbus must not exceed the specified maximum. The VCOFRQ[1:0] bits are used to configure the VCO gain for optimal stability and lock time. For correct PLL operation the VCOFRQ[1:0] bits have to be selected according to the actual target VCOCLK frequency as shown in Table 7-1. Setting the VCOFRQ[1:0] bits incorrectly can result in a non functional PLL (no locking and/or insufficient stability).
Table 7-1. VCO Clock Frequency Selection
VCOCLK Frequency Ranges 32MHz <= fVCO<= 48MHz 48MHz < fVCO<= 64MHz Reserved Reserved VCOFRQ[1:0] 00 01 10 11
7.3.2.2
S12CPMU Reference Divider Register (CPMUREFDIV)
The CPMUREFDIV register provides a finer granularity for the PLL multiplier steps when using the external Oscillator as reference.
0x0035
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R REFFRQ[1:0] W Reset 0 0
0
0 REFDIV[3:0]
0
0
1
1
1
1
Figure 7-5. S12CPMU Reference Divider Register (CPMUREFDIV)
Read: Anytime Write: If PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register), then write anytime. Else write has no effect.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 206 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
NOTE Write to this register clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits.
If OSCLCP is enabled (OSCE=1) If OSCLCP is disabled (OSCE=0)
f OSC f REF = -----------------------------------( REFDIV + 1 ) f REF = f IRC1M
The REFFRQ[1:0] bits are used to configure the internal PLL filter for optimal stability and lock time. For correct PLL operation the REFFRQ[1:0] bits have to be selected according to the actual REFCLK frequency as shown in Table 7-2. If IRC1M is selected as REFCLK (OSCE=0) the PLL filter is fixed configured for the 1MHz <= fREF <= 2MHz range. The bits cans still be written but will have no effect on the PLL filter configuration. For OSCE=1, setting the REFFRQ[1:0] bits incorrectly can result in a non functional PLL (no locking and/or insufficient stability).
Table 7-2. Reference Clock Frequency Selection if OSC_LCP is enabled
REFCLK Frequency Ranges (OSCE=1) 1MHz <= fREF <= 2MHz 2MHz < fREF <= 6MHz 6MHz < fREF <= 12MHz fREF >12MHz REFFRQ[1:0] 00 01 10 11
7.3.2.3
S12CPMU Post Divider Register (CPMUPOSTDIV)
The POSTDIV register controls the frequency ratio between the VCOCLK and the PLLCLK.
0x0036
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0 POSTDIV[4:0]
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-6. S12CPMU Post Divider Register (CPMUPOSTDIV)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 207
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Read: Anytime Write: If PLLSEL=1 write anytime, else write has no effect.
f VCO f PLL = ---------------------------------------( POSTDIV + 1 ) f VCO f PLL = --------------4 f PLL f bus = -----------2
If PLL is locked (LOCK=1)
If PLL is not locked (LOCK=0)
If PLL is selected (PLLSEL=1)
7.3.2.4
S12CPMU Flags Register (CPMUFLG)
This register provides S12CPMU status bits and flags.
0x0037
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R RTIF W Reset 0 Note 1 Note 2 0 PORF LVRF LOCKIF
LOCK ILAF 0 Note 3 OSCIF 0
UPOSC
0
1. PORF is set to 1 when a power on reset occurs. Unaffected by System Reset. 2. LVRF is set to 1 when a low voltage reset occurs. Unaffected by System Reset. Set by power on reset. 3. ILAF is set to 1 when an illegal address reset occurs. Unaffected by System Reset. Cleared by power on reset. = Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-7. S12CPMU Flags Register (CPMUFLG)
Read: Anytime Write: Refer to each bit for individual write conditions
Table 7-3. CPMUFLG Field Descriptions
Field 7 RTIF Description Real Time Interrupt Flag -- RTIF is set to 1 at the end of the RTI period. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (RTIE=1), RTIF causes an interrupt request. 0 RTI time-out has not yet occurred. 1 RTI time-out has occurred. Power on Reset Flag -- PORF is set to 1 when a power on reset occurs. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 0 Power on reset has not occurred. 1 Power on reset has occurred.
6 PORF
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 208 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-3. CPMUFLG Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 5 LVRF Description Low Voltage Reset Flag -- LVRF is set to 1 when a low voltage reset occurs. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 0 Low voltage reset has not occurred. 1 Low voltage reset has occurred. PLL Lock Interrupt Flag -- LOCKIF is set to 1 when LOCK status bit changes. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect.If enabled (LOCKIE=1), LOCKIF causes an interrupt request. 0 No change in LOCK bit. 1 LOCK bit has changed. Lock Status Bit -- LOCK reflects the current state of PLL lock condition. Writes have no effect. While PLL is unlocked (LOCK=0) fPLL is fVCO / 4 to protect the system from high core clock frequencies during the PLL stabilization time tlock. 0 VCOCLK is not within the desired tolerance of the target frequency. fPLL = fVCO/4. 1 VCOCLK is within the desired tolerance of the target frequency. fPLL = fVCO/(POSTDIV+1). Illegal Address Reset Flag -- ILAF is set to 1 when an illegal address reset occurs. Refer to MMC chapter for details. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. 0 Illegal address reset has not occurred. 1 Illegal address reset has occurred. Oscillator Interrupt Flag -- OSCIF is set to 1 when UPOSC status bit changes. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect.If enabled (OSCIE=1), OSCIF causes an interrupt request. 0 No change in UPOSC bit. 1 UPOSC bit has changed. Oscillator Status Bit -- UPOSC reflects the status of the oscillator. Writes have no effect. While UPOSC=0 the OSCCLK going to the MSCAN module is off. Entering full stop mode UPOSC is cleared. 0 The Oscillator is off or oscillation is not qualified by the PLL. 1 The Oscillator is qualified by the PLL.
4 LOCKIF
3 LOCK
2 ILAF
1 OSCIF
0 UPOSC
NOTE The adaptive spike filter uses the VCO clock as a reference to continuously qualify the external oscillator clock. Because of this, the PLL is always active and a valid PLL configuration is required for the system to work properly. Furthermore, the adaptive spike filter is used to determine the status of the external oscillator (reflected in the UPOSC bit). Since this function also relies on the VCO clock, losing PLL lock status (LOCK=0, except for entering pseudo stop mode) means losing the oscillator status information as well (UPOSC=0).
7.3.2.5
S12CPMU Interrupt Enable Register (CPMUINT)
This register enables S12CPMU interrupt requests.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 209
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
0x0038
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R RTIE W Reset 0
0
0 LOCKIE
0
0 OSCIE
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-8. S12CPMU Interrupt Enable Register (CPMUINT)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 7-4. CRGINT Field Descriptions
Field 7 RTIE 4 LOCKIE 1 OSCIE Description Real Time Interrupt Enable Bit 0 Interrupt requests from RTI are disabled. 1 Interrupt will be requested whenever RTIF is set. PLL Lock Interrupt Enable Bit 0 PLL LOCK interrupt requests are disabled. 1 Interrupt will be requested whenever LOCKIF is set. Oscillator Corrupt Interrupt Enable Bit 0 Oscillator Corrupt interrupt requests are disabled. 1 Interrupt will be requested whenever OSCIF is set.
7.3.2.6
S12CPMU Clock Select Register (CPMUCLKS)
This register controls S12CPMU clock selection.
0x0039
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R PLLSEL W Reset 1 0 PSTP
0
0 PRE PCE 0
RTI OSCSEL 0
COP OSCSEL 0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-9. S12CPMU Clock Select Register (CPMUCLKS)
Read: Anytime Write: Only possible when PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register). PLLSEL, PSTP, PRE, PCE, RTIOSCSEL: write anytime. COPOSCSEL: write anytime in normal mode until CPMUCOP write once is taken. If COPOSCSEL was cleared by UPOSC=0 (entering full stop mode with COPOSCSEL=1 or insufficient OSCCLK quality), then COPOSCSEL can be set again once. Write anytime in special mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 210 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
NOTE After writing CPMUCLKS register, it is strongly recommended to read back CPMUCLK register to make sure that write of PLLSEL, RTIOSCSEL and COPOSCSEL was successful.
Table 7-5. CPMUCLKS Descriptions
Field 7 PLLSEL Description PLL Select Bit This bit selects the PLLCLK as source of the System Clocks (Core Clock and Bus Clock). PLLSEL can only be set to 0, if UPOSC=1. UPOSC= 0 sets the PLLSEL bit. Entering full stop mode sets the PLLSEL bit. 0 System clocks are derived from OSCCLK if Oscillator is up (UPOSC=1, fbus = fosc / 2. 1 System clocks are derived from PLLCLK, fbus = fPLL / 2. Pseudo Stop Bit This bit controls the functionality of the oscillator during Stop Mode. 0 Oscillator is disabled in Stop Mode. 1 Oscillator continues to run in Stop Mode (Pseudo Stop), option to run RTI and COP. Note: Pseudo Stop Mode allows for faster STOP recovery and reduces the mechanical stress and aging of the resonator in case of frequent STOP conditions at the expense of a slightly increased power consumption. Note: When starting up the external Oscillator (either by programming OSCEN bit to 1 or on exit from full stop mode with OSCEN bit is already 1) the software must wait for a minimum time equivalent to the startuptime of the external Oscillator tUPOSC before entering Pseudo Stop Mode. RTI Enable During Pseudo Stop Bit -- PRE enables the RTI during Pseudo Stop Mode. 0 RTI stops running during Pseudo Stop Mode. 1 RTI continues running during Pseudo Stop Mode if RTIOSCSEL=1. Note: If PRE=0 or RTIOSCSEL=0 then the RTI will go static while Stop Mode is active. The RTI counter will not be reset. COP Enable During Pseudo Stop Bit -- PCE enables the COP during Pseudo Stop Mode. 0 COP stops running during Pseudo Stop Mode 1 COP continues running during Pseudo Stop Mode if COPOSCSEL=1 Note: If PCE=0 or COPOSCSEL=0 then the COP will go static while Stop Mode is active. The COP counter will not be reset.
6 PSTP
3 PRE
2 PCE
1 RTI Clock Select-- RTIOSCSEL selects the clock source to the RTI. Either IRCCLK or OSCCLK. Changing the RTIOSCSEL RTIOSCSEL bit re-starts the RTI timeout period. RTIOSCSEL can only be set to 1, if UPOSC=1. UPOSC= 0 clears the RTIOSCSEL bit. 0 RTI clock source is IRCCLK. 1 RTI clock source is OSCCLK. 0 COP Clock Select-- COPOSCSEL selects the clock source to the COP. Either IRCCLK or OSCCLK. Changing COPOSCSE the COPOSCSEL bit re-starts the COP timeout period. L COPOSCSEL can only be set to 1, if UPOSC=1. UPOSC= 0 clears the COPOSCSEL bit. 0 COP clock source is IRCCLK. 1 COP clock source is OSCCLK
7.3.2.7
S12CPMU PLL Control Register (CPMUPLL)
This register controls the PLL functionality.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 211
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
0x003A
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0 FM1 FM0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 7-10. S12CPMU PLL Control Register (CPMUPLL)
Read: Anytime Write: If PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register), then write anytime. Else write has no effect. NOTE Write to this register clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits. NOTE Care should be taken to ensure that the bus frequency does not exceed the specified maximum when frequency modulation is enabled. NOTE When using the oscillator filter, that is in the CPMUOSC register OSCEN=1 and OSCFILT[4:0] is not 00000, then the frequency modulation must be turned off (FM1=0, FM0=0).
Table 7-6. CPMUPLL Field Descriptions
Field 5, 4 FM1, FM0 Description PLL Frequency Modulation Enable Bits -- FM1 and FM0 enable frequency modulation on the VCOCLK. This is to reduce noise emission. The modulation frequency is fref divided by 16. See Table 7-7 for coding.
Table 7-7. FM Amplitude selection
FM1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 FM0 FM Amplitude / fVCO Variation FM off 1% 2% 4%
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 212 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
7.3.2.8
S12CPMU RTI Control Register (CPMURTI)
This register selects the timeout period for the Real Time Interrupt. The clock source for the RTI is either IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the setting of the RTIOSCSEL bit. In Stop Mode with PSTP=1 and RTIOSCSEL=1 the RTI continues to run, else the RTI counter halts in Stop Mode.
0x003B
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R RTDEC W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RTR6 RTR5 RTR4 RTR3 RTR2 RTR1 RTR0
Figure 7-11. S12CPMU RTI Control Register (CPMURTI)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime NOTE A write to this register start or re-starts the RTI time-out period. A change of the RTIOSCSEL bit (writing a different value or loosing UPOSC status) re-starts the RTI time-out period.
Table 7-8. CPMURTI Field Descriptions
Field 7 RTDEC 6-4 RTR[6:4] 3-0 RTR[3:0] Description Decimal or Binary Divider Select Bit -- RTDEC selects decimal or binary based prescaler values. 0 Binary based divider value. See Table 7-9 1 Decimal based divider value. See Table 7-10 Real Time Interrupt Prescale Rate Select Bits -- These bits select the prescale rate for the RTI. See Table 79 and Table 7-10. Real Time Interrupt Modulus Counter Select Bits -- These bits select the modulus counter target value to provide additional granularity.Table 7-9 and Table 7-10 show all possible divide values selectable by the CPMURTI register.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 213
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-9. RTI Frequency Divide Rates for RTDEC = 0
RTR[6:4] = RTR[3:0] 000 (OFF) OFF(1) OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 001 (210) 210 2x210 3x210 4x210 5x210 6x210 7x210 8x210 9x210 10x210 11x210 12x210 13x210 14x210 15x210 16x210 010 (211) 211 2x211 3x211 4x211 5x211 6x211 7x211 8x211 9x211 10x211 11x211 12x211 13x211 14x211 15x211 16x211 011 (212) 212 2x212 3x212 4x212 5x212 6x212 7x212 8x212 9x212 10x212 11x212 12x212 13x212 14x212 15x212 16x212 100 (213) 213 2x213 3x213 4x213 5x213 6x213 7x213 8x213 9x213 10x213 11x213 12x213 13x213 14x213 15x213 16x213 101 (214) 214 2x214 3x214 4x214 5x214 6x214 7x214 8x214 9x214 10x214 11x214 12x214 13x214 14x214 15x214 16x214 110 (215) 215 2x215 3x215 4x215 5x215 6x215 7x215 8x215 9x215 10x215 11x215 12x215 13x215 14x215 15x215 16x215 111 (216) 216 2x216 3x216 4x216 5x216 6x216 7x216 8x216 9x216 10x216 11x216 12x216 13x216 14x216 15x216 16x216
0000 (/1) 0001 (/2) 0010 (/3) 0011 (/4) 0100 (/5) 0101 (/6) 0110 (/7) 0111 (/8) 1000 (/9) 1001 (/10) 1010 (/11) 1011 (/12) 1100 (/13) 1101 (/14) 1110 (/15) 1111 (/16)
1. Denotes the default value out of reset.This value should be used to disable the RTI to ensure future backwards compatibility.
Table 7-10. RTI Frequency Divide Rates for RTDEC=1
RTR[6:4] = RTR[3:0] 000 (1x103) 1x103 2x103 3x103 4x103 5x103 001 (2x103) 2x103 4x103 6x103 8x103 10x103 010 (5x103) 5x103 10x103 15x103 20x103 25x103 011 (10x103) 10x103 20x103 30x103 40x103 50x103 100 (20x103) 20x103 40x103 60x103 80x103 100x103 101 (50x103) 50x103 100x103 150x103 200x103 250x103 110 (100x103) 100x103 200x103 300x103 400x103 500x103 111 (200x103) 200x103 400x103 600x103 800x103 1x106
0000 (/1) 0001 (/2) 0010 (/3) 0011 (/4) 0100 (/5)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 214 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-10. RTI Frequency Divide Rates for RTDEC=1
RTR[6:4] = RTR[3:0] 000 (1x103) 6x103 7x103 8x103 9x103 10 x103 11 x103 12x103 13x103 14x103 15x103 16x103 001 (2x103) 12x103 14x103 16x103 18x103 20x103 22x103 24x103 26x103 28x103 30x103 32x103 010 (5x103) 30x103 35x103 40x103 45x103 50x103 55x103 60x103 65x103 70x103 75x103 80x103 011 (10x103) 60x103 70x103 80x103 90x103 100x103 110x103 120x103 130x103 140x103 150x103 160x103 100 (20x103) 120x103 140x103 160x103 180x103 200x103 220x103 240x103 260x103 280x103 300x103 320x103 101 (50x103) 300x103 350x103 400x103 450x103 500x103 550x103 600x103 650x103 700x103 750x103 800x103 110 (100x103) 600x103 700x103 800x103 900x103 1x106 1.1x106 1.2x106 1.3x106 1.4x106 1.5x106 1.6x106 111 (200x103) 1.2x106 1.4x106 1.6x106 1.8x106 2x106 2.2x106 2.4x106 2.6x106 2.8x106 3x106 3.2x106
0101 (/6) 0110 (/7) 0111 (/8) 1000 (/9) 1001 (/10) 1010 (/11) 1011 (/12) 1100 (/13) 1101 (/14) 1110 (/15) 1111 (/16)
7.3.2.9
S12CPMU COP Control Register (CPMUCOP)
This register controls the COP (Computer Operating Properly) watchdog. The clock source for the COP is either IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the setting of the COPOSCSEL bit. In Stop Mode with PSTP=1, COPOSCSEL=1 and PCE=1 the COP continues to run, else the COP counter halts in Stop Mode.
0x003C
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R WCOP W Reset F 0 RSBCK
0 WRTMASK 0
0
0 CR2 CR1 F CR0 F
0
0
F
After de-assert of System Reset the values are automatically loaded from the Flash memory. See Device specification for details. = Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-12. S12CPMU COP Control Register (CPMUCOP)
Read: Anytime Write: 1. RSBCK: anytime in special mode; write to "1" but not to "0" in normal mode
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 215
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
2. WCOP, CR2, CR1, CR0: -- Anytime in special mode, when WRTMASK is 0, otherwise it has no effect -- Write once in normal mode, when WRTMASK is 0, otherwise it has no effect. - Writing CR[2:0] to "000" has no effect, but counts for the "write once" condition. - Writing WCOP to "0" has no effect, but counts for the "write once" condition. When a non-zero value is loaded from Flash to CR[2:0] the COP time-out period is started. A change of the COPOSCSEL bit (writing a different value or loosing UPOSC status) re-starts the COP time-out period. In normal mode the COP time-out period is restarted if either of these conditions is true: 1. Writing a non-zero value to CR[2:0] (anytime in special mode, once in normal mode) with WRTMASK = 0. 2. Writing WCOP bit (anytime in special mode, once in normal mode) with WRTMASK = 0. 3. Changing RSBCK bit from "0" to "1". In special mode, any write access to CPMUCOP register restarts the COP time-out period.
Table 7-11. CPMUCOP Field Descriptions
Field 7 WCOP Description Window COP Mode Bit -- When set, a write to the ARMCOP register must occur in the last 25% of the selected period. A write during the first 75% of the selected period generates a COP reset. As long as all writes occur during this window, $55 can be written as often as desired. Once $AA is written after the $55, the time-out logic restarts and the user must wait until the next window before writing to ARMCOP. Table 7-12 shows the duration of this window for the seven available COP rates. 0 Normal COP operation 1 Window COP operation COP and RTI Stop in Active BDM Mode Bit 0 Allows the COP and RTI to keep running in Active BDM mode. 1 Stops the COP and RTI counters whenever the part is in Active BDM mode.
6 RSBCK
5 Write Mask for WCOP and CR[2:0] Bit -- This write-only bit serves as a mask for the WCOP and CR[2:0] bits WRTMASK while writing the CPMUCOP register. It is intended for BDM writing the RSBCK without touching the contents of WCOP and CR[2:0]. 0 Write of WCOP and CR[2:0] has an effect with this write of CPMUCOP 1 Write of WCOP and CR[2:0] has no effect with this write of CPMUCOP. (Does not count for "write once".) 2-0 CR[2:0] COP Watchdog Timer Rate Select -- These bits select the COP time-out rate (see Table 7-12). Writing a nonzero value to CR[2:0] enables the COP counter and starts the time-out period. A COP counter time-out causes a System Reset. This can be avoided by periodically (before time-out) initializing the COP counter via the ARMCOP register. While all of the following four conditions are true the CR[2:0], WCOP bits are ignored and the COP operates at highest time-out period (2 24 cycles) in normal COP mode (Window COP mode disabled): 1) COP is enabled (CR[2:0] is not 000) 2) BDM mode active 3) RSBCK = 0 4) Operation in special mode
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 216 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-12. COP Watchdog Rates
COPCLK Cycles to Timeout (COPCLK is either IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the COPOSCSEL bit) COP disabled 2 14 2 16 2 18 2 20 2 22 2 23 2 24
CR2
CR1
CR0
0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1
0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1
0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
7.3.2.10
Reserved Register CPMUTEST0
NOTE This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only, and is not intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in special mode can alter the S12CPMU's functionality.
0x003D
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-13. Reserved Register (CPMUTEST0)
Read: Anytime Write: Only in special mode
7.3.2.11
Reserved Register CPMUTEST1
NOTE This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only, and is not intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in special mode can alter the S12CPMU's functionality.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 217
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
0x003E
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-14. Reserved Register (CPMUTEST1)
Read: Anytime Write: Only in special mode
7.3.2.12
S12CPMU COP Timer Arm/Reset Register (CPUARMCOP)
This register is used to restart the COP time-out period.
0x003F
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 Bit 7 0
0 Bit 6 0
0 Bit 5 0
0 Bit 4 0
0 Bit 3 0
0 Bit 2 0
0 Bit 1 0
0 Bit 0 0
Figure 7-15. S12CPMU CPMUARMCOP Register
Read: Always reads $00 Write: Anytime When the COP is disabled (CR[2:0] = "000") writing to this register has no effect. When the COP is enabled by setting CR[2:0] nonzero, the following applies: Writing any value other than $55 or $AA causes a COP reset. To restart the COP time-out period write $55 followed by a write of $AA. These writes do not need to occur back-to-back, but the sequence ($55, $AA) must be completed prior to COP end of time-out period to avoid a COP reset. Sequences of $55 writes are allowed. When the WCOP bit is set, $55 and $AA writes must be done in the last 25% of the selected time-out period; writing any value in the first 75% of the selected period will cause a COP reset.
7.3.2.13
High Temperature Control Register (CPMUHTCTL)
The CPMUHTCTL register configures the temperature sense features.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 218 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
0x02F0
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
VSEL 0
0 0
HTE 0
HTDS 0
HTIE 0
HTIF 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Read: Anytime Write: VSEL, HTE, HTIE and HTIF are write anytime, HTDS is read only
Figure 7-16. Voltage Access Select
VBG Ref VSEL
C
TEMPSENSE
ATD Channel
HTD
Table 7-13. CPMUHTCTL Field Descriptions
Field 5 VSEL Description Voltage Access Select Bit -- If set, the bandgap reference voltage VBG can be accessed internally (i.e. multiplexed to an internal Analog to Digital Converter channel). If not set, the die temperature proportional voltage VHT of the temperature sense can be accessed internally. See device level specification for connectivity. 0 An internal temperature proportional voltage VHT can be accessed internally. 1 Bandgap reference voltage VBG can be accessed internally. High Temperature Enable Bit -- This bit enables the high temperature sensor. 0 The temperature sense is disabled. 1 The temperature sense is enabled. High Temperature Detect Status Bit -- This read-only status bit reflects the temperature. status. Writes have no effect. 0 Junction Temperature is below level THTID or RPM. 1 Junction Temperature is above level THTIA and FPM.
3 HTE 2 HTDS
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 219
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-13. CPMUHTCTL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 HTIE 0 HTIF Description High Temperature Interrupt Enable Bit 0 Interrupt request is disabled. 1 Interrupt will be requested whenever HTIF is set. High Temperature Interrupt Flag -- HTIF -- High Temperature Interrupt Flag HTIF is set to 1 when HTDS status bit changes. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (HTIE=1), HTIF causes an interrupt request. 0 No change in HTDS bit. 1 HTDS bit has changed.
7.3.2.14
Low Voltage Control Register (CPMULVCTL)
The CPMULVCTL register allows the configuration of the low-voltage detect features.
0x02F1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
LVDS U
LVIE 0
LVIF U
The Reset state of LVDS and LVIF depends on the external supplied VDDA level = Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-17. Low Voltage Control Register (CPMULVCTL)
Read: Anytime Write: LVIE and LVIF are write anytime, LVDS is read only
Table 7-14. CPMULVCTL Field Descriptions
Field 2 LVDS Description Low-Voltage Detect Status Bit -- This read-only status bit reflects the voltage level on VDDA. Writes have no effect. 0 Input voltage VDDA is above level VLVID or RPM. 1 Input voltage VDDA is below level VLVIA and FPM. Low-Voltage Interrupt Enable Bit 0 Interrupt request is disabled. 1 Interrupt will be requested whenever LVIF is set. Low-Voltage Interrupt Flag -- LVIF is set to 1 when LVDS status bit changes. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (LVIE = 1), LVIF causes an interrupt request. 0 No change in LVDS bit. 1 LVDS bit has changed.
1 LVIE 0 LVIF
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 220 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
7.3.2.15
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Control Register (CPMUAPICTL)
The CPMUAPICTL register allows the configuration of the autonomous periodical interrupt features.
0x02F2
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
APICLK 0
0 0
0 0
APIES 0
APIEA 0
APIFE 0
APIE 0
APIF 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-18. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Control Register (CPMUAPICTL)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 7-15. CPMUAPICTL Field Descriptions
Field 7 APICLK Description Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Clock Select Bit -- Selects the clock source for the API. Writable only if APIFE = 0. APICLK cannot be changed if APIFE is set by the same write operation. 0 Autonomous periodical interrupt clock used as source. 1 Bus clock used as source. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt External Select Bit -- Selects the waveform at the external pin API_EXTCLK as shown in Figure 7-19. See device level specification for connectivity of API_EXTCLK pin. 0 If APIEA and APIFE are set, at the external pin API_EXTCLK periodic high pulses are visible at the end of every selected period with the size of half of the min period (APIR=0x0000 in Table 7-19). 1 If APIEA and APIFE are set, at the external pin API_EXTCLK a clock is visible with 2 times the selected API Period. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt External Access Enable Bit -- If set, the waveform selected by bit APIES can be accessed externally. See device level specification for connectivity. 0 Waveform selected by APIES can not be accessed externally. 1 Waveform selected by APIES can be accessed externally, if APIFE is set. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Feature Enable Bit -- Enables the API feature and starts the API timer when set. 0 Autonomous periodical interrupt is disabled. 1 Autonomous periodical interrupt is enabled and timer starts running. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Enable Bit 0 API interrupt request is disabled. 1 API interrupt will be requested whenever APIF is set. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Flag -- APIF is set to 1 when the in the API configured time has elapsed. This flag can only be cleared by writing a 1. Writing a 0 has no effect. If enabled (APIE = 1), APIF causes an interrupt request. 0 API timeout has not yet occurred. 1 API timeout has occurred.
4 APIES
3 APIEA
2 APIFE
1 APIE 0 APIF
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 221
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Figure 7-19. Waveform selected on API_EXTCLK pin (APIEA=1, APIFE=1)
API min period / 2
APIES=0 API period APIES=1
7.3.2.16
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Trimming Register (CPMUAPITR)
The CPMUAPITR register configures the trimming of the API timeout period.
0x02F3
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
APITR5 F
APITR4 F
APITR3 F
APITR2 F
APITR1 F
APITR0 F
0 0
0 0
After de-assert of System Reset a value is automatically loaded from the Flash memory.
Figure 7-20. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Trimming Register (CPMUAPITR)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 7-16. CPMUAPITR Field Descriptions
Field 7-2 APITR[5:0] Description Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Period Trimming Bits -- See Table 7-17 for trimming effects. The APITR[5:0] value represents a signed number influencing the ACLK period time.
Table 7-17. Trimming Effect of APITR
Bit APITR[5] APITR[4] APITR[3] APITR[2] Increases period Decreases period less than APITR[5] increased it Decreases period less than APITR[4] Decreases period less than APITR[3] Trimming Effect
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 222 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-17. Trimming Effect of APITR
Bit APITR[1] APITR[0] Trimming Effect Decreases period less than APITR[2] Decreases period less than APITR[1]
7.3.2.17
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Rate High and Low Register (CPMUAPIRH / CPMUAPIRL)
The CPMUAPIRH and CPMUAPIRL registers allow the configuration of the autonomous periodical interrupt rate.
0x02F4
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
APIR15 0
APIR14 0
APIR13 0
APIR12 0
APIR11 0
APIR10 0
APIR9 0
APIR8 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-21. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Rate High Register (CPMUAPIRH)
0x02F5
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
APIR7 0
APIR6 0
APIR5 0
APIR4 0
APIR3 0
APIR2 0
APIR1 0
APIR0 0
Figure 7-22. Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Rate Low Register (CPMUAPIRL)
Read: Anytime Write: If APIFE=0, then write anytime, else writes have no effect.
Table 7-18. CPMUAPIRH / CPMUAPIRL Field Descriptions
Field 15-0 APIR[15:0] Description Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Rate Bits -- These bits define the timeout period of the API. See Table 719 for details of the effect of the autonomous periodical interrupt rate bits.
The period can be calculated as follows depending on logical value of the APICLK bit: APICLK=0: Period = 2*(APIR[15:0] + 1) * fACLK APICLK=1: Period = 2*(APIR[15:0] + 1) * Bus Clock period
Table 7-19. Selectable Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Periods
APICLK 0 APIR[15:0] 0000 Selected Period 0.2 ms(1)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 223
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-19. Selectable Autonomous Periodical Interrupt Periods (continued)
APICLK 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 APIR[15:0] 0001 0002 0003 0004 0005 ..... FFFD FFFE FFFF 0000 0001 0002 0003 0004 0005 ..... FFFD FFFE Selected Period 0.4 ms1 0.6 ms1 0.8 ms1 1.0 ms1 1.2 ms1 ..... 13106.8 ms1 13107.0 ms1 13107.2 ms1 2 * Bus Clock period 4 * Bus Clock period 6 * Bus Clock period 8 * Bus Clock period 10 * Bus Clock period 12 * Bus Clock period ..... 131068 * Bus Clock period 131070 * Bus Clock period 131072 * Bus Clock period
1 FFFF 1. When fACLK is trimmed to 10KHz.
7.3.2.18
Reserved Register CPMUTEST3
NOTE This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only, and is not intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in special mode can alter the S12CPMU's functionality.
0x02F6
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-23. Reserved Register (CPMUTEST3)
Read: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 224 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Write: Only in special mode
7.3.2.19
High Temperature Trimming Register (CPMUHTTR)
The CPMUHTTR register configures the trimming of the S12CPMU temperature sense.
0x02F7
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
HTOE 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
HTTR3 F
HTTR2 F
HTTR1 F
HTTR0 F
After de-assert of System Reset a trim value is automatically loaded from the Flash memory. See Device specification for details. = Unimplemented or Reserved
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Field 7 HTOE 3-0 HTTR[3:0] Description High Temperature Offset Enable Bit -- If set the temperature sense offset is enabled. 0 The temperature sense offset is disabled. HTTR[3:0] bits don't care. 1 The temperature sense offset is enabled. HTTR[3:0] select the temperature offset. High Temperature Trimming Bits -- See Table 1-27 for trimming effects.
Bit HTTR[3] HTTR[2] HTTR[1] HTTR[0]
Trimming Effect Increases VHT twice of HTTR[2] Increases VHT twice of HTTR[1] Increases VHT twice of HTTR[0] Increases VHT (to compensate Temperature Offset)
7.3.2.20
S12CPMU IRC1M Trim Registers (CPMUIRCTRIMH / CPMUIRCTRIML)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 225
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
0x02F8
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
R TCTRIM[3:0] W Reset F F F F
0
0 IRCTRIM[9:8]
0
0
F
F
After de-assert of System Reset a factory programmed trim value is automatically loaded from the Flash memory to provide trimmed Internal Reference Frequency fIRC1M_TRIM.
Figure 7-24. S12CPMU IRC1M Trim High Register (CPMUIRCTRIMH)
0x02F9
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R IRCTRIM[7:0] W Reset F F F F F F F F
After de-assert of System Reset a factory programmed trim value is automatically loaded from the Flash memory to provide trimmed Internal Reference Frequency fIRC1M_TRIM.
Figure 7-25. S12CPMU IRC1M Trim Low Register (CPMUIRCTRIML)
Read: Anytime Write: If PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register), then write anytime. Else write has no effect NOTE Writes to these registers while PLLSEL=1 clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 226 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-20. CPMUIRCTRIMH/L Field Descriptions
Field Description
15,14,13,12 IRC1M temperature coefficient Trim Bits These bits are to trim the temperature coefficient (TC) of the frequency of the IRC1M. Figure 7-28 shows the influence of the bits TCTRIM3:0] on the relationship between frequency and temperature. Figure 7-27 shows an approximate TC variation, relative to the nominal TC of the IRC1M (i.e. for TCTRIM[3:0]=0000 or 1000). 9,8,7,6,5,4,3 IRC1M Frequency Trim Bits -- Trim bits for Internal Reference Clock ,2,1,0 After System Reset the factory programmed trim value is automatically loaded into these registers, resulting in a Internal Reference Frequency fIRC1M_TRIM. See device electrical characteristics for value of fIRC1M_TRIM. The frequency trimming consists of two different trimming methods: A rough trimming, controlled by the bits IRCTRIM[9:6], and allowing frequency leaps of about 6% in average. A fine trimming, controlled by the bits IRCTRIM[5:0], and allowing frequency leaps of about 0.3% (this trimming determines the precision of the frequency setting of 0.15%, i.e. 0.3% is the distance between two trimming values). Figure 7-26 shows the relationship between the trim bits and the resulting IRC1M frequency.
IRC1M frequency (IRCCLK) IRCTRIM[9:6] 1.5MHz
{
1MHz
IRCTRIM[5:0]
......
600KHz IRCTRIM[9:0] $000
Figure 7-26. IRC1M Frequency Trimming Diagram
$3FF
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 227
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
frequency
1 ]=% 111
TC
IM TR
[3:0
%1111 %1110 %1101 %1100 %1011 %1010 %1001 %0001 %0010 %0011 %0100 %0101 %0110 %0111 150C
TC increases
TCTRIM[3:0]=%1000 or %0000 (nominal TC)
TCT
TC decreases
RIM
[3:0
]=%
011
1
- 40C
temperature
Figure 7-27. Influence of TCTRIM[3:0] on the Temperature Coefficient
NOTE The frequency is not necessarily linear with the temperature (in most cases it will not be). The above diagram is meant only to give the direction (positive or negative) of the variation of the TC, relative to the nominal TC. Setting TCTRIM[3:0] at 0000 or 1000 does not mean that the temperature coefficient will be zero. These two combinations basically switch off the TC compensation module, and give the nominal TC of the IRC1M.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 228 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
TCTRIM[3:0] 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111
Indicative TC variation 0 (nominal TC of the IRC1M) -0.54% -1.08% -1.63% -2.20% -2.77% -3.33% -3.91% 0 (nominal TC of the IRC1M) +0.54% +1.07% +1.59% +2.11% +2.62% +3.12% +3.62%
Figure 7-28. TC trimming of the frequency of the IRC1M
NOTE Since the IRC1M frequency is not a linear function of the temperature, but more like a parabola, the above relative variation is only an indication and should be considered with care. Be aware that the output frequency varies with the TC trimming, of respectively +/- 0.8%, +/-1.6%, +/-2.4%, +/-3.2%, +/-4.0%, +/-4.8%, +/5.5% ambient temperature, from the lowest to the greatest TC correction. A frequency trimming correction is therefore necessary if a TC trimming correction has been performed. For high TC trimming corrections (+/-4 or 5%), and for very worst case silicon, the margin left to trim the part at 1MHz may be small, but should be sufficient.
7.3.2.21
S12CPMU Oscillator Register (CPMUOSC)
This registers configures the external oscillator (OSCLCP).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 229
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
0x02FA
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R OSCE W Reset 0 0 OSCBW
0 OSCFILT[4:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 7-29. S12CPMU Oscillator Register (CPMUOSC)
Read: Anytime Write: If PROT=0 (CPMUPROT register) and PLLSEL=1 (CPMUCLKS register), then write anytime. Else write has no effect. NOTE. Write to this register clears the LOCK and UPOSC status bits. NOTE. If the chosen VCOCLK-to-OSCCLK ratio is not an integer number, then the filter can not be used and the OSCFILT[4:0] bits must be set to 0.
Table 7-21. CPMUOSC Field Descriptions
Field 7 Description Oscillator Enable Bit -- This bit enables the external oscillator (OSCLCP). The UPOSC status bit in the CPMUFLG register indicates when the oscillation is stable and OSCCLK can be selected as Bus Clock or source of the COP or RTI. A loss of oscillation will lead to a clock monitor reset. 0 external Oscillator is disabled. 1 external Oscillator is enabled.Clock monitor is enabled. Note: When starting up the external Oscillator (either by programming OSCEN bit to 1 or on exit from full stop mode with OSCEN bit is already 1) the software must wait for a minimum time equivalent to the startuptime of the external Oscillator tUPOSC before entering Pseudo Stop Mode. Oscillator Filter Bandwidth Bit 0 Oscillator filter bandwidth is narrow. 1 Oscillator filter bandwidth is wide. Oscillator Filter Bits -- When using the Oscillator a noise filter can be enabled, which filters noise from the OSCCLK and detects if the OSCCLK is qualified or not (UPOSC status). For example when using a 4MHz crystal and synthesizing a VCOCLK of 64 MHz, then OSCFILT must be set to 8 (64MHz / 4MHz = 16, 16 divided by 2 is 8). 0x00 Oscillator Filter disabled. else Oscillator Filter enabled: the VCOCLK-to-OSCCLK frequency ratio divided by 2 must be written to OSCFILT[4:0]
6
4-0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 230 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
7.3.2.22
S12CPMU Protection Register (CPMUPROT)
This register is for protecting the clock configuration registers CPMUSYNR, CPMUREFDIV, CPMUPLL, CPMUIRCTRIMH/L and CPMUOSC from accidental overwrite.
0x02FB
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0 PROT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 7-30. S12CPMU Protection Register (CPMUPROT)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Field 0
Description Clock Configuration Registers Protection Bit -- This bit is to protect the following clock configuration registers from accidental overwrite: CPMUSYNR, CPMUREFDIV, CPMUCLKS, CPMUPLL, CPMUIRCTRIMH/L and CPMUOSC. Writing 0x26 to the CPMUPROT register clears the PROT bit, other write accesses set the PROT bit. 0 Protection of clock configuration registers is disabled. 1 Protection of clock configuration registers is enabled. CPMUSYNR, CPMUREFDIV, CPMUCLKS, CPMUPLL, CPMUIRCTRIMH/L and CPMUOSC are not writable.
7.3.2.23
Reserved Register CPMUTEST2
NOTE This reserved register is designed for factory test purposes only, and is not intended for general user access. Writing to this register when in special mode can alter the S12CPMU's functionality.
0x02FC
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 7-31. Reserved Register CPMUTEST2
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 231
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Read: Anytime Write: Only in special mode
7.4
7.4.1
Functional Description
Phase Locked Loop with Internal Filter (PLL)
The PLL is used to generate a high speed PLLCLK based on a low frequency REFCLK. The REFCLK is by default the IRCCLK which is trimmed to fIRC1M_TRIM=1MHz. If using the Oscillator (OSCE=1) REFCLK will be based on OSCCLK. For increased flexibility, OSCCLK can be divided in a range of 1 to 16 to generate the reference frequency REFCLK using the REFDIV[3:0] bits. Based on the SYNDIV[5:0] bits the PLL generates the VCOCLK by multiplying the reference clock by a 2, 4, 6,... 126, 128. Based on the POSTDIV[4:0] bits the VCOCLK can be divided in a range of 1,2, 3, 4, 5, 6,... to 32 to generate the PLLCLK.
f OSC f REF = -----------------------------------( REFDIV + 1 ) f REF = f IRC1M
If Oscillator is enabled (OSCE=1) If Oscillator is disabled (OSCE=0)
f VCO = 2 x f REF x ( SYNDIV + 1 ) f VCO f PLL = ---------------------------------------( POSTDIV + 1 ) f VCO f PLL = --------------4 f PLL f bus = -----------2
If PLL is locked (LOCK=1)
If PLL is not locked (LOCK=0)
If PLL is selected (PLLSEL=1)
.
NOTE Although it is possible to set the dividers to command a very high clock frequency, do not exceed the specified bus frequency limit for the MCU. Several examples of PLL divider settings are shown in Table 7-22. The following rules help to achieve optimum stability and shortest lock time: * Use lowest possible fVCO / fREF ratio (SYNDIV value). * Use highest possible REFCLK frequency fREF.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 232 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Table 7-22. Examples of PLL Divider Settings
fosc off off off 4MHz REFDIV[3:0] $00 $00 $00 $00 fREF 1MHz 1MHz 1MHz 4MHz REFFRQ[1:0] SYNDIV[5:0] 00 00 00 01 $1F $1F $0F $03 fVCO 64MHz 64MHz 32MHz 32MHz VCOFRQ[1:0] POSTDIV[4:0] 01 01 00 01 $03 $00 $00 $00 fPLL 16MHz 64MHz 32MHz 32MHz fbus 8MHz 32MHz 16MHz 16MHz
The phase detector then compares the FBCLK with the REFCLK. Correction pulses are generated based on the phase difference between the two signals. The loop filter then slightly alters the DC voltage on the internal filter capacitor, based on the width and direction of the correction pulse. The user must select the range of the REFCLK frequency (REFFRQ[1:0] bits) and the range of the VCOCLK frequency (VCOFRQ[1:0] bits) to ensure that the correct PLL loop bandwidth is set. The lock detector compares the frequencies of the FBCLK and the REFCLK. Therefore, the speed of the lock detector is directly proportional to the reference clock frequency. The circuit determines the lock condition based on this comparison. If PLL LOCK interrupt requests are enabled, the software can wait for an interrupt request and then check the LOCK bit. If interrupt requests are disabled, software can poll the LOCK bit continuously (during PLL start-up, usually) or at periodic intervals. In either case, only when the LOCK bit is set, the VCOCLK will have stabilized to the programmed frequency. * The LOCK bit is a read-only indicator of the locked state of the PLL. * The LOCK bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain tolerance, Lock, and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of a certain tolerance, unl. * Interrupt requests can occur if enabled (LOCKIE = 1) when the lock condition changes, toggling the LOCK bit.
7.4.2
Startup from Reset
An example of startup of clock system from Reset is given in Figure 7-32.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 233
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Figure 7-32. Startup of clock system after Reset System Reset PLLCLK LOCK fVCORST
768 cycles )(
fPLL increasing
fPLL=16MHz
fPLL=32 MHz
tlock
SYNDIV POSTDIV CPU
$1F (default target fVCO=64MHz) $03 (default target fPLL=fVCO/4 = 16MHz) reset state vector fetch, program execution $01
example change of POSTDIV
7.4.3
Stop Mode using PLL Clock as Bus Clock
An example of what happens going into Stop Mode and exiting Stop Mode after an interrupt is shown in Figure 7-33. Disable PLL Lock interrupt (LOCKIE=0) before going into Stop Mode.
Figure 7-33. Stop Mode using PLL Clock as Bus Clock wakeup
CPU
execution
STOP instruction tSTP_REC
interrupt
continue execution
PLLCLK LOCK tlock
7.4.4
Full Stop Mode using Oscillator Clock as Bus Clock
An example of what happens going into Full Stop Mode and exiting Full Stop Mode after an interrupt is shown in Figure 7-34.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 234 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Disable PLL Lock interrupt (LOCKIE=0) and Oscillator status change interrupt (OSCIE=0) before going into Full Stop Mode.
Figure 7-34. Stop Mode using Oscillator Clock as Bus Clock wakeup
CPU Core Clock
execution
STOP instruction tSTP_REC
interrupt
continue execution
PLLCLK
tlock
OSCCLK
UPOSC select OSCCLK as Core/Bus Clock by writing PLLSEL to "0" PLLSEL automatically set when going into Full Stop Mode
7.4.5
7.4.5.1
External Oscillator
Enabling the External Oscillator
An example of how to use the Oscillator as Bus Clock is shown in Figure 7-35.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 235
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Figure 7-35. Enabling the external Oscillator enable external Oscillator by writing OSCE bit to one. OSCE crystal/resonator starts oscillating EXTAL UPOSC flag is set upon successful start of oscillation UPOSC
OSCCLK select OSCCLK as Core/Bus Clock by writing PLLSEL to zero PLLSEL Core Clock based on PLL Clock based on OSCCLK
7.4.5.2
The Oscillator Filter
The purpose of new adaptive Oscillator Filter is to protect the MCU code execution from noise or spikes introduced through the EXTAL and XTAL pins. A spike on the Oscillator Clock going to the MSCAN module or - in the rare case that the Oscillator is used as Bus Clock - could have severe impact on code execution. The Oscillator Filter has two tasks: * Most importantly filter noise spikes from the incoming external Oscillator Clock to protect the MCU code execution. * Detect severe noise disturbance on external Oscillator Clock and signal it to the software using UPOSC status, flag and interrupt.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 236 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Figure 7-36. Using the Oscillator Filter enable external Oscillator OSCE configure the Oscillator Filter OSC FILT EXTAL LOCK UPOSC OSCCLK
filtered filtered
0
8 crystal/resonator starts oscillating
Minor single spikes on EXTAL are just filtered away internally, stronger noise disturbance like a burst of spikes will impact the PLL and be recognized by the filter. This will clear UPOSC and LOCK, and generate the respective interrupts if enabled. The filtering of spikes and protection of the MCU code execution always works, regardless of Bus Clock source being either PLLCLK or OSCCLK. For the default case using PLLCLK as Bus Clock (PLLSEL=1), the noise detection always works. For the more rare case of using the Oscillator Clock as Bus Clock (PLLSEL=0), not every noise disturbance can be recognized. So in some noise disturbance scenarios, contrary to the figure above, UPOSC and LOCK both could stay asserted and there will be occasional pauses on OSCCLK resulting in pauses on the Bus Clock.
7.4.6
7.4.6.1
System Clock Configurations
PLL Engaged Internal Mode (PEI)
This mode is the default mode after System Reset or Power-On Reset. The Bus clock is based on the PLL clock, the reference clock for the PLL is internally generated (IRC1M). The PLL is configured to 64 MHz VCOCLK with POSTDIV set to 0x03. If locked (LOCK=1) this results in a PLL clock of 16 MHz and a Bus clock of 8 MHz. The PLL can be re-configured to other bus frequencies. The clock sources for COP and RTI are based on the internal reference clock generator (IRC1M).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 237
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
7.4.6.2
PLL Engaged External Mode (PEE)
In this mode, the Bus clock is based on the PLL clock as well (like PEI). The reference clock for the PLL is based on the external oscillator. The adaptive spike filter is active and uses the VCOCLK to qualify the status of the external oscillator clock. The clock sources for COP and RTI can be based on the internal reference clock generator or on the external oscillator clock. This mode can be entered from default mode PEI by performing the following steps: 1. Configure the PLL for desired bus frequency. 2. Program the reference divider (REFDIV[3:0] bits) to divide down Oscillator frequency if necessary. 3. Enable the external Oscillator (OSCE bit). Since the adaptive spike filter uses VCOCLK (from PLL) to continuously qualify the external oscillator clock, losing PLL lock status (LOCK=0) means losing the oscillator status information as well (UPOSC=0). The impact of losing the oscillator status in PEE mode is as follows: * The MSCAN module, which can be configured to run on the oscillator clock, may need to be reconfigured. Application software needs to be prepared to deal with the impact of losing the oscillator status at any time.
7.4.6.3
PLL Bypassed External Mode (PBE)
In this mode, the Bus clock is based on the external oscillator clock. The reference clock for the PLL is based on the external oscillator. The adaptive spike filter is active and uses the VCOCLK to qualify the status of the external oscillator clock. The clock sources for COP and RTI can be based on the internal reference clock generator or on the external oscillator clock. This mode can be entered from default mode PEI by performing the following steps: 1. Make sure the PLL configuration is valid: Program the reference divider (REFDIV[3:0] bits) to divide down Oscillator frequency if necessary. 2. Enable the external Oscillator (OSCE bit) 3. Wait for Oscillator to start up (UPOSC=1) 4. Select the Oscillator clock as Bus clock (PLLSEL=0) Since the adaptive spike filter uses VCOCLK (from PLL) to continuously qualify the external oscillator clock, losing PLL lock status (LOCK=0) means losing the oscillator status information as well (UPOSC=0). The impact of losing the oscillator status in PBE mode is as follows: * The MSCAN module, which can be configured to run on the oscillator clock, may need to be reconfigured.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 238 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
*
PLLSEL is set automatically and the Bus clock is switched back to the PLL clock.
Application software needs to be prepared to deal with the impact of losing the oscillator status at any time.
7.5
7.5.1
Resets
General
All reset sources are listed in Table 7-23. Refer to MCU specification for related vector addresses and priorities.
Table 7-23. Reset Summary
Reset Source Power-On Reset (POR) Low Voltage Reset (LVR) External pin RESET Illegal Address Reset Clock Monitor Reset COP Reset Local Enable None None None None OSCE Bit in CPMUOSC register CR[2:0] in CPMUCOP register
7.5.2
Description of Reset Operation
Upon detection of any reset of Table 7-23, an internal circuit drives the RESET pin low for 512 PLLCLK cycles. After 512 PLL Clock cycles the RESET pin is released. The reset generator of the S12CPMU waits for additional 256 PLLCLK cycles and then samples the RESET pin to determine the originating source. Table 7-24 shows which vector will be fetched.
Table 7-24. Reset Vector Selection
Sampled RESET Pin (256 cycles after release) 1 Oscillator monitor fail pending 0 COP time out pending 0 Vector Fetch POR LVR Illegal Address Reset External pin RESET Clock Monitor Reset COP Reset POR LVR Illegal Address Reset External pin RESET
1 1 0
1 0 X
X 1 X
NOTE While System Reset is asserted the PLLCLK and runs with the frequency fVCORST.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 239
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
The internal reset of the MCU remains asserted while the reset generator completes the 768 PLLCLK cycles long reset sequence. In case the RESET pin is externally driven low for more than these 768 PLLCLK cycles (External Reset), the internal reset remains asserted longer.
Figure 7-37. RESET Timing RESET
S12_CPMU drives RESET pin low S12_CPMU releases RESET pin
fVCORST
PLLCLK ) ( 512 cycles
fVCORST
) ( 256 cycles
possibly RESET driven low externally
) (
7.5.2.1
Clock Monitor Reset
If the external oscillator is enabled (OSCE=1) in case of loss of oscillation or the oscillator frequency is below the failure assert frequency fCMFA (see device electrical characteristics for values), the S12CPMU generates a Clock Monitor Reset.In full stop mode the external oscillator and the clock monitor are disabled.
7.5.2.2
Computer Operating Properly Watchdog (COP) Reset
The COP (free running watchdog timer) enables the user to check that a program is running and sequencing properly. When the COP is being used, software is responsible for keeping the COP from timing out. If the COP times out it is an indication that the software is no longer being executed in the intended sequence; thus COP reset is generated. The clock source for the COP is either IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the setting of the COPOSCSEL bit. In Stop Mode with PSTP=1, COPOSCSEL=1 and PCE=1 the COP continues to run, else the COP counter halts in Stop Mode. Three control bits in the CPMUCOP register allow selection of seven COP time-out periods. When COP is enabled, the program must write $55 and $AA (in this order) to the ARMCOP register during the selected time-out period. Once this is done, the COP time-out period is restarted. If the program fails to do this and the COP times out, a COP reset is generated. Also, if any value other than $55 or $AA is written, a COP reset generated.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 240 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
Windowed COP operation is enabled by setting WCOP in the CPMUCOP register. In this mode, writes to the ARMCOP register to clear the COP timer must occur in the last 25% of the selected time-out period. A premature write will immediately reset the part.
7.5.3
Power-On Reset (POR)
The on-chip voltage POR circuitry detects when VDD is below a certain voltage level. POR is deasserted, if VDD exceeds VPORD. The POR is asserted if VDD drops below VPORA.
7.5.4
Low-Voltage Reset (LVR)
The on-chip voltage LVR circuitry detects when one of the voltages VDD, VDDX and VDDF is below a certain voltage level. If LVR is deasserted the MCU is fully operational at the specified maximum speed.
7.6
Interrupts
The interrupt/reset vectors requested by the S12CPMU are listed in Table 7-25. Refer to MCU specification for related vector addresses and priorities.
Table 7-25. S12CPMU Interrupt Vectors Interrupt Source
RTI timeout interrupt PLL lock interrupt Oscillator status interrupt Low voltage interrupt High temperature interrupt Autonomous Periodical Interrupt
CCR Mask
I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit I bit
Local Enable
CPMUINT (RTIE) CPMUINT (LOCKIE) CPMUINT (OSCIE) CPMULVCTL (LVIE) CPMUHTCTL (HTIE) CPMUAPICTL (APIE)
7.6.1
7.6.1.1
Description of Interrupt Operation
Real Time Interrupt (RTI)
The clock source for the RTI is either IRCCLK or OSCCLK depending on the setting of the RTIOSCSEL bit. In Stop Mode with PSTP=1, RTIOSCSEL=1 and PRE=1 the RTI continues to run, else the RTI counter halts in Stop Mode. The RTI can be used to generate a hardware interrupt at a fixed periodic rate. If enabled (by setting RTIE=1), this interrupt will occur at the rate selected by the CPMURTI register. At the end of the RTI timeout period the RTIF flag is set to one and a new RTI time-out period starts immediately.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 241
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
A write to the CPMURTI register restarts the RTI time-out period.
7.6.1.2
PLL Lock Interrupt
The S12CPMU generates a PLL Lock interrupt when the lock condition (LOCK status bit) of the PLL changes, either from a locked state to an unlocked state or vice versa. Lock interrupts are locally disabled by setting the LOCKIE bit to zero. The PLL Lock interrupt flag (LOCKIF) is set to1 when the lock condition has changed, and is cleared to 0 by writing a 1 to the LOCKIF bit.
7.6.1.3
Oscillator Status Interrupt
The Oscillator Filter has 2 different tasks: 1. It filters spikes. 2. It qualifies the oscillation. When the OSCE bit is 0, then UPOSC stays 0. When OSCEN=1 and OSCFILT = 0, then the filter is transparent and no spikes are filtered. The UPOSC bit is then set after the LOCK bit is set. Upon detection of a status change (UPOSC), that is either a unqualified oscillation becomes qualified or vice versa the OSCIF flag is set. Going into full stop mode or disabling the oscillator can also cause a status change of UPOSC. Also, since the oscillator filter is based on the PLL clock, any change in PLL configuration or any other event which causes the PLL lock status to be cleared leads to a loss of the oscillator status information as well (UPOSC=0). Oscillator status change interrupts are locally enabled with the OSCIE bit. NOTE Losing the oscillator status (UPOSC=0) affects the clock configuration of the system1. This needs to be dealt with in application software.
7.6.1.4
Low-Voltage Interrupt (LVI)
In FPM the input voltage VDDA is monitored. Whenever VDDA drops below level VLVIA, the status bit LVDS is set to 1. On the other hand, LVDS is reset to 0 when VDDA rises above level VLVID. An interrupt, indicated by flag LVIF = 1, is triggered by any change of the status bit LVDS if interrupt enable bit LVIE = 1.
7.6.1.5
HTI - High Temperature Interrupt
In FPM the junction temperature TJ is monitored. Whenever TJ exceeds level THTIA the status bit HTDS is set to 1. Vice versa, HTDS is reset to 0 when TJ get below level THTID. An interrupt, indicated by flag HTIF = 1, is triggered by any change of the status bit HTDS, if interrupt enable bit HTIE = 1.
1. For details please refer to "7.4.6 System Clock Configurations" S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 242 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
7.6.1.6
Autonomous Periodical Interrupt (API)
The API sub-block can generate periodical interrupts independent of the clock source of the MCU. To enable the timer, the bit APIFE needs to be set. The API timer is either clocked by a trimmable internal RC oscillator (ACLK) or the Bus Clock. Timer operation will freeze when MCU clock source is selected and Bus Clock is turned off. The clock source can be selected with bit APICLK. APICLK can only be written when APIFE is not set. The APIR[15:0] bits determine the interrupt period. APIR[15:0] can only be written when APIFE is cleared. As soon as APIFE is set, the timer starts running for the period selected by APIR[15:0] bits. When the configured time has elapsed, the flag APIF is set. An interrupt, indicated by flag APIF = 1, is triggered if interrupt enable bit APIE = 1. The timer is re-started automatically again after it has set APIF. The procedure to change APICLK or APIR[15:0] is first to clear APIFE, then write to APICLK or APIR[15:0], and afterwards set APIFE. The API Trimming bits APITR[5:0] must be set so the minimum period equals 0.2 ms if stable frequency is desired. See Table 7-17 for the trimming effect of APITR. NOTE The first period after enabling the counter by APIFE might be reduced by API start up delay tsdel. It is possible to generate with the API a waveform at the external pin API_EXTCLK by setting APIFE and enabling the external access with setting APIEA.
7.7
Initialization/Application Information
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 243
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 244 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 245
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 246 Freescale Semiconductor
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 247
S12 Clock, Reset and Power Management Unit (S12CPMU) Block Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 248 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 8 Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-1. Revision History
Revision Number V03.08 V03.09 V03.10 Revision Date 07 Mar 2006 04 May 2007 19 Aug 2008 8.3.2.11/8-266 8.4.7.4/8-300 8.4.4.5/8-294 8.2/8-251 Sections Affected - Internal updates only. - Corrected mnemonics of code example in CANTBSEL register description - Corrected wake-up description - Relocated initialization section - Added note to external pin descriptions for use with integrated physical layer - Minor corrections Description of Changes
8.1
Introduction
Freescale's scalable controller area network (S12MSCANV3) definition is based on the MSCAN12 definition, which is the specific implementation of the MSCAN concept targeted for the M68HC12 microcontroller family. The module is a communication controller implementing the CAN 2.0A/B protocol as defined in the Bosch specification dated September 1991. For users to fully understand the MSCAN specification, it is recommended that the Bosch specification be read first to familiarize the reader with the terms and concepts contained within this document. Though not exclusively intended for automotive applications, CAN protocol is designed to meet the specific requirements of a vehicle serial data bus: real-time processing, reliable operation in the EMI environment of a vehicle, cost-effectiveness, and required bandwidth. MSCAN uses an advanced buffer arrangement resulting in predictable real-time behavior and simplified application software.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 249
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.1.1
Glossary
Table 8-2. Terminology
ACK CAN CRC EOF FIFO IFS SOF CPU bus CAN bus oscillator clock bus clock CAN clock Acknowledge of CAN message Controller Area Network Cyclic Redundancy Code End of Frame First-In-First-Out Memory Inter-Frame Sequence Start of Frame CPU related read/write data bus CAN protocol related serial bus Direct clock from external oscillator CPU bus realated clock CAN protocol related clock
8.1.2
Block Diagram
MSCAN
Oscillator Clock Bus Clock
CANCLK
MUX
Presc.
Tq Clk
Receive/ Transmit Engine
RXCAN TXCAN
Transmit Interrupt Req. Receive Interrupt Req. Errors Interrupt Req. Wake-Up Interrupt Req.
Control and Status
Message Filtering and Buffering
Configuration Registers
Wake-Up
Low Pass Filter
Figure 8-1. MSCAN Block Diagram
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 250 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.1.3
Features
The basic features of the MSCAN are as follows: * Implementation of the CAN protocol -- Version 2.0A/B -- Standard and extended data frames -- Zero to eight bytes data length -- Programmable bit rate up to 1 Mbps1 -- Support for remote frames * Five receive buffers with FIFO storage scheme * Three transmit buffers with internal prioritization using a "local priority" concept * Flexible maskable identifier filter supports two full-size (32-bit) extended identifier filters, or four 16-bit filters, or eight 8-bit filters * Programmable wakeup functionality with integrated low-pass filter * Programmable loopback mode supports self-test operation * Programmable listen-only mode for monitoring of CAN bus * Programmable bus-off recovery functionality * Separate signalling and interrupt capabilities for all CAN receiver and transmitter error states (warning, error passive, bus-off) * Programmable MSCAN clock source either bus clock or oscillator clock * Internal timer for time-stamping of received and transmitted messages * Three low-power modes: sleep, power down, and MSCAN enable * Global initialization of configuration registers
8.1.4
Modes of Operation
For a description of the specific MSCAN modes and the module operation related to the system operating modes refer to Section 8.4.4, "Modes of Operation".
8.2
External Signal Description
NOTE On MCUs with an integrated CAN physical interface (transceiver) the MSCAN interface is connected internally to the transceiver interface. In these cases the external availability of signals TXCAN and RXCAN is optional.
The MSCAN uses two external pins.
8.2.1
RXCAN -- CAN Receiver Input Pin
RXCAN is the MSCAN receiver input pin.
1. Depending on the actual bit timing and the clock jitter of the PLL. S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 251
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.2.2
TXCAN -- CAN Transmitter Output Pin
TXCAN is the MSCAN transmitter output pin. The TXCAN output pin represents the logic level on the CAN bus: 0 = Dominant state 1 = Recessive state
8.2.3
CAN System
A typical CAN system with MSCAN is shown in Figure 8-2. Each CAN station is connected physically to the CAN bus lines through a transceiver device. The transceiver is capable of driving the large current needed for the CAN bus and has current protection against defective CAN or defective stations.
CAN node 1 MCU CAN Controller (MSCAN)
CAN node 2
CAN node n
TXCAN Transceiver
RXCAN
CANH
CANL CAN Bus
Figure 8-2. CAN System
8.3
Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the MSCAN.
8.3.1
Module Memory Map
Figure 8-3 gives an overview on all registers and their individual bits in the MSCAN memory map. The register address results from the addition of base address and address offset. The base address is determined at the MCU level and can be found in the MCU memory map description. The address offset is defined at the module level. The MSCAN occupies 64 bytes in the memory space. The base address of the MSCAN module is determined at the MCU level when the MCU is defined. The register decode map is fixed and begins at the first address of the module address offset.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 252 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
The detailed register descriptions follow in the order they appear in the register map.
Register Name 0x0000 CANCTL0 0x0001 CANCTL1 0x0002 CANBTR0 0x0003 CANBTR1 0x0004 CANRFLG 0x0005 CANRIER 0x0006 CANTFLG 0x0007 CANTIER 0x0008 CANTARQ 0x0009 CANTAAK 0x000A CANTBSEL 0x000B CANIDAC 0x000C Reserved 0x000D CANMISC R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W = Unimplemented or Reserved 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BOHOLD 0 0 0 0 IDAM1 0 IDAM0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TX2 IDHIT2 TX1 IDHIT1 TX0 IDHIT0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 6 RXACT 5 4 SYNCH 3 2 1 Bit 0
RXFRM
CSWAI
TIME
WUPE
SLPRQ SLPAK
INITRQ INITAK
CANE
CLKSRC
LOOPB
LISTEN
BORM
WUPM
SJW1
SJW0
BRP5
BRP4
BRP3
BRP2
BRP1
BRP0
SAMP
TSEG22
TSEG21 RSTAT1
TSEG20 RSTAT0
TSEG13 TSTAT1
TSEG12 TSTAT0
TSEG11
TSEG10
WUPIF
CSCIF
OVRIF
RXF
WUPIE 0
CSCIE 0
RSTATE1 0
RSTATE0 0
TSTATE1 0
TSTATE0
OVRIE
RXFIE
TXE2
TXE1
TXE0
TXEIE2
TXEIE1
TXEIE0
ABTRQ2 ABTAK2
ABTRQ1 ABTAK1
ABTRQ0 ABTAK0
0
0
0
0
Figure 8-3. MSCAN Register Summary
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 253
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Register Name 0x000E CANRXERR 0x000F CANTXERR 0x0010-0x0013 CANIDAR0-3 0x0014-0x0017 CANIDMRx 0x0018-0x001B CANIDAR4-7 0x001C-0x001F CANIDMR4-7 0x0020-0x002F CANRXFG 0x0030-0x003F CANTXFG R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
Bit 7 RXERR7
6 RXERR6
5 RXERR5
4 RXERR4
3 RXERR3
2 RXERR2
1 RXERR1
Bit 0 RXERR0
TXERR7
TXERR6
TXERR5
TXERR4
TXERR3
TXERR2
TXERR1
TXERR0
AC7
AC6
AC5
AC4
AC3
AC2
AC1
AC0
AM7
AM6
AM5
AM4
AM3
AM2
AM1
AM0
AC7
AC6
AC5
AC4
AC3
AC2
AC1
AC0
AM7
AM6
AM5
AM4
AM3
AM2
AM1
AM0
See Section 8.3.3, "Programmer's Model of Message Storage"
See Section 8.3.3, "Programmer's Model of Message Storage" = Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 8-3. MSCAN Register Summary (continued)
8.3.2
Register Descriptions
This section describes in detail all the registers and register bits in the MSCAN module. Each description includes a standard register diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field function follow the register diagrams, in bit order. All bits of all registers in this module are completely synchronous to internal clocks during a register read.
8.3.2.1
MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)
The CANCTL0 register provides various control bits of the MSCAN module as described below.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 254 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Module Base + 0x0000
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R RXFRM W Reset: 0
RXACT CSWAI 0 = Unimplemented 0
SYNCH TIME 0 0 WUPE 0 SLPRQ 0 INITRQ 1
Figure 8-4. MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when out of initialization mode; exceptions are read-only RXACT and SYNCH, RXFRM (which is set by the module only), and INITRQ (which is also writable in initialization mode)
NOTE The CANCTL0 register, except WUPE, INITRQ, and SLPRQ, is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable again as soon as the initialization mode is exited (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
Table 8-3. CANCTL0 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 RXFRM(1) Description Received Frame Flag -- This bit is read and clear only. It is set when a receiver has received a valid message correctly, independently of the filter configuration. After it is set, it remains set until cleared by software or reset. Clearing is done by writing a 1. Writing a 0 is ignored. This bit is not valid in loopback mode. 0 No valid message was received since last clearing this flag 1 A valid message was received since last clearing of this flag Receiver Active Status -- This read-only flag indicates the MSCAN is receiving a message. The flag is controlled by the receiver front end. This bit is not valid in loopback mode. 0 MSCAN is transmitting or idle2 1 MSCAN is receiving a message (including when arbitration is lost)(2) CAN Stops in Wait Mode -- Enabling this bit allows for lower power consumption in wait mode by disabling all the clocks at the CPU bus interface to the MSCAN module. 0 The module is not affected during wait mode 1 The module ceases to be clocked during wait mode Synchronized Status -- This read-only flag indicates whether the MSCAN is synchronized to the CAN bus and able to participate in the communication process. It is set and cleared by the MSCAN. 0 MSCAN is not synchronized to the CAN bus 1 MSCAN is synchronized to the CAN bus Timer Enable -- This bit activates an internal 16-bit wide free running timer which is clocked by the bit clock rate. If the timer is enabled, a 16-bit time stamp will be assigned to each transmitted/received message within the active TX/RX buffer. Right after the EOF of a valid message on the CAN bus, the time stamp is written to the highest bytes (0x000E, 0x000F) in the appropriate buffer (see Section 8.3.3, "Programmer's Model of Message Storage"). The internal timer is reset (all bits set to 0) when disabled. This bit is held low in initialization mode. 0 Disable internal MSCAN timer 1 Enable internal MSCAN timer
6 RXACT
5 CSWAI(3)
4 SYNCH
3 TIME
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 255
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-3. CANCTL0 Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 2 WUPE(4) Description Wake-Up Enable -- This configuration bit allows the MSCAN to restart from sleep mode or from power down mode (entered from sleep) when traffic on CAN is detected (see Section 8.4.5.5, "MSCAN Sleep Mode"). This bit must be configured before sleep mode entry for the selected function to take effect. 0 Wake-up disabled -- The MSCAN ignores traffic on CAN 1 Wake-up enabled -- The MSCAN is able to restart Sleep Mode Request -- This bit requests the MSCAN to enter sleep mode, which is an internal power saving mode (see Section 8.4.5.5, "MSCAN Sleep Mode"). The sleep mode request is serviced when the CAN bus is idle, i.e., the module is not receiving a message and all transmit buffers are empty. The module indicates entry to sleep mode by setting SLPAK = 1 (see Section 8.3.2.2, "MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)"). SLPRQ cannot be set while the WUPIF flag is set (see Section 8.3.2.5, "MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)"). Sleep mode will be active until SLPRQ is cleared by the CPU or, depending on the setting of WUPE, the MSCAN detects activity on the CAN bus and clears SLPRQ itself. 0 Running -- The MSCAN functions normally 1 Sleep mode request -- The MSCAN enters sleep mode when CAN bus idle
1 SLPRQ(5)
0 Initialization Mode Request -- When this bit is set by the CPU, the MSCAN skips to initialization mode (see INITRQ(6),(7) Section 8.4.4.5, "MSCAN Initialization Mode"). Any ongoing transmission or reception is aborted and synchronization to the CAN bus is lost. The module indicates entry to initialization mode by setting INITAK = 1 (Section 8.3.2.2, "MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)"). The following registers enter their hard reset state and restore their default values: CANCTL0(8), CANRFLG(9), CANRIER(10), CANTFLG, CANTIER, CANTARQ, CANTAAK, and CANTBSEL. The registers CANCTL1, CANBTR0, CANBTR1, CANIDAC, CANIDAR0-7, and CANIDMR0-7 can only be written by the CPU when the MSCAN is in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). The values of the error counters are not affected by initialization mode. When this bit is cleared by the CPU, the MSCAN restarts and then tries to synchronize to the CAN bus. If the MSCAN is not in bus-off state, it synchronizes after 11 consecutive recessive bits on the CAN bus; if the MSCAN is in bus-off state, it continues to wait for 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits. Writing to other bits in CANCTL0, CANRFLG, CANRIER, CANTFLG, or CANTIER must be done only after initialization mode is exited, which is INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0. 0 Normal operation 1 MSCAN in initialization mode 1. The MSCAN must be in normal mode for this bit to become set. 2. See the Bosch CAN 2.0A/B specification for a detailed definition of transmitter and receiver states. 3. In order to protect from accidentally violating the CAN protocol, TXCAN is immediately forced to a recessive state when the CPU enters wait (CSWAI = 1) or stop mode (see Section 8.4.5.2, "Operation in Wait Mode" and Section 8.4.5.3, "Operation in Stop Mode"). 4. The CPU has to make sure that the WUPE register and the WUPIE wake-up interrupt enable register (see Section 8.3.2.6, "MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)) is enabled, if the recovery mechanism from stop or wait is required. 5. The CPU cannot clear SLPRQ before the MSCAN has entered sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1). 6. The CPU cannot clear INITRQ before the MSCAN has entered initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). 7. In order to protect from accidentally violating the CAN protocol, TXCAN is immediately forced to a recessive state when the initialization mode is requested by the CPU. Thus, the recommended procedure is to bring the MSCAN into sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) before requesting initialization mode. 8. Not including WUPE, INITRQ, and SLPRQ. 9. TSTAT1 and TSTAT0 are not affected by initialization mode. 10. RSTAT1 and RSTAT0 are not affected by initialization mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 256 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.3.2.2
MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)
The CANCTL1 register provides various control bits and handshake status information of the MSCAN module as described below.
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base + 0x0001
7
R CANE W Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 1 0 0 CLKSRC LOOPB LISTEN BORM WUPM
SLPAK
INITAK
0
1
Figure 8-5. MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1); CANE is write once
Table 8-4. CANCTL1 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 CANE 6 CLKSRC MSCAN Enable 0 MSCAN module is disabled 1 MSCAN module is enabled MSCAN Clock Source -- This bit defines the clock source for the MSCAN module (only for systems with a clock generation module; Section 8.4.3.2, "Clock System," and Section Figure 8-43., "MSCAN Clocking Scheme,"). 0 MSCAN clock source is the oscillator clock 1 MSCAN clock source is the bus clock Loopback Self Test Mode -- When this bit is set, the MSCAN performs an internal loopback which can be used for self test operation. The bit stream output of the transmitter is fed back to the receiver internally. The RXCAN input is ignored and the TXCAN output goes to the recessive state (logic 1). The MSCAN behaves as it does normally when transmitting and treats its own transmitted message as a message received from a remote node. In this state, the MSCAN ignores the bit sent during the ACK slot in the CAN frame acknowledge field to ensure proper reception of its own message. Both transmit and receive interrupts are generated. 0 Loopback self test disabled 1 Loopback self test enabled Listen Only Mode -- This bit configures the MSCAN as a CAN bus monitor. When LISTEN is set, all valid CAN messages with matching ID are received, but no acknowledgement or error frames are sent out (see Section 8.4.4.4, "Listen-Only Mode"). In addition, the error counters are frozen. Listen only mode supports applications which require "hot plugging" or throughput analysis. The MSCAN is unable to transmit any messages when listen only mode is active. 0 Normal operation 1 Listen only mode activated Bus-Off Recovery Mode -- This bits configures the bus-off state recovery mode of the MSCAN. Refer to Section 8.5.2, "Bus-Off Recovery," for details. 0 Automatic bus-off recovery (see Bosch CAN 2.0A/B protocol specification) 1 Bus-off recovery upon user request Description
5 LOOPB
4 LISTEN
3 BORM
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 257
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-4. CANCTL1 Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 2 WUPM Description Wake-Up Mode -- If WUPE in CANCTL0 is enabled, this bit defines whether the integrated low-pass filter is applied to protect the MSCAN from spurious wake-up (see Section 8.4.5.5, "MSCAN Sleep Mode"). 0 MSCAN wakes up on any dominant level on the CAN bus 1 MSCAN wakes up only in case of a dominant pulse on the CAN bus that has a length of Twup Sleep Mode Acknowledge -- This flag indicates whether the MSCAN module has entered sleep mode (see Section 8.4.5.5, "MSCAN Sleep Mode"). It is used as a handshake flag for the SLPRQ sleep mode request. Sleep mode is active when SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1. Depending on the setting of WUPE, the MSCAN will clear the flag if it detects activity on the CAN bus while in sleep mode. 0 Running -- The MSCAN operates normally 1 Sleep mode active -- The MSCAN has entered sleep mode Initialization Mode Acknowledge -- This flag indicates whether the MSCAN module is in initialization mode (see Section 8.4.4.5, "MSCAN Initialization Mode"). It is used as a handshake flag for the INITRQ initialization mode request. Initialization mode is active when INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1. The registers CANCTL1, CANBTR0, CANBTR1, CANIDAC, CANIDAR0-CANIDAR7, and CANIDMR0-CANIDMR7 can be written only by the CPU when the MSCAN is in initialization mode. 0 Running -- The MSCAN operates normally 1 Initialization mode active -- The MSCAN has entered initialization mode
1 SLPAK
0 INITAK
8.3.2.3
MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0)
The CANBTR0 register configures various CAN bus timing parameters of the MSCAN module.
Module Base + 0x0002
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R SJW1 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SJW0 BRP5 BRP4 BRP3 BRP2 BRP1 BRP0
Figure 8-6. MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 8-5. CANBTR0 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-6 SJW[1:0] 5-0 BRP[5:0] Description Synchronization Jump Width -- The synchronization jump width defines the maximum number of time quanta (Tq) clock cycles a bit can be shortened or lengthened to achieve resynchronization to data transitions on the CAN bus (see Table 8-6). Baud Rate Prescaler -- These bits determine the time quanta (Tq) clock which is used to build up the bit timing (see Table 8-7).
Table 8-6. Synchronization Jump Width
SJW1 0 SJW0 0 Synchronization Jump Width 1 Tq clock cycle
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 258 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-6. Synchronization Jump Width (continued)
SJW1 0 1 1 SJW0 1 0 1 Synchronization Jump Width 2 Tq clock cycles 3 Tq clock cycles 4 Tq clock cycles
Table 8-7. Baud Rate Prescaler
BRP5 0 0 0 0 : 1 BRP4 0 0 0 0 : 1 BRP3 0 0 0 0 : 1 BRP2 0 0 0 0 : 1 BRP1 0 0 1 1 : 1 BRP0 0 1 0 1 : 1 Prescaler value (P) 1 2 3 4 : 64
8.3.2.4
MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1)
The CANBTR1 register configures various CAN bus timing parameters of the MSCAN module.
Module Base + 0x0003
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R SAMP W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TSEG22 TSEG21 TSEG20 TSEG13 TSEG12 TSEG11 TSEG10
Figure 8-7. MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 8-8. CANBTR1 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 SAMP Description Sampling -- This bit determines the number of CAN bus samples taken per bit time. 0 One sample per bit. 1 Three samples per bit(1). If SAMP = 0, the resulting bit value is equal to the value of the single bit positioned at the sample point. If SAMP = 1, the resulting bit value is determined by using majority rule on the three total samples. For higher bit rates, it is recommended that only one sample is taken per bit time (SAMP = 0).
6-4 Time Segment 2 -- Time segments within the bit time fix the number of clock cycles per bit time and the location TSEG2[2:0] of the sample point (see Figure 8-44). Time segment 2 (TSEG2) values are programmable as shown in Table 89. 3-0 Time Segment 1 -- Time segments within the bit time fix the number of clock cycles per bit time and the location TSEG1[3:0] of the sample point (see Figure 8-44). Time segment 1 (TSEG1) values are programmable as shown in Table 810.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 259
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
1. In this case, PHASE_SEG1 must be at least 2 time quanta (Tq).
Table 8-9. Time Segment 2 Values
TSEG22 0 0 : 1 TSEG21 0 0 : 1 TSEG20 0 1 : 0 Time Segment 2 1 Tq clock cycle(1) 2 Tq clock cycles : 7 Tq clock cycles
1 1 1 8 Tq clock cycles 1. This setting is not valid. Please refer to Table 8-37 for valid settings.
Table 8-10. Time Segment 1 Values
TSEG13 0 0 0 0 : 1 TSEG12 0 0 0 0 : 1 TSEG11 0 0 1 1 : 1 TSEG10 0 1 0 1 : 0 Time segment 1 1 Tq clock cycle(1) 2 Tq clock cycles1 3 Tq clock cycles1 4 Tq clock cycles : 15 Tq clock cycles
1 1 1 1 16 Tq clock cycles 1. This setting is not valid. Please refer to Table 8-37 for valid settings.
The bit time is determined by the oscillator frequency, the baud rate prescaler, and the number of time quanta (Tq) clock cycles per bit (as shown in Table 8-9 and Table 8-10).
Eqn. 8-1
( Prescaler value ) Bit Time = ----------------------------------------------------- * ( 1 + TimeSegment1 + TimeSegment2 ) f CANCLK
8.3.2.5
MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)
A flag can be cleared only by software (writing a 1 to the corresponding bit position) when the condition which caused the setting is no longer valid. Every flag has an associated interrupt enable bit in the CANRIER register.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 260 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Module Base + 0x0004
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R WUPIF W Reset: 0 0 CSCIF
RSTAT1
RSTAT0
TSTAT1
TSTAT0 OVRIF RXF 0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-8. MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode, except RSTAT[1:0] and TSTAT[1:0] flags which are read-only; write of 1 clears flag; write of 0 is ignored
NOTE The CANRFLG register is held in the reset state1 when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable again as soon as the initialization mode is exited (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
Table 8-11. CANRFLG Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 WUPIF Description Wake-Up Interrupt Flag -- If the MSCAN detects CAN bus activity while in sleep mode (see Section 8.4.5.5, "MSCAN Sleep Mode,") and WUPE = 1 in CANTCTL0 (see Section 8.3.2.1, "MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)"), the module will set WUPIF. If not masked, a wake-up interrupt is pending while this flag is set. 0 No wake-up activity observed while in sleep mode 1 MSCAN detected activity on the CAN bus and requested wake-up CAN Status Change Interrupt Flag -- This flag is set when the MSCAN changes its current CAN bus status due to the actual value of the transmit error counter (TEC) and the receive error counter (REC). An additional 4bit (RSTAT[1:0], TSTAT[1:0]) status register, which is split into separate sections for TEC/REC, informs the system on the actual CAN bus status (see Section 8.3.2.6, "MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)"). If not masked, an error interrupt is pending while this flag is set. CSCIF provides a blocking interrupt. That guarantees that the receiver/transmitter status bits (RSTAT/TSTAT) are only updated when no CAN status change interrupt is pending. If the TECs/RECs change their current value after the CSCIF is asserted, which would cause an additional state change in the RSTAT/TSTAT bits, these bits keep their status until the current CSCIF interrupt is cleared again. 0 No change in CAN bus status occurred since last interrupt 1 MSCAN changed current CAN bus status Receiver Status Bits -- The values of the error counters control the actual CAN bus status of the MSCAN. As soon as the status change interrupt flag (CSCIF) is set, these bits indicate the appropriate receiver related CAN bus status of the MSCAN. The coding for the bits RSTAT1, RSTAT0 is: 00 RxOK: 0 receive error counter 96 01 RxWRN: 96 < receive error counter 127 10 RxERR: 127 < receive error counter 11 Bus-off(1): transmit error counter > 255
6 CSCIF
5-4 RSTAT[1:0]
1. The RSTAT[1:0], TSTAT[1:0] bits are not affected by initialization mode. S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 261
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-11. CANRFLG Register Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 3-2 TSTAT[1:0] Description Transmitter Status Bits -- The values of the error counters control the actual CAN bus status of the MSCAN. As soon as the status change interrupt flag (CSCIF) is set, these bits indicate the appropriate transmitter related CAN bus status of the MSCAN. The coding for the bits TSTAT1, TSTAT0 is: 00 TxOK: 0 transmit error counter 96 01 TxWRN: 96 < transmit error counter 127 10 TxERR: 127 < transmit error counter 255 11 Bus-Off: transmit error counter > 255 Overrun Interrupt Flag -- This flag is set when a data overrun condition occurs. If not masked, an error interrupt is pending while this flag is set. 0 No data overrun condition 1 A data overrun detected
1 OVRIF
Receive Buffer Full Flag -- RXF is set by the MSCAN when a new message is shifted in the receiver FIFO. This flag indicates whether the shifted buffer is loaded with a correctly received message (matching identifier, matching cyclic redundancy code (CRC) and no other errors detected). After the CPU has read that message from the RxFG buffer in the receiver FIFO, the RXF flag must be cleared to release the buffer. A set RXF flag prohibits the shifting of the next FIFO entry into the foreground buffer (RxFG). If not masked, a receive interrupt is pending while this flag is set. 0 No new message available within the RxFG 1 The receiver FIFO is not empty. A new message is available in the RxFG 1. Redundant Information for the most critical CAN bus status which is "bus-off". This only occurs if the Tx error counter exceeds a number of 255 errors. Bus-off affects the receiver state. As soon as the transmitter leaves its bus-off state the receiver state skips to RxOK too. Refer also to TSTAT[1:0] coding in this register. 2. To ensure data integrity, do not read the receive buffer registers while the RXF flag is cleared. For MCUs with dual CPUs, reading the receive buffer registers while the RXF flag is cleared may result in a CPU fault condition.
0 RXF(2)
8.3.2.6
MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)
Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
This register contains the interrupt enable bits for the interrupt flags described in the CANRFLG register.
Module Base + 0x0005
7
R WUPIE W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CSCIE RSTATE1 RSTATE0 TSTATE1 TSTATE0 OVRIE RXFIE
Figure 8-9. MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
NOTE The CANRIER register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ=1 and INITAK=1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ=0 and INITAK=0). The RSTATE[1:0], TSTATE[1:0] bits are not affected by initialization mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 262 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-12. CANRIER Register Field Descriptions
Field 7 WUPIE(1) 6 CSCIE Description Wake-Up Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 A wake-up event causes a Wake-Up interrupt request. CAN Status Change Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 A CAN Status Change event causes an error interrupt request.
5-4 Receiver Status Change Enable -- These RSTAT enable bits control the sensitivity level in which receiver state RSTATE[1:0] changes are causing CSCIF interrupts. Independent of the chosen sensitivity level the RSTAT flags continue to indicate the actual receiver state and are only updated if no CSCIF interrupt is pending. 00 Do not generate any CSCIF interrupt caused by receiver state changes. 01 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the receiver enters or leaves "bus-off" state. Discard other receiver state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt. 10 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the receiver enters or leaves "RxErr" or "bus-off"(2) state. Discard other receiver state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt. 11 Generate CSCIF interrupt on all state changes. 3-2 Transmitter Status Change Enable -- These TSTAT enable bits control the sensitivity level in which transmitter TSTATE[1:0] state changes are causing CSCIF interrupts. Independent of the chosen sensitivity level, the TSTAT flags continue to indicate the actual transmitter state and are only updated if no CSCIF interrupt is pending. 00 Do not generate any CSCIF interrupt caused by transmitter state changes. 01 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the transmitter enters or leaves "bus-off" state. Discard other transmitter state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt. 10 Generate CSCIF interrupt only if the transmitter enters or leaves "TxErr" or "bus-off" state. Discard other transmitter state changes for generating CSCIF interrupt. 11 Generate CSCIF interrupt on all state changes. 1 OVRIE 0 RXFIE Overrun Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 An overrun event causes an error interrupt request.
Receiver Full Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 A receive buffer full (successful message reception) event causes a receiver interrupt request. 1. WUPIE and WUPE (see Section 8.3.2.1, "MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)") must both be enabled if the recovery mechanism from stop or wait is required. 2. Bus-off state is defined by the CAN standard (see Bosch CAN 2.0A/B protocol specification: for only transmitters. Because the only possible state change for the transmitter from bus-off to TxOK also forces the receiver to skip its current state to RxOK, the coding of the RXSTAT[1:0] flags define an additional bus-off state for the receiver (see Section 8.3.2.5, "MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)").
8.3.2.7
MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)
The transmit buffer empty flags each have an associated interrupt enable bit in the CANTIER register.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 263
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Module Base + 0x0006
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 TXE2 TXE1 1 TXE0 1
0
0
0
0
0
1
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-10. MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode; write of 1 clears flag, write of 0 is ignored
NOTE The CANTFLG register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
Table 8-13. CANTFLG Register Field Descriptions
Field 2-0 TXE[2:0] Description Transmitter Buffer Empty -- This flag indicates that the associated transmit message buffer is empty, and thus not scheduled for transmission. The CPU must clear the flag after a message is set up in the transmit buffer and is due for transmission. The MSCAN sets the flag after the message is sent successfully. The flag is also set by the MSCAN when the transmission request is successfully aborted due to a pending abort request (see Section 8.3.2.9, "MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)"). If not masked, a transmit interrupt is pending while this flag is set. Clearing a TXEx flag also clears the corresponding ABTAKx (see Section 8.3.2.10, "MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)"). When a TXEx flag is set, the corresponding ABTRQx bit is cleared (see Section 8.3.2.9, "MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)"). When listen-mode is active (see Section 8.3.2.2, "MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)") the TXEx flags cannot be cleared and no transmission is started. Read and write accesses to the transmit buffer will be blocked, if the corresponding TXEx bit is cleared (TXEx = 0) and the buffer is scheduled for transmission. 0 The associated message buffer is full (loaded with a message due for transmission) 1 The associated message buffer is empty (not scheduled)
8.3.2.8
MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)
This register contains the interrupt enable bits for the transmit buffer empty interrupt flags.
Module Base + 0x0007
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 TXEIE2 TXEIE1 0 TXEIE0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-11. MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 264 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
NOTE The CANTIER register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
Table 8-14. CANTIER Register Field Descriptions
Field 2-0 TXEIE[2:0] Description Transmitter Empty Interrupt Enable 0 No interrupt request is generated from this event. 1 A transmitter empty (transmit buffer available for transmission) event causes a transmitter empty interrupt request.
8.3.2.9
MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)
The CANTARQ register allows abort request of queued messages as described below.
Module Base + 0x0008
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 ABTRQ2 ABTRQ1 0 ABTRQ0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-12. MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
NOTE The CANTARQ register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
Table 8-15. CANTARQ Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2-0 Abort Request -- The CPU sets the ABTRQx bit to request that a scheduled message buffer (TXEx = 0) be ABTRQ[2:0] aborted. The MSCAN grants the request if the message has not already started transmission, or if the transmission is not successful (lost arbitration or error). When a message is aborted, the associated TXE (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)") and abort acknowledge flags (ABTAK, see Section 8.3.2.10, "MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)") are set and a transmit interrupt occurs if enabled. The CPU cannot reset ABTRQx. ABTRQx is reset whenever the associated TXE flag is set. 0 No abort request 1 Abort request pending
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 265
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.3.2.10
MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)
The CANTAAK register indicates the successful abort of a queued message, if requested by the appropriate bits in the CANTARQ register.
Module Base + 0x0009
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
ABTAK2
ABTAK1
ABTAK0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-13. MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Acknowledge Register (CANTAAK)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Unimplemented
NOTE The CANTAAK register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1).
Table 8-16. CANTAAK Register Field Descriptions
Field Description
2-0 Abort Acknowledge -- This flag acknowledges that a message was aborted due to a pending abort request ABTAK[2:0] from the CPU. After a particular message buffer is flagged empty, this flag can be used by the application software to identify whether the message was aborted successfully or was sent anyway. The ABTAKx flag is cleared whenever the corresponding TXE flag is cleared. 0 The message was not aborted. 1 The message was aborted.
8.3.2.11
MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)
The CANTBSEL register allows the selection of the actual transmit message buffer, which then will be accessible in the CANTXFG register space.
Module Base + 0x000A
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0 TX2 TX1 0 TX0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-14. MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)
1. Read: Find the lowest ordered bit set to 1, all other bits will be read as 0 Write: Anytime when not in initialization mode
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 266 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
NOTE The CANTBSEL register is held in the reset state when the initialization mode is active (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK=1). This register is writable when not in initialization mode (INITRQ = 0 and INITAK = 0).
Table 8-17. CANTBSEL Register Field Descriptions
Field 2-0 TX[2:0] Description Transmit Buffer Select -- The lowest numbered bit places the respective transmit buffer in the CANTXFG register space (e.g., TX1 = 1 and TX0 = 1 selects transmit buffer TX0; TX1 = 1 and TX0 = 0 selects transmit buffer TX1). Read and write accesses to the selected transmit buffer will be blocked, if the corresponding TXEx bit is cleared and the buffer is scheduled for transmission (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)"). 0 The associated message buffer is deselected 1 The associated message buffer is selected, if lowest numbered bit
The following gives a short programming example of the usage of the CANTBSEL register: To get the next available transmit buffer, application software must read the CANTFLG register and write this value back into the CANTBSEL register. In this example Tx buffers TX1 and TX2 are available. The value read from CANTFLG is therefore 0b0000_0110. When writing this value back to CANTBSEL, the Tx buffer TX1 is selected in the CANTXFG because the lowest numbered bit set to 1 is at bit position 1. Reading back this value out of CANTBSEL results in 0b0000_0010, because only the lowest numbered bit position set to 1 is presented. This mechanism eases the application software the selection of the next available Tx buffer. * LDAA CANTFLG; value read is 0b0000_0110 * STAA CANTBSEL; value written is 0b0000_0110 * LDAA CANTBSEL; value read is 0b0000_0010 If all transmit message buffers are deselected, no accesses are allowed to the CANTXFG registers.
8.3.2.12
MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)
The CANIDAC register is used for identifier acceptance control as described below.
Module Base + 0x000B
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
0
0 IDAM1 IDAM0 0
0
IDHIT2
IDHIT1
IDHIT0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-15. MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1), except bits IDHITx, which are read-only
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 267
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-18. CANIDAC Register Field Descriptions
Field 5-4 IDAM[1:0] 2-0 IDHIT[2:0] Description Identifier Acceptance Mode -- The CPU sets these flags to define the identifier acceptance filter organization (see Section 8.4.3, "Identifier Acceptance Filter"). Table 8-19 summarizes the different settings. In filter closed mode, no message is accepted such that the foreground buffer is never reloaded. Identifier Acceptance Hit Indicator -- The MSCAN sets these flags to indicate an identifier acceptance hit (see Section 8.4.3, "Identifier Acceptance Filter"). Table 8-20 summarizes the different settings.
Table 8-19. Identifier Acceptance Mode Settings
IDAM1 0 0 1 1 IDAM0 0 1 0 1 Identifier Acceptance Mode Two 32-bit acceptance filters Four 16-bit acceptance filters Eight 8-bit acceptance filters Filter closed
Table 8-20. Identifier Acceptance Hit Indication
IDHIT2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 IDHIT1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 IDHIT0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Identifier Acceptance Hit Filter 0 hit Filter 1 hit Filter 2 hit Filter 3 hit Filter 4 hit Filter 5 hit Filter 6 hit Filter 7 hit
The IDHITx indicators are always related to the message in the foreground buffer (RxFG). When a message gets shifted into the foreground buffer of the receiver FIFO the indicators are updated as well.
8.3.2.13
MSCAN Reserved Register
This register is reserved for factory testing of the MSCAN module and is not available in normal system operating modes.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 268 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Module Base + 0x000C to Module Base + 0x000D
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-16. MSCAN Reserved Register
1. Read: Always reads zero in normal system operation modes Write: Unimplemented in normal system operation modes
NOTE Writing to this register when in special systm operating modes can alter the MSCAN functionality.
8.3.2.14
MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC)
This register provides additional features.
Module Base + 0x000D
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0 BOHOLD
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-17. MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime; write of `1' clears flag; write of `0' ignored
Table 8-21. CANMISC Register Field Descriptions
Field 0 BOHOLD Description Bus-off State Hold Until User Request -- If BORM is set in MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1), this bit indicates whether the module has entered the bus-off state. Clearing this bit requests the recovery from bus-off. Refer to Section 8.5.2, "Bus-Off Recovery," for details. 0 Module is not bus-off or recovery has been requested by user in bus-off state 1 Module is bus-off and holds this state until user request
8.3.2.15
MSCAN Receive Error Counter (CANRXERR)
This register reflects the status of the MSCAN receive error counter.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 269
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Module Base + 0x000E
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
RXERR7
RXERR6
RXERR5
RXERR4
RXERR3
RXERR2
RXERR1
RXERR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-18. MSCAN Receive Error Counter (CANRXERR)
1. Read: Only when in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) or initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1) Write: Unimplemented
NOTE Reading this register when in any other mode other than sleep or initialization mode may return an incorrect value. For MCUs with dual CPUs, this may result in a CPU fault condition. Writing to this register when in special modes can alter the MSCAN functionality.
8.3.2.16
MSCAN Transmit Error Counter (CANTXERR)
This register reflects the status of the MSCAN transmit error counter.
Module Base + 0x000F
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
TXERR7
TXERR6
TXERR5
TXERR4
TXERR3
TXERR2
TXERR1
TXERR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-19. MSCAN Transmit Error Counter (CANTXERR)
1. Read: Only when in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) or initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1) Write: Unimplemented
NOTE Reading this register when in any other mode other than sleep or initialization mode, may return an incorrect value. For MCUs with dual CPUs, this may result in a CPU fault condition. Writing to this register when in special modes can alter the MSCAN functionality.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 270 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.3.2.17
MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (CANIDAR0-7)
On reception, each message is written into the background receive buffer. The CPU is only signalled to read the message if it passes the criteria in the identifier acceptance and identifier mask registers (accepted); otherwise, the message is overwritten by the next message (dropped). The acceptance registers of the MSCAN are applied on the IDR0-IDR3 registers (see Section 8.3.3.1, "Identifier Registers (IDR0-IDR3)") of incoming messages in a bit by bit manner (see Section 8.4.3, "Identifier Acceptance Filter"). For extended identifiers, all four acceptance and mask registers are applied. For standard identifiers, only the first two (CANIDAR0/1, CANIDMR0/1) are applied.
Module Base + 0x0010 to Module Base + 0x0013
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R AC7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AC6 AC5 AC4 AC3 AC2 AC1 AC0
Figure 8-20. MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (First Bank) -- CANIDAR0-CANIDAR3
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 8-22. CANIDAR0-CANIDAR3 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 AC[7:0] Description Acceptance Code Bits -- AC[7:0] comprise a user-defined sequence of bits with which the corresponding bits of the related identifier register (IDRn) of the receive message buffer are compared. The result of this comparison is then masked with the corresponding identifier mask register. Access: User read/write(1)
5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base + 0x0018 to Module Base + 0x001B
7 6
R AC7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AC6 AC5 AC4 AC3 AC2 AC1 AC0
Figure 8-21. MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Registers (Second Bank) -- CANIDAR4-CANIDAR7
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 271
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-23. CANIDAR4-CANIDAR7 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 AC[7:0] Description Acceptance Code Bits -- AC[7:0] comprise a user-defined sequence of bits with which the corresponding bits of the related identifier register (IDRn) of the receive message buffer are compared. The result of this comparison is then masked with the corresponding identifier mask register.
8.3.2.18
MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (CANIDMR0-CANIDMR7)
The identifier mask register specifies which of the corresponding bits in the identifier acceptance register are relevant for acceptance filtering. To receive standard identifiers in 32 bit filter mode, it is required to program the last three bits (AM[2:0]) in the mask registers CANIDMR1 and CANIDMR5 to "don't care." To receive standard identifiers in 16 bit filter mode, it is required to program the last three bits (AM[2:0]) in the mask registers CANIDMR1, CANIDMR3, CANIDMR5, and CANIDMR7 to "don't care."
Module Base + 0x0014 to Module Base + 0x0017
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R AM7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AM6 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0
Figure 8-22. MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (First Bank) -- CANIDMR0-CANIDMR3
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 8-24. CANIDMR0-CANIDMR3 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 AM[7:0] Description Acceptance Mask Bits -- If a particular bit in this register is cleared, this indicates that the corresponding bit in the identifier acceptance register must be the same as its identifier bit before a match is detected. The message is accepted if all such bits match. If a bit is set, it indicates that the state of the corresponding bit in the identifier acceptance register does not affect whether or not the message is accepted. 0 Match corresponding acceptance code register and identifier bits 1 Ignore corresponding acceptance code register bit Access: User read/write(1)
5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base + 0x001C to Module Base + 0x001F
7 6
R AM7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AM6 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0
Figure 8-23. MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (Second Bank) -- CANIDMR4-CANIDMR7
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 272 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
1. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime in initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1)
Table 8-25. CANIDMR4-CANIDMR7 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 AM[7:0] Description Acceptance Mask Bits -- If a particular bit in this register is cleared, this indicates that the corresponding bit in the identifier acceptance register must be the same as its identifier bit before a match is detected. The message is accepted if all such bits match. If a bit is set, it indicates that the state of the corresponding bit in the identifier acceptance register does not affect whether or not the message is accepted. 0 Match corresponding acceptance code register and identifier bits 1 Ignore corresponding acceptance code register bit
8.3.3
Programmer's Model of Message Storage
The following section details the organization of the receive and transmit message buffers and the associated control registers. To simplify the programmer interface, the receive and transmit message buffers have the same outline. Each message buffer allocates 16 bytes in the memory map containing a 13 byte data structure. An additional transmit buffer priority register (TBPR) is defined for the transmit buffers. Within the last two bytes of this memory map, the MSCAN stores a special 16-bit time stamp, which is sampled from an internal timer after successful transmission or reception of a message. This feature is only available for transmit and receiver buffers, if the TIME bit is set (see Section 8.3.2.1, "MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)"). The time stamp register is written by the MSCAN. The CPU can only read these registers.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 273
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-26. Message Buffer Organization
Offset Address 0x00X0 0x00X1 0x00X2 0x00X3 0x00X4 0x00X5 0x00X6 0x00X7 0x00X8 0x00X9 0x00XA 0x00XB 0x00XC 0x00XD 0x00XE Identifier Register 0 Identifier Register 1 Identifier Register 2 Identifier Register 3 Data Segment Register 0 Data Segment Register 1 Data Segment Register 2 Data Segment Register 3 Data Segment Register 4 Data Segment Register 5 Data Segment Register 6 Data Segment Register 7 Data Length Register Transmit Buffer Priority Register
(1)
Register
Access R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R R
Time Stamp Register (High Byte)
0x00XF Time Stamp Register (Low Byte) 1. Not applicable for receive buffers
Figure 8-24 shows the common 13-byte data structure of receive and transmit buffers for extended identifiers. The mapping of standard identifiers into the IDR registers is shown in Figure 8-25. All bits of the receive and transmit buffers are `x' out of reset because of RAM-based implementation1. All reserved or unused bits of the receive and transmit buffers always read `x'.
Figure 8-24. Receive/Transmit Message Buffer -- Extended Identifier Mapping
Register Name 0x00X0 IDR0 R ID28 W R ID20 W R ID14 W R ID6 W ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 RTR ID13 ID12 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 ID7 ID19 ID18 SRR (=1) IDE (=1) ID17 ID16 ID15 ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 ID23 ID22 ID21 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit0
0x00X1 IDR1
0x00X2 IDR2
0x00X3 IDR3
1. Exception: The transmit buffer priority registers are 0 out of reset. S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 274 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Figure 8-24. Receive/Transmit Message Buffer -- Extended Identifier Mapping (continued)
Register Name 0x00X4 DSR0 R DB7 W R DB7 W R DB7 W R DB7 W R DB7 W R DB7 W R DB7 W R DB7 W R DLC3 W DLC2 DLC1 DLC0 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit0
0x00X5 DSR1
0x00X6 DSR2
0x00X7 DSR3
0x00X8 DSR4
0x00X9 DSR5
0x00XA DSR6
0x00XB DSR7
0x00XC DLR
= Unused, always read `x'
Read: * For transmit buffers, anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)") and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 8.3.2.11, "MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)"). * For receive buffers, only when RXF flag is set (see Section 8.3.2.5, "MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)"). Write:
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 275
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
*
*
For transmit buffers, anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)") and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 8.3.2.11, "MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)"). Unimplemented for receive buffers.
Figure 8-25. Receive/Transmit Message Buffer -- Standard Identifier Mapping
Reset: Undefined because of RAM-based implementation
Register Name IDR0 0x00X0 R
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
ID10 W R ID2 W R W R W
ID9
ID8
ID7
ID6
ID5
ID4
ID3
IDR1 0x00X1
ID1
ID0
RTR
IDE (=0)
IDR2 0x00X2
IDR3 0x00X3
= Unused, always read `x'
8.3.3.1
Identifier Registers (IDR0-IDR3)
The identifier registers for an extended format identifier consist of a total of 32 bits; ID[28:0], SRR, IDE, and RTR bits. The identifier registers for a standard format identifier consist of a total of 13 bits; ID[10:0], RTR, and IDE bits.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 276 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.3.3.1.1
IDR0-IDR3 for Extended Identifier Mapping
Module Base + 0x00X0
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ID28 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID27 ID26 ID25 ID24 ID23 ID22 ID21
Figure 8-26. Identifier Register 0 (IDR0) -- Extended Identifier Mapping Table 8-27. IDR0 Register Field Descriptions -- Extended
Field 7-0 ID[28:21] Description Extended Format Identifier -- The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
Module Base + 0x00X1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ID20 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID19 ID18 SRR (=1) IDE (=1) ID17 ID16 ID15
Figure 8-27. Identifier Register 1 (IDR1) -- Extended Identifier Mapping Table 8-28. IDR1 Register Field Descriptions -- Extended
Field 7-5 ID[20:18] 4 SRR 3 IDE Description Extended Format Identifier -- The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. Substitute Remote Request -- This fixed recessive bit is used only in extended format. It must be set to 1 by the user for transmission buffers and is stored as received on the CAN bus for receive buffers. ID Extended -- This flag indicates whether the extended or standard identifier format is applied in this buffer. In the case of a receive buffer, the flag is set as received and indicates to the CPU how to process the buffer identifier registers. In the case of a transmit buffer, the flag indicates to the MSCAN what type of identifier to send. 0 Standard format (11 bit) 1 Extended format (29 bit) Extended Format Identifier -- The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
2-0 ID[17:15]
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 277
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Module Base + 0x00X2
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ID14 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID13 ID12 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 ID7
Figure 8-28. Identifier Register 2 (IDR2) -- Extended Identifier Mapping Table 8-29. IDR2 Register Field Descriptions -- Extended
Field 7-0 ID[14:7] Description Extended Format Identifier -- The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number.
Module Base + 0x00X3
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ID6 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 RTR
Figure 8-29. Identifier Register 3 (IDR3) -- Extended Identifier Mapping Table 8-30. IDR3 Register Field Descriptions -- Extended
Field 7-1 ID[6:0] 0 RTR Description Extended Format Identifier -- The identifiers consist of 29 bits (ID[28:0]) for the extended format. ID28 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. Remote Transmission Request -- This flag reflects the status of the remote transmission request bit in the CAN frame. In the case of a receive buffer, it indicates the status of the received frame and supports the transmission of an answering frame in software. In the case of a transmit buffer, this flag defines the setting of the RTR bit to be sent. 0 Data frame 1 Remote frame
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 278 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.3.3.1.2
IDR0-IDR3 for Standard Identifier Mapping
Module Base + 0x00X0
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ID10 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID9 ID8 ID7 ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3
Figure 8-30. Identifier Register 0 -- Standard Mapping
Table 8-31. IDR0 Register Field Descriptions -- Standard
Field 7-0 ID[10:3] Description Standard Format Identifier -- The identifiers consist of 11 bits (ID[10:0]) for the standard format. ID10 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. See also ID bits in Table 8-32.
Module Base + 0x00X1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ID2 W Reset: x x x x x x x x ID1 ID0 RTR IDE (=0)
= Unused; always read `x'
Figure 8-31. Identifier Register 1 -- Standard Mapping Table 8-32. IDR1 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-5 ID[2:0] 4 RTR Description Standard Format Identifier -- The identifiers consist of 11 bits (ID[10:0]) for the standard format. ID10 is the most significant bit and is transmitted first on the CAN bus during the arbitration procedure. The priority of an identifier is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. See also ID bits in Table 8-31. Remote Transmission Request -- This flag reflects the status of the Remote Transmission Request bit in the CAN frame. In the case of a receive buffer, it indicates the status of the received frame and supports the transmission of an answering frame in software. In the case of a transmit buffer, this flag defines the setting of the RTR bit to be sent. 0 Data frame 1 Remote frame ID Extended -- This flag indicates whether the extended or standard identifier format is applied in this buffer. In the case of a receive buffer, the flag is set as received and indicates to the CPU how to process the buffer identifier registers. In the case of a transmit buffer, the flag indicates to the MSCAN what type of identifier to send. 0 Standard format (11 bit) 1 Extended format (29 bit)
3 IDE
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 279
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Module Base + 0x00X2
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset: x x x x x x x x
= Unused; always read `x'
Figure 8-32. Identifier Register 2 -- Standard Mapping
Module Base + 0x00X3
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset: x x x x x x x x
= Unused; always read `x'
Figure 8-33. Identifier Register 3 -- Standard Mapping
8.3.3.2
Data Segment Registers (DSR0-7)
The eight data segment registers, each with bits DB[7:0], contain the data to be transmitted or received. The number of bytes to be transmitted or received is determined by the data length code in the corresponding DLR register.
Module Base + 0x00X4 to Module Base + 0x00XB
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R DB7 W Reset: x x x x x x x x DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0
Figure 8-34. Data Segment Registers (DSR0-DSR7) -- Extended Identifier Mapping
Table 8-33. DSR0-DSR7 Register Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 DB[7:0] Data bits 7-0 Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 280 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.3.3.3
Data Length Register (DLR)
This register keeps the data length field of the CAN frame.
Module Base + 0x00XC
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R DLC3 W Reset: x x x x x x x x DLC2 DLC1 DLC0
= Unused; always read "x"
Figure 8-35. Data Length Register (DLR) -- Extended Identifier Mapping Table 8-34. DLR Register Field Descriptions
Field 3-0 DLC[3:0] Description Data Length Code Bits -- The data length code contains the number of bytes (data byte count) of the respective message. During the transmission of a remote frame, the data length code is transmitted as programmed while the number of transmitted data bytes is always 0. The data byte count ranges from 0 to 8 for a data frame. Table 8-35 shows the effect of setting the DLC bits.
Table 8-35. Data Length Codes
Data Length Code DLC3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 DLC2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 DLC1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 DLC0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 Data Byte Count 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
8.3.3.4
Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR)
This register defines the local priority of the associated message buffer. The local priority is used for the internal prioritization process of the MSCAN and is defined to be highest for the smallest binary number. The MSCAN implements the following internal prioritization mechanisms: * All transmission buffers with a cleared TXEx flag participate in the prioritization immediately before the SOF (start of frame) is sent. * The transmission buffer with the lowest local priority field wins the prioritization.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 281
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
In cases of more than one buffer having the same lowest priority, the message buffer with the lower index number wins.
Module Base + 0x00XD
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R PRIO7 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PRIO6 PRIO5 PRIO4 PRIO3 PRIO2 PRIO1 PRIO0
Figure 8-36. Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR)
1. Read: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)") and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 8.3.2.11, "MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)") Write: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)") and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 8.3.2.11, "MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)")
8.3.3.5
Time Stamp Register (TSRH-TSRL)
If the TIME bit is enabled, the MSCAN will write a time stamp to the respective registers in the active transmit or receive buffer right after the EOF of a valid message on the CAN bus (see Section 8.3.2.1, "MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)"). In case of a transmission, the CPU can only read the time stamp after the respective transmit buffer has been flagged empty. The timer value, which is used for stamping, is taken from a free running internal CAN bit clock. A timer overrun is not indicated by the MSCAN. The timer is reset (all bits set to 0) during initialization mode. The CPU can only read the time stamp registers.
Module Base + 0x00XE
7 6 5 4 3 2
Access: User read/write(1)
1 0
R W Reset:
TSR15
TSR14
TSR13
TSR12
TSR11
TSR10
TSR9
TSR8
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Figure 8-37. Time Stamp Register -- High Byte (TSRH)
1. Read: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)") and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 8.3.2.11, "MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)") Write: Unimplemented Access: User read/write(1)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base + 0x00XF
7
R W Reset:
TSR7
TSR6
TSR5
TSR4
TSR3
TSR2
TSR1
TSR0
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Figure 8-38. Time Stamp Register -- Low Byte (TSRL)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 282 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
1. Read: Anytime when TXEx flag is set (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)") and the corresponding transmit buffer is selected in CANTBSEL (see Section 8.3.2.11, "MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)") Write: Unimplemented
8.4
8.4.1
Functional Description
General
This section provides a complete functional description of the MSCAN.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 283
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.4.2
Message Storage
CAN Receive / Transmit Engine Memory Mapped I/O
Rx0
Rx1 Rx2 Rx3 Rx4
RXF
RxBG
MSCAN
Receiver
Tx0
RxFG
CPU bus
TXE0
TxBG
Tx1
PRIO
TXE1
TxFG
MSCAN
CPU bus
PRIO
Tx2
TXE2
Transmitter
TxBG
PRIO
Figure 8-39. User Model for Message Buffer Organization
The MSCAN facilitates a sophisticated message storage system which addresses the requirements of a broad range of network applications.
8.4.2.1
Message Transmit Background
Modern application layer software is built upon two fundamental assumptions:
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 284 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
*
*
Any CAN node is able to send out a stream of scheduled messages without releasing the CAN bus between the two messages. Such nodes arbitrate for the CAN bus immediately after sending the previous message and only release the CAN bus in case of lost arbitration. The internal message queue within any CAN node is organized such that the highest priority message is sent out first, if more than one message is ready to be sent.
The behavior described in the bullets above cannot be achieved with a single transmit buffer. That buffer must be reloaded immediately after the previous message is sent. This loading process lasts a finite amount of time and must be completed within the inter-frame sequence (IFS) to be able to send an uninterrupted stream of messages. Even if this is feasible for limited CAN bus speeds, it requires that the CPU reacts with short latencies to the transmit interrupt. A double buffer scheme de-couples the reloading of the transmit buffer from the actual message sending and, therefore, reduces the reactiveness requirements of the CPU. Problems can arise if the sending of a message is finished while the CPU re-loads the second buffer. No buffer would then be ready for transmission, and the CAN bus would be released. At least three transmit buffers are required to meet the first of the above requirements under all circumstances. The MSCAN has three transmit buffers. The second requirement calls for some sort of internal prioritization which the MSCAN implements with the "local priority" concept described in Section 8.4.2.2, "Transmit Structures."
8.4.2.2
Transmit Structures
The MSCAN triple transmit buffer scheme optimizes real-time performance by allowing multiple messages to be set up in advance. The three buffers are arranged as shown in Figure 8-39. All three buffers have a 13-byte data structure similar to the outline of the receive buffers (see Section 8.3.3, "Programmer's Model of Message Storage"). An additional Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR) contains an 8-bit local priority field (PRIO) (see Section 8.3.3.4, "Transmit Buffer Priority Register (TBPR)"). The remaining two bytes are used for time stamping of a message, if required (see Section 8.3.3.5, "Time Stamp Register (TSRH-TSRL)"). To transmit a message, the CPU must identify an available transmit buffer, which is indicated by a set transmitter buffer empty (TXEx) flag (see Section 8.3.2.7, "MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG)"). If a transmit buffer is available, the CPU must set a pointer to this buffer by writing to the CANTBSEL register (see Section 8.3.2.11, "MSCAN Transmit Buffer Selection Register (CANTBSEL)"). This makes the respective buffer accessible within the CANTXFG address space (see Section 8.3.3, "Programmer's Model of Message Storage"). The algorithmic feature associated with the CANTBSEL register simplifies the transmit buffer selection. In addition, this scheme makes the handler software simpler because only one address area is applicable for the transmit process, and the required address space is minimized. The CPU then stores the identifier, the control bits, and the data content into one of the transmit buffers. Finally, the buffer is flagged as ready for transmission by clearing the associated TXE flag.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 285
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
The MSCAN then schedules the message for transmission and signals the successful transmission of the buffer by setting the associated TXE flag. A transmit interrupt (see Section 8.4.7.2, "Transmit Interrupt") is generated1 when TXEx is set and can be used to drive the application software to re-load the buffer. If more than one buffer is scheduled for transmission when the CAN bus becomes available for arbitration, the MSCAN uses the local priority setting of the three buffers to determine the prioritization. For this purpose, every transmit buffer has an 8-bit local priority field (PRIO). The application software programs this field when the message is set up. The local priority reflects the priority of this particular message relative to the set of messages being transmitted from this node. The lowest binary value of the PRIO field is defined to be the highest priority. The internal scheduling process takes place whenever the MSCAN arbitrates for the CAN bus. This is also the case after the occurrence of a transmission error. When a high priority message is scheduled by the application software, it may become necessary to abort a lower priority message in one of the three transmit buffers. Because messages that are already in transmission cannot be aborted, the user must request the abort by setting the corresponding abort request bit (ABTRQ) (see Section 8.3.2.9, "MSCAN Transmitter Message Abort Request Register (CANTARQ)".) The MSCAN then grants the request, if possible, by: 1. Setting the corresponding abort acknowledge flag (ABTAK) in the CANTAAK register. 2. Setting the associated TXE flag to release the buffer. 3. Generating a transmit interrupt. The transmit interrupt handler software can determine from the setting of the ABTAK flag whether the message was aborted (ABTAK = 1) or sent (ABTAK = 0).
8.4.2.3
Receive Structures
The received messages are stored in a five stage input FIFO. The five message buffers are alternately mapped into a single memory area (see Figure 8-39). The background receive buffer (RxBG) is exclusively associated with the MSCAN, but the foreground receive buffer (RxFG) is addressable by the CPU (see Figure 8-39). This scheme simplifies the handler software because only one address area is applicable for the receive process. All receive buffers have a size of 15 bytes to store the CAN control bits, the identifier (standard or extended), the data contents, and a time stamp, if enabled (see Section 8.3.3, "Programmer's Model of Message Storage"). The receiver full flag (RXF) (see Section 8.3.2.5, "MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)") signals the status of the foreground receive buffer. When the buffer contains a correctly received message with a matching identifier, this flag is set. On reception, each message is checked to see whether it passes the filter (see Section 8.4.3, "Identifier Acceptance Filter") and simultaneously is written into the active RxBG. After successful reception of a valid message, the MSCAN shifts the content of RxBG into the receiver FIFO2, sets the RXF flag, and generates a receive interrupt (see Section 8.4.7.3, "Receive Interrupt") to the CPU3. The user's receive handler must read the received message from the RxFG and then reset the RXF flag to acknowledge the interrupt and to release the foreground buffer. A new message, which can follow immediately after the IFS field of the CAN frame, is received into the next available RxBG. If the MSCAN receives an invalid
1. The transmit interrupt occurs only if not masked. A polling scheme can be applied on TXEx also. 2. Only if the RXF flag is not set. 3. The receive interrupt occurs only if not masked. A polling scheme can be applied on RXF also. S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 286 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
message in its RxBG (wrong identifier, transmission errors, etc.) the actual contents of the buffer will be over-written by the next message. The buffer will then not be shifted into the FIFO. When the MSCAN module is transmitting, the MSCAN receives its own transmitted messages into the background receive buffer, RxBG, but does not shift it into the receiver FIFO, generate a receive interrupt, or acknowledge its own messages on the CAN bus. The exception to this rule is in loopback mode (see Section 8.3.2.2, "MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)") where the MSCAN treats its own messages exactly like all other incoming messages. The MSCAN receives its own transmitted messages in the event that it loses arbitration. If arbitration is lost, the MSCAN must be prepared to become a receiver. An overrun condition occurs when all receive message buffers in the FIFO are filled with correctly received messages with accepted identifiers and another message is correctly received from the CAN bus with an accepted identifier. The latter message is discarded and an error interrupt with overrun indication is generated if enabled (see Section 8.4.7.5, "Error Interrupt"). The MSCAN remains able to transmit messages while the receiver FIFO being filled, but all incoming messages are discarded. As soon as a receive buffer in the FIFO is available again, new valid messages will be accepted.
8.4.3
Identifier Acceptance Filter
The MSCAN identifier acceptance registers (see Section 8.3.2.12, "MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)") define the acceptable patterns of the standard or extended identifier (ID[10:0] or ID[28:0]). Any of these bits can be marked `don't care' in the MSCAN identifier mask registers (see Section 8.3.2.18, "MSCAN Identifier Mask Registers (CANIDMR0-CANIDMR7)"). A filter hit is indicated to the application software by a set receive buffer full flag (RXF = 1) and three bits in the CANIDAC register (see Section 8.3.2.12, "MSCAN Identifier Acceptance Control Register (CANIDAC)"). These identifier hit flags (IDHIT[2:0]) clearly identify the filter section that caused the acceptance. They simplify the application software's task to identify the cause of the receiver interrupt. If more than one hit occurs (two or more filters match), the lower hit has priority. A very flexible programmable generic identifier acceptance filter has been introduced to reduce the CPU interrupt loading. The filter is programmable to operate in four different modes (see Bosch CAN 2.0A/B protocol specification): * Two identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to: -- The full 29 bits of the extended identifier and to the following bits of the CAN 2.0B frame: - Remote transmission request (RTR) - Identifier extension (IDE) - Substitute remote request (SRR) -- The 11 bits of the standard identifier plus the RTR and IDE bits of the CAN 2.0A/B messages1. This mode implements two filters for a full length CAN 2.0B compliant extended identifier. Figure 8-40 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0-CANIDAR3, CANIDMR0-CANIDMR3) produces a filter 0 hit. Similarly, the second filter bank (CANIDAR4-CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4-CANIDMR7) produces a filter 1 hit. * Four identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to
1. Although this mode can be used for standard identifiers, it is recommended to use the four or eight identifier acceptance filters for standard identifiers S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 287
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
*
*
-- a) the 14 most significant bits of the extended identifier plus the SRR and IDE bits of CAN 2.0B messages or -- b) the 11 bits of the standard identifier, the RTR and IDE bits of CAN 2.0A/B messages. Figure 8-41 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0-CANIDA3, CANIDMR0-3CANIDMR) produces filter 0 and 1 hits. Similarly, the second filter bank (CANIDAR4-CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4-CANIDMR7) produces filter 2 and 3 hits. Eight identifier acceptance filters, each to be applied to the first 8 bits of the identifier. This mode implements eight independent filters for the first 8 bits of a CAN 2.0A/B compliant standard identifier or a CAN 2.0B compliant extended identifier. Figure 8-42 shows how the first 32-bit filter bank (CANIDAR0-CANIDAR3, CANIDMR0-CANIDMR3) produces filter 0 to 3 hits. Similarly, the second filter bank (CANIDAR4-CANIDAR7, CANIDMR4-CANIDMR7) produces filter 4 to 7 hits. Closed filter. No CAN message is copied into the foreground buffer RxFG, and the RXF flag is never set.
IDR0 IDR0 ID21 ID3 ID20 ID2 IDR1 IDR1 ID15 IDE ID14 ID10 IDR2 IDR2 ID7 ID3 ID6 ID10 IDR3 IDR3 RTR ID3
CAN 2.0B Extended Identifier ID28 CAN 2.0A/B Standard Identifier ID10
AM7
CANIDMR0
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR1
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR2
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR3
AM0
AC7
CANIDAR0
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR1
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR2
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR3
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
Figure 8-40. 32-bit Maskable Identifier Acceptance Filter
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 288 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
CAN 2.0B Extended Identifier CAN 2.0A/B Standard Identifier
ID28 ID10
IDR0 IDR0
ID21 ID3
ID20 ID2
IDR1 IDR1
ID15 IDE
ID14 ID10
IDR2 IDR2
ID7 ID3
ID6 ID10
IDR3 IDR3
RTR ID3
AM7
CANIDMR0
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR1
AM0
AC7
CANIDAR0
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR1
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
AM7
CANIDMR2
AM0
AM7
CANIDMR3
AM0
AC7
CANIDAR2
AC0
AC7
CANIDAR3
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 1 Hit)
Figure 8-41. 16-bit Maskable Identifier Acceptance Filters
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 289
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
CAN 2.0B Extended Identifier ID28 CAN 2.0A/B Standard Identifier ID10
IDR0 IDR0
ID21 ID3
ID20 ID2
IDR1 IDR1
ID15 IDE
ID14 ID10
IDR2 IDR2
ID7 ID3
ID6 ID10
IDR3 IDR3
RTR ID3
AM7
CIDMR0
AM0
AC7
CIDAR0
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 0 Hit)
AM7
CIDMR1
AM0
AC7
CIDAR1
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 1 Hit)
AM7
CIDMR2
AM0
AC7
CIDAR2
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 2 Hit)
AM7
CIDMR3
AM0
AC7
CIDAR3
AC0
ID Accepted (Filter 3 Hit)
Figure 8-42. 8-bit Maskable Identifier Acceptance Filters
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 290 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.4.3.1
Protocol Violation Protection
The MSCAN protects the user from accidentally violating the CAN protocol through programming errors. The protection logic implements the following features: * The receive and transmit error counters cannot be written or otherwise manipulated. * All registers which control the configuration of the MSCAN cannot be modified while the MSCAN is on-line. The MSCAN has to be in Initialization Mode. The corresponding INITRQ/INITAK handshake bits in the CANCTL0/CANCTL1 registers (see Section 8.3.2.1, "MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)") serve as a lock to protect the following registers: -- MSCAN control 1 register (CANCTL1) -- MSCAN bus timing registers 0 and 1 (CANBTR0, CANBTR1) -- MSCAN identifier acceptance control register (CANIDAC) -- MSCAN identifier acceptance registers (CANIDAR0-CANIDAR7) -- MSCAN identifier mask registers (CANIDMR0-CANIDMR7) * The TXCAN is immediately forced to a recessive state when the MSCAN goes into the power down mode or initialization mode (see Section 8.4.5.6, "MSCAN Power Down Mode," and Section 8.4.4.5, "MSCAN Initialization Mode"). * The MSCAN enable bit (CANE) is writable only once in normal system operation modes, which provides further protection against inadvertently disabling the MSCAN.
8.4.3.2
Clock System
Figure 8-43 shows the structure of the MSCAN clock generation circuitry.
MSCAN
Bus Clock
CANCLK CLKSRC
Prescaler (1 .. 64)
Time quanta clock (Tq)
CLKSRC Oscillator Clock
Figure 8-43. MSCAN Clocking Scheme
The clock source bit (CLKSRC) in the CANCTL1 register (8.3.2.2/8-257) defines whether the internal CANCLK is connected to the output of a crystal oscillator (oscillator clock) or to the bus clock. The clock source has to be chosen such that the tight oscillator tolerance requirements (up to 0.4%) of the CAN protocol are met. Additionally, for high CAN bus rates (1 Mbps), a 45% to 55% duty cycle of the clock is required. If the bus clock is generated from a PLL, it is recommended to select the oscillator clock rather than the bus clock due to jitter considerations, especially at the faster CAN bus rates.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 291
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
For microcontrollers without a clock and reset generator (CRG), CANCLK is driven from the crystal oscillator (oscillator clock). A programmable prescaler generates the time quanta (Tq) clock from CANCLK. A time quantum is the atomic unit of time handled by the MSCAN.
Eqn. 8-2
f CANCLK = ----------------------------------------------------Tq ( Prescaler value ) A bit time is subdivided into three segments as described in the Bosch CAN specification. (see Figure 844): * SYNC_SEG: This segment has a fixed length of one time quantum. Signal edges are expected to happen within this section. * Time Segment 1: This segment includes the PROP_SEG and the PHASE_SEG1 of the CAN standard. It can be programmed by setting the parameter TSEG1 to consist of 4 to 16 time quanta. * Time Segment 2: This segment represents the PHASE_SEG2 of the CAN standard. It can be programmed by setting the TSEG2 parameter to be 2 to 8 time quanta long.
Eqn. 8-3
f Tq Bit Rate = -------------------------------------------------------------------------------( number of Time Quanta )
NRZ Signal
SYNC_SEG
Time Segment 1 (PROP_SEG + PHASE_SEG1) 4 ... 16 8 ... 25 Time Quanta = 1 Bit Time
Time Segment 2 (PHASE_SEG2) 2 ... 8
1
Transmit Point
Sample Point (single or triple sampling)
Figure 8-44. Segments within the Bit Time
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 292 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-36. Time Segment Syntax
Syntax SYNC_SEG Transmit Point Description System expects transitions to occur on the CAN bus during this period. A node in transmit mode transfers a new value to the CAN bus at this point. A node in receive mode samples the CAN bus at this point. If the three samples per bit option is selected, then this point marks the position of the third sample.
Sample Point
The synchronization jump width (see the Bosch CAN specification for details) can be programmed in a range of 1 to 4 time quanta by setting the SJW parameter. The SYNC_SEG, TSEG1, TSEG2, and SJW parameters are set by programming the MSCAN bus timing registers (CANBTR0, CANBTR1) (see Section 8.3.2.3, "MSCAN Bus Timing Register 0 (CANBTR0)" and Section 8.3.2.4, "MSCAN Bus Timing Register 1 (CANBTR1)"). Table 8-37 gives an overview of the CAN compliant segment settings and the related parameter values. NOTE It is the user's responsibility to ensure the bit time settings are in compliance with the CAN standard.
Table 8-37. CAN Standard Compliant Bit Time Segment Settings
Time Segment 1 5 .. 10 4 .. 11 5 .. 12 6 .. 13 7 .. 14 8 .. 15 9 .. 16 TSEG1 4 .. 9 3 .. 10 4 .. 11 5 .. 12 6 .. 13 7 .. 14 8 .. 15 Time Segment 2 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 TSEG2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Synchronization Jump Width 1 .. 2 1 .. 3 1 .. 4 1 .. 4 1 .. 4 1 .. 4 1 .. 4 SJW 0 .. 1 0 .. 2 0 .. 3 0 .. 3 0 .. 3 0 .. 3 0 .. 3
8.4.4
8.4.4.1
Modes of Operation
Normal System Operating Modes
The MSCAN module behaves as described within this specification in all normal system operating modes. Write restrictions exist for some registers.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 293
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.4.4.2
Special System Operating Modes
The MSCAN module behaves as described within this specification in all special system operating modes. Write restrictions which exist on specific registers in normal modes are lifted for test purposes in special modes.
8.4.4.3
Emulation Modes
In all emulation modes, the MSCAN module behaves just like in normal system operating modes as described within this specification.
8.4.4.4
Listen-Only Mode
In an optional CAN bus monitoring mode (listen-only), the CAN node is able to receive valid data frames and valid remote frames, but it sends only "recessive" bits on the CAN bus. In addition, it cannot start a transmission. If the MAC sub-layer is required to send a "dominant" bit (ACK bit, overload flag, or active error flag), the bit is rerouted internally so that the MAC sub-layer monitors this "dominant" bit, although the CAN bus may remain in recessive state externally.
8.4.4.5
MSCAN Initialization Mode
The MSCAN enters initialization mode when it is enabled (CANE=1). When entering initialization mode during operation, any on-going transmission or reception is immediately aborted and synchronization to the CAN bus is lost, potentially causing CAN protocol violations. To protect the CAN bus system from fatal consequences of violations, the MSCAN immediately drives TXCAN into a recessive state. NOTE The user is responsible for ensuring that the MSCAN is not active when initialization mode is entered. The recommended procedure is to bring the MSCAN into sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) before setting the INITRQ bit in the CANCTL0 register. Otherwise, the abort of an on-going message can cause an error condition and can impact other CAN bus devices. In initialization mode, the MSCAN is stopped. However, interface registers remain accessible. This mode is used to reset the CANCTL0, CANRFLG, CANRIER, CANTFLG, CANTIER, CANTARQ, CANTAAK, and CANTBSEL registers to their default values. In addition, the MSCAN enables the configuration of the CANBTR0, CANBTR1 bit timing registers; CANIDAC; and the CANIDAR, CANIDMR message filters. See Section 8.3.2.1, "MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0)," for a detailed description of the initialization mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 294 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Bus Clock Domain
CAN Clock Domain INIT Flag
INITRQ CPU Init Request
SYNC
sync. INITRQ
INITAK Flag
sync.
INITAK
SYNC
INITAK
Figure 8-45. Initialization Request/Acknowledge Cycle
Due to independent clock domains within the MSCAN, INITRQ must be synchronized to all domains by using a special handshake mechanism. This handshake causes additional synchronization delay (see Section Figure 8-45., "Initialization Request/Acknowledge Cycle"). If there is no message transfer ongoing on the CAN bus, the minimum delay will be two additional bus clocks and three additional CAN clocks. When all parts of the MSCAN are in initialization mode, the INITAK flag is set. The application software must use INITAK as a handshake indication for the request (INITRQ) to go into initialization mode. NOTE The CPU cannot clear INITRQ before initialization mode (INITRQ = 1 and INITAK = 1) is active.
8.4.5
Low-Power Options
If the MSCAN is disabled (CANE = 0), the MSCAN clocks are stopped for power saving. If the MSCAN is enabled (CANE = 1), the MSCAN has two additional modes with reduced power consumption, compared to normal mode: sleep and power down mode. In sleep mode, power consumption is reduced by stopping all clocks except those to access the registers from the CPU side. In power down mode, all clocks are stopped and no power is consumed. Table 8-38 summarizes the combinations of MSCAN and CPU modes. A particular combination of modes is entered by the given settings on the CSWAI and SLPRQ/SLPAK bits.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 295
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
Table 8-38. CPU vs. MSCAN Operating Modes
MSCAN Mode CPU Mode Normal Sleep CSWAI = X(1) SLPRQ = 0 SLPAK = 0 CSWAI = 0 SLPRQ = 0 SLPAK = 0 CSWAI = X SLPRQ = 1 SLPAK = 1 CSWAI = 0 SLPRQ = 1 SLPAK = 1 CSWAI = 1 SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X Power Down Reduced Power Consumption Disabled (CANE=0) CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X CSWAI = X SLPRQ = X SLPAK = X
RUN
WAIT
STOP 1. `X' means don't care.
8.4.5.1
Operation in Run Mode
As shown in Table 8-38, only MSCAN sleep mode is available as low power option when the CPU is in run mode.
8.4.5.2
Operation in Wait Mode
The WAI instruction puts the MCU in a low power consumption stand-by mode. If the CSWAI bit is set, additional power can be saved in power down mode because the CPU clocks are stopped. After leaving this power down mode, the MSCAN restarts and enters normal mode again. While the CPU is in wait mode, the MSCAN can be operated in normal mode and generate interrupts (registers can be accessed via background debug mode).
8.4.5.3
Operation in Stop Mode
The STOP instruction puts the MCU in a low power consumption stand-by mode. In stop mode, the MSCAN is set in power down mode regardless of the value of the SLPRQ/SLPAK and CSWAI bits (Table 8-38).
8.4.5.4
MSCAN Normal Mode
This is a non-power-saving mode. Enabling the MSCAN puts the module from disabled mode into normal mode. In this mode the module can either be in initialization mode or out of initialization mode. See Section 8.4.4.5, "MSCAN Initialization Mode".
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 296 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.4.5.5
MSCAN Sleep Mode
The CPU can request the MSCAN to enter this low power mode by asserting the SLPRQ bit in the CANCTL0 register. The time when the MSCAN enters sleep mode depends on a fixed synchronization delay and its current activity: * If there are one or more message buffers scheduled for transmission (TXEx = 0), the MSCAN will continue to transmit until all transmit message buffers are empty (TXEx = 1, transmitted successfully or aborted) and then goes into sleep mode. * If the MSCAN is receiving, it continues to receive and goes into sleep mode as soon as the CAN bus next becomes idle. * If the MSCAN is neither transmitting nor receiving, it immediately goes into sleep mode.
Bus Clock Domain
CAN Clock Domain SLPRQ Flag
SLPRQ CPU Sleep Request
SYNC
sync. SLPRQ
SLPAK Flag
sync.
SLPAK
SYNC
SLPAK MSCAN in Sleep Mode
Figure 8-46. Sleep Request / Acknowledge Cycle
NOTE The application software must avoid setting up a transmission (by clearing one or more TXEx flag(s)) and immediately request sleep mode (by setting SLPRQ). Whether the MSCAN starts transmitting or goes into sleep mode directly depends on the exact sequence of operations. If sleep mode is active, the SLPRQ and SLPAK bits are set (Figure 8-46). The application software must use SLPAK as a handshake indication for the request (SLPRQ) to go into sleep mode. When in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1), the MSCAN stops its internal clocks. However, clocks that allow register accesses from the CPU side continue to run. If the MSCAN is in bus-off state, it stops counting the 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits due to the stopped clocks. TXCAN remains in a recessive state. If RXF = 1, the message can be read and RXF can be cleared. Shifting a new message into the foreground buffer of the receiver FIFO (RxFG) does not take place while in sleep mode. It is possible to access the transmit buffers and to clear the associated TXE flags. No message abort takes place while in sleep mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 297
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
If the WUPE bit in CANCTL0 is not asserted, the MSCAN will mask any activity it detects on CAN. RXCAN is therefore held internally in a recessive state. This locks the MSCAN in sleep mode. WUPE must be set before entering sleep mode to take effect. The MSCAN is able to leave sleep mode (wake up) only when: * CAN bus activity occurs and WUPE = 1 or * the CPU clears the SLPRQ bit NOTE The CPU cannot clear the SLPRQ bit before sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) is active. After wake-up, the MSCAN waits for 11 consecutive recessive bits to synchronize to the CAN bus. As a consequence, if the MSCAN is woken-up by a CAN frame, this frame is not received. The receive message buffers (RxFG and RxBG) contain messages if they were received before sleep mode was entered. All pending actions will be executed upon wake-up; copying of RxBG into RxFG, message aborts and message transmissions. If the MSCAN remains in bus-off state after sleep mode was exited, it continues counting the 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits.
8.4.5.6
MSCAN Power Down Mode
The MSCAN is in power down mode (Table 8-38) when * CPU is in stop mode or * CPU is in wait mode and the CSWAI bit is set When entering the power down mode, the MSCAN immediately stops all ongoing transmissions and receptions, potentially causing CAN protocol violations. To protect the CAN bus system from fatal consequences of violations to the above rule, the MSCAN immediately drives TXCAN into a recessive state. NOTE The user is responsible for ensuring that the MSCAN is not active when power down mode is entered. The recommended procedure is to bring the MSCAN into Sleep mode before the STOP or WAI instruction (if CSWAI is set) is executed. Otherwise, the abort of an ongoing message can cause an error condition and impact other CAN bus devices. In power down mode, all clocks are stopped and no registers can be accessed. If the MSCAN was not in sleep mode before power down mode became active, the module performs an internal recovery cycle after powering up. This causes some fixed delay before the module enters normal mode again.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 298 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.4.5.7
Disabled Mode
The MSCAN is in disabled mode out of reset (CANE=0). All module clocks are stopped for power saving, however the register map can still be accessed as specified.
8.4.5.8
Programmable Wake-Up Function
The MSCAN can be programmed to wake up from sleep or power down mode as soon as CAN bus activity is detected (see control bit WUPE in MSCAN Control Register 0 (CANCTL0). The sensitivity to existing CAN bus action can be modified by applying a low-pass filter function to the RXCAN input line (see control bit WUPM in Section 8.3.2.2, "MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)"). This feature can be used to protect the MSCAN from wake-up due to short glitches on the CAN bus lines. Such glitches can result from--for example--electromagnetic interference within noisy environments.
8.4.6
Reset Initialization
The reset state of each individual bit is listed in Section 8.3.2, "Register Descriptions," which details all the registers and their bit-fields.
8.4.7
Interrupts
This section describes all interrupts originated by the MSCAN. It documents the enable bits and generated flags. Each interrupt is listed and described separately.
8.4.7.1
Description of Interrupt Operation
The MSCAN supports four interrupt vectors (see Table 8-39), any of which can be individually masked (for details see Section 8.3.2.6, "MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)" to Section 8.3.2.8, "MSCAN Transmitter Interrupt Enable Register (CANTIER)"). NOTE The dedicated interrupt vector addresses are defined in the Resets and Interrupts chapter.
Table 8-39. Interrupt Vectors
Interrupt Source Wake-Up Interrupt (WUPIF) Error Interrupts Interrupt (CSCIF, OVRIF) Receive Interrupt (RXF) Transmit Interrupts (TXE[2:0]) CCR Mask I bit I bit I bit I bit Local Enable CANRIER (WUPIE) CANRIER (CSCIE, OVRIE) CANRIER (RXFIE) CANTIER (TXEIE[2:0])
8.4.7.2
Transmit Interrupt
At least one of the three transmit buffers is empty (not scheduled) and can be loaded to schedule a message for transmission. The TXEx flag of the empty message buffer is set.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 299
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.4.7.3
Receive Interrupt
A message is successfully received and shifted into the foreground buffer (RxFG) of the receiver FIFO. This interrupt is generated immediately after receiving the EOF symbol. The RXF flag is set. If there are multiple messages in the receiver FIFO, the RXF flag is set as soon as the next message is shifted to the foreground buffer.
8.4.7.4
Wake-Up Interrupt
A wake-up interrupt is generated if activity on the CAN bus occurs during MSCAN sleep or power-down mode. NOTE This interrupt can only occur if the MSCAN was in sleep mode (SLPRQ = 1 and SLPAK = 1) before entering power down mode, the wake-up option is enabled (WUPE = 1), and the wake-up interrupt is enabled (WUPIE = 1).
8.4.7.5
Error Interrupt
An error interrupt is generated if an overrun of the receiver FIFO, error, warning, or bus-off condition occurrs. MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG) indicates one of the following conditions: * Overrun -- An overrun condition of the receiver FIFO as described in Section 8.4.2.3, "Receive Structures," occurred. * CAN Status Change -- The actual value of the transmit and receive error counters control the CAN bus state of the MSCAN. As soon as the error counters skip into a critical range (Tx/Rxwarning, Tx/Rx-error, bus-off) the MSCAN flags an error condition. The status change, which caused the error condition, is indicated by the TSTAT and RSTAT flags (see Section 8.3.2.5, "MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG)" and Section 8.3.2.6, "MSCAN Receiver Interrupt Enable Register (CANRIER)").
8.4.7.6
Interrupt Acknowledge
Interrupts are directly associated with one or more status flags in either the MSCAN Receiver Flag Register (CANRFLG) or the MSCAN Transmitter Flag Register (CANTFLG). Interrupts are pending as long as one of the corresponding flags is set. The flags in CANRFLG and CANTFLG must be reset within the interrupt handler to handshake the interrupt. The flags are reset by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit position. A flag cannot be cleared if the respective condition prevails. NOTE It must be guaranteed that the CPU clears only the bit causing the current interrupt. For this reason, bit manipulation instructions (BSET) must not be used to clear interrupt flags. These instructions may cause accidental clearing of interrupt flags which are set after entering the current interrupt service routine.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 300 Freescale Semiconductor
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
8.5
8.5.1
Initialization/Application Information
MSCAN initialization
The procedure to initially start up the MSCAN module out of reset is as follows: 1. Assert CANE 2. Write to the configuration registers in initialization mode 3. Clear INITRQ to leave initialization mode If the configuration of registers which are only writable in initialization mode shall be changed: 1. Bring the module into sleep mode by setting SLPRQ and awaiting SLPAK to assert after the CAN bus becomes idle. 2. Enter initialization mode: assert INITRQ and await INITAK 3. Write to the configuration registers in initialization mode 4. Clear INITRQ to leave initialization mode and continue
8.5.2
Bus-Off Recovery
The bus-off recovery is user configurable. The bus-off state can either be left automatically or on user request. For reasons of backwards compatibility, the MSCAN defaults to automatic recovery after reset. In this case, the MSCAN will become error active again after counting 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits on the CAN bus (see the Bosch CAN specification for details). If the MSCAN is configured for user request (BORM set in MSCAN Control Register 1 (CANCTL1)), the recovery from bus-off starts after both independent events have become true: * 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits on the CAN bus have been monitored * BOHOLD in MSCAN Miscellaneous Register (CANMISC) has been cleared by the user These two events may occur in any order.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 301
Freescale's Scalable Controller Area Network (S12MSCANV3)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 302 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 9 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description Revision History
Version Number
V01.00 V01.01 V01.02 V01.03
Revision Date
25 July 2007 14 Sept 2007 1 Oct 2007 9 Oct 2007
Effective Date
25 July 2007 14 Sept 2007 1 Oct 2007 9 Oct 2007
Author
Initial version
Description of Changes
Added reserved registers at the end the memory map. Added following mention where applies: (n conversion number, NOT channel number!) Modified table "Analog Input Channel Select Coding" due to new customer feature (SPECIAL17).
9.1
Introduction
The ADC12B10C is a 10-channel, 12-bit, multiplexed input successive approximation analog-to-digital converter. Refer to device electrical specifications for ATD accuracy.
9.1.1
* * * * * * * * * * * *
Features
8-, 10-, or 12-bit resolution. Conversion in Stop Mode using internally generated clock Automatic return to low power after conversion sequence Automatic compare with interrupt for higher than or less/equal than programmable value Programmable sample time. Left/right justified result data. External trigger control. Sequence complete interrupt. Analog input multiplexer for 10 analog input channels. Special conversions for VRH, VRL, (VRL+VRH)/2. 1-to-10 conversion sequence lengths. Continuous conversion mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12
Freescale Semiconductor
303
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
* *
*
Multiple channel scans. Configurable external trigger functionality on any AD channel or any of four additional trigger inputs. The four additional trigger inputs can be chip external or internal. Refer to device specification for availability and connectivity. Configurable location for channel wrap around (when converting multiple channels in a sequence).
9.1.2
9.1.2.1
Modes of Operation
Conversion Modes
There is software programmable selection between performing single or continuous conversion on a single channel or multiple channels.
9.1.2.2
*
MCU Operating Modes
*
*
Stop Mode -- ICLKSTP=0 (in ATDCTL2 register) Entering Stop Mode aborts any conversion sequence in progress and if a sequence was aborted restarts it after exiting stop mode. This has the same effect/consequences as starting a conversion sequence with write to ATDCTL5. So after exiting from stop mode with a previously aborted sequence all flags are cleared etc. -- ICLKSTP=1 (in ATDCTL2 register) A/D conversion sequence seamless continues in Stop Mode based on the internally generated clock ICLK as ATD clock. For conversions during transition from Run to Stop Mode or vice versa the result is not written to the results register, no CCF flag is set and no compare is done. When converting in Stop Mode (ICLKSTP=1) an ATD Stop Recovery time tATDSTPRCV is required to switch back to bus clock based ATDCLK when leaving Stop Mode. Do not access ATD registers during this time. Wait Mode ADC12B10C behaves same in Run and Wait Mode. For reduced power consumption continuous conversions should be aborted before entering Wait mode. Freeze Mode In Freeze Mode the ADC12B10C will either continue or finish or stop converting according to the FRZ1 and FRZ0 bits. This is useful for debugging and emulation.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 304 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.1.3
Block Diagram
Bus Clock ICLK Clock Prescaler Trigger Mux Internal Clock
ATD_12B10C
Sequence Complete Interrupt Compare Interrupt
ATD Clock ETRIG0 ETRIG1 ETRIG2 ETRIG3 (See device specification for availability and connectivity) ATDCTL1 ATDDIEN
Mode and Timing Control
VDDA VSSA VRH VRL Successive Approximation Register (SAR) and DAC
Results ATD 0 ATD 1 ATD 2 ATD 3 ATD 4 ATD 5 ATD 6 ATD 7 ATD 8 ATD 9
+ Sample & Hold AN9 AN8 Analog MUX Comparator -
AN7 AN6 AN5 AN4 AN3 AN2 AN1 AN0
Figure 9-1. ADC12B10C Block Diagram
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 305
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.2
Signal Description
This section lists all inputs to the ADC12B10C block.
9.2.1
9.2.1.1
Detailed Signal Descriptions
ANx (x = 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0)
This pin serves as the analog input Channel x. It can also be configured as digital port or external trigger for the ATD conversion.
9.2.1.2
ETRIG3, ETRIG2, ETRIG1, ETRIG0
These inputs can be configured to serve as an external trigger for the ATD conversion. Refer to device specification for availability and connection of these inputs!
9.2.1.3
VRH, VRL
VRH is the high reference voltage, VRL is the low reference voltage for ATD conversion.
9.2.1.4
VDDA, VSSA
These pins are the power supplies for the analog circuitry of the ADC12B10C block.
9.3
Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all registers accessible in the ADC12B10C.
9.3.1
Module Memory Map
NOTE Register Address = Base Address + Address Offset, where the Base Address is defined at the MCU level and the Address Offset is defined at the module level.
Figure 9-2 gives an overview on all ADC12B10C registers.
Address 0x0000 0x0001 0x0002
Name ATDCTL0 ATDCTL1 ATDCTL2
Bit 7 R Reserved W R ETRIGSEL W R 0 W
6 0
5 0
4 0
3 WRAP3
2 WRAP2
1 WRAP1
Bit 0 WRAP0
SRES1 AFFC
SRES0
SMP_DIS ETRIGCH3 ETRIGCH2 ETRIGCH1 ETRIGCH0 ETRIGP ETRIGE ASCIE ACMPIE
ICLKSTP ETRIGLE
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-2. ADC12B10C Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 306 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Address 0x0003 0x0004 0x0005 0x0006 0x0007 0x0008 0x0009 0x000A 0x000B 0x000C 0x000D
Name R ATDCTL3 W R ATDCTL4 W R ATDCTL5 W R ATDSTAT0 W R Unimplemented W R ATDCMPEH W R W R ATDSTAT2H W R ATDSTAT2L W R ATDDIENH W ATDCMPEL ATDDIENL
Bit 7 DJM SMP2 0
6 S8C SMP1 SC 0 0 0
5 S4C SMP0 SCAN ETORF 0 0
4 S2C
3 S1C
2 FIFO PRS[4:0]
1 FRZ1
Bit 0 FRZ0
MULT FIFOR 0 0
CD CC3 0 0
CC CC2 0 0
CB CC1 0
CA CC0 0
SCF 0 0
CMPE[9:8]
CMPE[7:0] 0 0 0 0 0 CCF[7:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CCF[9:8]
IEN[9:8]
R W R 0x000E ATDCMPHTH W 0x000F ATDCMPHTL 0x0010 0x0012 0x0014 0x0016 0x0018 0x001A ATDDR0 ATDDR1 ATDDR2 ATDDR3 ATDDR4 ATDDR5 ATDDR6 ATDDR7 R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
IEN[7:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0 CMPHT[9:8]
CMPHT[7:0] See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" = Unimplemented or Reserved
0x001C 0x001E
Figure 9-2. ADC12B10C Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 307
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Address 0x0020 0x0022 0x0024 0x002F
Name ATDDR8 ATDDR9 Unimplemented R W R W R W
Bit 7
6 5 4 3 2 1 See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)" See Section 9.3.2.12.1, "Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)" and Section 9.3.2.12.2, "Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)"
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-2. ADC12B10C Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3)
9.3.2
Register Descriptions
This section describes in address order all the ADC12B10C registers and their individual bits.
9.3.2.1
ATD Control Register 0 (ATDCTL0)
Writes to this register will abort current conversion sequence.
Module Base + 0x0000
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Reserved 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
WRAP3 1
WRAP2 1
WRAP1 1
WRAP0 1
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-3. ATD Control Register 0 (ATDCTL0)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime, in special modes always write 0 to Reserved Bit 7.
Table 9-1. ATDCTL0 Field Descriptions
Field Description
3-0 WRAP[3-0]
Wrap Around Channel Select Bits -- These bits determine the channel for wrap around when doing multichannel conversions. The coding is summarized in Table 9-2.
Table 9-2. Multi-Channel Wrap Around Coding
WRAP3 WRAP2 WRAP1 WRAP0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 Multiple Channel Conversions (MULT = 1) Wraparound to AN0 after Converting Reserved(1) AN1 AN2 AN3 AN4 AN5
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 308 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Table 9-2. Multi-Channel Wrap Around Coding
WRAP3 WRAP2 WRAP1 WRAP0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 Multiple Channel Conversions (MULT = 1) Wraparound to AN0 after Converting AN6 AN7 AN8 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9
1 1 1 1 1. If only AN0 should be converted use MULT=0.
9.3.2.2
ATD Control Register 1 (ATDCTL1)
Writes to this register will abort current conversion sequence.
Module Base + 0x0001
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R ETRIGSEL W Reset 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 SRES1 SRES0 SMP_DIS ETRIGCH3 ETRIGCH2 ETRIGCH1 ETRIGCH0
Figure 9-4. ATD Control Register 1 (ATDCTL1)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 9-3. ATDCTL1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 ETRIGSEL Description External Trigger Source Select -- This bit selects the external trigger source to be either one of the AD channels or one of the ETRIG3-0 inputs. See device specification for availability and connectivity of ETRIG30 inputs. If a particular ETRIG3-0 input option is not available, writing a 1 to ETRISEL only sets the bit but has not effect, this means that one of the AD channels (selected by ETRIGCH3-0) is configured as the source for external trigger. The coding is summarized in Table 9-5. A/D Resolution Select -- These bits select the resolution of A/D conversion results. See Table 9-4 for coding.
6-5 SRES[1:0]
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 309
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Table 9-3. ATDCTL1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 4 SMP_DIS Description Discharge Before Sampling Bit 0 No discharge before sampling. 1 The internal sample capacitor is discharged before sampling the channel. This adds 2 ATD clock cycles to the sampling time. This can help to detect an open circuit instead of measuring the previous sampled channel.
3-0 External Trigger Channel Select -- These bits select one of the AD channels or one of the ETRIG3-0 inputs ETRIGCH[3:0] as source for the external trigger. The coding is summarized in Table 9-5.
Table 9-4. A/D Resolution Coding
SRES1 0 0 1 1 SRES0 0 1 0 1 A/D Resolution 8-bit data 10-bit data 12-bit data Reserved
Table 9-5. External Trigger Channel Select Coding
ETRIGSEL 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 ETRIGCH3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 ETRIGCH2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 ETRIGCH1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 X ETRIGCH0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 X External trigger source is AN0 AN1 AN2 AN3 AN4 AN5 AN6 AN7 AN8 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 ETRIG0(1) ETRIG11 ETRIG21 ETRIG31 Reserved
1 1 X X X Reserved 1. Only if ETRIG3-0 input option is available (see device specification), else ETRISEL is ignored, that means external trigger source is still on one of the AD channels selected by ETRIGCH3-0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 310 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.3.2.3
ATD Control Register 2 (ATDCTL2)
Writes to this register will abort current conversion sequence.
Module Base + 0x0002
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 AFFC 0 0 ICLKSTP 0 ETRIGLE 0 ETRIGP 0 ETRIGE 0 ASCIE 0 ACMPIE 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-5. ATD Control Register 2 (ATDCTL2)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 9-6. ATDCTL2 Field Descriptions
Field 6 AFFC Description ATD Fast Flag Clear All 0 ATD flag clearing done by write 1 to respective CCF[n] flag. 1 Changes all ATD conversion complete flags to a fast clear sequence. For compare disabled (CMPE[n]=0) a read access to the result register will cause the associated CCF[n] flag to clear automatically. For compare enabled (CMPE[n]=1) a write access to the result register will cause the associated CCF[n] flag to clear automatically. Internal Clock in Stop Mode Bit -- This bit enables A/D conversions in stop mode. When going into stop mode and ICLKSTP=1 the ATD conversion clock is automatically switched to the internally generated clock ICLK. Current conversion sequence will seamless continue. Conversion speed will change from prescaled bus frequency to the ICLK frequency (see ATD Electrical Characteristics in device description). The prescaler bits PRS4-0 in ATDCTL4 have no effect on the ICLK frequency. For conversions during stop mode the automatic compare interrupt or the sequence complete interrupt can be used to inform software handler about changing A/D values. External trigger will not work while converting in stop mode. For conversions during transition from Run to Stop Mode or vice versa the result is not written to the results register, no CCF flag is set and no compare is done. When converting in Stop Mode (ICLKSTP=1) an ATD Stop Recovery time tATDSTPRCV is required to switch back to bus clock based ATDCLK when leaving Stop Mode. Do not access ATD registers during this time. 0 If A/D conversion sequence is ongoing when going into stop mode, the actual conversion sequence will be aborted and automatically restarted when exiting stop mode. 1 A/D continues to convert in stop mode using internally generated clock (ICLK) External Trigger Level/Edge Control -- This bit controls the sensitivity of the external trigger signal. See Table 9-7 for details. External Trigger Polarity -- This bit controls the polarity of the external trigger signal. See Table 9-7 for details. External Trigger Mode Enable -- This bit enables the external trigger on one of the AD channels or one of the ETRIG3-0 inputs as described in Table 9-5. If external trigger source is one of the AD channels, the digital input buffer of this channel is enabled. The external trigger allows to synchronize the start of conversion with external events. External trigger will not work while converting in stop mode. 0 Disable external trigger 1 Enable external trigger
5 ICLKSTP
4 ETRIGLE 3 ETRIGP 2 ETRIGE
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 311
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Table 9-6. ATDCTL2 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 ASCIE 0 ACMPIE Description ATD Sequence Complete Interrupt Enable 0 ATD Sequence Complete interrupt requests are disabled. 1 ATD Sequence Complete interrupt will be requested whenever SCF=1 is set. ATD Compare Interrupt Enable -- If automatic compare is enabled for conversion n (CMPE[n]=1 in ATDCMPE register) this bit enables the compare interrupt. If the CCF[n] flag is set (showing a successful compare for conversion n), the compare interrupt is triggered. 0 ATD Compare interrupt requests are disabled. 1 For the conversions in a sequence for which automatic compare is enabled (CMPE[n]=1), ATD Compare Interrupt will be requested whenever any of the respective CCF flags is set.
Table 9-7. External Trigger Configurations
ETRIGLE 0 0 1 1 ETRIGP 0 1 0 1 External Trigger Sensitivity Falling edge Rising edge Low level High level
9.3.2.4
ATD Control Register 3 (ATDCTL3)
Writes to this register will abort current conversion sequence.
Module Base + 0x0003
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R DJM W Reset 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 S8C S4C S2C S1C FIFO FRZ1 FRZ0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-6. ATD Control Register 3 (ATDCTL3)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 312 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Table 9-8. ATDCTL3 Field Descriptions
Field 7 DJM Description Result Register Data Justification -- Result data format is always unsigned. This bit controls justification of conversion data in the result registers. 0 Left justified data in the result registers. 1 Right justified data in the result registers. Table 9-9 gives examples ATD results for an input signal range between 0 and 5.12 Volts. Conversion Sequence Length -- These bits control the number of conversions per sequence. Table 9-10 shows all combinations. At reset, S4C is set to 1 (sequence length is 4). This is to maintain software continuity to HC12 family. Result Register FIFO Mode -- If this bit is zero (non-FIFO mode), the A/D conversion results map into the result registers based on the conversion sequence; the result of the first conversion appears in the first result register (ATDDR0), the second result in the second result register (ATDDR1), and so on. If this bit is one (FIFO mode) the conversion counter is not reset at the beginning or ending of a conversion sequence; sequential conversion results are placed in consecutive result registers. In a continuously scanning conversion sequence, the result register counter will wrap around when it reaches the end of the result register file. The conversion counter value (CC3-0 in ATDSTAT0) can be used to determine where in the result register file, the current conversion result will be placed. Aborting a conversion or starting a new conversion clears the conversion counter even if FIFO=1. So the first result of a new conversion sequence, started by writing to ATDCTL5, will always be place in the first result register (ATDDDR0). Intended usage of FIFO mode is continuos conversion (SCAN=1) or triggered conversion (ETRIG=1). Which result registers hold valid data can be tracked using the conversion complete flags. Fast flag clear mode may or may not be useful in a particular application to track valid data. If this bit is one, automatic compare of result registers is always disabled, that is ADC12B10C will behave as if ACMPIE and all CPME[n] were zero. 0 Conversion results are placed in the corresponding result register up to the selected sequence length. 1 Conversion results are placed in consecutive result registers (wrap around at end). 1-0 FRZ[1:0] Background Debug Freeze Enable -- When debugging an application, it is useful in many cases to have the ATD pause when a breakpoint (Freeze Mode) is encountered. These 2 bits determine how the ATD will respond to a breakpoint as shown in Table 9-11. Leakage onto the storage node and comparator reference capacitors may compromise the accuracy of an immediately frozen conversion depending on the length of the freeze period.
6-3 S8C, S4C, S2C, S1C 2 FIFO
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 313
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Table 9-9. Examples of ideal decimal ATD Results
Input Signal VRL = 0 Volts VRH = 5.12 Volts 5.120 Volts ... 0.022 0.020 0.018 0.016 0.014 0.012 0.010 0.008 0.006 0.004 0.003 0.002 0.000 8-Bit Codes (resolution=20mV) 255 ... 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 10-Bit Codes (resolution=5mV) 1023 ... 4 4 4 3 3 2 2 2 1 1 0 0 0 12-Bit Codes (transfer curve has 1.25mV offset) (resolution=1.25mV) 4095 ... 17 16 14 12 11 9 8 6 4 3 2 1 0
Table 9-10. Conversion Sequence Length Coding
S8C 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 S4C 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 S2C 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 S1C 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Number of Conversions per Sequence 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 10 10 10 10 10
Table 9-11. ATD Behavior in Freeze Mode (Breakpoint)
FRZ1 0 FRZ0 0 Behavior in Freeze Mode Continue conversion
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 314 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Table 9-11. ATD Behavior in Freeze Mode (Breakpoint)
FRZ1 0 1 1 FRZ0 1 0 1 Reserved Finish current conversion, then freeze Freeze Immediately Behavior in Freeze Mode
9.3.2.5
ATD Control Register 4 (ATDCTL4)
Writes to this register will abort current conversion sequence.
Module Base + 0x0004
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R SMP2 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 SMP1 SMP0 PRS[4:0]
Figure 9-7. ATD Control Register 4 (ATDCTL4)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 9-12. ATDCTL4 Field Descriptions
Field 7-5 SMP[2:0] 4-0 PRS[4:0] Description Sample Time Select -- These three bits select the length of the sample time in units of ATD conversion clock cycles. Note that the ATD conversion clock period is itself a function of the prescaler value (bits PRS4-0). Table 913 lists the available sample time lengths. ATD Clock Prescaler -- These 5 bits are the binary prescaler value PRS. The ATD conversion clock frequency is calculated as follows:
f BUS f ATDCLK = -----------------------------------2 x ( PRS + 1 )
Refer to Device Specification for allowed frequency range of fATDCLK.
Table 9-13. Sample Time Select
SMP2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 SMP1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SMP0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Sample Time in Number of ATD Clock Cycles 4 6 8 10 12 16 20 24
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 315
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.3.2.6
ATD Control Register 5 (ATDCTL5)
Writes to this register will abort current conversion sequence and start a new conversion sequence. If external trigger is enabled (ETRIGE=1) an initial write to ATDCTL5 is required to allow starting of a conversion sequence which will then occur on each trigger event. Start of conversion means the beginning of the sampling phase.
Module Base + 0x0005
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 SC 0 0 SCAN 0 MULT 0 CD 0 CC 0 CB 0 CA 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-8. ATD Control Register 5 (ATDCTL5)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 9-14. ATDCTL5 Field Descriptions
Field 6 SC Description Special Channel Conversion Bit -- If this bit is set, then special channel conversion can be selected using CD, CC, CB and CA of ATDCTL5. Table 9-15 lists the coding. 0 Special channel conversions disabled 1 Special channel conversions enabled Continuous Conversion Sequence Mode -- This bit selects whether conversion sequences are performed continuously or only once. If external trigger is enabled (ETRIGE=1) setting this bit has no effect, that means external trigger always starts a single conversion sequence. 0 Single conversion sequence 1 Continuous conversion sequences (scan mode) Multi-Channel Sample Mode -- When MULT is 0, the ATD sequence controller samples only from the specified analog input channel for an entire conversion sequence. The analog channel is selected by channel selection code (control bits CD/CC/CB/CA located in ATDCTL5). When MULT is 1, the ATD sequence controller samples across channels. The number of channels sampled is determined by the sequence length value (S8C, S4C, S2C, S1C). The first analog channel examined is determined by channel selection code (CD, CC, CB, CA control bits); subsequent channels sampled in the sequence are determined by incrementing the channel selection code or wrapping around to AN0 (channel 0). 0 Sample only one channel 1 Sample across several channels Analog Input Channel Select Code -- These bits select the analog input channel(s) whose signals are sampled and converted to digital codes. Table 9-15 lists the coding used to select the various analog input channels. In the case of single channel conversions (MULT=0), this selection code specifies the channel to be examined. In the case of multiple channel conversions (MULT=1), this selection code specifies the first channel to be examined in the conversion sequence. Subsequent channels are determined by incrementing the channel selection code or wrapping around to AN0 (after converting the channel defined by the Wrap Around Channel Select Bits WRAP3-0 in ATDCTL0). In case of starting with a channel number higher than the one defined by WRAP3-0 the first wrap around will be AN9 to AN0.
5 SCAN
4 MULT
3-0 CD, CC, CB, CA
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 316 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Table 9-15. Analog Input Channel Select Coding
SC 0 CD 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 CC 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 X CB 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 X CA 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 X 0 1 0 1 X Analog Input Channel AN0 AN1 AN2 AN3 AN4 AN5 AN6 AN7 AN8 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 AN9 Reserved SPECIAL17 Reserved VRH VRL (VRH+VRL) / 2 Reserved Reserved
9.3.2.7
ATD Status Register 0 (ATDSTAT0)
This register contains the Sequence Complete Flag, overrun flags for external trigger and FIFO mode, and the conversion counter.
Module Base + 0x0006
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R SCF W Reset 0
0 ETORF 0 0 FIFOR 0
CC3
CC2
CC1
CC0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-9. ATD Status Register 0 (ATDSTAT0)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 317
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime (No effect on (CC3, CC2, CC1, CC0))
Table 9-16. ATDSTAT0 Field Descriptions
Field 7 SCF Description Sequence Complete Flag -- This flag is set upon completion of a conversion sequence. If conversion sequences are continuously performed (SCAN=1), the flag is set after each one is completed. This flag is cleared when one of the following occurs: A) Write "1" to SCF B) Write to ATDCTL5 (a new conversion sequence is started) C) If AFFC=1 and read of a result register 0 Conversion sequence not completed 1 Conversion sequence has completed External Trigger Overrun Flag -- While in edge trigger mode (ETRIGLE=0), if additional active edges are detected while a conversion sequence is in process the overrun flag is set. This flag is cleared when one of the following occurs: A) Write "1" to ETORF B) Write to ATDCTL0,1,2,3,4, ATDCMPE or ATDCMPHT (a conversion sequence is aborted) C) Write to ATDCTL5 (a new conversion sequence is started) 0 No External trigger over run error has occurred 1 External trigger over run error has occurred Result Register Over Run Flag -- This bit indicates that a result register has been written to before its associated conversion complete flag (CCF) has been cleared. This flag is most useful when using the FIFO mode because the flag potentially indicates that result registers are out of sync with the input channels. However, it is also practical for non-FIFO modes, and indicates that a result register has been over written before it has been read (i.e. the old data has been lost). This flag is cleared when one of the following occurs: A) Write "1" to FIFOR B) Write to ATDCTL0,1,2,3,4, ATDCMPE or ATDCMPHT (a conversion sequence is aborted) C) Write to ATDCTL5 (a new conversion sequence is started) 0 No over run has occurred 1 Overrun condition exists (result register has been written while associated CCFx flag was still set) Conversion Counter -- These 4 read-only bits are the binary value of the conversion counter. The conversion counter points to the result register that will receive the result of the current conversion. E.g. CC3=0, CC2=1, CC1=1, CC0=0 indicates that the result of the current conversion will be in ATD Result Register 6. If in non-FIFO mode (FIFO=0) the conversion counter is initialized to zero at the begin and end of the conversion sequence. If in FIFO mode (FIFO=1) the register counter is not initialized. The conversion counters wraps around when its maximum value is reached. Aborting a conversion or starting a new conversion clears the conversion counter even if FIFO=1.
5 ETORF
4 FIFOR
3-0 CC[3:0]
9.3.2.8
ATD Compare Enable Register (ATDCMPE)
Writes to this register will abort current conversion sequence. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 318 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Module Base + 0x0008
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0
CMPE[9:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-10. ATD Compare Enable Register (ATDCMPE) Table 9-17. ATDCMPE Field Descriptions
Field 9-0 CMPE[9:0] Description Compare Enable for Conversion Number n (n= 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0) of a Sequence (n conversion number, NOT channel number!) -- These bits enable automatic compare of conversion results individually for conversions of a sequence. The sense of each comparison is determined by the CMPHT[n] bit in the ATDCMPHT register. For each conversion number with CMPE[n]=1 do the following: 1) Write compare value to ATDDRn result register 2) Write compare operator with CMPHT[n] in ATDCPMHT register CCF[n] in ATDSTAT2 register will flag individual success of any comparison. 0 No automatic compare 1 Automatic compare of results for conversion n of a sequence is enabled.
9.3.2.9
ATD Status Register 2 (ATDSTAT2)
This read-only register contains the Conversion Complete Flags CCF[9:0].
Module Base + 0x000A
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0
CCF[9:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-11. ATD Status Register 2 (ATDSTAT2)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime, no effect
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 319
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
Table 9-18. ATDSTAT2 Field Descriptions
Field 9-0 CCF[9:0] Description Conversion Complete Flag n (n= 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0) (n conversion number, NOT channel number!)-- A conversion complete flag is set at the end of each conversion in a sequence. The flags are associated with the conversion position in a sequence (and also the result register number). Therefore in non-fifo mode, CCF[8] is set when the ninth conversion in a sequence is complete and the result is available in result register ATDDR8; CCF[9] is set when the tenth conversion in a sequence is complete and the result is available in ATDDR9, and so forth. If automatic compare of conversion results is enabled (CMPE[n]=1 in ATDCMPE), the conversion complete flag is only set if comparison with ATDDRn is true and if ACMPIE=1 a compare interrupt will be requested. In this case, as the ATDDRn result register is used to hold the compare value, the result will not be stored there at the end of the conversion but is lost. A flag CCF[n] is cleared when one of the following occurs: A) Write to ATDCTL5 (a new conversion sequence is started) B) If AFFC=0, write "1" to CCF[n] C) If AFFC=1 and CMPE[n]=0, read of result register ATDDRn D) If AFFC=1 and CMPE[n]=1, write to result register ATDDRn In case of a concurrent set and clear on CCF[n]: The clearing by method A) will overwrite the set. The clearing by methods B) or C) or D) will be overwritten by the set. 0 Conversion number n not completed or successfully compared 1 If (CMPE[n]=0): Conversion number n has completed. Result is ready in ATDDRn. If (CMPE[n]=1): Compare for conversion result number n with compare value in ATDDRn, using compare operator CMPGT[n] is true. (No result available in ATDDRn)
9.3.2.10
ATD Input Enable Register (ATDDIEN)
Module Base + 0x000C
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0
IEN[9:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-12. ATD Input Enable Register (ATDDIEN)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 9-19. ATDDIEN Field Descriptions
Field 9-0 IEN[9:0] Description ATD Digital Input Enable on channel x (x= 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0) -- This bit controls the digital input buffer from the analog input pin (ANx) to the digital data register. 0 Disable digital input buffer to ANx pin 1 Enable digital input buffer on ANx pin. Note: Setting this bit will enable the corresponding digital input buffer continuously. If this bit is set while simultaneously using it as an analog port, there is potentially increased power consumption because the digital input buffer maybe in the linear region.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 320 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.3.2.11
ATD Compare Higher Than Register (ATDCMPHT)
Writes to this register will abort current conversion sequence. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Module Base + 0x000E
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0
CMPHT[9:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-13. ATD Compare Higher Than Register (ATDCMPHT) Table 9-20. ATDCMPHT Field Descriptions
Field 9-0 CMPHT[9:0] Description Compare Operation Higher Than Enable for conversion number n (n= 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0) of a Sequence (n conversion number, NOT channel number!) -- This bit selects the operator for comparison of conversion results. 0 If result of conversion n is lower or same than compare value in ATDDRn, this is flagged in ATDSTAT2 1 If result of conversion n is higher than compare value in ATDDRn, this is flagged in ATDSTAT2
9.3.2.12
ATD Conversion Result Registers (ATDDRn)
The A/D conversion results are stored in 10 result registers. Results are always in unsigned data representation. Left and right justification is selected using the DJM control bit in ATDCTL3. If automatic compare of conversions results is enabled (CMPE[n]=1 in ATDCMPE), these registers must be written with the compare values in left or right justified format depending on the actual value of the DJM bit. In this case, as the ATDDRn register is used to hold the compare value, the result will not be stored there at the end of the conversion but is lost. Attention, n is the conversion number, NOT the channel number! Read: Anytime Write: Anytime NOTE For conversions not using automatic compare, results are stored in the result registers after each conversion. In this case avoid writing to ATDDRn except for initial values, because an A/D result might be overwritten.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 321
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.3.2.12.1
Left Justified Result Data (DJM=0)
Module Base + 0x0010 = ATDDR0, 0x0012 = ATDDR1, 0x0014 = ATDDR2, 0x0016 = ATDDR3 0x0018 = ATDDR4, 0x001A = ATDDR5, 0x001C = ATDDR6, 0x001E = ATDDR7 0x0020 = ATDDR8, 0x0022 = ATDDR9
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 0 0 0
Bit 8 0
Bit 7 0
Bit 6 0
Bit 5 0
Bit 4 0
Bit 3 0
Bit 2 0
Bit 1 0
Bit 0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-14. Left justified ATD conversion result register (ATDDRn)
9.3.2.12.2
Right Justified Result Data (DJM=1)
Module Base + 0x0010 = ATDDR0, 0x0012 = ATDDR1, 0x0014 = ATDDR2, 0x0016 = ATDDR3 0x0018 = ATDDR4, 0x001A = ATDDR5, 0x001C = ATDDR6, 0x001E = ATDDR7 0x0020 = ATDDR8, 0x0022 = ATDDR9
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 0 0 0
Bit 8 0
Bit 7 0
Bit 6 0
Bit 5 0
Bit 4 0
Bit 3 0
Bit 2 0
Bi1 1 0
Bit 0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 9-15. Right justified ATD conversion result register (ATDDRn)
Table 9-21 shows how depending on the A/D resolution the conversion result is transferred to the ATD result registers. Compare is always done using all 12 bits of both the conversion result and the compare value in ATDDRn.
Table 9-21. Conversion result mapping to ATDDRn
A/D resolution 8-bit data 8-bit data 10-bit data 10-bit data 12-bit data DJM 0 1 0 1 X conversion result mapping to
ATDDRn
Bit[11:4] = result, Bit[3:0]=0000 Bit[7:0] = result, Bit[11:8]=0000 Bit[11:2] = result, Bit[1:0]=00 Bit[9:0] = result, Bit[11:10]=00 Bit[11:0] = result
9.4
Functional Description
The ADC12B10C is structured into an analog sub-block and a digital sub-block.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 322 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.4.1
Analog Sub-Block
The analog sub-block contains all analog electronics required to perform a single conversion. Separate power supplies VDDA and VSSA allow to isolate noise of other MCU circuitry from the analog sub-block.
9.4.1.1
Sample and Hold Machine
The Sample and Hold (S/H) Machine accepts analog signals from the external world and stores them as capacitor charge on a storage node. During the sample process the analog input connects directly to the storage node. The input analog signals are unipolar and must fall within the potential range of VSSA to VDDA. During the hold process the analog input is disconnected from the storage node.
9.4.1.2
Analog Input Multiplexer
The analog input multiplexer connects one of the 10 external analog input channels to the sample and hold machine.
9.4.1.3
Analog-to-Digital (A/D) Machine
The A/D Machine performs analog to digital conversions. The resolution is program selectable at either 8 or 10 or 12 bits. The A/D machine uses a successive approximation architecture. It functions by comparing the stored analog sample potential with a series of digitally generated analog potentials. By following a binary search algorithm, the A/D machine locates the approximating potential that is nearest to the sampled potential. When not converting the A/D machine is automatically powered down. Only analog input signals within the potential range of VRL to VRH (A/D reference potentials) will result in a non-railed digital output code.
9.4.2
Digital Sub-Block
This subsection explains some of the digital features in more detail. See Section 9.3.2, "Register Descriptions" for all details.
9.4.2.1
External Trigger Input
The external trigger feature allows the user to synchronize ATD conversions to the external environment events rather than relying on software to signal the ATD module when ATD conversions are to take place. The external trigger signal (out of reset ATD channel 9, configurable in ATDCTL1) is programmable to
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 323
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
be edge or level sensitive with polarity control. Table 9-22 gives a brief description of the different combinations of control bits and their effect on the external trigger function.
Table 9-22. External Trigger Control Bits
ETRIGLE X X 0 0 1 1 ETRIGP X X 0 1 0 1 ETRIGE 0 0 1 1 1 1 SCAN 0 1 X X X X Description Ignores external trigger. Performs one conversion sequence and stops. Ignores external trigger. Performs continuous conversion sequences. Falling edge triggered. Performs one conversion sequence per trigger. Rising edge triggered. Performs one conversion sequence per trigger. Trigger active low. Performs continuous conversions while trigger is active. Trigger active high. Performs continuous conversions while trigger is active.
During a conversion, if additional active edges are detected the overrun error flag ETORF is set. In either level or edge triggered modes, the first conversion begins when the trigger is received. Once ETRIGE is enabled, conversions cannot be started by a write to ATDCTL5, but rather must be triggered externally. If the level mode is active and the external trigger both de-asserts and re-asserts itself during a conversion sequence, this does not constitute an overrun. Therefore, the flag is not set. If the trigger is left asserted in level mode while a sequence is completing, another sequence will be triggered immediately.
9.4.2.2
General-Purpose Digital Port Operation
The input channel pins can be multiplexed between analog and digital data. As analog inputs, they are multiplexed and sampled as analog channels to the A/D converter. The analog/digital multiplex operation is performed in the input pads. The input pad is always connected to the analog input channels of the ADC12B10C. The input pad signal is buffered to the digital port registers. This buffer can be turned on or off with the ATDDIEN register. This is important so that the buffer does not draw excess current when analog potentials are presented at its input.
9.5
Resets
At reset the ADC12B10C is in a power down state. The reset state of each individual bit is listed within the Register Description section (see Section 9.3.2, "Register Descriptions") which details the registers and their bit-field.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 324 Freescale Semiconductor
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
9.6
Interrupts
The interrupts requested by the ADC12B10C are listed in Table 9-23. Refer to MCU specification for related vector address and priority.
Table 9-23. ATD Interrupt Vectors
Interrupt Source Sequence Complete Interrupt Compare Interrupt CCR Mask I bit I bit Local Enable ASCIE in ATDCTL2 ACMPIE in ATDCTL2
See Section 9.3.2, "Register Descriptions" for further details.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 325
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC12B10CRev 00.05) Block Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 326 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 10 Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
10.1 Introduction
The pulse width modulation (PWM) definition is based on the HC12 PWM definitions. The PWM8B6CV1 module contains the basic features from the HC11 with some of the enhancements incorporated on the HC12, that is center aligned output mode and four available clock sources. The PWM8B6CV1 module has six channels with independent control of left and center aligned outputs on each channel. Each of the six PWM channels has a programmable period and duty cycle as well as a dedicated counter. A flexible clock select scheme allows a total of four different clock sources to be used with the counters. Each of the modulators can create independent continuous waveforms with software-selectable duty rates from 0% to 100%. The PWM outputs can be programmed as left aligned outputs or center aligned outputs
10.1.1
* * * * * * * * * *
Features
Six independent PWM channels with programmable period and duty cycle Dedicated counter for each PWM channel Programmable PWM enable/disable for each channel Software selection of PWM duty pulse polarity for each channel Period and duty cycle are double buffered. Change takes effect when the end of the effective period is reached (PWM counter reaches 0) or when the channel is disabled. Programmable center or left aligned outputs on individual channels Six 8-bit channel or three 16-bit channel PWM resolution Four clock sources (A, B, SA, and SB) provide for a wide range of frequencies. Programmable clock select logic Emergency shutdown
10.1.2
Modes of Operation
There is a software programmable option for low power consumption in wait mode that disables the input clock to the prescaler. In freeze mode there is a software programmable option to disable the input clock to the prescaler. This is useful for emulation.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 327
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
10.1.3
Block Diagram
PWM8B6C
PWM Channels Channel 5 Bus Clock Clock Select PWM Clock Period and Duty Counter PWM5
Channel 4 Period and Duty Control Channel 3 Period and Duty Counter Counter
PWM4
PWM3
Channel 2 Enable Period and Duty Counter
PWM2
Polarity
Channel 1 Period and Duty Counter
PWM1
Alignment
Channel 0 Period and Duty Counter
PWM0
Figure 10-1. PWM8B6CV1 Block Diagram
10.2
External Signal Description
The PWM8B6CV1 module has a total of six external pins.
10.2.1
PWM5 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 5 Pin
This pin serves as waveform output of PWM channel 5 and as an input for the emergency shutdown feature.
10.2.2
PWM4 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 4 Pin
This pin serves as waveform output of PWM channel 4.
10.2.3
PWM3 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 3 Pin
This pin serves as waveform output of PWM channel 3.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 328 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
10.2.4
PWM2 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 2 Pin
This pin serves as waveform output of PWM channel 2.
10.2.5
PWM1 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 1 Pin
This pin serves as waveform output of PWM channel 1.
10.2.6
PWM0 -- Pulse Width Modulator Channel 0 Pin
This pin serves as waveform output of PWM channel 0.
10.3
Memory Map and Register Definition
This subsection describes in detail all the registers and register bits in the PWM8B6CV1 module. The special-purpose registers and register bit functions that would not normally be made available to device end users, such as factory test control registers and reserved registers are clearly identified by means of shading the appropriate portions of address maps and register diagrams. Notes explaining the reasons for restricting access to the registers and functions are also explained in the individual register descriptions.
10.3.1
Module Memory Map
The following paragraphs describe the content of the registers in the PWM8B6CV1 module. The base address of the PWM8B6CV1 module is determined at the MCU level when the MCU is defined. The register decode map is fixed and begins at the first address of the module address offset. Table 10-1 shows the registers associated with the PWM and their relative offset from the base address. The register detail description follows the order in which they appear in the register map. Reserved bits within a register will always read as 0 and the write will be unimplemented. Unimplemented functions are indicated by shading the bit. Table 10-1 shows the memory map for the PWM8B6CV1 module. NOTE Register address = base address + address offset, where the base address is defined at the MCU level and the address offset is defined at the module level.
Table 10-1. PWM8B6CV1 Memory Map
Address Offset 0x0000 0x0001 0x0002 0x0003 0x0004 PWM Enable Register (PWME) PWM Polarity Register (PWMPOL) PWM Clock Select Register (PWMCLK) PWM Prescale Clock Select Register (PWMPRCLK) PWM Center Align Enable Register (PWMCAE) Register Access R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 329
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Table 10-1. PWM8B6CV1 Memory Map
0x0005 0x0006 0x0007 0x0008 0x0009 0x000A 0x000B 0x000C 0x000D 0x000E 0x000F 0x0010 0x0011 0x0012 0x0013 0x0014 0x0015 0x0016 0x0017 0x0018 0x0019 0x001A 0x001B 0x001C 0x001D PWM Control Register (PWMCTL) PWM Test Register (PWMTST)
(1) (2)
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
(3) (4)
PWM Prescale Counter Register (PWMPRSC) PWM Scale A Register (PWMSCLA) PWM Scale B Register (PWMSCLB)
PWM Scale A Counter Register (PWMSCNTA)
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
PWM Scale B Counter Register (PWMSCNTB)
PWM Channel 0 Counter Register (PWMCNT0) PWM Channel 1 Counter Register (PWMCNT1) PWM Channel 2 Counter Register (PWMCNT2) PWM Channel 3 Counter Register (PWMCNT3) PWM Channel 4 Counter Register (PWMCNT4) PWM Channel 5 Counter Register (PWMCNT5) PWM Channel 0 Period Register (PWMPER0) PWM Channel 1 Period Register (PWMPER1) PWM Channel 2 Period Register (PWMPER2) PWM Channel 3 Period Register (PWMPER3) PWM Channel 4 Period Register (PWMPER4) PWM Channel 5 Period Register (PWMPER5) PWM Channel 0 Duty Register (PWMDTY0) PWM Channel 1 Duty Register (PWMDTY1) PWM Channel 2 Duty Register (PWMDTY2) PWM Channel 3 Duty Register (PWMDTY3) PWM Channel 4 Duty Register (PWMDTY4) PWM Channel 5 Duty Register (PWMDTY5)
0x001E PWM Shutdown Register (PWMSDN) 1. PWMTST is intended for factory test purposes only. 2. PWMPRSC is intended for factory test purposes only. 3. PWMSCNTA is intended for factory test purposes only. 4. PWMSCNTB is intended for factory test purposes only.
10.3.2
Register Descriptions
The following paragraphs describe in detail all the registers and register bits in the PWM8B6CV1 module.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 330 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Register Name 0x0000 PWME 0x0001 PWMPOL 0x0002 PWMCLK 0x0003 PWMPRCLK 0x0004 PWMCAE 0x0005 PWMCTL 0x0006 PWMTST 0x0007 PWMPRSC 0x0008 PWMSCLA 0x0009 PWMSCLB 0x000A PWMSCNTA 0x000B PWMSCNTB 0x000C PWMCNT0 0x000D PWMCNT1 0x000E PWMCNT2 0x000F PWMCNT3 R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
Bit 7 0
6 0
5 PWME5
4 PWME4
3 PWME3
2 PWME2
1 PWME1
Bit 0 PWME0
0
0
PPOL5
PPOL4
PPOL3
PPOL2
PPOL1
PPOL0
0
0
PCLK5
PCLK4
PCLK3 0
PCLK2
PCLK1
PCLK0
0
PCKB2 0
PCKB1
PCKB0
PCKA2
PCKA1
PCKA0
0
CAE5
CAE4
CAE2
CAE2
CAE1 0
CAE0 0
0
CON45 0
CON23 0
CON01 0
PSWAI 0
PFRZ 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7 0
6 0
5 0
4 0
3 0
2 0
1 0
Bit 0 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0
6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0
5 0 5 0 5 0 5 0
4 0 4 0 4 0 4 0
3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0
2 0 2 0 2 0 2 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-2. PWM Register Summary
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 331
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Register Name 0x0010 PWMCNT4 0x0011 PWMCNT5 0x0012 PWMPER0 0x0013 PWMPER1 0x0014 PWMPER2 0x0015 PWMPER3 0x0016 PWMPER4 0x0017 PWMPER5 0x0018 PWMDTY0 0x0019 PWMDTY1 0x001A PWMDTY2 0x001B PWMDTY3 0x001C PWMDTY4 0x001D PWMDTY5 0x001E PWMSDB R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
Bit 7 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7
6 6 0 6 0 6
5 5 0 5 0 5
4 4 0 4 0 4
3 3 0 3 0 3
2 2 0 2 0 2
1 1 0 1 0 1
Bit 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5 0 PWMRSTRT
4
3 0
2 PWM5IN
1
Bit 0
PWMIF
PWMIE
PWMLVL
PWM5INL PWM5ENA
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-2. PWM Register Summary (continued)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 332 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
10.3.2.1
PWM Enable Register (PWME)
Each PWM channel has an enable bit (PWMEx) to start its waveform output. When any of the PWMEx bits are set (PWMEx = 1), the associated PWM output is enabled immediately. However, the actual PWM waveform is not available on the associated PWM output until its clock source begins its next cycle due to the synchronization of PWMEx and the clock source. NOTE The first PWM cycle after enabling the channel can be irregular. An exception to this is when channels are concatenated. After concatenated mode is enabled (CONxx bits set in PWMCTL register), enabling/disabling the corresponding 16-bit PWM channel is controlled by the low-order PWMEx bit. In this case, the high-order bytes PWMEx bits have no effect and their corresponding PWM output lines are disabled. While in run mode, if all six PWM channels are disabled (PWME5-PWME0 = 0), the prescaler counter shuts off for power savings.
Module Base + 0x0000
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0 PWME5 PWME4 0 PWME3 0 PWME2 0 PWME1 0 PWME0 0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-3. PWM Enable Register (PWME)
Read: anytime Write: anytime
Table 10-2. PWME Field Descriptions
Field 5 PWME5 Description Pulse Width Channel 5 Enable 0 Pulse width channel 5 is disabled. 1 Pulse width channel 5 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM,output bit 5 when its clock source begins its next cycle. Pulse Width Channel 4 Enable 0 Pulse width channel 4 is disabled. 1 Pulse width channel 4 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 4 when its clock source begins its next cycle. If CON45 = 1, then bit has no effect and PWM output line 4 is disabled. Pulse Width Channel 3 Enable 0 Pulse width channel 3 is disabled. 1 Pulse width channel 3 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 3 when its clock source begins its next cycle. Pulse Width Channel 2 Enable 0 Pulse width channel 2 is disabled. 1 Pulse width channel 2 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 2 when its clock source begins its next cycle. If CON23 = 1, then bit has no effect and PWM output line 2 is disabled.
4 PWME4
3 PWME3
2 PWME2
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 333
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Table 10-2. PWME Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 PWME1 Description Pulse Width Channel 1 Enable 0 Pulse width channel 1 is disabled. 1 Pulse width channel 1 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 1 when its clock source begins its next cycle. Pulse Width Channel 0 Enable 0 Pulse width channel 0 is disabled. 1 Pulse width channel 0 is enabled. The pulse modulated signal becomes available at PWM, output bit 0 when its clock source begins its next cycle. If CON01 = 1, then bit has no effect and PWM output line 0 is disabled.
0 PWME0
10.3.2.2
PWM Polarity Register (PWMPOL)
The starting polarity of each PWM channel waveform is determined by the associated PPOLx bit in the PWMPOL register. If the polarity bit is 1, the PWM channel output is high at the beginning of the cycle and then goes low when the duty count is reached. Conversely, if the polarity bit is 0 the output starts low and then goes high when the duty count is reached.
Module Base + 0x0001
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0 PPOL5 PPOL4 0 PPOL3 0 PPOL2 0 PPOL1 0 PPOL0 0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-4. PWM Polarity Register (PWMPOL)
Read: anytime Write: anytime NOTE PPOLx register bits can be written anytime. If the polarity is changed while a PWM signal is being generated, a truncated or stretched pulse can occur during the transition
Table 10-3. PWMPOL Field Descriptions
Field 5 PPOL5 4 PPOL4 Description Pulse Width Channel 5 Polarity 0 PWM channel 5 output is low at the beginning of the period, then goes high when the duty count is reached. 1 PWM channel 5 output is high at the beginning of the period, then goes low when the duty count is reached. Pulse Width Channel 4 Polarity 0 PWM channel 4 output is low at the beginning of the period, then goes high when the duty count is reached. 1 PWM channel 4 output is high at the beginning of the period, then goes low when the duty count is reached.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 334 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Table 10-3. PWMPOL Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 3 PPOL3 2 PPOL2 1 PPOL1 0 PPOL0 Description Pulse Width Channel 3 Polarity 0 PWM channel 3 output is low at the beginning of the period, then goes high when the duty count is reached. 1 PWM channel 3 output is high at the beginning of the period, then goes low when the duty count is reached. Pulse Width Channel 2 Polarity 0 PWM channel 2 output is low at the beginning of the period, then goes high when the duty count is reached. 1 PWM channel 2 output is high at the beginning of the period, then goes low when the duty count is reached. Pulse Width Channel 1 Polarity 0 PWM channel 1 output is low at the beginning of the period, then goes high when the duty count is reached. 1 PWM channel 1 output is high at the beginning of the period, then goes low when the duty count is reached. Pulse Width Channel 0 Polarity 0 PWM channel 0 output is low at the beginning of the period, then goes high when the duty count is reached 1 PWM channel 0 output is high at the beginning of the period, then goes low when the duty count is reached.
10.3.2.3
PWM Clock Select Register (PWMCLK)
Each PWM channel has a choice of two clocks to use as the clock source for that channel as described below.
Module Base + 0x0002
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0 PCLK5 PCLK4 0 PCLK3 0 PCLK2 0 PCLK1 0 PCLK0 0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-5. PWM Clock Select Register (PWMCLK)
Read: anytime Write: anytime NOTE Register bits PCLK0 to PCLK5 can be written anytime. If a clock select is changed while a PWM signal is being generated, a truncated or stretched pulse can occur during the transition.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 335
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Table 10-4. PWMCLK Field Descriptions
Field 5 PCLK5 4 PCLK4 3 PCLK3 2 PCLK2 1 PCLK1 0 PCLK0 Description Pulse Width Channel 5 Clock Select 0 Clock A is the clock source for PWM channel 5. 1 Clock SA is the clock source for PWM channel 5. Pulse Width Channel 4 Clock Select 0 Clock A is the clock source for PWM channel 4. 1 Clock SA is the clock source for PWM channel 4. Pulse Width Channel 3 Clock Select 0 Clock B is the clock source for PWM channel 3. 1 Clock SB is the clock source for PWM channel 3. Pulse Width Channel 2 Clock Select 0 Clock B is the clock source for PWM channel 2. 1 Clock SB is the clock source for PWM channel 2. Pulse Width Channel 1 Clock Select 0 Clock A is the clock source for PWM channel 1. 1 Clock SA is the clock source for PWM channel 1. Pulse Width Channel 0 Clock Select 0 Clock A is the clock source for PWM channel 0. 1 Clock SA is the clock source for PWM channel 0.
10.3.2.4
PWM Prescale Clock Select Register (PWMPRCLK)
This register selects the prescale clock source for clocks A and B independently.
Module Base + 0x0003
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 PCKB2 0 0 PCKB1 0 PCKB0 0
0 PCKA2 0 0 PCKA1 0 PCKA0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-6. PWM Prescaler Clock Select Register (PWMPRCLK)
Read: anytime Write: anytime NOTE PCKB2-PCKB0 and PCKA2-PCKA0 register bits can be written anytime. If the clock prescale is changed while a PWM signal is being generated, a truncated or stretched pulse can occur during the transition.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 336 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Table 10-5. PWMPRCLK Field Descriptions
Field 6:5 PCKB[2:0] 2:0 PCKA[2:0] Description Prescaler Select for Clock B -- Clock B is 1 of two clock sources which can be used for channels 2 or 3. These three bits determine the rate of clock B, as shown in Table 10-6. Prescaler Select for Clock A -- Clock A is 1 of two clock sources which can be used for channels 0, 1, 4, or 5. These three bits determine the rate of clock A, as shown in Table 10-7.
Table 10-6. Clock B Prescaler Selects
PCKB2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PCKB1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 PCKB0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Value of Clock B Bus Clock Bus Clock / 2 Bus Clock / 4 Bus Clock / 8 Bus Clock / 16 Bus Clock / 32 Bus Clock / 64 Bus Clock / 128
Table 10-7. Clock A Prescaler Selects
PCKA2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PCKA1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 PCKA0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Value of Clock A Bus Clock Bus Clock / 2 Bus Clock / 4 Bus Clock / 8 Bus Clock / 16 Bus Clock / 32 Bus Clock / 64 Bus Clock / 128
10.3.2.5
PWM Center Align Enable Register (PWMCAE)
The PWMCAE register contains six control bits for the selection of center aligned outputs or left aligned outputs for each PWM channel. If the CAEx bit is set to a 1, the corresponding PWM output will be center aligned. If the CAEx bit is cleared, the corresponding PWM output will be left aligned. Reference Section 10.4.2.5, "Left Aligned Outputs," and Section 10.4.2.6, "Center Aligned Outputs," for a more detailed description of the PWM output modes.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 337
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Module Base + 0x0004
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0 CAE5 CAE4 0 CAE3 0 CAE2 0 CAE1 0 CAE0 0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-7. PWM Center Align Enable Register (PWMCAE)
Read: anytime Write: anytime NOTE Write these bits only when the corresponding channel is disabled.
Table 10-8. PWMCAE Field Descriptions
Field 5 CAE5 4 CAE4 3 CAE3 2 CAE2 1 CAE1 0 CAE0 Description Center Aligned Output Mode on Channel 5 0 Channel 5 operates in left aligned output mode. 1 Channel 5 operates in center aligned output mode. Center Aligned Output Mode on Channel 4 0 Channel 4 operates in left aligned output mode. 1 Channel 4 operates in center aligned output mode. Center Aligned Output Mode on Channel 3 1 Channel 3 operates in left aligned output mode. 1 Channel 3 operates in center aligned output mode. Center Aligned Output Mode on Channel 2 0 Channel 2 operates in left aligned output mode. 1 Channel 2 operates in center aligned output mode. Center Aligned Output Mode on Channel 1 0 Channel 1 operates in left aligned output mode. 1 Channel 1 operates in center aligned output mode. Center Aligned Output Mode on Channel 0 0 Channel 0 operates in left aligned output mode. 1 Channel 0 operates in center aligned output mode.
10.3.2.6
PWM Control Register (PWMCTL)
The PWMCTL register provides for various control of the PWM module.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 338 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Module Base + 0x0005
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 CON45 0 0 CON23 0 CON01 0 PSWAI 0 PFRZ 0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-8. PWM Control Register (PWMCTL)
Read: anytime Write: anytime There are three control bits for concatenation, each of which is used to concatenate a pair of PWM channels into one 16-bit channel. When channels 4 and 5 are concatenated, channel 4 registers become the high-order bytes of the double-byte channel. When channels 2 and 3 are concatenated, channel 2 registers become the high-order bytes of the double-byte channel. When channels 0 and 1 are concatenated, channel 0 registers become the high-order bytes of the double-byte channel. Reference Section 10.4.2.7, "PWM 16-Bit Functions," for a more detailed description of the concatenation PWM function. NOTE Change these bits only when both corresponding channels are disabled.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 339
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Table 10-9. PWMCTL Field Descriptions
Field 6 CON45 Description Concatenate Channels 4 and 5 0 Channels 4 and 5 are separate 8-bit PWMs. 1 Channels 4 and 5 are concatenated to create one 16-bit PWM channel. Channel 4 becomes the high-order byte and channel 5 becomes the low-order byte. Channel 5 output pin is used as the output for this 16-bit PWM (bit 5 of port PWMP). Channel 5 clock select control bit determines the clock source, channel 5 polarity bit determines the polarity, channel 5 enable bit enables the output and channel 5 center aligned enable bit determines the output mode. Concatenate Channels 2 and 3 0 Channels 2 and 3 are separate 8-bit PWMs. 1 Channels 2 and 3 are concatenated to create one 16-bit PWM channel. Channel 2 becomes the high-order byte and channel 3 becomes the low-order byte. Channel 3 output pin is used as the output for this 16-bit PWM (bit 3 of port PWMP). Channel 3 clock select control bit determines the clock source, channel 3 polarity bit determines the polarity, channel 3 enable bit enables the output and channel 3 center aligned enable bit determines the output mode. Concatenate Channels 0 and 1 0 Channels 0 and 1 are separate 8-bit PWMs. 1 Channels 0 and 1 are concatenated to create one 16-bit PWM channel. Channel 0 becomes the high-order byte and channel 1 becomes the low-order byte. Channel 1 output pin is used as the output for this 16-bit PWM (bit 1 of port PWMP). Channel 1 clock select control bit determines the clock source, channel 1 polarity bit determines the polarity, channel 1 enable bit enables the output and channel 1 center aligned enable bit determines the output mode. PWM Stops in Wait Mode -- Enabling this bit allows for lower power consumption in wait mode by disabling the input clock to the prescaler. 0 Allow the clock to the prescaler to continue while in wait mode. 1 Stop the input clock to the prescaler whenever the MCU is in wait mode. PWM Counters Stop in Freeze Mode -- In freeze mode, there is an option to disable the input clock to the prescaler by setting the PFRZ bit in the PWMCTL register. If this bit is set, whenever the MCU is in freeze mode the input clock to the prescaler is disabled. This feature is useful during emulation as it allows the PWM function to be suspended. In this way, the counters of the PWM can be stopped while in freeze mode so that after normal program flow is continued, the counters are re-enabled to simulate real-time operations. Because the registers remain accessible in this mode, to re-enable the prescaler clock, either disable the PFRZ bit or exit freeze mode. 0 Allow PWM to continue while in freeze mode. 1 Disable PWM input clock to the prescaler whenever the part is in freeze mode. This is useful for emulation.
5 CON23
4 CON01
3 PSWAI
2 PFRZ
10.3.2.7
Reserved Register (PWMTST)
This register is reserved for factory testing of the PWM module and is not available in normal modes.
Module Base + 0x0006
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-9. Reserved Register (PWMTST)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 340 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Read: always read 0x0000 in normal modes Write: unimplemented in normal modes NOTE Writing to this register when in special modes can alter the PWM functionality.
10.3.2.8
Reserved Register (PWMPRSC)
This register is reserved for factory testing of the PWM module and is not available in normal modes.
Module Base + 0x0007
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-10. Reserved Register (PWMPRSC)
Read: always read 0x0000 in normal modes Write: unimplemented in normal modes NOTE Writing to this register when in special modes can alter the PWM functionality.
10.3.2.9
PWM Scale A Register (PWMSCLA)
PWMSCLA is the programmable scale value used in scaling clock A to generate clock SA. Clock SA is generated by taking clock A, dividing it by the value in the PWMSCLA register and dividing that by two. Clock SA = Clock A / (2 * PWMSCLA) NOTE When PWMSCLA = 0x0000, PWMSCLA value is considered a full scale value of 256. Clock A is thus divided by 512. Any value written to this register will cause the scale counter to load the new scale value (PWMSCLA).
Module Base + 0x0008
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-11. PWM Scale A Register (PWMSCLA)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 341
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Read: anytime Write: anytime (causes the scale counter to load the PWMSCLA value)
10.3.2.10 PWM Scale B Register (PWMSCLB)
PWMSCLB is the programmable scale value used in scaling clock B to generate clock SB. Clock SB is generated by taking clock B, dividing it by the value in the PWMSCLB register and dividing that by two. Clock SB = Clock B / (2 * PWMSCLB) NOTE When PWMSCLB = 0x0000, PWMSCLB value is considered a full scale value of 256. Clock B is thus divided by 512. Any value written to this register will cause the scale counter to load the new scale value (PWMSCLB).
Module Base + 0x0009
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-12. PWM Scale B Register (PWMSCLB)
Read: anytime Write: anytime (causes the scale counter to load the PWMSCLB value).
10.3.2.11 Reserved Registers (PWMSCNTx)
The registers PWMSCNTA and PWMSCNTB are reserved for factory testing of the PWM module and are not available in normal modes.
Module Base + 0x000A
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-13. Reserved Register (PWMSCNTA)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 342 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Module Base + 0x000B
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-14. Reserved Register (PWMSCNTB)
Read: always read 0x0000 in normal modes Write: unimplemented in normal modes NOTE Writing to these registers when in special modes can alter the PWM functionality.
10.3.2.12 PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNTx)
Each channel has a dedicated 8-bit up/down counter which runs at the rate of the selected clock source. The counter can be read at any time without affecting the count or the operation of the PWM channel. In left aligned output mode, the counter counts from 0 to the value in the period register - 1. In center aligned output mode, the counter counts from 0 up to the value in the period register and then back down to 0. Any value written to the counter causes the counter to reset to 0x0000, the counter direction to be set to up, the immediate load of both duty and period registers with values from the buffers, and the output to change according to the polarity bit. The counter is also cleared at the end of the effective period (see Section 10.4.2.5, "Left Aligned Outputs," and Section 10.4.2.6, "Center Aligned Outputs," for more details). When the channel is disabled (PWMEx = 0), the PWMCNTx register does not count. When a channel becomes enabled (PWMEx = 1), the associated PWM counter starts at the count in the PWMCNTx register. For more detailed information on the operation of the counters, reference Section 10.4.2.4, "PWM Timer Counters." In concatenated mode, writes to the 16-bit counter by using a 16-bit access or writes to either the low- or high-order byte of the counter will reset the 16-bit counter. Reads of the 16-bit counter must be made by 16-bit access to maintain data coherency. NOTE Writing to the counter while the channel is enabled can cause an irregular PWM cycle to occur.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 343
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Module Base + 0x000C
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0 0
6 0 0
5 0 0
4 0 0
3 0 0
2 0 0
1 0 0
Bit 0 0 0
Figure 10-15. PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNT0)
Module Base + 0x000D
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0 0
6 0 0
5 0 0
4 0 0
3 0 0
2 0 0
1 0 0
Bit 0 0 0
Figure 10-16. PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNT1)
Module Base + 0x000E
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0 0
6 0 0
5 0 0
4 0 0
3 0 0
2 0 0
1 0 0
Bit 0 0 0
Figure 10-17. PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNT2)
Module Base + 0x000F
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0 0
6 0 0
5 0 0
4 0 0
3 0 0
2 0 0
1 0 0
Bit 0 0 0
Figure 10-18. PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNT3)
Module Base + 0x00010
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0 0
6 0 0
5 0 0
4 0 0
3 0 0
2 0 0
1 0 0
Bit 0 0 0
Figure 10-19. PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNT4)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 344 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Module Base + 0x00011
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
Bit 7 0 0
6 0 0
5 0 0
4 0 0
3 0 0
2 0 0
1 0 0
Bit 0 0 0
Figure 10-20. PWM Channel Counter Registers (PWMCNT5)
Read: anytime Write: anytime (any value written causes PWM counter to be reset to 0x0000).
10.3.2.13 PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPERx)
There is a dedicated period register for each channel. The value in this register determines the period of the associated PWM channel. The period registers for each channel are double buffered so that if they change while the channel is enabled, the change will NOT take effect until one of the following occurs: * The effective period ends * The counter is written (counter resets to 0x0000) * The channel is disabled In this way, the output of the PWM will always be either the old waveform or the new waveform, not some variation in between. If the channel is not enabled, then writes to the period register will go directly to the latches as well as the buffer. NOTE Reads of this register return the most recent value written. Reads do not necessarily return the value of the currently active period due to the double buffering scheme. Reference Section 10.4.2.3, "PWM Period and Duty," for more information. To calculate the output period, take the selected clock source period for the channel of interest (A, B, SA, or SB) and multiply it by the value in the period register for that channel: * Left aligned output (CAEx = 0) * PWMx period = channel clock period * PWMPERx center aligned output (CAEx = 1) * PWMx period = channel clock period * (2 * PWMPERx) For boundary case programming values, please refer to Section 10.4.2.8, "PWM Boundary Cases."
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 345
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Module Base + 0x0012
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-21. PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPER0)
Module Base + 0x0013
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-22. PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPER1)
Module Base + 0x0014
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-23. PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPER2)
Module Base + 0x0015
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-24. PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPER3)
Module Base + 0x0016
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-25. PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPER4)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 346 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Module Base + 0x0017
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-26. PWM Channel Period Registers (PWMPER5)
Read: anytime Write: anytime
10.3.2.14 PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTYx)
There is a dedicated duty register for each channel. The value in this register determines the duty of the associated PWM channel. The duty value is compared to the counter and if it is equal to the counter value a match occurs and the output changes state. The duty registers for each channel are double buffered so that if they change while the channel is enabled, the change will NOT take effect until one of the following occurs: * The effective period ends * The counter is written (counter resets to 0x0000) * The channel is disabled In this way, the output of the PWM will always be either the old duty waveform or the new duty waveform, not some variation in between. If the channel is not enabled, then writes to the duty register will go directly to the latches as well as the buffer. NOTE Reads of this register return the most recent value written. Reads do not necessarily return the value of the currently active duty due to the double buffering scheme. Reference Section 10.4.2.3, "PWM Period and Duty," for more information. NOTE Depending on the polarity bit, the duty registers will contain the count of either the high time or the low time. If the polarity bit is 1, the output starts high and then goes low when the duty count is reached, so the duty registers contain a count of the high time. If the polarity bit is 0, the output starts low and then goes high when the duty count is reached, so the duty registers contain a count of the low time. To calculate the output duty cycle (high time as a % of period) for a particular channel: * Polarity = 0 (PPOLx = 0) Duty cycle = [(PWMPERx PWMDTYx)/PWMPERx] * 100% * Polarity = 1 (PPOLx = 1) Duty cycle = [PWMDTYx / PWMPERx] * 100%
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 347
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
*
For boundary case programming values, please refer to Section 10.4.2.8, "PWM Boundary Cases."
Module Base + 0x0018
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-27. PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTY0)
Module Base + 0x0019
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-28. PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTY1)
Module Base + 0x001A
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-29. PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTY2)
Module Base + 0x001B
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-30. PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTY3)
Module Base + 0x001C
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-31. PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTY4)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 348 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Module Base + 0x001D
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
Figure 10-32. PWM Channel Duty Registers (PWMDTY5)
Read: anytime Write: anytime
10.3.2.15 PWM Shutdown Register (PWMSDN)
The PWMSDN register provides for the shutdown functionality of the PWM module in the emergency cases.
Module Base + 0x00E
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R PWMIF W Reset 0 0 PWMIE
0 PWMLVL PWMRSTRT 0 0
0
PWM5IN PWM5INL PWM5ENA 0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 10-33. PWM Shutdown Register (PWMSDN)
Read: anytime Write: anytime
Table 10-10. PWMSDN Field Descriptions
Field 7 PWMIF Description PWM Interrupt Flag -- Any change from passive to asserted (active) state or from active to passive state will be flagged by setting the PWMIF flag = 1. The flag is cleared by writing a logic 1 to it. Writing a 0 has no effect. 0 No change on PWM5IN input. 1 Change on PWM5IN input PWM Interrupt Enable -- If interrupt is enabled an interrupt to the CPU is asserted. 0 PWM interrupt is disabled. 1 PWM interrupt is enabled.
6 PWMIE
5 PWM Restart -- The PWM can only be restarted if the PWM channel input 5 is deasserted. After writing a logic 1 PWMRSTRT to the PWMRSTRT bit (trigger event) the PWM channels start running after the corresponding counter passes next "counter = 0" phase. Also, if the PWM5ENA bit is reset to 0, the PWM do not start before the counter passes 0x0000. The bit is always read as 0. 4 PWMLVL PWM Shutdown Output Level -- If active level as defined by the PWM5IN input, gets asserted all enabled PWM channels are immediately driven to the level defined by PWMLVL. 0 PWM outputs are forced to 0 1 PWM outputs are forced to 1.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 349
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Table 10-10. PWMSDN Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 2 PWM5IN 1 PWM5INL Description PWM Channel 5 Input Status -- This reflects the current status of the PWM5 pin. PWM Shutdown Active Input Level for Channel 5 -- If the emergency shutdown feature is enabled (PWM5ENA = 1), this bit determines the active level of the PWM5 channel. 0 Active level is low 1 Active level is high
0 PWM Emergency Shutdown Enable -- If this bit is logic 1 the pin associated with channel 5 is forced to input PWM5ENA and the emergency shutdown feature is enabled. All the other bits in this register are meaningful only if PWM5ENA = 1. 0 PWM emergency feature disabled. 1 PWM emergency feature is enabled.
10.4
10.4.1
Functional Description
PWM Clock Select
There are four available clocks called clock A, clock B, clock SA (scaled A), and clock SB (scaled B). These four clocks are based on the bus clock. Clock A and B can be software selected to be 1, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8,..., 1/64, 1/128 times the bus clock. Clock SA uses clock A as an input and divides it further with a reloadable counter. Similarly, clock SB uses clock B as an input and divides it further with a reloadable counter. The rates available for clock SA are software selectable to be clock A divided by 2, 4, 6, 8, ..., or 512 in increments of divide by 2. Similar rates are available for clock SB. Each PWM channel has the capability of selecting one of two clocks, either the pre-scaled clock (clock A or B) or the scaled clock (clock SA or SB). The block diagram in Figure 10-34 shows the four different clocks and how the scaled clocks are created.
10.4.1.1
Prescale
The input clock to the PWM prescaler is the bus clock. It can be disabled whenever the part is in freeze mode by setting the PFRZ bit in the PWMCTL register. If this bit is set, whenever the MCU is in freeze mode the input clock to the prescaler is disabled. This is useful for emulation in order to freeze the PWM. The input clock can also be disabled when all six PWM channels are disabled (PWME5-PWME0 = 0) This is useful for reducing power by disabling the prescale counter. Clock A and clock B are scaled values of the input clock. The value is software selectable for both clock A and clock B and has options of 1, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, or 1/128 times the bus clock. The value selected for clock A is determined by the PCKA2, PCKA1, and PCKA0 bits in the PWMPRCLK register. The value selected for clock B is determined by the PCKB2, PCKB1, and PCKB0 bits also in the PWMPRCLK register.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 350 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Clock A
M U X PCLK0
Clock to PWM Ch 0
Clock A/2, A/4, A/6,....A/512 PCKA2 PCKA1 PCKA0 Count = 1 Load PWMSCLA M U X PCLK2 M U X PCLK3 Clock B M U X PCLK4 8-Bit Down Counter Count = 1 Load PWMSCLB DIV 2 Clock SB M U X PCLK5 Clock to PWM Ch 5 Clock to PWM Ch 4 Clock to PWM Ch 3 DIV 2 Clock SA
8-Bit Down Counter
M U X PCLK1 M U X
Clock to PWM Ch 1
Clock to PWM Ch 2
Divide by Prescaler Taps:
4
8 16 32 64 128
Clock B/2, B/4, B/6,....B/512 M U X
2
Bus Clock PFRZ FREEZE
PWME5:0
PRESCALE
PCKB2 PCKB1 PCKB0
SCALE
CLOCK SELECT
Figure 10-34. PWM Clock Select Block Diagram
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 351
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
10.4.1.2
Clock Scale
The scaled A clock uses clock A as an input and divides it further with a user programmable value and then divides this by 2. The scaled B clock uses clock B as an input and divides it further with a user programmable value and then divides this by 2. The rates available for clock SA are software selectable to be clock A divided by 2, 4, 6, 8, ..., or 512 in increments of divide by 2. Similar rates are available for clock SB. Clock A is used as an input to an 8-bit down counter. This down counter loads a user programmable scale value from the scale register (PWMSCLA). When the down counter reaches 1, two things happen; a pulse is output and the 8-bit counter is re-loaded. The output signal from this circuit is further divided by two. This gives a greater range with only a slight reduction in granularity. Clock SA equals clock A divided by two times the value in the PWMSCLA register. NOTE Clock SA = Clock A / (2 * PWMSCLA) When PWMSCLA = 0x0000, PWMSCLA value is considered a full scale value of 256. Clock A is thus divided by 512. Similarly, clock B is used as an input to an 8-bit down counter followed by a divide by two producing clock SB. Thus, clock SB equals clock B divided by two times the value in the PWMSCLB register. NOTE Clock SB = Clock B / (2 * PWMSCLB) When PWMSCLB = 0x0000, PWMSCLB value is considered a full scale value of 256. Clock B is thus divided by 512. As an example, consider the case in which the user writes 0x00FF into the PWMSCLA register. Clock A for this case will be bus clock divided by 4. A pulse will occur at a rate of once every 255 x 4 bus cycles. Passing this through the divide by two circuit produces a clock signal at a bus clock divided by 2040 rate. Similarly, a value of 0x0001 in the PWMSCLA register when clock A is bus clock divided by 4 will produce a bus clock divided by 8 rate. Writing to PWMSCLA or PWMSCLB causes the associated 8-bit down counter to be re-loaded. Otherwise, when changing rates the counter would have to count down to 0x0001 before counting at the proper rate. Forcing the associated counter to re-load the scale register value every time PWMSCLA or PWMSCLB is written prevents this. NOTE Writing to the scale registers while channels are operating can cause irregularities in the PWM outputs.
10.4.1.3
Clock Select
Each PWM channel has the capability of selecting one of two clocks. For channels 0, 1, 4, and 5 the clock choices are clock A or clock SA. For channels 2 and 3 the choices are clock B or clock SB. The clock selection is done with the PCLKx control bits in the PWMCLK register.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 352 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
NOTE Changing clock control bits while channels are operating can cause irregularities in the PWM outputs.
10.4.2
PWM Channel Timers
The main part of the PWM module are the actual timers. Each of the timer channels has a counter, a period register and a duty register (each are 8 bit). The waveform output period is controlled by a match between the period register and the value in the counter. The duty is controlled by a match between the duty register and the counter value and causes the state of the output to change during the period. The starting polarity of the output is also selectable on a per channel basis. Figure 10-35 shows a block diagram for PWM timer.
Clock Source 8-Bit Counter GATE (clock edge sync) 8-Bit Compare = T PWMDTYx R 8-Bit Compare = PWMPERx PPOLx Q Q PWMCNTx From Port PWMP Data Register
up/down reset
M U X
M U X
To Pin Driver
Q Q
T R
CAEx
PWMEx
Figure 10-35. PWM Timer Channel Block Diagram
10.4.2.1
PWM Enable
Each PWM channel has an enable bit (PWMEx) to start its waveform output. When any of the PWMEx bits are set (PWMEx = 1), the associated PWM output signal is enabled immediately. However, the actual PWM waveform is not available on the associated PWM output until its clock source begins its next cycle
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 353
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
due to the synchronization of PWMEx and the clock source. An exception to this is when channels are concatenated. Refer to Section 10.4.2.7, "PWM 16-Bit Functions," for more detail. NOTE The first PWM cycle after enabling the channel can be irregular. On the front end of the PWM timer, the clock is enabled to the PWM circuit by the PWMEx bit being high. There is an edge-synchronizing circuit to guarantee that the clock will only be enabled or disabled at an edge. When the channel is disabled (PWMEx = 0), the counter for the channel does not count.
10.4.2.2
PWM Polarity
Each channel has a polarity bit to allow starting a waveform cycle with a high or low signal. This is shown on the block diagram as a mux select of either the Q output or the Q output of the PWM output flip-flop. When one of the bits in the PWMPOL register is set, the associated PWM channel output is high at the beginning of the waveform, then goes low when the duty count is reached. Conversely, if the polarity bit is 0, the output starts low and then goes high when the duty count is reached.
10.4.2.3
PWM Period and Duty
Dedicated period and duty registers exist for each channel and are double buffered so that if they change while the channel is enabled, the change will NOT take effect until one of the following occurs: * The effective period ends * The counter is written (counter resets to 0x0000) * The channel is disabled In this way, the output of the PWM will always be either the old waveform or the new waveform, not some variation in between. If the channel is not enabled, then writes to the period and duty registers will go directly to the latches as well as the buffer. A change in duty or period can be forced into effect "immediately" by writing the new value to the duty and/or period registers and then writing to the counter. This forces the counter to reset and the new duty and/or period values to be latched. In addition, because the counter is readable it is possible to know where the count is with respect to the duty value and software can be used to make adjustments. NOTE When forcing a new period or duty into effect immediately, an irregular PWM cycle can occur. Depending on the polarity bit, the duty registers will contain the count of either the high time or the low time.
10.4.2.4
PWM Timer Counters
Each channel has a dedicated 8-bit up/down counter which runs at the rate of the selected clock source (reference Figure 10-34 for the available clock sources and rates). The counter compares to two registers, a duty register and a period register as shown in Figure 10-35. When the PWM counter matches the duty register the output flip-flop changes state causing the PWM waveform to also change state. A match
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 354 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
between the PWM counter and the period register behaves differently depending on what output mode is selected as shown in Figure 10-35 and described in Section 10.4.2.5, "Left Aligned Outputs," and Section 10.4.2.6, "Center Aligned Outputs." Each channel counter can be read at anytime without affecting the count or the operation of the PWM channel. Any value written to the counter causes the counter to reset to 0x0000, the counter direction to be set to up, the immediate load of both duty and period registers with values from the buffers, and the output to change according to the polarity bit. When the channel is disabled (PWMEx = 0), the counter stops. When a channel becomes enabled (PWMEx = 1), the associated PWM counter continues from the count in the PWMCNTx register. This allows the waveform to resume when the channel is re-enabled. When the channel is disabled, writing 0 to the period register will cause the counter to reset on the next selected clock. NOTE If the user wants to start a new "clean" PWM waveform without any "history" from the old waveform, the user must write to channel counter (PWMCNTx) prior to enabling the PWM channel (PWMEx = 1). Generally, writes to the counter are done prior to enabling a channel to start from a known state. However, writing a counter can also be done while the PWM channel is enabled (counting). The effect is similar to writing the counter when the channel is disabled except that the new period is started immediately with the output set according to the polarity bit. NOTE Writing to the counter while the channel is enabled can cause an irregular PWM cycle to occur. The counter is cleared at the end of the effective period (see Section 10.4.2.5, "Left Aligned Outputs," and Section 10.4.2.6, "Center Aligned Outputs," for more details).
Table 10-11. PWM Timer Counter Conditions
Counter Clears (0x0000) When PWMCNTx register written to any value Effective period ends Counter Counts When PWM channel is enabled (PWMEx = 1). Counts from last value in PWMCNTx. Counter Stops When PWM channel is disabled (PWMEx = 0)
10.4.2.5
Left Aligned Outputs
The PWM timer provides the choice of two types of outputs, left aligned or center aligned outputs. They are selected with the CAEx bits in the PWMCAE register. If the CAEx bit is cleared (CAEx = 0), the corresponding PWM output will be left aligned. In left aligned output mode, the 8-bit counter is configured as an up counter only. It compares to two registers, a duty register and a period register as shown in the block diagram in Figure 10-35. When the
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 355
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
PWM counter matches the duty register the output flip-flop changes state causing the PWM waveform to also change state. A match between the PWM counter and the period register resets the counter and the output flip-flop as shown in Figure 10-35 as well as performing a load from the double buffer period and duty register to the associated registers as described in Section 10.4.2.3, "PWM Period and Duty." The counter counts from 0 to the value in the period register - 1. NOTE Changing the PWM output mode from left aligned output to center aligned output (or vice versa) while channels are operating can cause irregularities in the PWM output. It is recommended to program the output mode before enabling the PWM channel.
PPOLx = 0
PPOLx = 1 PWMDTYx Period = PWMPERx
Figure 10-36. PWM Left Aligned Output Waveform
To calculate the output frequency in left aligned output mode for a particular channel, take the selected clock source frequency for the channel (A, B, SA, or SB) and divide it by the value in the period register for that channel. * PWMx frequency = clock (A, B, SA, or SB) / PWMPERx * PWMx duty cycle (high time as a% of period): -- Polarity = 0 (PPOLx = 0) Duty cycle = [(PWMPERx-PWMDTYx)/PWMPERx] * 100% -- Polarity = 1 (PPOLx = 1) Duty cycle = [PWMDTYx / PWMPERx] * 100% As an example of a left aligned output, consider the following case: Clock source = bus clock, where bus clock = 10 MHz (100 ns period) PPOLx = 0 PWMPERx = 4 PWMDTYx = 1 PWMx frequency = 10 MHz/4 = 2.5 MHz PWMx period = 400 ns PWMx duty cycle = 3/4 *100% = 75% Shown below is the output waveform generated.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 356 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
E = 100 ns
DUTY CYCLE = 75% PERIOD = 400 ns
Figure 10-37. PWM Left Aligned Output Example Waveform
10.4.2.6
Center Aligned Outputs
For center aligned output mode selection, set the CAEx bit (CAEx = 1) in the PWMCAE register and the corresponding PWM output will be center aligned. The 8-bit counter operates as an up/down counter in this mode and is set to up whenever the counter is equal to 0x0000. The counter compares to two registers, a duty register and a period register as shown in the block diagram in Figure 10-35. When the PWM counter matches the duty register the output flip-flop changes state causing the PWM waveform to also change state. A match between the PWM counter and the period register changes the counter direction from an up-count to a down-count. When the PWM counter decrements and matches the duty register again, the output flip-flop changes state causing the PWM output to also change state. When the PWM counter decrements and reaches 0, the counter direction changes from a down-count back to an up-count and a load from the double buffer period and duty registers to the associated registers is performed as described in Section 10.4.2.3, "PWM Period and Duty." The counter counts from 0 up to the value in the period register and then back down to 0. Thus the effective period is PWMPERx*2. NOTE Changing the PWM output mode from left aligned output to center aligned output (or vice versa) while channels are operating can cause irregularities in the PWM output. It is recommended to program the output mode before enabling the PWM channel.
PPOLx = 0
PPOLx = 1 PWMDTYx PWMPERx Period = PWMPERx*2 PWMDTYx PWMPERx
Figure 10-38. PWM Center Aligned Output Waveform
To calculate the output frequency in center aligned output mode for a particular channel, take the selected clock source frequency for the channel (A, B, SA, or SB) and divide it by twice the value in the period register for that channel. * PWMx frequency = clock (A, B, SA, or SB) / (2*PWMPERx)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 357
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
*
PWMx duty cycle (high time as a% of period): -- Polarity = 0 (PPOLx = 0) Duty cycle = [(PWMPERx-PWMDTYx)/PWMPERx] * 100% -- Polarity = 1 (PPOLx = 1) Duty cycle = [PWMDTYx / PWMPERx] * 100%
As an example of a center aligned output, consider the following case: Clock source = bus clock, where bus clock = 10 MHz (100 ns period) PPOLx = 0 PWMPERx = 4 PWMDTYx = 1 PWMx frequency = 10 MHz/8 = 1.25 MHz PWMx period = 800 ns PWMx duty cycle = 3/4 *100% = 75% Shown below is the output waveform generated.
E = 100 ns E = 100 ns
DUTY CYCLE = 75% PERIOD = 800 ns
Figure 10-39. PWM Center Aligned Output Example Waveform
10.4.2.7
PWM 16-Bit Functions
The PWM timer also has the option of generating 6-channels of 8-bits or 3-channels of 16-bits for greater PWM resolution}. This 16-bit channel option is achieved through the concatenation of two 8-bit channels. The PWMCTL register contains three control bits, each of which is used to concatenate a pair of PWM channels into one 16-bit channel. Channels 4 and 5 are concatenated with the CON45 bit, channels 2 and 3 are concatenated with the CON23 bit, and channels 0 and 1 are concatenated with the CON01 bit. NOTE Change these bits only when both corresponding channels are disabled. When channels 4 and 5 are concatenated, channel 4 registers become the high-order bytes of the double byte channel as shown in Figure 10-40. Similarly, when channels 2 and 3 are concatenated, channel 2 registers become the high-order bytes of the double byte channel. When channels 0 and 1 are concatenated, channel 0 registers become the high-order bytes of the double byte channel.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 358 Freescale Semiconductor
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Clock Source 5 High PWMCNT4 Low PWCNT5
Period/Duty Compare
PWM5
Clock Source 3 High PWMCNT2 Low PWCNT3
Period/Duty Compare
PWM3
Clock Source 1 High PWMCNT0 Low PWCNT1
Period/Duty Compare
PWM1
Figure 10-40. PWM 16-Bit Mode
When using the 16-bit concatenated mode, the clock source is determined by the low-order 8-bit channel clock select control bits. That is channel 5 when channels 4 and 5 are concatenated, channel 3 when channels 2 and 3 are concatenated, and channel 1 when channels 0 and 1 are concatenated. The resulting PWM is output to the pins of the corresponding low-order 8-bit channel as also shown in Figure 10-40. The polarity of the resulting PWM output is controlled by the PPOLx bit of the corresponding low-order 8-bit channel as well. After concatenated mode is enabled (CONxx bits set in PWMCTL register), enabling/disabling the corresponding 16-bit PWM channel is controlled by the low-order PWMEx bit. In this case, the high-order bytes PWMEx bits have no effect and their corresponding PWM output is disabled. In concatenated mode, writes to the 16-bit counter by using a 16-bit access or writes to either the low or high-order byte of the counter will reset the 16-bit counter. Reads of the 16-bit counter must be made by 16-bit access to maintain data coherency. Either left aligned or center aligned output mode can be used in concatenated mode and is controlled by the low-order CAEx bit. The high-order CAEx bit has no effect.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 359
Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM8B6CV1) Block Description
Table 10-12 is used to summarize which channels are used to set the various control bits when in 16-bit mode.
Table 10-12. 16-bit Concatenation Mode Summary
CONxx CON45 CON23 CON01 PWMEx PWME5 PWME3 PWME1 PPOLx PPOL5 PPOL3 PPOL1 PCLKx PCLK5 PCLK3 PCLK1 CAEx CAE5 CAE3 CAE1 PWMx Output PWM5 PWM3 PWM1
10.4.2.8
PWM Boundary Cases
Table 10-13 summarizes the boundary conditions for the PWM regardless of the output mode (left aligned or center aligned) and 8-bit (normal) or 16-bit (concatenation):
Table 10-13. PWM Boundary Cases
PWMDTYx 0x0000 (indicates no duty) 0x0000 (indicates no duty) XX XX >= PWMPERx >= PWMPERx PWMPERx >0x0000 >0x0000 0x0000(1) (indicates no period) 0x00001 (indicates no period) XX XX PPOLx 1 0 1 0 1 0 PWMx Output Always Low Always High Always High Always Low Always High Always Low
1. Counter = 0x0000 and does not count.
10.5
Resets
The reset state of each individual bit is listed within the register description section (see Section 10.3, "Memory Map and Register Definition," which details the registers and their bit-fields. All special functions or modes which are initialized during or just following reset are described within this section. * The 8-bit up/down counter is configured as an up counter out of reset. * All the channels are disabled and all the counters don't count.
10.6
Interrupts
The PWM8B6CV1 module has only one interrupt which is generated at the time of emergency shutdown, if the corresponding enable bit (PWMIE) is set. This bit is the enable for the interrupt. The interrupt flag PWMIF is set whenever the input level of the PWM5 channel changes while PWM5ENA=1 or when PWMENA is being asserted while the level at PWM5 is active. A description of the registers involved and affected due to this interrupt is explained in Section 10.3.2.15, "PWM Shutdown Register (PWMSDN)."
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 360 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 11 Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Table 11-1. Revision History
Revision Number V05.00 Revision Date 02 Jun 2003 Sections Affected 11.3.2.2/11-366 11.4.6.6/11-391 11.4.5.5/11-383 11.4.2/11-376 11.4.4/11-378 V05.01 16 Apr 2004 Description of Changes - Opened three new registers using a Mode bit. - Added Wakeup capability on Receive Input. - Added LIN transmit collision detect capability. - Added LIN break detect capability. - Updated block diagram. - Updated Table 4-3 to use more general bus clock frequency. - Updated to be SRS3.0 compliant.
11.3.2.7/11-371 - Update OR and PF flag description. - Correct baud rate tolerance in 4.7.5.1 and 4.7.5.2. - Clean up classification and NDA message banners. 11.3.2.3/11-368 - Correct alternative registers address. 11.4.4/11-378 - Remove unavailable baud rate in Table1-16.
V05.02
14 Oct 2005
11.1
Introduction
This block guide provides an overview of the serial communication interface (SCI) module. The SCI allows asynchronous serial communications with peripheral devices and other CPUs.
11.1.1
Glossary
IR: InfraRed IrDA: Infrared Design Associate IRQ: Interrupt Request LIN: Local Interconnect Network LSB: Least Significant Bit MSB: Most Significant Bit NRZ: Non-Return-to-Zero RZI: Return-to-Zero-Inverted RXD: Receive Pin SCI : Serial Communication Interface
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 361
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
TXD: Transmit Pin
11.1.2
Features
The SCI includes these distinctive features: * Full-duplex or single-wire operation * Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format * Selectable IrDA 1.4 return-to-zero-inverted (RZI) format with programmable pulse widths * 13-bit baud rate selection * Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit data format * Separately enabled transmitter and receiver * Programmable polarity for transmitter and receiver * Programmable transmitter output parity * Two receiver wakeup methods: -- Idle line wakeup -- Address mark wakeup * Interrupt-driven operation with eight flags: -- Transmitter empty -- Transmission complete -- Receiver full -- Idle receiver input -- Receiver overrun -- Noise error -- Framing error -- Parity error -- Receive wakeup on active edge -- Transmit collision detect supporting LIN -- Break Detect supporting LIN * Receiver framing error detection * Hardware parity checking * 1/16 bit-time noise detection
11.1.3
Modes of Operation
The SCI functions the same in normal, special, and emulation modes. It has two low power modes, wait and stop modes. * Run mode * Wait mode
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 362 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
*
Stop mode
11.1.4
Block Diagram
Figure 11-1 is a high level block diagram of the SCI module, showing the interaction of various function blocks.
SCI Data Register RXD Data In Infrared Decoder
Receive Shift Register IDLE Receive RDRF/OR Interrupt Generation BRKD RXEDG BERR Transmit TDRE Interrupt Generation TC
Receive & Wakeup Control
SCI Interrupt Request
Bus Clock
Baud Rate Generator
Data Format Control
1/16
Transmit Control
Transmit Shift Register
Infrared Encoder
Data Out TXD
SCI Data Register
Figure 11-1. SCI Block Diagram
11.2
External Signal Description
The SCI module has a total of two external pins.
11.2.1
TXD -- Transmit Pin
The TXD pin transmits SCI (standard or infrared) data. It will idle high in either mode and is high impedance anytime the transmitter is disabled.
11.2.2
RXD -- Receive Pin
The RXD pin receives SCI (standard or infrared) data. An idle line is detected as a line high. This input is ignored when the receiver is disabled and should be terminated to a known voltage.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 363
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.3
Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all the SCI registers.
11.3.1
Module Memory Map and Register Definition
The memory map for the SCI module is given below in Figure 11-2. The address listed for each register is the address offset. The total address for each register is the sum of the base address for the SCI module and the address offset for each register.
11.3.2
Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order. Each description includes a standard register diagram with an associated figure number. Writes to a reserved register locations do not have any effect and reads of these locations return a zero. Details of register bit and field function follow the register diagrams, in bit order.
Register Name 0x0000 SCIBDH1 0x0001 SCIBDL1 0x0002 SCICR11 0x0000 SCIASR12 0x0001 SCIACR12 0x0002 SCIACR22 0x0003 SCICR2 R W R W R W R W R W R W R W TIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE Bit 7 IREN 6 TNP1 5 TNP0 4 SBR12 3 SBR11 2 SBR10 1 SBR9 Bit 0 SBR8
SBR7
SBR6
SBR5
SBR4
SBR3
SBR2
SBR1
SBR0
LOOPS
SCISWAI 0
RSRC 0
M 0
WAKE 0
ILT
PE
PT
RXEDGIF
BERRV 0
BERRIF
BKDIF
RXEDGIE 0
0
0
0
0
BERRIE
BKDIE
0
0
0
0
BERRM1
BERRM0
BKDFE
RE
RWU
SBK
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-2. SCI Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 2)
1 2
Those registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCISR2 register is set to zero Those registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCISR2 register is set to one
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 364 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Register Name 0x0004 SCISR1 0x0005 SCISR2 0x0006 SCIDRH 0x0007 SCIDRL R W R W R W R W
Bit 7 TDRE
6 TC
5 RDRF
4 IDLE
3 OR
2 NF
1 FE
Bit 0 PF
AMAP R8
0
0
TXPOL 0
RXPOL 0
BRK13 0
TXDIR 0
RAF
T8 R6 T6
0
0
R7 T7
R5 T5
R4 T4
R3 T3
R2 T2
R1 T1
R0 T0
1.These registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCISR2 register is set to zero. 2,These registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCISR2 register is set to one. = Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-2. SCI Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 2)
1 2
Those registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCISR2 register is set to zero Those registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCISR2 register is set to one
11.3.2.1
SCI Baud Rate Registers (SCIBDH, SCIBDL)
Module Base + 0x0000
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
IREN 0
TNP1 0
TNP0 0
SBR12 0
SBR11 0
SBR10 0
SBR9 0
SBR8 0
Figure 11-3. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCIBDH)
Module Base + 0x0001
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
SBR7 0
SBR6 0
SBR5 0
SBR4 0
SBR3 0
SBR2 0
SBR1 0
SBR0 0
Figure 11-4. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCIBDL)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 0. If only SCIBDH is written to, a read will not return the correct data until SCIBDL is written to as well, following a write to SCIBDH. Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 0. NOTE Those two registers are only visible in the memory map if AMAP = 0 (reset condition).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 365
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
The SCI baud rate register is used by to determine the baud rate of the SCI, and to control the infrared modulation/demodulation submodule.
Table 11-2. SCIBDH and SCIBDL Field Descriptions
Field 7 IREN 6:5 TNP[1:0] 4:0 7:0 SBR[12:0] Description Infrared Enable Bit -- This bit enables/disables the infrared modulation/demodulation submodule. 0 IR disabled 1 IR enabled Transmitter Narrow Pulse Bits -- These bits enable whether the SCI transmits a 1/16, 3/16, 1/32 or 1/4 narrow pulse. See Table 11-3. SCI Baud Rate Bits -- The baud rate for the SCI is determined by the bits in this register. The baud rate is calculated two different ways depending on the state of the IREN bit. The formulas for calculating the baud rate are: When IREN = 0 then, SCI baud rate = SCI bus clock / (16 x SBR[12:0]) When IREN = 1 then, SCI baud rate = SCI bus clock / (32 x SBR[12:1]) Note: The baud rate generator is disabled after reset and not started until the TE bit or the RE bit is set for the first time. The baud rate generator is disabled when (SBR[12:0] = 0 and IREN = 0) or (SBR[12:1] = 0 and IREN = 1). Note: Writing to SCIBDH has no effect without writing to SCIBDL, because writing to SCIBDH puts the data in a temporary location until SCIBDL is written to.
Table 11-3. IRSCI Transmit Pulse Width
TNP[1:0] 11 10 01 00 Narrow Pulse Width 1/4 1/32 1/16 3/16
11.3.2.2
SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1)
Module Base + 0x0002
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
LOOPS 0
SCISWAI 0
RSRC 0
M 0
WAKE 0
ILT 0
PE 0
PT 0
Figure 11-5. SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 0. Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 0. NOTE This register is only visible in the memory map if AMAP = 0 (reset condition).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 366 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Table 11-4. SCICR1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 LOOPS Description Loop Select Bit -- LOOPS enables loop operation. In loop operation, the RXD pin is disconnected from the SCI and the transmitter output is internally connected to the receiver input. Both the transmitter and the receiver must be enabled to use the loop function. 0 Normal operation enabled 1 Loop operation enabled The receiver input is determined by the RSRC bit. SCI Stop in Wait Mode Bit -- SCISWAI disables the SCI in wait mode. 0 SCI enabled in wait mode 1 SCI disabled in wait mode Receiver Source Bit -- When LOOPS = 1, the RSRC bit determines the source for the receiver shift register input. See Table 11-5. 0 Receiver input internally connected to transmitter output 1 Receiver input connected externally to transmitter Data Format Mode Bit -- MODE determines whether data characters are eight or nine bits long. 0 One start bit, eight data bits, one stop bit 1 One start bit, nine data bits, one stop bit Wakeup Condition Bit -- WAKE determines which condition wakes up the SCI: a logic 1 (address mark) in the most significant bit position of a received data character or an idle condition on the RXD pin. 0 Idle line wakeup 1 Address mark wakeup Idle Line Type Bit -- ILT determines when the receiver starts counting logic 1s as idle character bits. The counting begins either after the start bit or after the stop bit. If the count begins after the start bit, then a string of logic 1s preceding the stop bit may cause false recognition of an idle character. Beginning the count after the stop bit avoids false idle character recognition, but requires properly synchronized transmissions. 0 Idle character bit count begins after start bit 1 Idle character bit count begins after stop bit Parity Enable Bit -- PE enables the parity function. When enabled, the parity function inserts a parity bit in the most significant bit position. 0 Parity function disabled 1 Parity function enabled Parity Type Bit -- PT determines whether the SCI generates and checks for even parity or odd parity. With even parity, an even number of 1s clears the parity bit and an odd number of 1s sets the parity bit. With odd parity, an odd number of 1s clears the parity bit and an even number of 1s sets the parity bit. 1 Even parity 1 Odd parity
6 SCISWAI 5 RSRC
4 M 3 WAKE
2 ILT
1 PE
0 PT
Table 11-5. Loop Functions
LOOPS 0 1 1 RSRC x 0 1 Normal operation Loop mode with transmitter output internally connected to receiver input Single-wire mode with TXD pin connected to receiver input Function
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 367
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.3.2.3
SCI Alternative Status Register 1 (SCIASR1)
Module Base + 0x0000
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
RXEDGIF 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
BERRV 0
BERRIF 0
BKDIF 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-6. SCI Alternative Status Register 1 (SCIASR1)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 1 Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
Table 11-6. SCIASR1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 RXEDGIF Description Receive Input Active Edge Interrupt Flag -- RXEDGIF is asserted, if an active edge (falling if RXPOL = 0, rising if RXPOL = 1) on the RXD input occurs. RXEDGIF bit is cleared by writing a "1" to it. 0 No active receive on the receive input has occurred 1 An active edge on the receive input has occurred Bit Error Value -- BERRV reflects the state of the RXD input when the bit error detect circuitry is enabled and a mismatch to the expected value happened. The value is only meaningful, if BERRIF = 1. 0 A low input was sampled, when a high was expected 1 A high input reassembled, when a low was expected Bit Error Interrupt Flag -- BERRIF is asserted, when the bit error detect circuitry is enabled and if the value sampled at the RXD input does not match the transmitted value. If the BERRIE interrupt enable bit is set an interrupt will be generated. The BERRIF bit is cleared by writing a "1" to it. 0 No mismatch detected 1 A mismatch has occurred Break Detect Interrupt Flag -- BKDIF is asserted, if the break detect circuitry is enabled and a break signal is received. If the BKDIE interrupt enable bit is set an interrupt will be generated. The BKDIF bit is cleared by writing a "1" to it. 0 No break signal was received 1 A break signal was received
2 BERRV
1 BERRIF
0 BKDIF
11.3.2.4
SCI Alternative Control Register 1 (SCIACR1)
Module Base + 0x0001
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
RXEDGIE 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
BERRIE 0
BKDIE 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-7. SCI Alternative Control Register 1 (SCIACR1)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 1 Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 368 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Table 11-7. SCIACR1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 RSEDGIE Description Receive Input Active Edge Interrupt Enable -- RXEDGIE enables the receive input active edge interrupt flag, RXEDGIF, to generate interrupt requests. 0 RXEDGIF interrupt requests disabled 1 RXEDGIF interrupt requests enabled Bit Error Interrupt Enable -- BERRIE enables the bit error interrupt flag, BERRIF, to generate interrupt requests. 0 BERRIF interrupt requests disabled 1 BERRIF interrupt requests enabled Break Detect Interrupt Enable -- BKDIE enables the break detect interrupt flag, BKDIF, to generate interrupt requests. 0 BKDIF interrupt requests disabled 1 BKDIF interrupt requests enabled
1 BERRIE
0 BKDIE
11.3.2.5
SCI Alternative Control Register 2 (SCIACR2)
Module Base + 0x0002
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
BERRM1 0
BERRM0 0
BKDFE 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-8. SCI Alternative Control Register 2 (SCIACR2)
Read: Anytime, if AMAP = 1 Write: Anytime, if AMAP = 1
Table 11-8. SCIACR2 Field Descriptions
Field Description
2:1 Bit Error Mode -- Those two bits determines the functionality of the bit error detect feature. See Table 11-9. BERRM[1:0] 0 BKDFE Break Detect Feature Enable -- BKDFE enables the break detect circuitry. 0 Break detect circuit disabled 1 Break detect circuit enabled
Table 11-9. Bit Error Mode Coding
BERRM1 0 0 1 1 BERRM0 0 1 0 1 Bit error detect circuit is disabled Receive input sampling occurs during the 9th time tick of a transmitted bit (refer to Figure 11-19) Receive input sampling occurs during the 13th time tick of a transmitted bit (refer to Figure 11-19) Reserved Function
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 369
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.3.2.6
SCI Control Register 2 (SCICR2)
Module Base + 0x0003
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
TIE 0
TCIE 0
RIE 0
ILIE 0
TE 0
RE 0
RWU 0
SBK 0
Figure 11-9. SCI Control Register 2 (SCICR2)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 11-10. SCICR2 Field Descriptions
Field 7 TIE Description Transmitter Interrupt Enable Bit -- TIE enables the transmit data register empty flag, TDRE, to generate interrupt requests. 0 TDRE interrupt requests disabled 1 TDRE interrupt requests enabled Transmission Complete Interrupt Enable Bit -- TCIE enables the transmission complete flag, TC, to generate interrupt requests. 0 TC interrupt requests disabled 1 TC interrupt requests enabled Receiver Full Interrupt Enable Bit -- RIE enables the receive data register full flag, RDRF, or the overrun flag, OR, to generate interrupt requests. 0 RDRF and OR interrupt requests disabled 1 RDRF and OR interrupt requests enabled Idle Line Interrupt Enable Bit -- ILIE enables the idle line flag, IDLE, to generate interrupt requests. 0 IDLE interrupt requests disabled 1 IDLE interrupt requests enabled Transmitter Enable Bit -- TE enables the SCI transmitter and configures the TXD pin as being controlled by the SCI. The TE bit can be used to queue an idle preamble. 0 Transmitter disabled 1 Transmitter enabled Receiver Enable Bit -- RE enables the SCI receiver. 0 Receiver disabled 1 Receiver enabled Receiver Wakeup Bit -- Standby state 0 Normal operation. 1 RWU enables the wakeup function and inhibits further receiver interrupt requests. Normally, hardware wakes the receiver by automatically clearing RWU. Send Break Bit -- Toggling SBK sends one break character (10 or 11 logic 0s, respectively 13 or 14 logics 0s if BRK13 is set). Toggling implies clearing the SBK bit before the break character has finished transmitting. As long as SBK is set, the transmitter continues to send complete break characters (10 or 11 bits, respectively 13 or 14 bits). 0 No break characters 1 Transmit break characters
6 TCIE
5 RIE
4 ILIE 3 TE
2 RE 1 RWU
0 SBK
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 370 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.3.2.7
SCI Status Register 1 (SCISR1)
The SCISR1 and SCISR2 registers provides inputs to the MCU for generation of SCI interrupts. Also, these registers can be polled by the MCU to check the status of these bits. The flag-clearing procedures require that the status register be read followed by a read or write to the SCI data register.It is permissible to execute other instructions between the two steps as long as it does not compromise the handling of I/O, but the order of operations is important for flag clearing.
Module Base + 0x0004
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
TDRE 1
TC 1
RDRF 0
IDLE 0
OR 0
NF 0
FE 0
PF 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-10. SCI Status Register 1 (SCISR1)
Read: Anytime Write: Has no meaning or effect
Table 11-11. SCISR1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 TDRE Description Transmit Data Register Empty Flag -- TDRE is set when the transmit shift register receives a byte from the SCI data register. When TDRE is 1, the transmit data register (SCIDRH/L) is empty and can receive a new value to transmit.Clear TDRE by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1), with TDRE set and then writing to SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 0 No byte transferred to transmit shift register 1 Byte transferred to transmit shift register; transmit data register empty Transmit Complete Flag -- TC is set low when there is a transmission in progress or when a preamble or break character is loaded. TC is set high when the TDRE flag is set and no data, preamble, or break character is being transmitted.When TC is set, the TXD pin becomes idle (logic 1). Clear TC by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with TC set and then writing to SCI data register low (SCIDRL). TC is cleared automatically when data, preamble, or break is queued and ready to be sent. TC is cleared in the event of a simultaneous set and clear of the TC flag (transmission not complete). 0 Transmission in progress 1 No transmission in progress Receive Data Register Full Flag -- RDRF is set when the data in the receive shift register transfers to the SCI data register. Clear RDRF by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with RDRF set and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 0 Data not available in SCI data register 1 Received data available in SCI data register Idle Line Flag -- IDLE is set when 10 consecutive logic 1s (if M = 0) or 11 consecutive logic 1s (if M =1) appear on the receiver input. Once the IDLE flag is cleared, a valid frame must again set the RDRF flag before an idle condition can set the IDLE flag.Clear IDLE by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with IDLE set and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 0 Receiver input is either active now or has never become active since the IDLE flag was last cleared 1 Receiver input has become idle Note: When the receiver wakeup bit (RWU) is set, an idle line condition does not set the IDLE flag.
6 TC
5 RDRF
4 IDLE
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 371
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Table 11-11. SCISR1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 3 OR Description Overrun Flag -- OR is set when software fails to read the SCI data register before the receive shift register receives the next frame. The OR bit is set immediately after the stop bit has been completely received for the second frame. The data in the shift register is lost, but the data already in the SCI data registers is not affected. Clear OR by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with OR set and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 0 No overrun 1 Overrun Note: OR flag may read back as set when RDRF flag is clear. This may happen if the following sequence of events occurs: 1. After the first frame is received, read status register SCISR1 (returns RDRF set and OR flag clear); 2. Receive second frame without reading the first frame in the data register (the second frame is not received and OR flag is set); 3. Read data register SCIDRL (returns first frame and clears RDRF flag in the status register); 4. Read status register SCISR1 (returns RDRF clear and OR set). Event 3 may be at exactly the same time as event 2 or any time after. When this happens, a dummy SCIDRL read following event 4 will be required to clear the OR flag if further frames are to be received. Noise Flag -- NF is set when the SCI detects noise on the receiver input. NF bit is set during the same cycle as the RDRF flag but does not get set in the case of an overrun. Clear NF by reading SCI status register 1(SCISR1), and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 0 No noise 1 Noise Framing Error Flag -- FE is set when a logic 0 is accepted as the stop bit. FE bit is set during the same cycle as the RDRF flag but does not get set in the case of an overrun. FE inhibits further data reception until it is cleared. Clear FE by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with FE set and then reading the SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 0 No framing error 1 Framing error Parity Error Flag -- PF is set when the parity enable bit (PE) is set and the parity of the received data does not match the parity type bit (PT). PF bit is set during the same cycle as the RDRF flag but does not get set in the case of an overrun. Clear PF by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1), and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 0 No parity error 1 Parity error
2 NF
1 FE
0 PF
11.3.2.8
SCI Status Register 2 (SCISR2)
Module Base + 0x0005
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
AMAP 0
0 0
0 0
TXPOL 0
RXPOL 0
BRK13 0
TXDIR 0
RAF 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-11. SCI Status Register 2 (SCISR2)
Read: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 372 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Write: Anytime
Table 11-12. SCISR2 Field Descriptions
Field 7 AMAP Description Alternative Map -- This bit controls which registers sharing the same address space are accessible. In the reset condition the SCI behaves as previous versions. Setting AMAP=1 allows the access to another set of control and status registers and hides the baud rate and SCI control Register 1. 0 The registers labelled SCIBDH (0x0000),SCIBDL (0x0001), SCICR1 (0x0002) are accessible 1 The registers labelled SCIASR1 (0x0000),SCIACR1 (0x0001), SCIACR2 (0x00002) are accessible Transmit Polarity -- This bit control the polarity of the transmitted data. In NRZ format, a one is represented by a mark and a zero is represented by a space for normal polarity, and the opposite for inverted polarity. In IrDA format, a zero is represented by short high pulse in the middle of a bit time remaining idle low for a one for normal polarity, and a zero is represented by short low pulse in the middle of a bit time remaining idle high for a one for inverted polarity. 0 Normal polarity 1 Inverted polarity Receive Polarity -- This bit control the polarity of the received data. In NRZ format, a one is represented by a mark and a zero is represented by a space for normal polarity, and the opposite for inverted polarity. In IrDA format, a zero is represented by short high pulse in the middle of a bit time remaining idle low for a one for normal polarity, and a zero is represented by short low pulse in the middle of a bit time remaining idle high for a one for inverted polarity. 0 Normal polarity 1 Inverted polarity Break Transmit Character Length -- This bit determines whether the transmit break character is 10 or 11 bit respectively 13 or 14 bits long. The detection of a framing error is not affected by this bit. 0 Break character is 10 or 11 bit long 1 Break character is 13 or 14 bit long Transmitter Pin Data Direction in Single-Wire Mode -- This bit determines whether the TXD pin is going to be used as an input or output, in the single-wire mode of operation. This bit is only relevant in the single-wire mode of operation. 0 TXD pin to be used as an input in single-wire mode 1 TXD pin to be used as an output in single-wire mode Receiver Active Flag -- RAF is set when the receiver detects a logic 0 during the RT1 time period of the start bit search. RAF is cleared when the receiver detects an idle character. 0 No reception in progress 1 Reception in progress
4 TXPOL
3 RXPOL
2 BRK13
1 TXDIR
0 RAF
11.3.2.9
SCI Data Registers (SCIDRH, SCIDRL)
Module Base + 0x0006
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
R8 0
T8 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 11-12. SCI Data Registers (SCIDRH)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 373
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Module Base + 0x0007
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
R7 T7 0
R6 T6 0
R5 T5 0
R4 T4 0
R3 T3 0
R2 T2 0
R1 T1 0
R0 T0 0
Figure 11-13. SCI Data Registers (SCIDRL)
Read: Anytime; reading accesses SCI receive data register Write: Anytime; writing accesses SCI transmit data register; writing to R8 has no effect
Table 11-13. SCIDRH and SCIDRL Field Descriptions
Field SCIDRH 7 R8 SCIDRH 6 T8 SCIDRL 7:0 R[7:0] T[7:0] Description Received Bit 8 -- R8 is the ninth data bit received when the SCI is configured for 9-bit data format (M = 1).
Transmit Bit 8 -- T8 is the ninth data bit transmitted when the SCI is configured for 9-bit data format (M = 1).
R7:R0 -- Received bits seven through zero for 9-bit or 8-bit data formats T7:T0 -- Transmit bits seven through zero for 9-bit or 8-bit formats
NOTE If the value of T8 is the same as in the previous transmission, T8 does not have to be rewritten.The same value is transmitted until T8 is rewritten In 8-bit data format, only SCI data register low (SCIDRL) needs to be accessed. When transmitting in 9-bit data format and using 8-bit write instructions, write first to SCI data register high (SCIDRH), then SCIDRL.
11.4
Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the SCI block, detailing the operation of the design from the end user perspective in a number of subsections. Figure 11-14 shows the structure of the SCI module. The SCI allows full duplex, asynchronous, serial communication between the CPU and remote devices, including other CPUs. The SCI transmitter and receiver operate independently, although they use the same baud rate generator. The CPU monitors the status of the SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes received data.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 374 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
IREN SCI Data Register RXD Infrared Receive Decoder Ir_RXD SCRXD Receive Shift Register RE R16XCLK Receive and Wakeup Control RWU LOOPS RSRC M Baud Rate Generator WAKE Data Format Control ILT PE SBR12:SBR0 PT
R8 NF FE PF RAF IDLE RDRF OR RIE TIE TDRE SCI Interrupt Request RDRF/OR TC RXEDGIE Active Edge Detect Break Detect BKDIE RXEDGIF BKDIF RXD BERRIE Infrared Transmit Encoder R32XCLK TNP[1:0] IREN BERRM[1:0] Ir_TXD TXD ILIE IDLE
Bus Clock
TDRE TC TCIE
TE /16 Transmit Control LOOPS SBK RSRC T8 Transmit Shift Register SCI Data Register
BKDFE
SCTXD R16XCLK
LIN Transmit BERRIF Collision Detect
Figure 11-14. Detailed SCI Block Diagram
11.4.1
Infrared Interface Submodule
This module provides the capability of transmitting narrow pulses to an IR LED and receiving narrow pulses and transforming them to serial bits, which are sent to the SCI. The IrDA physical layer specification defines a half-duplex infrared communication link for exchange data. The full standard includes data rates up to 16 Mbits/s. This design covers only data rates between 2.4 Kbits/s and 115.2 Kbits/s. The infrared submodule consists of two major blocks: the transmit encoder and the receive decoder. The SCI transmits serial bits of data which are encoded by the infrared submodule to transmit a narrow pulse
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 375
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
for every zero bit. No pulse is transmitted for every one bit. When receiving data, the IR pulses should be detected using an IR photo diode and transformed to CMOS levels by the IR receive decoder (external from the MCU). The narrow pulses are then stretched by the infrared submodule to get back to a serial bit stream to be received by the SCI.The polarity of transmitted pulses and expected receive pulses can be inverted so that a direct connection can be made to external IrDA transceiver modules that uses active low pulses. The infrared submodule receives its clock sources from the SCI. One of these two clocks are selected in the infrared submodule in order to generate either 3/16, 1/16, 1/32 or 1/4 narrow pulses during transmission. The infrared block receives two clock sources from the SCI, R16XCLK and R32XCLK, which are configured to generate the narrow pulse width during transmission. The R16XCLK and R32XCLK are internal clocks with frequencies 16 and 32 times the baud rate respectively. Both R16XCLK and R32XCLK clocks are used for transmitting data. The receive decoder uses only the R16XCLK clock.
11.4.1.1
Infrared Transmit Encoder
The infrared transmit encoder converts serial bits of data from transmit shift register to the TXD pin. A narrow pulse is transmitted for a zero bit and no pulse for a one bit. The narrow pulse is sent in the middle of the bit with a duration of 1/32, 1/16, 3/16 or 1/4 of a bit time. A narrow high pulse is transmitted for a zero bit when TXPOL is cleared, while a narrow low pulse is transmitted for a zero bit when TXPOL is set.
11.4.1.2
Infrared Receive Decoder
The infrared receive block converts data from the RXD pin to the receive shift register. A narrow pulse is expected for each zero received and no pulse is expected for each one received. A narrow high pulse is expected for a zero bit when RXPOL is cleared, while a narrow low pulse is expected for a zero bit when RXPOL is set. This receive decoder meets the edge jitter requirement as defined by the IrDA serial infrared physical layer specification.
11.4.2
LIN Support
This module provides some basic support for the LIN protocol. At first this is a break detect circuitry making it easier for the LIN software to distinguish a break character from an incoming data stream. As a further addition is supports a collision detection at the bit level as well as cancelling pending transmissions.
11.4.3
Data Format
The SCI uses the standard NRZ mark/space data format. When Infrared is enabled, the SCI uses RZI data format where zeroes are represented by light pulses and ones remain low. See Figure 11-15 below.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 376 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
8-Bit Data Format (Bit M in SCICR1 Clear) Start Bit
Possible Parity Bit Bit 6 Bit 7 STOP Bit
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Next Start Bit
Standard SCI Data
Infrared SCI Data
9-Bit Data Format (Bit M in SCICR1 Set) Start Bit Bit 0 Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 Bit 7
POSSIBLE PARITY Bit Bit 8 STOP Bit
NEXT START Bit
Standard SCI Data Infrared SCI Data
Figure 11-15. SCI Data Formats
Each data character is contained in a frame that includes a start bit, eight or nine data bits, and a stop bit. Clearing the M bit in SCI control register 1 configures the SCI for 8-bit data characters. A frame with eight data bits has a total of 10 bits. Setting the M bit configures the SCI for nine-bit data characters. A frame with nine data bits has a total of 11 bits.
Table 11-14. Example of 8-Bit Data Formats
Start Bit 1 1 Data Bits 8 7 Address Bits 0 0
(1)
Parity Bits 0 1
Stop Bit 1 1
0 1 1 7 1 1. The address bit identifies the frame as an address character. See Section 11.4.6.6, "Receiver Wakeup".
When the SCI is configured for 9-bit data characters, the ninth data bit is the T8 bit in SCI data register high (SCIDRH). It remains unchanged after transmission and can be used repeatedly without rewriting it. A frame with nine data bits has a total of 11 bits.
Table 11-15. Example of 9-Bit Data Formats
Start Bit 1 1 Data Bits 9 8 Address Bits 0 0
(1)
Parity Bits 0 1
Stop Bit 1 1
0 1 1 8 1 1. The address bit identifies the frame as an address character. See Section 11.4.6.6, "Receiver Wakeup".
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 377
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.4.4
Baud Rate Generation
A 13-bit modulus counter in the baud rate generator derives the baud rate for both the receiver and the transmitter. The value from 0 to 8191 written to the SBR12:SBR0 bits determines the bus clock divisor. The SBR bits are in the SCI baud rate registers (SCIBDH and SCIBDL). The baud rate clock is synchronized with the bus clock and drives the receiver. The baud rate clock divided by 16 drives the transmitter. The receiver has an acquisition rate of 16 samples per bit time. Baud rate generation is subject to one source of error: * Integer division of the bus clock may not give the exact target frequency. Table 11-16 lists some examples of achieving target baud rates with a bus clock frequency of 25 MHz. When IREN = 0 then, SCI baud rate = SCI bus clock / (16 * SCIBR[12:0])
Table 11-16. Baud Rates (Example: Bus Clock = 25 MHz)
Bits SBR[12:0] 41 81 163 326 651 1302 2604 5208 Receiver Clock (Hz) 609,756.1 308,642.0 153,374.2 76,687.1 38,402.5 19,201.2 9600.6 4800.0 Transmitter Clock (Hz) 38,109.8 19,290.1 9585.9 4792.9 2400.2 1200.1 600.0 300.0 Target Baud Rate 38,400 19,200 9,600 4,800 2,400 1,200 600 300 Error (%) .76 .47 .16 .15 .01 .01 .00 .00
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 378 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.4.5
Transmitter
Internal Bus
Bus Clock
Baud Divider
/ 16
SCI Data Registers
SBR12:SBR0 Start Stop 11-Bit Transmit Register 8 MSB 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TXPOL SCTXD
M
H
L
T8 Load from SCIDR Preamble (All 1s) Break (All 0s)
LOOP CONTROL
To Receiver
PT TDRE IRQ
Parity Generation TIE TDRE
Shift Enable
PE
LOOPS RSRC
Transmitter Control TC IRQ TC TCIE TE SBK BERRM[1:0]
BERRIF BER IRQ TCIE
Transmit Collision Detect
SCTXD SCRXD (From Receiver)
Figure 11-16. Transmitter Block Diagram
11.4.5.1
Transmitter Character Length
The SCI transmitter can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data characters. The state of the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1) determines the length of data characters. When transmitting 9-bit data, bit T8 in SCI data register high (SCIDRH) is the ninth bit (bit 8).
11.4.5.2
Character Transmission
To transmit data, the MCU writes the data bits to the SCI data registers (SCIDRH/SCIDRL), which in turn are transferred to the transmitter shift register. The transmit shift register then shifts a frame out through the TXD pin, after it has prefaced them with a start bit and appended them with a stop bit. The SCI data registers (SCIDRH and SCIDRL) are the write-only buffers between the internal data bus and the transmit shift register.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 379
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
The SCI also sets a flag, the transmit data register empty flag (TDRE), every time it transfers data from the buffer (SCIDRH/L) to the transmitter shift register.The transmit driver routine may respond to this flag by writing another byte to the Transmitter buffer (SCIDRH/SCIDRL), while the shift register is still shifting out the first byte. To initiate an SCI transmission: 1. Configure the SCI: a) Select a baud rate. Write this value to the SCI baud registers (SCIBDH/L) to begin the baud rate generator. Remember that the baud rate generator is disabled when the baud rate is zero. Writing to the SCIBDH has no effect without also writing to SCIBDL. b) Write to SCICR1 to configure word length, parity, and other configuration bits (LOOPS,RSRC,M,WAKE,ILT,PE,PT). c) Enable the transmitter, interrupts, receive, and wake up as required, by writing to the SCICR2 register bits (TIE,TCIE,RIE,ILIE,TE,RE,RWU,SBK). A preamble or idle character will now be shifted out of the transmitter shift register. 2. Transmit Procedure for each byte: a) Poll the TDRE flag by reading the SCISR1 or responding to the TDRE interrupt. Keep in mind that the TDRE bit resets to one. b) If the TDRE flag is set, write the data to be transmitted to SCIDRH/L, where the ninth bit is written to the T8 bit in SCIDRH if the SCI is in 9-bit data format. A new transmission will not result until the TDRE flag has been cleared. 3. Repeat step 2 for each subsequent transmission. NOTE The TDRE flag is set when the shift register is loaded with the next data to be transmitted from SCIDRH/L, which happens, generally speaking, a little over half-way through the stop bit of the previous frame. Specifically, this transfer occurs 9/16ths of a bit time AFTER the start of the stop bit of the previous frame. Writing the TE bit from 0 to a 1 automatically loads the transmit shift register with a preamble of 10 logic 1s (if M = 0) or 11 logic 1s (if M = 1). After the preamble shifts out, control logic transfers the data from the SCI data register into the transmit shift register. A logic 0 start bit automatically goes into the least significant bit position of the transmit shift register. A logic 1 stop bit goes into the most significant bit position. Hardware supports odd or even parity. When parity is enabled, the most significant bit (MSB) of the data character is the parity bit. The transmit data register empty flag, TDRE, in SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) becomes set when the SCI data register transfers a byte to the transmit shift register. The TDRE flag indicates that the SCI data register can accept new data from the internal data bus. If the transmit interrupt enable bit, TIE, in SCI control register 2 (SCICR2) is also set, the TDRE flag generates a transmitter interrupt request.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 380 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
When the transmit shift register is not transmitting a frame, the TXD pin goes to the idle condition, logic 1. If at any time software clears the TE bit in SCI control register 2 (SCICR2), the transmitter enable signal goes low and the transmit signal goes idle. If software clears TE while a transmission is in progress (TC = 0), the frame in the transmit shift register continues to shift out. To avoid accidentally cutting off the last frame in a message, always wait for TDRE to go high after the last frame before clearing TE. To separate messages with preambles with minimum idle line time, use this sequence between messages: 1. Write the last byte of the first message to SCIDRH/L. 2. Wait for the TDRE flag to go high, indicating the transfer of the last frame to the transmit shift register. 3. Queue a preamble by clearing and then setting the TE bit. 4. Write the first byte of the second message to SCIDRH/L.
11.4.5.3
Break Characters
Writing a logic 1 to the send break bit, SBK, in SCI control register 2 (SCICR2) loads the transmit shift register with a break character. A break character contains all logic 0s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Break character length depends on the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1). As long as SBK is at logic 1, transmitter logic continuously loads break characters into the transmit shift register. After software clears the SBK bit, the shift register finishes transmitting the last break character and then transmits at least one logic 1. The automatic logic 1 at the end of a break character guarantees the recognition of the start bit of the next frame. The SCI recognizes a break character when there are 10 or 11(M = 0 or M = 1) consecutive zero received. Depending if the break detect feature is enabled or not receiving a break character has these effects on SCI registers. If the break detect feature is disabled (BKDFE = 0): * Sets the framing error flag, FE * Sets the receive data register full flag, RDRF * Clears the SCI data registers (SCIDRH/L) * May set the overrun flag, OR, noise flag, NF, parity error flag, PE, or the receiver active flag, RAF (see 3.4.4 and 3.4.5 SCI Status Register 1 and 2) If the break detect feature is enabled (BKDFE = 1) there are two scenarios1 The break is detected right from a start bit or is detected during a byte reception. * Sets the break detect interrupt flag, BLDIF * Does not change the data register full flag, RDRF or overrun flag OR * Does not change the framing error flag FE, parity error flag PE. * Does not clear the SCI data registers (SCIDRH/L) * May set noise flag NF, or receiver active flag RAF.
1. A Break character in this context are either 10 or 11 consecutive zero received bits
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 381
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Figure 11-17 shows two cases of break detect. In trace RXD_1 the break symbol starts with the start bit, while in RXD_2 the break starts in the middle of a transmission. If BRKDFE = 1, in RXD_1 case there will be no byte transferred to the receive buffer and the RDRF flag will not be modified. Also no framing error or parity error will be flagged from this transfer. In RXD_2 case, however the break signal starts later during the transmission. At the expected stop bit position the byte received so far will be transferred to the receive buffer, the receive data register full flag will be set, a framing error and if enabled and appropriate a parity error will be set. Once the break is detected the BRKDIF flag will be set.
Start Bit Position Stop Bit Position BRKDIF = 1 RXD_1 Zero Bit Counter 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 . . . FE = 1 RXD_2 BRKDIF = 1
Zero Bit Counter
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
...
Figure 11-17. Break Detection if BRKDFE = 1 (M = 0)
11.4.5.4
Idle Characters
An idle character (or preamble) contains all logic 1s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Idle character length depends on the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1). The preamble is a synchronizing idle character that begins the first transmission initiated after writing the TE bit from 0 to 1. If the TE bit is cleared during a transmission, the TXD pin becomes idle after completion of the transmission in progress. Clearing and then setting the TE bit during a transmission queues an idle character to be sent after the frame currently being transmitted. NOTE When queueing an idle character, return the TE bit to logic 1 before the stop bit of the current frame shifts out through the TXD pin. Setting TE after the stop bit appears on TXD causes data previously written to the SCI data register to be lost. Toggle the TE bit for a queued idle character while the TDRE flag is set and immediately before writing the next byte to the SCI data register. If the TE bit is clear and the transmission is complete, the SCI is not the master of the TXD pin
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 382 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.4.5.5
LIN Transmit Collision Detection
LIN Physical Interface
This module allows to check for collisions on the LIN bus.
Synchronizer Stage Receive Shift Register Compare Bit Error Bus Clock
RXD Pin LIN Bus
Sample Point Transmit Shift Register TXD Pin
Figure 11-18. Collision Detect Principle
If the bit error circuit is enabled (BERRM[1:0] = 0:1 or = 1:0]), the error detect circuit will compare the transmitted and the received data stream at a point in time and flag any mismatch. The timing checks run when transmitter is active (not idle). As soon as a mismatch between the transmitted data and the received data is detected the following happens: * The next bit transmitted will have a high level (TXPOL = 0) or low level (TXPOL = 1) * The transmission is aborted and the byte in transmit buffer is discarded. * the transmit data register empty and the transmission complete flag will be set * The bit error interrupt flag, BERRIF, will be set. * No further transmissions will take place until the BERRIF is cleared.
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Sampling Begin 9 Sampling End 10 11 12 Sampling Begin 13 Sampling End 14 15 0
Output Transmit Shift Register Input Receive Shift Register
BERRM[1:0] = 0:1
BERRM[1:0] = 1:1
Compare Sample Points
Figure 11-19. Timing Diagram Bit Error Detection
If the bit error detect feature is disabled, the bit error interrupt flag is cleared. NOTE The RXPOL and TXPOL bit should be set the same when transmission collision detect feature is enabled, otherwise the bit error interrupt flag may be set incorrectly.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 383
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.4.6
Receiver
Internal Bus
SBR12:SBR0
SCI Data Register
11-Bit Receive Shift Register 8 7 6 All 1s 5 4 3 2 1 0
RXPOL SCRXD From TXD Pin or Transmitter Loop Control
Data Recovery
H
RE RAF
MSB
LOOPS RSRC
FE M WAKE ILT PE PT Wakeup Logic NF PE RWU
Parity Checking
R8 IDLE ILIE Idle IRQ
Start L RDRF/OR IRQ
BRKDFE
Stop
Bus Clock
Baud Divider
RDRF OR RIE Break IRQ
Break Detect Logic
BRKDIF BRKDIE
Active Edge Detect Logic
RXEDGIF RXEDGIE RX Active Edge IRQ
Figure 11-20. SCI Receiver Block Diagram
11.4.6.1
Receiver Character Length
The SCI receiver can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data characters. The state of the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1) determines the length of data characters. When receiving 9-bit data, bit R8 in SCI data register high (SCIDRH) is the ninth bit (bit 8).
11.4.6.2
Character Reception
During an SCI reception, the receive shift register shifts a frame in from the RXD pin. The SCI data register is the read-only buffer between the internal data bus and the receive shift register. After a complete frame shifts into the receive shift register, the data portion of the frame transfers to the SCI data register. The receive data register full flag, RDRF, in SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) becomes set,
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 384 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
indicating that the received byte can be read. If the receive interrupt enable bit, RIE, in SCI control register 2 (SCICR2) is also set, the RDRF flag generates an RDRF interrupt request.
11.4.6.3
Data Sampling
The RT clock rate. The RT clock is an internal signal with a frequency 16 times the baud rate. To adjust for baud rate mismatch, the RT clock (see Figure 11-21) is re-synchronized: * After every start bit * After the receiver detects a data bit change from logic 1 to logic 0 (after the majority of data bit samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10 returns a valid logic 1 and the majority of the next RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples returns a valid logic 0) To locate the start bit, data recovery logic does an asynchronous search for a logic 0 preceded by three logic 1s.When the falling edge of a possible start bit occurs, the RT clock begins to count to 16.
Start Bit RXD Samples 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 LSB
Start Bit Qualification
Start Bit Verification
Data Sampling
RT Clock RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 RT9 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT10 RT11 RT12 RT13 RT14 RT15 RT CLock Count Reset RT Clock RT16 RT4
Figure 11-21. Receiver Data Sampling
To verify the start bit and to detect noise, data recovery logic takes samples at RT3, RT5, and RT7. Figure 11-17 summarizes the results of the start bit verification samples.
Table 11-17. Start Bit Verification
RT3, RT5, and RT7 Samples 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Start Bit Verification Yes Yes Yes No Yes No No No Noise Flag 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 0
If start bit verification is not successful, the RT clock is reset and a new search for a start bit begins.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 385
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
To determine the value of a data bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 11-18 summarizes the results of the data bit samples.
Table 11-18. Data Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Data Bit Determination 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 Noise Flag 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0
NOTE The RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples do not affect start bit verification. If any or all of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 start bit samples are logic 1s following a successful start bit verification, the noise flag (NF) is set and the receiver assumes that the bit is a start bit (logic 0). To verify a stop bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 11-19 summarizes the results of the stop bit samples.
Table 11-19. Stop Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Framing Error Flag 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 Noise Flag 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0
In Figure 11-22 the verification samples RT3 and RT5 determine that the first low detected was noise and not the beginning of a start bit. The RT clock is reset and the start bit search begins again. The noise flag is not set because the noise occurred before the start bit was found.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 386 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Start Bit RXD Samples 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
LSB
RT Clock RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT1 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 RT9 RT1 RT2 LSB RT6 RT10 RT11 RT12 RT13 RT14 RT15 RT Clock Count Reset RT Clock RT16 RT3 RT7
Figure 11-22. Start Bit Search Example 1
In Figure 11-23, verification sample at RT3 is high. The RT3 sample sets the noise flag. Although the perceived bit time is misaligned, the data samples RT8, RT9, and RT10 are within the bit time and data recovery is successful.
Perceived Start Bit Actual Start Bit RXD Samples 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0
RT Clock RT10 RT11 RT12 RT13 RT14 RT15 RT16 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 RT9 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT Clock Count Reset RT Clock RT5
Figure 11-23. Start Bit Search Example 2
In Figure 11-24, a large burst of noise is perceived as the beginning of a start bit, although the test sample at RT5 is high. The RT5 sample sets the noise flag. Although this is a worst-case misalignment of perceived bit time, the data samples RT8, RT9, and RT10 are within the bit time and data recovery is successful.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 387
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Perceived Start Bit Actual Start Bit RXD Samples 1 1 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 LSB
RT Clock RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 RT9 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 LSB RT2 RT10 RT11 RT12 RT13 RT14 RT15 RT Clock Count Reset RT Clock RT16 RT9 RT3
Figure 11-24. Start Bit Search Example 3
Figure 11-25 shows the effect of noise early in the start bit time. Although this noise does not affect proper synchronization with the start bit time, it does set the noise flag.
Perceived and Actual Start Bit RXD Samples 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 0
RT Clock RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT2
RT3
RT4
RT5
RT6
RT7
RT8
RT9
RT10
RT11
RT12
RT13
RT14
RT15
RT Clock Count Reset RT Clock
Figure 11-25. Start Bit Search Example 4
Figure 11-26 shows a burst of noise near the beginning of the start bit that resets the RT clock. The sample after the reset is low but is not preceded by three high samples that would qualify as a falling edge. Depending on the timing of the start bit search and on the data, the frame may be missed entirely or it may set the framing error flag.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 388 Freescale Semiconductor
RT16
RT1
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Start Bit RXD Samples 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 No Start Bit Found 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
LSB
RT Clock RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 LSB RT2 RT Clock Count Reset RT Clock RT1 RT3
Figure 11-26. Start Bit Search Example 5
In Figure 11-27, a noise burst makes the majority of data samples RT8, RT9, and RT10 high. This sets the noise flag but does not reset the RT clock. In start bits only, the RT8, RT9, and RT10 data samples are ignored.
Start Bit RXD Samples 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 1
RT Clock RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 RT9 RT10 RT11 RT12 RT13 RT14 RT15 RT Clock Count Reset RT Clock RT16 RT1
Figure 11-27. Start Bit Search Example 6
11.4.6.4
Framing Errors
If the data recovery logic does not detect a logic 1 where the stop bit should be in an incoming frame, it sets the framing error flag, FE, in SCI status register 1 (SCISR1). A break character also sets the FE flag because a break character has no stop bit. The FE flag is set at the same time that the RDRF flag is set.
11.4.6.5
Baud Rate Tolerance
A transmitting device may be operating at a baud rate below or above the receiver baud rate. Accumulated bit time misalignment can cause one of the three stop bit data samples (RT8, RT9, and RT10) to fall outside the actual stop bit. A noise error will occur if the RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples are not all the same logical values. A framing error will occur if the receiver clock is misaligned in such a way that the majority of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 stop bit samples are a logic zero.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 389
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
As the receiver samples an incoming frame, it re-synchronizes the RT clock on any valid falling edge within the frame. Re synchronization within frames will correct a misalignment between transmitter bit times and receiver bit times. 11.4.6.5.1 Slow Data Tolerance
Figure 11-28 shows how much a slow received frame can be misaligned without causing a noise error or a framing error. The slow stop bit begins at RT8 instead of RT1 but arrives in time for the stop bit data samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10.
MSB Stop
Receiver RT Clock RT10 RT11 RT12 RT13 RT14 RT15 RT16 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 RT9
Data Samples
Figure 11-28. Slow Data
Let's take RTr as receiver RT clock and RTt as transmitter RT clock. For an 8-bit data character, it takes the receiver 9 bit times x 16 RTr cycles +7 RTr cycles = 151 RTr cycles to start data sampling of the stop bit. With the misaligned character shown in Figure 11-28, the receiver counts 151 RTr cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is 9 bit times x 16 RTt cycles = 144 RTt cycles. The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a slow 8-bit data character with no errors is: ((151 - 144) / 151) x 100 = 4.63% For a 9-bit data character, it takes the receiver 10 bit times x 16 RTr cycles + 7 RTr cycles = 167 RTr cycles to start data sampling of the stop bit. With the misaligned character shown in Figure 11-28, the receiver counts 167 RTr cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is 10 bit times x 16 RTt cycles = 160 RTt cycles. The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a slow 9-bit character with no errors is: ((167 - 160) / 167) X 100 = 4.19% 11.4.6.5.2 Fast Data Tolerance
Figure 11-29 shows how much a fast received frame can be misaligned. The fast stop bit ends at RT10 instead of RT16 but is still sampled at RT8, RT9, and RT10.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 390 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
Stop
Idle or Next Frame
Receiver RT Clock RT10 RT11 RT12 RT13 RT14 RT15 RT16 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 RT9
Data Samples
Figure 11-29. Fast Data
For an 8-bit data character, it takes the receiver 9 bit times x 16 RTr cycles + 10 RTr cycles = 154 RTr cycles to finish data sampling of the stop bit. With the misaligned character shown in Figure 11-29, the receiver counts 154 RTr cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is 10 bit times x 16 RTt cycles = 160 RTt cycles. The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a fast 8-bit character with no errors is: ((160 - 154) / 160) x 100 = 3.75% For a 9-bit data character, it takes the receiver 10 bit times x 16 RTr cycles + 10 RTr cycles = 170 RTr cycles to finish data sampling of the stop bit. With the misaligned character shown in Figure 11-29, the receiver counts 170 RTr cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is 11 bit times x 16 RTt cycles = 176 RTt cycles. The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a fast 9-bit character with no errors is: ((176 - 170) /176) x 100 = 3.40%
11.4.6.6
Receiver Wakeup
To enable the SCI to ignore transmissions intended only for other receivers in multiple-receiver systems, the receiver can be put into a standby state. Setting the receiver wakeup bit, RWU, in SCI control register 2 (SCICR2) puts the receiver into standby state during which receiver interrupts are disabled.The SCI will still load the receive data into the SCIDRH/L registers, but it will not set the RDRF flag. The transmitting device can address messages to selected receivers by including addressing information in the initial frame or frames of each message. The WAKE bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1) determines how the SCI is brought out of the standby state to process an incoming message. The WAKE bit enables either idle line wakeup or address mark wakeup. 11.4.6.6.1 Idle Input line Wakeup (WAKE = 0)
In this wakeup method, an idle condition on the RXD pin clears the RWU bit and wakes up the SCI. The initial frame or frames of every message contain addressing information. All receivers evaluate the addressing information, and receivers for which the message is addressed process the frames that follow. Any receiver for which a message is not addressed can set its RWU bit and return to the standby state. The
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 391
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
RWU bit remains set and the receiver remains on standby until another idle character appears on the RXD pin. Idle line wakeup requires that messages be separated by at least one idle character and that no message contains idle characters. The idle character that wakes a receiver does not set the receiver idle bit, IDLE, or the receive data register full flag, RDRF. The idle line type bit, ILT, determines whether the receiver begins counting logic 1s as idle character bits after the start bit or after the stop bit. ILT is in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1). 11.4.6.6.2 Address Mark Wakeup (WAKE = 1)
In this wakeup method, a logic 1 in the most significant bit (MSB) position of a frame clears the RWU bit and wakes up the SCI. The logic 1 in the MSB position marks a frame as an address frame that contains addressing information. All receivers evaluate the addressing information, and the receivers for which the message is addressed process the frames that follow.Any receiver for which a message is not addressed can set its RWU bit and return to the standby state. The RWU bit remains set and the receiver remains on standby until another address frame appears on the RXD pin. The logic 1 MSB of an address frame clears the receiver's RWU bit before the stop bit is received and sets the RDRF flag. Address mark wakeup allows messages to contain idle characters but requires that the MSB be reserved for use in address frames. NOTE With the WAKE bit clear, setting the RWU bit after the RXD pin has been idle can cause the receiver to wake up immediately.
11.4.7
Single-Wire Operation
Normally, the SCI uses two pins for transmitting and receiving. In single-wire operation, the RXD pin is disconnected from the SCI. The SCI uses the TXD pin for both receiving and transmitting.
Transmitter TXD
Receiver
RXD
Figure 11-30. Single-Wire Operation (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 1)
Enable single-wire operation by setting the LOOPS bit and the receiver source bit, RSRC, in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1). Setting the LOOPS bit disables the path from the RXD pin to the receiver. Setting the RSRC bit connects the TXD pin to the receiver. Both the transmitter and receiver must be enabled (TE = 1 and RE = 1).The TXDIR bit (SCISR2[1]) determines whether the TXD pin is going to be used as an input (TXDIR = 0) or an output (TXDIR = 1) in this mode of operation.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 392 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
NOTE In single-wire operation data from the TXD pin is inverted if RXPOL is set.
11.4.8
Loop Operation
In loop operation the transmitter output goes to the receiver input. The RXD pin is disconnected from the SCI.
Transmitter TXD
Receiver
RXD
Figure 11-31. Loop Operation (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 0)
Enable loop operation by setting the LOOPS bit and clearing the RSRC bit in SCI control register 1 (SCICR1). Setting the LOOPS bit disables the path from the RXD pin to the receiver. Clearing the RSRC bit connects the transmitter output to the receiver input. Both the transmitter and receiver must be enabled (TE = 1 and RE = 1). NOTE In loop operation data from the transmitter is not recognized by the receiver if RXPOL and TXPOL are not the same.
11.5
11.5.1
Initialization/Application Information
Reset Initialization
See Section 11.3.2, "Register Descriptions".
11.5.2
11.5.2.1
Modes of Operation
Run Mode
Normal mode of operation. To initialize a SCI transmission, see Section 11.4.5.2, "Character Transmission".
11.5.2.2
Wait Mode
SCI operation in wait mode depends on the state of the SCISWAI bit in the SCI control register 1 (SCICR1). * If SCISWAI is clear, the SCI operates normally when the CPU is in wait mode. * If SCISWAI is set, SCI clock generation ceases and the SCI module enters a power-conservation state when the CPU is in wait mode. Setting SCISWAI does not affect the state of the receiver enable bit, RE, or the transmitter enable bit, TE.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 393
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
If SCISWAI is set, any transmission or reception in progress stops at wait mode entry. The transmission or reception resumes when either an internal or external interrupt brings the CPU out of wait mode. Exiting wait mode by reset aborts any transmission or reception in progress and resets the SCI.
11.5.2.3
Stop Mode
The SCI is inactive during stop mode for reduced power consumption. The STOP instruction does not affect the SCI register states, but the SCI bus clock will be disabled. The SCI operation resumes from where it left off after an external interrupt brings the CPU out of stop mode. Exiting stop mode by reset aborts any transmission or reception in progress and resets the SCI. The receive input active edge detect circuit is still active in stop mode. An active edge on the receive input can be used to bring the CPU out of stop mode.
11.5.3
Interrupt Operation
This section describes the interrupt originated by the SCI block.The MCU must service the interrupt requests. Table 11-20 lists the eight interrupt sources of the SCI.
Table 11-20. SCI Interrupt Sources
Interrupt TDRE TC RDRF OR IDLE Source SCISR1[7] SCISR1[6] SCISR1[5] SCISR1[3] SCISR1[4] ILIE RXEDGIE BERRIE BRKDIE Local Enable TIE TCIE RIE Description Active high level. Indicates that a byte was transferred from SCIDRH/L to the transmit shift register. Active high level. Indicates that a transmit is complete. Active high level. The RDRF interrupt indicates that received data is available in the SCI data register. Active high level. This interrupt indicates that an overrun condition has occurred. Active high level. Indicates that receiver input has become idle. Active high level. Indicates that an active edge (falling for RXPOL = 0, rising for RXPOL = 1) was detected. Active high level. Indicates that a mismatch between transmitted and received data in a single wire application has happened. Active high level. Indicates that a break character has been received.
RXEDGIF SCIASR1[7] BERRIF BKDIF SCIASR1[1] SCIASR1[0]
11.5.3.1
Description of Interrupt Operation
The SCI only originates interrupt requests. The following is a description of how the SCI makes a request and how the MCU should acknowledge that request. The interrupt vector offset and interrupt number are chip dependent. The SCI only has a single interrupt line (SCI Interrupt Signal, active high operation) and all the following interrupts, when generated, are ORed together and issued through that port. 11.5.3.1.1 TDRE Description
The TDRE interrupt is set high by the SCI when the transmit shift register receives a byte from the SCI data register. A TDRE interrupt indicates that the transmit data register (SCIDRH/L) is empty and that a
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 394 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
new byte can be written to the SCIDRH/L for transmission.Clear TDRE by reading SCI status register 1 with TDRE set and then writing to SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 11.5.3.1.2 TC Description
The TC interrupt is set by the SCI when a transmission has been completed. Transmission is completed when all bits including the stop bit (if transmitted) have been shifted out and no data is queued to be transmitted. No stop bit is transmitted when sending a break character and the TC flag is set (providing there is no more data queued for transmission) when the break character has been shifted out. A TC interrupt indicates that there is no transmission in progress. TC is set high when the TDRE flag is set and no data, preamble, or break character is being transmitted. When TC is set, the TXD pin becomes idle (logic 1). Clear TC by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with TC set and then writing to SCI data register low (SCIDRL).TC is cleared automatically when data, preamble, or break is queued and ready to be sent. 11.5.3.1.3 RDRF Description
The RDRF interrupt is set when the data in the receive shift register transfers to the SCI data register. A RDRF interrupt indicates that the received data has been transferred to the SCI data register and that the byte can now be read by the MCU. The RDRF interrupt is cleared by reading the SCI status register one (SCISR1) and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 11.5.3.1.4 OR Description
The OR interrupt is set when software fails to read the SCI data register before the receive shift register receives the next frame. The newly acquired data in the shift register will be lost in this case, but the data already in the SCI data registers is not affected. The OR interrupt is cleared by reading the SCI status register one (SCISR1) and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 11.5.3.1.5 IDLE Description
The IDLE interrupt is set when 10 consecutive logic 1s (if M = 0) or 11 consecutive logic 1s (if M = 1) appear on the receiver input. Once the IDLE is cleared, a valid frame must again set the RDRF flag before an idle condition can set the IDLE flag. Clear IDLE by reading SCI status register 1 (SCISR1) with IDLE set and then reading SCI data register low (SCIDRL). 11.5.3.1.6 RXEDGIF Description
The RXEDGIF interrupt is set when an active edge (falling if RXPOL = 0, rising if RXPOL = 1) on the RXD pin is detected. Clear RXEDGIF by writing a "1" to the SCIASR1 SCI alternative status register 1. 11.5.3.1.7 BERRIF Description
The BERRIF interrupt is set when a mismatch between the transmitted and the received data in a single wire application like LIN was detected. Clear BERRIF by writing a "1" to the SCIASR1 SCI alternative status register 1. This flag is also cleared if the bit error detect feature is disabled.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 395
Serial Communication Interface (S12SCIV5)
11.5.3.1.8
BKDIF Description
The BKDIF interrupt is set when a break signal was received. Clear BKDIF by writing a "1" to the SCIASR1 SCI alternative status register 1. This flag is also cleared if break detect feature is disabled.
11.5.4
Recovery from Wait Mode
The SCI interrupt request can be used to bring the CPU out of wait mode.
11.5.5
Recovery from Stop Mode
An active edge on the receive input can be used to bring the CPU out of stop mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 396 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 12 Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
Table 12-1. Revision History
Revision Number V05.00 Revision Date 24 Mar 2005 Sections Affected 12.3.2/12-401 Description of Changes - Added 16-bit transfer width feature.
12.1
Introduction
The SPI module allows a duplex, synchronous, serial communication between the MCU and peripheral devices. Software can poll the SPI status flags or the SPI operation can be interrupt driven.
12.1.1
Glossary of Terms
SPI SS SCK MOSI MISO MOMI SISO
Serial Peripheral Interface Slave Select Serial Clock Master Output, Slave Input Master Input, Slave Output Master Output, Master Input Slave Input, Slave Output
12.1.2
Features
The SPI includes these distinctive features: * Master mode and slave mode * Selectable 8 or 16-bit transfer width * Bidirectional mode * Slave select output * Mode fault error flag with CPU interrupt capability * Double-buffered data register * Serial clock with programmable polarity and phase * Control of SPI operation during wait mode
12.1.3
Modes of Operation
The SPI functions in three modes: run, wait, and stop.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 397
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
* *
*
Run mode This is the basic mode of operation. Wait mode SPI operation in wait mode is a configurable low power mode, controlled by the SPISWAI bit located in the SPICR2 register. In wait mode, if the SPISWAI bit is clear, the SPI operates like in run mode. If the SPISWAI bit is set, the SPI goes into a power conservative state, with the SPI clock generation turned off. If the SPI is configured as a master, any transmission in progress stops, but is resumed after CPU goes into run mode. If the SPI is configured as a slave, reception and transmission of data continues, so that the slave stays synchronized to the master. Stop mode The SPI is inactive in stop mode for reduced power consumption. If the SPI is configured as a master, any transmission in progress stops, but is resumed after CPU goes into run mode. If the SPI is configured as a slave, reception and transmission of data continues, so that the slave stays synchronized to the master.
For a detailed description of operating modes, please refer to Section 12.4.7, "Low Power Mode Options".
12.1.4
Block Diagram
Figure 12-1 gives an overview on the SPI architecture. The main parts of the SPI are status, control and data registers, shifter logic, baud rate generator, master/slave control logic, and port control logic.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 398 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
SPI 2 SPI Control Register 1 BIDIROE 2 SPI Control Register 2 SPC0 SPI Status Register SPIF MODF SPTEF Interrupt Control SPI Interrupt Request Baud Rate Generator Counter Bus Clock Prescaler Clock Select SPPR 3 SPR 3 Shifter SPI Baud Rate Register LSBFE=1 SPI Data Register LSBFE=0 MSB LSBFE=0 LSBFE=1 LSBFE=0 LSB LSBFE=1 Data Out Data In Baud Rate Shift Clock Sample Clock Slave Control
CPOL
CPHA
MOSI
Phase + SCK In Slave Baud Rate Polarity Control Master Baud Rate Phase + SCK Out Polarity Control Master Control
Port Control Logic
SCK
SS
Figure 12-1. SPI Block Diagram
12.2
External Signal Description
This section lists the name and description of all ports including inputs and outputs that do, or may, connect off chip. The SPI module has a total of four external pins.
12.2.1
MOSI -- Master Out/Slave In Pin
This pin is used to transmit data out of the SPI module when it is configured as a master and receive data when it is configured as slave.
12.2.2
MISO -- Master In/Slave Out Pin
This pin is used to transmit data out of the SPI module when it is configured as a slave and receive data when it is configured as master.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 399
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
12.2.3
SS -- Slave Select Pin
This pin is used to output the select signal from the SPI module to another peripheral with which a data transfer is to take place when it is configured as a master and it is used as an input to receive the slave select signal when the SPI is configured as slave.
12.2.4
SCK -- Serial Clock Pin
In master mode, this is the synchronous output clock. In slave mode, this is the synchronous input clock.
12.3
12.3.1
Memory Map and Register Definition
Module Memory Map
This section provides a detailed description of address space and registers used by the SPI.
The memory map for the SPI is given in Figure 12-2. The address listed for each register is the sum of a base address and an address offset. The base address is defined at the SoC level and the address offset is defined at the module level. Reads from the reserved bits return zeros and writes to the reserved bits have no effect.
Register Name 0x0000 SPICR1 0x0001 SPICR2 0x0002 SPIBR 0x0003 SPISR 0x0004 SPIDRH 0x0005 SPIDRL 0x0006 Reserved 0x0007 Reserved R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W = Unimplemented or Reserved Bit 7 SPIE 0 6 SPE 5 SPTIE 0 4 MSTR 3 CPOL 2 CPHA 0 1 SSOE Bit 0 LSBFE
XFRW
MODFEN
BIDIROE 0
SPISWAI
SPC0
0
SPPR2 0
SPPR1 SPTEF
SPPR0 MODF
SPR2 0
SPR1 0
SPR0 0
SPIF
0
R15 T15 R7 T7
R14 T14 R6 T6
R13 T13 R5 T5
R12 T12 R4 T4
R11 T11 R3 T3
R10 T10 R2 T2
R9 T9 R1 T1
R8 T8 R0 T0
Figure 12-2. SPI Register Summary
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 400 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
12.3.2
Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order. Each description includes a standard register diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field function follow the register diagrams, in bit order.
12.3.2.1
SPI Control Register 1 (SPICR1)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base +0x0000 R W Reset
SPIE 0
SPE 0
SPTIE 0
MSTR 0
CPOL 0
CPHA 1
SSOE 0
LSBFE 0
Figure 12-3. SPI Control Register 1 (SPICR1)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 12-2. SPICR1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 SPIE 6 SPE Description SPI Interrupt Enable Bit -- This bit enables SPI interrupt requests, if SPIF or MODF status flag is set. 0 SPI interrupts disabled. 1 SPI interrupts enabled. SPI System Enable Bit -- This bit enables the SPI system and dedicates the SPI port pins to SPI system functions. If SPE is cleared, SPI is disabled and forced into idle state, status bits in SPISR register are reset. 0 SPI disabled (lower power consumption). 1 SPI enabled, port pins are dedicated to SPI functions. SPI Transmit Interrupt Enable -- This bit enables SPI interrupt requests, if SPTEF flag is set. 0 SPTEF interrupt disabled. 1 SPTEF interrupt enabled. SPI Master/Slave Mode Select Bit -- This bit selects whether the SPI operates in master or slave mode. Switching the SPI from master to slave or vice versa forces the SPI system into idle state. 0 SPI is in slave mode. 1 SPI is in master mode. SPI Clock Polarity Bit -- This bit selects an inverted or non-inverted SPI clock. To transmit data between SPI modules, the SPI modules must have identical CPOL values. In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state. 0 Active-high clocks selected. In idle state SCK is low. 1 Active-low clocks selected. In idle state SCK is high. SPI Clock Phase Bit -- This bit is used to select the SPI clock format. In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state. 0 Sampling of data occurs at odd edges (1,3,5,...) of the SCK clock. 1 Sampling of data occurs at even edges (2,4,6,...) of the SCK clock.
5 SPTIE 4 MSTR
3 CPOL
2 CPHA
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 401
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
Table 12-2. SPICR1 Field Descriptions (continued)
Field 1 SSOE 0 LSBFE Description Slave Select Output Enable -- The SS output feature is enabled only in master mode, if MODFEN is set, by asserting the SSOE as shown in Table 12-3. In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state. LSB-First Enable -- This bit does not affect the position of the MSB and LSB in the data register. Reads and writes of the data register always have the MSB in the highest bit position. In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state. 0 Data is transferred most significant bit first. 1 Data is transferred least significant bit first.
Table 12-3. SS Input / Output Selection
MODFEN 0 0 1 1 SSOE 0 1 0 1 Master Mode SS not used by SPI SS not used by SPI SS input with MODF feature SS is slave select output Slave Mode SS input SS input SS input SS input
12.3.2.2
SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base +0x0001 R W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0
XFRW 0
MODFEN 0
BIDIROE 0
SPISWAI 0
SPC0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 12-4. SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime; writes to the reserved bits have no effect
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 402 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
Table 12-4. SPICR2 Field Descriptions
Field 6 XFRW Description Transfer Width -- This bit is used for selecting the data transfer width. If 8-bit transfer width is selected, SPIDRL becomes the dedicated data register and SPIDRH is unused. If 16-bit transfer width is selected, SPIDRH and SPIDRL form a 16-bit data register. Please refer to Section 12.3.2.4, "SPI Status Register (SPISR) for information about transmit/receive data handling and the interrupt flag clearing mechanism. In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state. 0 8-bit Transfer Width (n = 8)(1) 1 16-bit Transfer Width (n = 16)1 Mode Fault Enable Bit -- This bit allows the MODF failure to be detected. If the SPI is in master mode and MODFEN is cleared, then the SS port pin is not used by the SPI. In slave mode, the SS is available only as an input regardless of the value of MODFEN. For an overview on the impact of the MODFEN bit on the SS port pin configuration, refer to Table 12-3. In master mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state. 0 SS port pin is not used by the SPI. 1 SS port pin with MODF feature. Output Enable in the Bidirectional Mode of Operation -- This bit controls the MOSI and MISO output buffer of the SPI, when in bidirectional mode of operation (SPC0 is set). In master mode, this bit controls the output buffer of the MOSI port, in slave mode it controls the output buffer of the MISO port. In master mode, with SPC0 set, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI into idle state. 0 Output buffer disabled. 1 Output buffer enabled. SPI Stop in Wait Mode Bit -- This bit is used for power conservation while in wait mode. 0 SPI clock operates normally in wait mode. 1 Stop SPI clock generation when in wait mode.
4 MODFEN
3 BIDIROE
1 SPISWAI
0 Serial Pin Control Bit 0 -- This bit enables bidirectional pin configurations as shown in Table 12-5. In master SPC0 mode, a change of this bit will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state. 1. n is used later in this document as a placeholder for the selected transfer width.
Table 12-5. Bidirectional Pin Configurations
Pin Mode SPC0 BIDIROE MISO MOSI
Master Mode of Operation Normal Bidirectional 0 1 X 0 1 Slave Mode of Operation Normal Bidirectional 0 1 X 0 1 Slave Out Slave In Slave I/O Slave In MOSI not used by SPI Master In MISO not used by SPI Master Out Master In Master I/O
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 403
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
12.3.2.3
SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIBR)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base +0x0002 R W Reset 0 0 0 0
SPPR2 0
SPPR1 0
SPPR0 0
SPR2 0
SPR1 0
SPR0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 12-5. SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIBR)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime; writes to the reserved bits have no effect
Table 12-6. SPIBR Field Descriptions
Field 6-4 SPPR[2:0] 2-0 SPR[2:0] Description SPI Baud Rate Preselection Bits -- These bits specify the SPI baud rates as shown in Table 12-7. In master mode, a change of these bits will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state. SPI Baud Rate Selection Bits -- These bits specify the SPI baud rates as shown in Table 12-7. In master mode, a change of these bits will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI system into idle state.
The baud rate divisor equation is as follows:
BaudRateDivisor = (SPPR + 1) * 2(SPR + 1) Eqn. 12-1
The baud rate can be calculated with the following equation:
Baud Rate = BusClock / BaudRateDivisor Eqn. 12-2
NOTE For maximum allowed baud rates, please refer to the SPI Electrical Specification in the Electricals chapter of this data sheet.
Table 12-7. Example SPI Baud Rate Selection (25 MHz Bus Clock) (Sheet 1 of 3)
SPPR2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SPPR1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SPPR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 SPR2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 SPR1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SPR0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Baud Rate Divisor 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 256 4 8 16 32 Baud Rate 12.5 Mbit/s 6.25 Mbit/s 3.125 Mbit/s 1.5625 Mbit/s 781.25 kbit/s 390.63 kbit/s 195.31 kbit/s 97.66 kbit/s 6.25 Mbit/s 3.125 Mbit/s 1.5625 Mbit/s 781.25 kbit/s
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 404 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
Table 12-7. Example SPI Baud Rate Selection (25 MHz Bus Clock) (Sheet 2 of 3)
SPPR2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 SPPR1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 SPPR0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 SPR2 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 SPR1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 SPR0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Baud Rate Divisor 64 128 256 512 6 12 24 48 96 192 384 768 8 16 32 64 128 256 512 1024 10 20 40 80 160 320 640 1280 12 24 48 96 192 384 768 1536 14 28 56 112 224 448 Baud Rate 390.63 kbit/s 195.31 kbit/s 97.66 kbit/s 48.83 kbit/s 4.16667 Mbit/s 2.08333 Mbit/s 1.04167 Mbit/s 520.83 kbit/s 260.42 kbit/s 130.21 kbit/s 65.10 kbit/s 32.55 kbit/s 3.125 Mbit/s 1.5625 Mbit/s 781.25 kbit/s 390.63 kbit/s 195.31 kbit/s 97.66 kbit/s 48.83 kbit/s 24.41 kbit/s 2.5 Mbit/s 1.25 Mbit/s 625 kbit/s 312.5 kbit/s 156.25 kbit/s 78.13 kbit/s 39.06 kbit/s 19.53 kbit/s 2.08333 Mbit/s 1.04167 Mbit/s 520.83 kbit/s 260.42 kbit/s 130.21 kbit/s 65.10 kbit/s 32.55 kbit/s 16.28 kbit/s 1.78571 Mbit/s 892.86 kbit/s 446.43 kbit/s 223.21 kbit/s 111.61 kbit/s 55.80 kbit/s
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 405
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
Table 12-7. Example SPI Baud Rate Selection (25 MHz Bus Clock) (Sheet 3 of 3)
SPPR2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 SPPR1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 SPPR0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 SPR2 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 SPR1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SPR0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Baud Rate Divisor 896 1792 16 32 64 128 256 512 1024 2048 Baud Rate 27.90 kbit/s 13.95 kbit/s 1.5625 Mbit/s 781.25 kbit/s 390.63 kbit/s 195.31 kbit/s 97.66 kbit/s 48.83 kbit/s 24.41 kbit/s 12.21 kbit/s
12.3.2.4
SPI Status Register (SPISR)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base +0x0003 R W Reset 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved SPIF 0 SPTEF MODF 0 0 0 0
Figure 12-6. SPI Status Register (SPISR)
Read: Anytime Write: Has no effect
Table 12-8. SPISR Field Descriptions
Field 7 SPIF Description SPIF Interrupt Flag -- This bit is set after received data has been transferred into the SPI data register. For information about clearing SPIF Flag, please refer to Table 12-9. 0 Transfer not yet complete. 1 New data copied to SPIDR. SPI Transmit Empty Interrupt Flag -- If set, this bit indicates that the transmit data register is empty. For information about clearing this bit and placing data into the transmit data register, please refer to Table 12-10. 0 SPI data register not empty. 1 SPI data register empty. Mode Fault Flag -- This bit is set if the SS input becomes low while the SPI is configured as a master and mode fault detection is enabled, MODFEN bit of SPICR2 register is set. Refer to MODFEN bit description in Section 12.3.2.2, "SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)". The flag is cleared automatically by a read of the SPI status register (with MODF set) followed by a write to the SPI control register 1. 0 Mode fault has not occurred. 1 Mode fault has occurred.
5 SPTEF
4 MODF
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 406 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
Table 12-9. SPIF Interrupt Flag Clearing Sequence
XFRW Bit 0 1 SPIF Interrupt Flag Clearing Sequence Read SPISR with SPIF == 1 Read SPISR with SPIF == 1 then Read SPIDRL Byte Read SPIDRL (1) or then Byte Read SPIDRH (2) or Word Read (SPIDRH:SPIDRL) 1. Data in SPIDRH is lost in this case. 2. SPIDRH can be read repeatedly without any effect on SPIF. SPIF Flag is cleared only by the read of SPIDRL after reading SPISR with SPIF == 1. Byte Read SPIDRL
Table 12-10. SPTEF Interrupt Flag Clearing Sequence
XFRW Bit 0 1 SPTEF Interrupt Flag Clearing Sequence Read SPISR with SPTEF == 1 then Read SPISR with SPTEF == 1 Write to SPIDRL (1) Byte Write to SPIDRL 1(2) or then Byte Write to SPIDRH 1(3) Byte Write to SPIDRL 1 or Word Write to (SPIDRH:SPIDRL) 1 1. Any write to SPIDRH or SPIDRL with SPTEF == 0 is effectively ignored. 2. Data in SPIDRH is undefined in this case. 3. SPIDRH can be written repeatedly without any effect on SPTEF. SPTEF Flag is cleared only by writing to SPIDRL after reading SPISR with SPTEF == 1.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 407
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
12.3.2.5
SPI Data Register (SPIDR = SPIDRH:SPIDRL)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Module Base +0x0004 R W Reset R15 T15 0 R14 T14 0 R13 T13 0 R12 T12 0 R11 T11 0 R10 T10 0 R9 T9 0 R8 T8 0
Figure 12-7. SPI Data Register High (SPIDRH)
Module Base +0x0005
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
R7 T7 0
R6 T6 0
R5 T5 0
R4 T4 0
R3 T3 0
R2 T2 0
R1 T1 0
R0 T0 0
Figure 12-8. SPI Data Register Low (SPIDRL)
Read: Anytime; read data only valid when SPIF is set Write: Anytime The SPI data register is both the input and output register for SPI data. A write to this register allows data to be queued and transmitted. For an SPI configured as a master, queued data is transmitted immediately after the previous transmission has completed. The SPI transmitter empty flag SPTEF in the SPISR register indicates when the SPI data register is ready to accept new data. Received data in the SPIDR is valid when SPIF is set. If SPIF is cleared and data has been received, the received data is transferred from the receive shift register to the SPIDR and SPIF is set. If SPIF is set and not serviced, and a second data value has been received, the second received data is kept as valid data in the receive shift register until the start of another transmission. The data in the SPIDR does not change. If SPIF is set and valid data is in the receive shift register, and SPIF is serviced before the start of a third transmission, the data in the receive shift register is transferred into the SPIDR and SPIF remains set (see Figure 12-9). If SPIF is set and valid data is in the receive shift register, and SPIF is serviced after the start of a third transmission, the data in the receive shift register has become invalid and is not transferred into the SPIDR (see Figure 12-10).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 408 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
Data A Received
Data B Received
Data C Received SPIF Serviced
Receive Shift Register
Data A
Data B
Data C
SPIF
SPI Data Register
Data A
Data B
Data C
= Unspecified
= Reception in progress
Figure 12-9. Reception with SPIF serviced in Time
Data A Received
Data B Received
Data C Received Data B Lost SPIF Serviced
Receive Shift Register
Data A
Data B
Data C
SPIF
SPI Data Register
Data A
Data C
= Unspecified
= Reception in progress
Figure 12-10. Reception with SPIF serviced too late
12.4
Functional Description
The SPI module allows a duplex, synchronous, serial communication between the MCU and peripheral devices. Software can poll the SPI status flags or SPI operation can be interrupt driven. The SPI system is enabled by setting the SPI enable (SPE) bit in SPI control register 1. While SPE is set, the four associated SPI port pins are dedicated to the SPI function as: * Slave select (SS) * Serial clock (SCK) * Master out/slave in (MOSI) * Master in/slave out (MISO)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 409
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
The main element of the SPI system is the SPI data register. The n-bit1 data register in the master and the n-bit1 data register in the slave are linked by the MOSI and MISO pins to form a distributed 2n-bit1 register. When a data transfer operation is performed, this 2n-bit1 register is serially shifted n1 bit positions by the S-clock from the master, so data is exchanged between the master and the slave. Data written to the master SPI data register becomes the output data for the slave, and data read from the master SPI data register after a transfer operation is the input data from the slave. A read of SPISR with SPTEF = 1 followed by a write to SPIDR puts data into the transmit data register. When a transfer is complete and SPIF is cleared, received data is moved into the receive data register. This data register acts as the SPI receive data register for reads and as the SPI transmit data register for writes. A common SPI data register address is shared for reading data from the read data buffer and for writing data to the transmit data register. The clock phase control bit (CPHA) and a clock polarity control bit (CPOL) in the SPI control register 1 (SPICR1) select one of four possible clock formats to be used by the SPI system. The CPOL bit simply selects a non-inverted or inverted clock. The CPHA bit is used to accommodate two fundamentally different protocols by sampling data on odd numbered SCK edges or on even numbered SCK edges (see Section 12.4.3, "Transmission Formats"). The SPI can be configured to operate as a master or as a slave. When the MSTR bit in SPI control register1 is set, master mode is selected, when the MSTR bit is clear, slave mode is selected. NOTE A change of CPOL or MSTR bit while there is a received byte pending in the receive shift register will destroy the received byte and must be avoided.
12.4.1
Master Mode
The SPI operates in master mode when the MSTR bit is set. Only a master SPI module can initiate transmissions. A transmission begins by writing to the master SPI data register. If the shift register is empty, data immediately transfers to the shift register. Data begins shifting out on the MOSI pin under the control of the serial clock. * Serial clock The SPR2, SPR1, and SPR0 baud rate selection bits, in conjunction with the SPPR2, SPPR1, and SPPR0 baud rate preselection bits in the SPI baud rate register, control the baud rate generator and determine the speed of the transmission. The SCK pin is the SPI clock output. Through the SCK pin, the baud rate generator of the master controls the shift register of the slave peripheral. * MOSI, MISO pin In master mode, the function of the serial data output pin (MOSI) and the serial data input pin (MISO) is determined by the SPC0 and BIDIROE control bits. * SS pin If MODFEN and SSOE are set, the SS pin is configured as slave select output. The SS output becomes low during each transmission and is high when the SPI is in idle state. If MODFEN is set and SSOE is cleared, the SS pin is configured as input for detecting mode fault error. If the SS input becomes low this indicates a mode fault error where another master tries to
1. n depends on the selected transfer width, please refer to Section 12.3.2.2, "SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2) S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 410 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
drive the MOSI and SCK lines. In this case, the SPI immediately switches to slave mode, by clearing the MSTR bit and also disables the slave output buffer MISO (or SISO in bidirectional mode). So the result is that all outputs are disabled and SCK, MOSI, and MISO are inputs. If a transmission is in progress when the mode fault occurs, the transmission is aborted and the SPI is forced into idle state. This mode fault error also sets the mode fault (MODF) flag in the SPI status register (SPISR). If the SPI interrupt enable bit (SPIE) is set when the MODF flag becomes set, then an SPI interrupt sequence is also requested. When a write to the SPI data register in the master occurs, there is a half SCK-cycle delay. After the delay, SCK is started within the master. The rest of the transfer operation differs slightly, depending on the clock format specified by the SPI clock phase bit, CPHA, in SPI control register 1 (see Section 12.4.3, "Transmission Formats"). NOTE A change of the bits CPOL, CPHA, SSOE, LSBFE, XFRW, MODFEN, SPC0, or BIDIROE with SPC0 set, SPPR2-SPPR0 and SPR2-SPR0 in master mode will abort a transmission in progress and force the SPI into idle state. The remote slave cannot detect this, therefore the master must ensure that the remote slave is returned to idle state.
12.4.2
Slave Mode
The SPI operates in slave mode when the MSTR bit in SPI control register 1 is clear. * Serial clock In slave mode, SCK is the SPI clock input from the master. * MISO, MOSI pin In slave mode, the function of the serial data output pin (MISO) and serial data input pin (MOSI) is determined by the SPC0 bit and BIDIROE bit in SPI control register 2. * SS pin The SS pin is the slave select input. Before a data transmission occurs, the SS pin of the slave SPI must be low. SS must remain low until the transmission is complete. If SS goes high, the SPI is forced into idle state. The SS input also controls the serial data output pin, if SS is high (not selected), the serial data output pin is high impedance, and, if SS is low, the first bit in the SPI data register is driven out of the serial data output pin. Also, if the slave is not selected (SS is high), then the SCK input is ignored and no internal shifting of the SPI shift register occurs. Although the SPI is capable of duplex operation, some SPI peripherals are capable of only receiving SPI data in a slave mode. For these simpler devices, there is no serial data out pin. NOTE When peripherals with duplex capability are used, take care not to simultaneously enable two receivers whose serial outputs drive the same system slave's serial data output line.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 411
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
As long as no more than one slave device drives the system slave's serial data output line, it is possible for several slaves to receive the same transmission from a master, although the master would not receive return information from all of the receiving slaves. If the CPHA bit in SPI control register 1 is clear, odd numbered edges on the SCK input cause the data at the serial data input pin to be latched. Even numbered edges cause the value previously latched from the serial data input pin to shift into the LSB or MSB of the SPI shift register, depending on the LSBFE bit. If the CPHA bit is set, even numbered edges on the SCK input cause the data at the serial data input pin to be latched. Odd numbered edges cause the value previously latched from the serial data input pin to shift into the LSB or MSB of the SPI shift register, depending on the LSBFE bit. When CPHA is set, the first edge is used to get the first data bit onto the serial data output pin. When CPHA is clear and the SS input is low (slave selected), the first bit of the SPI data is driven out of the serial data output pin. After the nth1 shift, the transfer is considered complete and the received data is transferred into the SPI data register. To indicate transfer is complete, the SPIF flag in the SPI status register is set. NOTE A change of the bits CPOL, CPHA, SSOE, LSBFE, MODFEN, SPC0, or BIDIROE with SPC0 set in slave mode will corrupt a transmission in progress and must be avoided.
12.4.3
Transmission Formats
During an SPI transmission, data is transmitted (shifted out serially) and received (shifted in serially) simultaneously. The serial clock (SCK) synchronizes shifting and sampling of the information on the two serial data lines. A slave select line allows selection of an individual slave SPI device; slave devices that are not selected do not interfere with SPI bus activities. Optionally, on a master SPI device, the slave select line can be used to indicate multiple-master bus contention.
MASTER SPI MISO MOSI SCK BAUD RATE GENERATOR SS MISO MOSI SCK SS SLAVE SPI
SHIFT REGISTER
SHIFT REGISTER
VDD
Figure 12-11. Master/Slave Transfer Block Diagram
12.4.3.1
Clock Phase and Polarity Controls
Using two bits in the SPI control register 1, software selects one of four combinations of serial clock phase and polarity.
1. n depends on the selected transfer width, please refer to Section 12.3.2.2, "SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2) S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 412 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
The CPOL clock polarity control bit specifies an active high or low clock and has no significant effect on the transmission format. The CPHA clock phase control bit selects one of two fundamentally different transmission formats. Clock phase and polarity should be identical for the master SPI device and the communicating slave device. In some cases, the phase and polarity are changed between transmissions to allow a master device to communicate with peripheral slaves having different requirements.
12.4.3.2
CPHA = 0 Transfer Format
The first edge on the SCK line is used to clock the first data bit of the slave into the master and the first data bit of the master into the slave. In some peripherals, the first bit of the slave's data is available at the slave's data out pin as soon as the slave is selected. In this format, the first SCK edge is issued a half cycle after SS has become low. A half SCK cycle later, the second edge appears on the SCK line. When this second edge occurs, the value previously latched from the serial data input pin is shifted into the LSB or MSB of the shift register, depending on LSBFE bit. After this second edge, the next bit of the SPI master data is transmitted out of the serial data output pin of the master to the serial input pin on the slave. This process continues for a total of 16 edges on the SCK line, with data being latched on odd numbered edges and shifted on even numbered edges. Data reception is double buffered. Data is shifted serially into the SPI shift register during the transfer and is transferred to the parallel SPI data register after the last bit is shifted in. After 2n1 (last) SCK edges: * Data that was previously in the master SPI data register should now be in the slave data register and the data that was in the slave data register should be in the master. * The SPIF flag in the SPI status register is set, indicating that the transfer is complete. Figure 12-12 is a timing diagram of an SPI transfer where CPHA = 0. SCK waveforms are shown for CPOL = 0 and CPOL = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master or slave timing diagram because the SCK, MISO, and MOSI pins are connected directly between the master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from the slave and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS pin of the master must be either high or reconfigured as a general-purpose output not affecting the SPI.
1. n depends on the selected transfer width, please refer to Section 12.3.2.2, "SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2) S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 413
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
End of Idle State SCK Edge Number SCK (CPOL = 0) SCK (CPOL = 1) 1 2
Begin 3 4 5 6
Transfer 7 8 9 10 11 12
End 13 14 15 16
Begin of Idle State
CHANGE O MOSI pin CHANGE O MISO pin SEL SS (O) Master only SEL SS (I)
tL
tT Bit 1 Bit 6
tI
tL
MSB first (LSBFE = 0): MSB Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 LSB first (LSBFE = 1): LSB Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge tI = Minimum idling time between transfers (minimum SS high time) tL, tT, and tI are guaranteed for the master mode and required for the slave mode.
LSB Minimum 1/2 SCK for tT, tl, tL MSB
Figure 12-12. SPI Clock Format 0 (CPHA = 0), with 8-bit Transfer Width selected (XFRW = 0)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 414 Freescale Semiconductor
If next transfer begins here
SAMPLE I MOSI/MISO
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
End of Idle State SCK Edge Number SCK (CPOL = 0) SCK (CPOL = 1) 1 2 3 4
Begin 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Transfer 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
End 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
Begin of Idle State
CHANGE O MOSI pin CHANGE O MISO pin SEL SS (O) Master only SEL SS (I)
MSB first (LSBFE = 0) LSB first (LSBFE = 1)
tL tT tI tL MSB Bit 14Bit 13Bit 12Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB Minimum 1/2 SCK LSB Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 Bit 7 Bit 8 Bit 9 Bit 10Bit 11Bit 12Bit 13Bit 14 MSB for tT, tl, tL
tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge tI = Minimum idling time between transfers (minimum SS high time) tL, tT, and tI are guaranteed for the master mode and required for the slave mode.
Figure 12-13. SPI Clock Format 0 (CPHA = 0), with 16-Bit Transfer Width selected (XFRW = 1)
In slave mode, if the SS line is not deasserted between the successive transmissions then the content of the SPI data register is not transmitted; instead the last received data is transmitted. If the SS line is deasserted for at least minimum idle time (half SCK cycle) between successive transmissions, then the content of the SPI data register is transmitted. In master mode, with slave select output enabled the SS line is always deasserted and reasserted between successive transfers for at least minimum idle time.
12.4.3.3
CPHA = 1 Transfer Format
Some peripherals require the first SCK edge before the first data bit becomes available at the data out pin, the second edge clocks data into the system. In this format, the first SCK edge is issued by setting the CPHA bit at the beginning of the n1-cycle transfer operation. The first edge of SCK occurs immediately after the half SCK clock cycle synchronization delay. This first edge commands the slave to transfer its first data bit to the serial data input pin of the master. A half SCK cycle later, the second edge appears on the SCK pin. This is the latching edge for both the master and slave.
1. n depends on the selected transfer width, please refer to Section 12.3.2.2, "SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2) S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 415
If next transfer begins here
SAMPLE I MOSI/MISO
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
When the third edge occurs, the value previously latched from the serial data input pin is shifted into the LSB or MSB of the SPI shift register, depending on LSBFE bit. After this edge, the next bit of the master data is coupled out of the serial data output pin of the master to the serial input pin on the slave. This process continues for a total of n1 edges on the SCK line with data being latched on even numbered edges and shifting taking place on odd numbered edges. Data reception is double buffered, data is serially shifted into the SPI shift register during the transfer and is transferred to the parallel SPI data register after the last bit is shifted in. After 2n1 SCK edges: * Data that was previously in the SPI data register of the master is now in the data register of the slave, and data that was in the data register of the slave is in the master. * The SPIF flag bit in SPISR is set indicating that the transfer is complete. Figure 12-14 shows two clocking variations for CPHA = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master or slave timing diagram because the SCK, MISO, and MOSI pins are connected directly between the master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from the slave, and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS line is the slave select input to the slave. The SS pin of the master must be either high or reconfigured as a general-purpose output not affecting the SPI.
End of Idle State SCK Edge Number SCK (CPOL = 0) SCK (CPOL = 1) 1 2 3 Begin 4 5 6 7 Transfer 8 9 10 11 12 End 13 14 15 16 Begin of Idle State
CHANGE O MOSI pin CHANGE O MISO pin SEL SS (O) Master only SEL SS (I)
tL
tT
tI
tL
MSB first (LSBFE = 0): LSB first (LSBFE = 1):
MSB Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB Minimum 1/2 SCK for tT, tl, tL LSB Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 MSB tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge, not required for back-to-back transfers tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge tI = Minimum idling time between transfers (minimum SS high time), not required for back-to-back transfers
Figure 12-14. SPI Clock Format 1 (CPHA = 1), with 8-Bit Transfer Width selected (XFRW = 0)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 416 Freescale Semiconductor
If next transfer begins here
SAMPLE I MOSI/MISO
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
End of Idle State SCK Edge Number SCK (CPOL = 0) SCK (CPOL = 1) 1 2 3 4
Begin 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Transfer 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
End 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
Begin of Idle State
CHANGE O MOSI pin CHANGE O MISO pin SEL SS (O) Master only SEL SS (I)
tL MSB first (LSBFE = 0) LSB first (LSBFE = 1)
MSB Bit 14Bit 13Bit 12Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB LSB Bit 1 Bit 2 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 5 Bit 6 Bit 7 Bit 8 Bit 9 Bit 10Bit 11Bit 12Bit 13Bit 14 MSB
tT tI tL Minimum 1/2 SCK for tT, tl, tL
tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge, not required for back-to-back transfers tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge tI = Minimum idling time between transfers (minimum SS high time), not required for back-to-back transfers
Figure 12-15. SPI Clock Format 1 (CPHA = 1), with 16-Bit Transfer Width selected (XFRW = 1)
The SS line can remain active low between successive transfers (can be tied low at all times). This format is sometimes preferred in systems having a single fixed master and a single slave that drive the MISO data line. * Back-to-back transfers in master mode In master mode, if a transmission has completed and new data is available in the SPI data register, this data is sent out immediately without a trailing and minimum idle time. The SPI interrupt request flag (SPIF) is common to both the master and slave modes. SPIF gets set one half SCK cycle after the last SCK edge.
12.4.4
SPI Baud Rate Generation
Baud rate generation consists of a series of divider stages. Six bits in the SPI baud rate register (SPPR2, SPPR1, SPPR0, SPR2, SPR1, and SPR0) determine the divisor to the SPI module clock which results in the SPI baud rate. The SPI clock rate is determined by the product of the value in the baud rate preselection bits (SPPR2-SPPR0) and the value in the baud rate selection bits (SPR2-SPR0). The module clock divisor equation is shown in Equation 12-3.
BaudRateDivisor = (SPPR + 1) * 2(SPR + 1)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 417
If next transfer begins here
SAMPLE I MOSI/MISO
Eqn. 12-3
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
When all bits are clear (the default condition), the SPI module clock is divided by 2. When the selection bits (SPR2-SPR0) are 001 and the preselection bits (SPPR2-SPPR0) are 000, the module clock divisor becomes 4. When the selection bits are 010, the module clock divisor becomes 8, etc. When the preselection bits are 001, the divisor determined by the selection bits is multiplied by 2. When the preselection bits are 010, the divisor is multiplied by 3, etc. See Table 12-7 for baud rate calculations for all bit conditions, based on a 25 MHz bus clock. The two sets of selects allows the clock to be divided by a non-power of two to achieve other baud rates such as divide by 6, divide by 10, etc. The baud rate generator is activated only when the SPI is in master mode and a serial transfer is taking place. In the other cases, the divider is disabled to decrease IDD current. NOTE For maximum allowed baud rates, please refer to the SPI Electrical Specification in the Electricals chapter of this data sheet.
12.4.5
12.4.5.1
Special Features
SS Output
The SS output feature automatically drives the SS pin low during transmission to select external devices and drives it high during idle to deselect external devices. When SS output is selected, the SS output pin is connected to the SS input pin of the external device. The SS output is available only in master mode during normal SPI operation by asserting SSOE and MODFEN bit as shown in Table 12-3. The mode fault feature is disabled while SS output is enabled. NOTE Care must be taken when using the SS output feature in a multimaster system because the mode fault feature is not available for detecting system errors between masters.
12.4.5.2
Bidirectional Mode (MOMI or SISO)
The bidirectional mode is selected when the SPC0 bit is set in SPI control register 2 (see Table 12-11). In this mode, the SPI uses only one serial data pin for the interface with external device(s). The MSTR bit decides which pin to use. The MOSI pin becomes the serial data I/O (MOMI) pin for the master mode, and the MISO pin becomes serial data I/O (SISO) pin for the slave mode. The MISO pin in master mode and MOSI pin in slave mode are not used by the SPI.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 418 Freescale Semiconductor
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
Table 12-11. Normal Mode and Bidirectional Mode
When SPE = 1 Master Mode MSTR = 1 Slave Mode MSTR = 0
Serial Out
MOSI
Serial In SPI
MOSI
Normal Mode SPC0 = 0
SPI Serial In MISO
Serial Out
MISO
Serial Out
MOMI BIDIROE
Serial In BIDIROE SPI Serial Out SISO
Bidirectional Mode SPC0 = 1
SPI Serial In
The direction of each serial I/O pin depends on the BIDIROE bit. If the pin is configured as an output, serial data from the shift register is driven out on the pin. The same pin is also the serial input to the shift register. * The SCK is output for the master mode and input for the slave mode. * The SS is the input or output for the master mode, and it is always the input for the slave mode. * The bidirectional mode does not affect SCK and SS functions. NOTE In bidirectional master mode, with mode fault enabled, both data pins MISO and MOSI can be occupied by the SPI, though MOSI is normally used for transmissions in bidirectional mode and MISO is not used by the SPI. If a mode fault occurs, the SPI is automatically switched to slave mode. In this case MISO becomes occupied by the SPI and MOSI is not used. This must be considered, if the MISO pin is used for another purpose.
12.4.6
Error Conditions
The SPI has one error condition: * Mode fault error
12.4.6.1
Mode Fault Error
If the SS input becomes low while the SPI is configured as a master, it indicates a system error where more than one master may be trying to drive the MOSI and SCK lines simultaneously. This condition is not permitted in normal operation, the MODF bit in the SPI status register is set automatically, provided the MODFEN bit is set. In the special case where the SPI is in master mode and MODFEN bit is cleared, the SS pin is not used by the SPI. In this special case, the mode fault error function is inhibited and MODF remains cleared. In case
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 419
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
the SPI system is configured as a slave, the SS pin is a dedicated input pin. Mode fault error doesn't occur in slave mode. If a mode fault error occurs, the SPI is switched to slave mode, with the exception that the slave output buffer is disabled. So SCK, MISO, and MOSI pins are forced to be high impedance inputs to avoid any possibility of conflict with another output driver. A transmission in progress is aborted and the SPI is forced into idle state. If the mode fault error occurs in the bidirectional mode for a SPI system configured in master mode, output enable of the MOMI (MOSI in bidirectional mode) is cleared if it was set. No mode fault error occurs in the bidirectional mode for SPI system configured in slave mode. The mode fault flag is cleared automatically by a read of the SPI status register (with MODF set) followed by a write to SPI control register 1. If the mode fault flag is cleared, the SPI becomes a normal master or slave again. NOTE If a mode fault error occurs and a received data byte is pending in the receive shift register, this data byte will be lost.
12.4.7
12.4.7.1
Low Power Mode Options
SPI in Run Mode
In run mode with the SPI system enable (SPE) bit in the SPI control register clear, the SPI system is in a low-power, disabled state. SPI registers remain accessible, but clocks to the core of this module are disabled.
12.4.7.2
SPI in Wait Mode
SPI operation in wait mode depends upon the state of the SPISWAI bit in SPI control register 2. * If SPISWAI is clear, the SPI operates normally when the CPU is in wait mode * If SPISWAI is set, SPI clock generation ceases and the SPI module enters a power conservation state when the CPU is in wait mode. - If SPISWAI is set and the SPI is configured for master, any transmission and reception in progress stops at wait mode entry. The transmission and reception resumes when the SPI exits wait mode. If SPISWAI is set and the SPI is configured as a slave, any transmission and reception in progress continues if the SCK continues to be driven from the master. This keeps the slave synchronized to the master and the SCK. If the master transmits several bytes while the slave is in wait mode, the slave will continue to send out bytes consistent with the operation mode at the start of wait mode (i.e., if the slave is currently sending its SPIDR to the master, it will continue to send the same byte. Else if the slave is currently sending the last received byte from the master, it will continue to send each previous master byte).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 420 Freescale Semiconductor
-
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
NOTE Care must be taken when expecting data from a master while the slave is in wait or stop mode. Even though the shift register will continue to operate, the rest of the SPI is shut down (i.e., a SPIF interrupt will not be generated until exiting stop or wait mode). Also, the byte from the shift register will not be copied into the SPIDR register until after the slave SPI has exited wait or stop mode. In slave mode, a received byte pending in the receive shift register will be lost when entering wait or stop mode. An SPIF flag and SPIDR copy is generated only if wait mode is entered or exited during a tranmission. If the slave enters wait mode in idle mode and exits wait mode in idle mode, neither a SPIF nor a SPIDR copy will occur.
12.4.7.3
SPI in Stop Mode
Stop mode is dependent on the system. The SPI enters stop mode when the module clock is disabled (held high or low). If the SPI is in master mode and exchanging data when the CPU enters stop mode, the transmission is frozen until the CPU exits stop mode. After stop, data to and from the external SPI is exchanged correctly. In slave mode, the SPI will stay synchronized with the master. The stop mode is not dependent on the SPISWAI bit.
12.4.7.4
Reset
The reset values of registers and signals are described in Section 12.3, "Memory Map and Register Definition", which details the registers and their bit fields. * If a data transmission occurs in slave mode after reset without a write to SPIDR, it will transmit garbage, or the data last received from the master before the reset. * Reading from the SPIDR after reset will always read zeros.
12.4.7.5
Interrupts
The SPI only originates interrupt requests when SPI is enabled (SPE bit in SPICR1 set). The following is a description of how the SPI makes a request and how the MCU should acknowledge that request. The interrupt vector offset and interrupt priority are chip dependent. The interrupt flags MODF, SPIF, and SPTEF are logically ORed to generate an interrupt request. 12.4.7.5.1 MODF
MODF occurs when the master detects an error on the SS pin. The master SPI must be configured for the MODF feature (see Table 12-3). After MODF is set, the current transfer is aborted and the following bit is changed: * MSTR = 0, The master bit in SPICR1 resets. The MODF interrupt is reflected in the status register MODF flag. Clearing the flag will also clear the interrupt. This interrupt will stay active while the MODF flag is set. MODF has an automatic clearing process which is described in Section 12.3.2.4, "SPI Status Register (SPISR)".
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 421
Serial Peripheral Interface (S12SPIV5)
12.4.7.5.2
SPIF
SPIF occurs when new data has been received and copied to the SPI data register. After SPIF is set, it does not clear until it is serviced. SPIF has an automatic clearing process, which is described in Section 12.3.2.4, "SPI Status Register (SPISR)". 12.4.7.5.3 SPTEF
SPTEF occurs when the SPI data register is ready to accept new data. After SPTEF is set, it does not clear until it is serviced. SPTEF has an automatic clearing process, which is described in Section 12.3.2.4, "SPI Status Register (SPISR)".
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 422 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 13 128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-1. Revision History
Revision Number V01.09 V01.10 Revision Date 28 Jul 2008 19 Dec 2008 Sections Affected 13.1.1/13-424 13.3.1/13-427 13.1/13-423 13.4.5.4/13-455 13.4.5.6/13-457 13.4.5.11/13461 13.4.5.11/13461 13.4.5.11/13461 13.5.2/13-469 Description of Changes - Remove reference to IFRON in Program IFR definition - Remove reference to IFRON in Table 13-4 and Figure 13-3 - Clarify single bit fault correction for P-Flash phrase - Add statement concerning code runaway when executing Read Once, Program Once, and Verify Backdoor Access Key commands from Flash block containing associated fields - Relate Key 0 to associated Backdoor Comparison Key address - Change "power down reset" to "reset" - Reformat section on unsecuring MCU using BDM
V01.11
25 Sep 2009
-The following changes were made to clarify module behavior related to Flash register access during reset sequence and while Flash commands are active: 13.3.2/13-430 - Add caution concerning register writes while command is active 13.3.2.1/13-431 - Writes to FCLKDIV are allowed during reset sequence while CCIF is clear 13.4.3.2/13-449 - Add caution concerning register writes while command is active - Writes to FCCOBIX, FCCOBHI, FCCOBLO registers are ignored during 13.6/13-470 reset sequence
13.1
Introduction
The FTMRC128K1 module implements the following: * 128 Kbytes of P-Flash (Program Flash) memory * 4 Kbytes of D-Flash (Data Flash) memory The Flash memory is ideal for single-supply applications allowing for field reprogramming without requiring external high voltage sources for program or erase operations. The Flash module includes a memory controller that executes commands to modify Flash memory contents. The user interface to the memory controller consists of the indexed Flash Common Command Object (FCCOB) register which is written to with the command, global address, data, and any required command parameters. The memory controller must complete the execution of a command before the FCCOB register can be written to with a new command.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 423
CAUTION A Flash word or phrase must be in the erased state before being programmed. Cumulative programming of bits within a Flash word or phrase is not allowed. The Flash memory may be read as bytes, aligned words, or misaligned words. Read access time is one bus cycle for bytes and aligned words, and two bus cycles for misaligned words. For Flash memory, an erased bit reads 1 and a programmed bit reads 0. It is possible to read from P-Flash memory while some commands are executing on D-Flash memory. It is not possible to read from D-Flash memory while a command is executing on P-Flash memory. Simultaneous P-Flash and D-Flash operations are discussed in Section 13.4.4. Both P-Flash and D-Flash memories are implemented with Error Correction Codes (ECC) that can resolve single bit faults and detect double bit faults. For P-Flash memory, the ECC implementation requires that programming be done on an aligned 8 byte basis (a Flash phrase). Since P-Flash memory is always read by half-phrase, only one single bit fault in an aligned 4 byte half-phrase containing the byte or word accessed will be corrected.
13.1.1
Glossary
Command Write Sequence -- An MCU instruction sequence to execute built-in algorithms (including program and erase) on the Flash memory. D-Flash Memory -- The D-Flash memory constitutes the nonvolatile memory store for data. D-Flash Sector -- The D-Flash sector is the smallest portion of the D-Flash memory that can be erased. The D-Flash sector consists of four 64 byte rows for a total of 256 bytes. NVM Command Mode -- An NVM mode using the CPU to setup the FCCOB register to pass parameters required for Flash command execution. Phrase -- An aligned group of four 16-bit words within the P-Flash memory. Each phrase includes two sets of aligned double words with each set including 7 ECC bits for single bit fault correction and double bit fault detection within each double word. P-Flash Memory -- The P-Flash memory constitutes the main nonvolatile memory store for applications. P-Flash Sector -- The P-Flash sector is the smallest portion of the P-Flash memory that can be erased. Each P-Flash sector contains 512 bytes. Program IFR -- Nonvolatile information register located in the P-Flash block that contains the Device ID, Version ID, and the Program Once field.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 424
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
13.1.2
13.1.2.1
* * * * * *
Features
P-Flash Features
128 Kbytes of P-Flash memory composed of one 128 Kbyte Flash block divided into 256 sectors of 512 bytes Single bit fault correction and double bit fault detection within a 32-bit double word during read operations Automated program and erase algorithm with verify and generation of ECC parity bits Fast sector erase and phrase program operation Ability to read the P-Flash memory while programming a word in the D-Flash memory Flexible protection scheme to prevent accidental program or erase of P-Flash memory
13.1.2.2
* * * * * *
D-Flash Features
4 Kbytes of D-Flash memory composed of one 4 Kbyte Flash block divided into 16 sectors of 256 bytes Single bit fault correction and double bit fault detection within a word during read operations Automated program and erase algorithm with verify and generation of ECC parity bits Fast sector erase and word program operation Protection scheme to prevent accidental program or erase of D-Flash memory Ability to program up to four words in a burst sequence
13.1.2.3
* * *
Other Flash Module Features
No external high-voltage power supply required for Flash memory program and erase operations Interrupt generation on Flash command completion and Flash error detection Security mechanism to prevent unauthorized access to the Flash memory
13.1.3
Block Diagram
The block diagram of the Flash module is shown in Figure 13-1.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 425
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Flash Interface
Command Interrupt Request Error Interrupt Request Registers
16bit internal bus
P-Flash 32Kx39
sector 0 sector 1 sector 255
Protection
Security Bus Clock
Clock Divider FCLK Memory Controller D-Flash 2Kx22
sector 0 sector 1 sector 15
CPU
Scratch RAM 384x16
Figure 13-1. FTMRC128K1 Block Diagram
13.2
External Signal Description
The Flash module contains no signals that connect off-chip.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 426 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
13.3
Memory Map and Registers
This section describes the memory map and registers for the Flash module. Read data from unimplemented memory space in the Flash module is undefined. Write access to unimplemented or reserved memory space in the Flash module will be ignored by the Flash module.
13.3.1
Module Memory Map
The S12 architecture places the P-Flash memory between global addresses 0x2_0000 and 0x3_FFFF as shown in Table 13-2.The P-Flash memory map is shown in Figure 13-2.
Table 13-2. P-Flash Memory Addressing
Global Address Size (Bytes) 128 K Description P-Flash Block Contains Flash Configuration Field (see Table 13-3)
0x2_0000 - 0x3_FFFF
The FPROT register, described in Section 13.3.2.9, can be set to protect regions in the Flash memory from accidental program or erase. Three separate memory regions, one growing upward from global address 0x3_8000 in the Flash memory (called the lower region), one growing downward from global address 0x3_FFFF in the Flash memory (called the higher region), and the remaining addresses in the Flash memory, can be activated for protection. The Flash memory addresses covered by these protectable regions are shown in the P-Flash memory map. The higher address region is mainly targeted to hold the boot loader code since it covers the vector space. Default protection settings as well as security information that allows the MCU to restrict access to the Flash module are stored in the Flash configuration field as described in Table 13-3.
Table 13-3. Flash Configuration Field
Global Address Size (Bytes) 8 4 1 1 1 1 Description Backdoor Comparison Key Refer to Section 13.4.5.11, "Verify Backdoor Access Key Command," and Section 13.5.1, "Unsecuring the MCU using Backdoor Key Access" Reserved P-Flash Protection byte. Refer to Section 13.3.2.9, "P-Flash Protection Register (FPROT)" D-Flash Protection byte. Refer to Section 13.3.2.10, "D-Flash Protection Register (DFPROT)" Flash Nonvolatile byte Refer to Section 13.3.2.16, "Flash Option Register (FOPT)"
0x3_FF00-0x3_FF07 0x3_FF08-0x3_FF0B(1) 0x3_FF0C1 0x3_FF0D1 0x3_FF0E1 0x3_FF0F1
Flash Security byte Refer to Section 13.3.2.2, "Flash Security Register (FSEC)" 1. 0x3FF08-0x3_FF0F form a Flash phrase and must be programmed in a single command write sequence. Each byte in the 0x3_FF08 - 0x3_FF0B reserved field should be programmed to 0xFF.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 427
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
P-Flash START = 0x2_0000
Flash Protected/Unprotected Region 96 Kbytes
0x3_8000 0x3_8400 0x3_8800 0x3_9000 Protection Fixed End 0x3_A000
Flash Protected/Unprotected Lower Region 1, 2, 4, 8 Kbytes
Protection Movable End 0x3_C000 Protection Fixed End
Flash Protected/Unprotected Region 8 Kbytes (up to 29 Kbytes)
0x3_E000
Flash Protected/Unprotected Higher Region 2, 4, 8, 16 Kbytes
0x3_F000 0x3_F800 P-Flash END = 0x3_FFFF Flash Configuration Field 16 bytes (0x3_FF00 - 0x3_FF0F)
Figure 13-2. P-Flash Memory Map Table 13-4. Program IFR Fields
Global Address 0x0_4000 - 0x0_4007 0x0_4008 - 0x0_40B5 0x0_40B6 - 0x0_40B7 Size (Bytes) 8 174 2 Reserved Reserved Version ID(1) Field Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 428 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-4. Program IFR Fields
Global Address 0x0_40B8 - 0x0_40BF 0x0_40C0 - 0x0_40FF Size (Bytes) 8 64 Reserved Field Description
Program Once Field Refer to Section 13.4.5.6, "Program Once Command" 1. Used to track firmware patch versions, see Section 13.4.2
Table 13-5. D-Flash and Memory Controller Resource Fields
Global Address 0x0_4000 - 0x0_43FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_53FF 0x0_5400 - 0x0_57FF 0x0_5800 - 0x0_5AFF 0x0_5B00 - 0x0_5FFF 0x0_6000 - 0x0_67FF 0x0_6800 - 0x0_7FFF 1. MMCCTL1 register bit Size (Bytes) 1,024 4,096 1,024 768 1,280 2,048 6,144 Reserved D-Flash Memory Reserved Memory Controller Scratch RAM (RAMON(1) = 1) Reserved Reserved Reserved Description
0x0_4000 0x0_40FF D-Flash Start = 0x0_4400
P-Flash IFR 1 Kbyte
D-Flash Memory 4 Kbytes D-Flash End = 0x0_53FF Reserved 1 Kbyte RAM Start = 0x0_5800 RAM End = 0x0_5AFF 0x0_6000 0x0_6800 Reserved 6 Kbytes Scratch Ram 768 bytes (RAMON) Reserved 1280 bytes Reserved 2 Kbytes
0x0_7FFF
Figure 13-3. D-Flash and Memory Controller Resource Memory Map
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 429
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
13.3.2
Register Descriptions
The Flash module contains a set of 20 control and status registers located between Flash module base + 0x0000 and 0x0013. A summary of the Flash module registers is given in Figure 13-4 with detailed descriptions in the following subsections. CAUTION Writes to any Flash register must be avoided while a Flash command is active (CCIF=0) to prevent corruption of Flash register contents and adversely affect Memory Controller behavior.
Address & Name 0x0000 FCLKDIV 0x0001 FSEC 0x0002 FCCOBIX 0x0003 FRSV0 0x0004 FCNFG 0x0005 FERCNFG 0x0006 FSTAT 0x0007 FERSTAT 0x0008 FPROT 0x0009 DFPROT R W R W R W R W R CCIE W R W R CCIF W R W R FPOPEN W R DPOPEN W 0 0 0 DPS3 DPS2 DPS1 DPS0 RNV6 FPHDIS FPHS1 FPHS0 FPLDIS FPLS1 FPLS0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DFDIF SFDIF 0 ACCERR FPVIOL MGBUSY RSVD MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DFDIE SFDIE 0 0 IGNSF 0 0 FDFD FSFD 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CCOBIX2 CCOBIX1 CCOBIX0 KEYEN1 KEYEN0 RNV5 RNV4 RNV3 RNV2 SEC1 SEC0 7 FDIVLD FDIVLCK FDIV5 FDIV4 FDIV3 FDIV2 FDIV1 FDIV0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Figure 13-4. FTMRC128K1 Register Summary
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 430 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Address & Name 0x000A FCCOBHI 0x000B FCCOBLO 0x000C FRSV1 0x000D FRSV2 0x000E FRSV3 0x000F FRSV4 0x0010 FOPT 0x0011 FRSV5 0x0012 FRSV6 0x0013 FRSV7 R
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CCOB15 W R CCOB7 W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W 0 0 0 NV7 0 0 0 0
CCOB14
CCOB13
CCOB12
CCOB11
CCOB10
CCOB9
CCOB8
CCOB6
CCOB5
CCOB4
CCOB3
CCOB2
CCOB1
CCOB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
NV6
NV5
NV4
NV3
NV2
NV1
NV0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-4. FTMRC128K1 Register Summary (continued)
13.3.2.1
Flash Clock Divider Register (FCLKDIV)
The FCLKDIV register is used to control timed events in program and erase algorithms.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 431
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Offset Module Base + 0x0000
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
FDIVLD FDIVLCK 0 0 0 0 0 FDIV[5:0] 0 0 0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-5. Flash Clock Divider Register (FCLKDIV)
All bits in the FCLKDIV register are readable, bit 7 is not writable, bit 6 is write-once-hi and controls the writability of the FDIV field. CAUTION The FCLKDIV register must never be written to while a Flash command is executing (CCIF=0). The FCLKDIV register is writable during the Flash reset sequence even though CCIF is clear.
Table 13-6. FCLKDIV Field Descriptions
Field 7 FDIVLD 6 FDIVLCK Description Clock Divider Loaded 0 FCLKDIV register has not been written since the last reset 1 FCLKDIV register has been written since the last reset Clock Divider Locked 0 FDIV field is open for writing 1 FDIV value is locked and cannot be changed. Once the lock bit is set high, only reset can clear this bit and restore writability to the FDIV field. Clock Divider Bits -- FDIV[5:0] must be set to effectively divide BUSCLK down to 1 MHz to control timed events during Flash program and erase algorithms. Table 13-7 shows recommended values for FDIV[5:0] based on the BUSCLK frequency. Please refer to Section 13.4.3, "Flash Command Operations," for more information.
5-0 FDIV[5:0]
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 432 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-7. FDIV values for various BUSCLK Frequencies
BUSCLK Frequency (MHz) MIN(1) 1.0 1.6 2.6 3.6 4.6 5.6 6.6 7.6 8.6 9.6 10.6 11.6 12.6 13.6 14.6 MAX(2) 1.6 2.6 3.6 4.6 5.6 6.6 7.6 8.6 9.6 10.6 11.6 12.6 13.6 14.6 15.6 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E BUSCLK Frequency (MHz) MIN
1
FDIV[5:0]
FDIV[5:0]
MAX
2
16.6 17.6 18.6 19.6 20.6 21.6 22.6 23.6 24.6 25.6 26.6 27.6 28.6 29.6 30.6 31.6
17.6 18.6 19.6 20.6 21.6 22.6 23.6 24.6 25.6 26.6 27.6 28.6 29.6 30.6 31.6 32.6
0x10 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x14 0x15 0x16 0x17 0x18 0x19 0x1A 0x1B 0x1C 0x1D 0x1E 0x1F
15.6 16.6 0x0F 1. BUSCLK is Greater Than this value. 2. BUSCLK is Less Than or Equal to this value.
13.3.2.2
Flash Security Register (FSEC)
The FSEC register holds all bits associated with the security of the MCU and Flash module.
Offset Module Base + 0x0001
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset F
KEYEN[1:0]
RNV[5:2]
SEC[1:0]
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-6. Flash Security Register (FSEC)
All bits in the FSEC register are readable but not writable. During the reset sequence, the FSEC register is loaded with the contents of the Flash security byte in the Flash configuration field at global address 0x3_FF0F located in P-Flash memory (see Table 13-3) as indicated by reset condition F in Figure 13-6. If a double bit fault is detected while reading the P-Flash
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 433
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
phrase containing the Flash security byte during the reset sequence, all bits in the FSEC register will be set to leave the Flash module in a secured state with backdoor key access disabled.
Table 13-8. FSEC Field Descriptions
Field Description
7-6 Backdoor Key Security Enable Bits -- The KEYEN[1:0] bits define the enabling of backdoor key access to the KEYEN[1:0] Flash module as shown in Table 13-9. 5-2 RNV[5:2} 1-0 SEC[1:0] Reserved Nonvolatile Bits -- The RNV bits should remain in the erased state for future enhancements. Flash Security Bits -- The SEC[1:0] bits define the security state of the MCU as shown in Table 13-10. If the Flash module is unsecured using backdoor key access, the SEC bits are forced to 10.
Table 13-9. Flash KEYEN States
KEYEN[1:0] 00 01 10 Status of Backdoor Key Access DISABLED DISABLED(1) ENABLED
11 DISABLED 1. Preferred KEYEN state to disable backdoor key access.
Table 13-10. Flash Security States
SEC[1:0] 00 01 10 Status of Security SECURED SECURED(1) UNSECURED
11 SECURED 1. Preferred SEC state to set MCU to secured state.
The security function in the Flash module is described in Section 13.5.
13.3.2.3
Flash CCOB Index Register (FCCOBIX)
The FCCOBIX register is used to index the FCCOB register for Flash memory operations.
Offset Module Base + 0x0002
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0 CCOBIX[2:0]
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-7. FCCOB Index Register (FCCOBIX)
CCOBIX bits are readable and writable while remaining bits read 0 and are not writable.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 434 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-11. FCCOBIX Field Descriptions
Field 2-0 CCOBIX[1:0] Description Common Command Register Index-- The CCOBIX bits are used to select which word of the FCCOB register array is being read or written to. See Section 13.3.2.11, "Flash Common Command Object Register (FCCOB)," for more details.
13.3.2.4
Flash Reserved0 Register (FRSV0)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
Offset Module Base + 0x000C
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-8. Flash Reserved0 Register (FRSV0)
All bits in the FRSV0 register read 0 and are not writable.
13.3.2.5
Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG)
The FCNFG register enables the Flash command complete interrupt and forces ECC faults on Flash array read access from the CPU.
Offset Module Base + 0x0004
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R CCIE W Reset 0
0
0 IGNSF
0
0 FDFD FSFD 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-9. Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG)
CCIE, IGNSF, FDFD, and FSFD bits are readable and writable while remaining bits read 0 and are not writable.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 435
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-12. FCNFG Field Descriptions
Field 7 CCIE Description Command Complete Interrupt Enable -- The CCIE bit controls interrupt generation when a Flash command has completed. 0 Command complete interrupt disabled 1 An interrupt will be requested whenever the CCIF flag in the FSTAT register is set (see Section 13.3.2.7) Ignore Single Bit Fault -- The IGNSF controls single bit fault reporting in the FERSTAT register (see Section 13.3.2.8). 0 All single bit faults detected during array reads are reported 1 Single bit faults detected during array reads are not reported and the single bit fault interrupt will not be generated Force Double Bit Fault Detect -- The FDFD bit allows the user to simulate a double bit fault during Flash array read operations and check the associated interrupt routine. The FDFD bit is cleared by writing a 0 to FDFD. The FECCR registers will not be updated during the Flash array read operation with FDFD set unless an actual double bit fault is detected. 0 Flash array read operations will set the DFDIF flag in the FERSTAT register only if a double bit fault is detected 1 Any Flash array read operation will force the DFDIF flag in the FERSTAT register to be set (see Section 13.3.2.7) and an interrupt will be generated as long as the DFDIE interrupt enable in the FERCNFG register is set (see Section 13.3.2.6) Force Single Bit Fault Detect -- The FSFD bit allows the user to simulate a single bit fault during Flash array read operations and check the associated interrupt routine. The FSFD bit is cleared by writing a 0 to FSFD. The FECCR registers will not be updated during the Flash array read operation with FSFD set unless an actual single bit fault is detected. 0 Flash array read operations will set the SFDIF flag in the FERSTAT register only if a single bit fault is detected 1 Flash array read operation will force the SFDIF flag in the FERSTAT register to be set (see Section 13.3.2.7) and an interrupt will be generated as long as the SFDIE interrupt enable in the FERCNFG register is set (see Section 13.3.2.6)
4 IGNSF
1 FDFD
0 FSFD
13.3.2.6
Flash Error Configuration Register (FERCNFG)
The FERCNFG register enables the Flash error interrupts for the FERSTAT flags.
Offset Module Base + 0x0005
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0 DFDIE SFDIE 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-10. Flash Error Configuration Register (FERCNFG)
All assigned bits in the FERCNFG register are readable and writable.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 436 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-13. FERCNFG Field Descriptions
Field 1 DFDIE Description Double Bit Fault Detect Interrupt Enable -- The DFDIE bit controls interrupt generation when a double bit fault is detected during a Flash block read operation. 0 DFDIF interrupt disabled 1 An interrupt will be requested whenever the DFDIF flag is set (see Section 13.3.2.8) Single Bit Fault Detect Interrupt Enable -- The SFDIE bit controls interrupt generation when a single bit fault is detected during a Flash block read operation. 0 SFDIF interrupt disabled whenever the SFDIF flag is set (see Section 13.3.2.8) 1 An interrupt will be requested whenever the SFDIF flag is set (see Section 13.3.2.8)
0 SFDIE
13.3.2.7
Flash Status Register (FSTAT)
The FSTAT register reports the operational status of the Flash module.
Offset Module Base + 0x0006
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R CCIF W Reset 1
0 ACCERR 0 0 FPVIOL 0
MGBUSY
RSVD
MGSTAT[1:0]
0
0
0(1)
01
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-11. Flash Status Register (FSTAT)
1. Reset value can deviate from the value shown if a double bit fault is detected during the reset sequence (see Section 13.6).
CCIF, ACCERR, and FPVIOL bits are readable and writable, MGBUSY and MGSTAT bits are readable but not writable, while remaining bits read 0 and are not writable.
Table 13-14. FSTAT Field Descriptions Field 7 CCIF Description Command Complete Interrupt Flag -- The CCIF flag indicates that a Flash command has completed. The CCIF flag is cleared by writing a 1 to CCIF to launch a command and CCIF will stay low until command completion or command violation. 0 Flash command in progress 1 Flash command has completed Flash Access Error Flag -- The ACCERR bit indicates an illegal access has occurred to the Flash memory caused by either a violation of the command write sequence (see Section 13.4.3.2) or issuing an illegal Flash command. While ACCERR is set, the CCIF flag cannot be cleared to launch a command. The ACCERR bit is cleared by writing a 1 to ACCERR. Writing a 0 to the ACCERR bit has no effect on ACCERR. 0 No access error detected 1 Access error detected Flash Protection Violation Flag --The FPVIOL bit indicates an attempt was made to program or erase an address in a protected area of P-Flash or D-Flash memory during a command write sequence. The FPVIOL bit is cleared by writing a 1 to FPVIOL. Writing a 0 to the FPVIOL bit has no effect on FPVIOL. While FPVIOL is set, it is not possible to launch a command or start a command write sequence. 0 No protection violation detected 1 Protection violation detected
5 ACCERR
4 FPVIOL
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 437
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-14. FSTAT Field Descriptions (continued) Field 3 MGBUSY 2 RSVD Description Memory Controller Busy Flag -- The MGBUSY flag reflects the active state of the Memory Controller. 0 Memory Controller is idle 1 Memory Controller is busy executing a Flash command (CCIF = 0) Reserved Bit -- This bit is reserved and always reads 0.
1-0 Memory Controller Command Completion Status Flag -- One or more MGSTAT flag bits are set if an error MGSTAT[1:0] is detected during execution of a Flash command or during the Flash reset sequence. See Section 13.4.5, "Flash Command Description," and Section 13.6, "Initialization" for details.
13.3.2.8
Flash Error Status Register (FERSTAT)
The FERSTAT register reflects the error status of internal Flash operations.
Offset Module Base + 0x0007
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0 DFDIF SFDIF 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-12. Flash Error Status Register (FERSTAT)
All flags in the FERSTAT register are readable and only writable to clear the flag.
Table 13-15. FERSTAT Field Descriptions
Field 1 DFDIF Description Double Bit Fault Detect Interrupt Flag -- The setting of the DFDIF flag indicates that a double bit fault was detected in the stored parity and data bits during a Flash array read operation or that a Flash array read operation was attempted on a Flash block that was under a Flash command operation.(1) The DFDIF flag is cleared by writing a 1 to DFDIF. Writing a 0 to DFDIF has no effect on DFDIF. 0 No double bit fault detected 1 Double bit fault detected or an invalid Flash array read operation attempted
Single Bit Fault Detect Interrupt Flag -- With the IGNSF bit in the FCNFG register clear, the SFDIF flag indicates that a single bit fault was detected in the stored parity and data bits during a Flash array read operation or that a Flash array read operation was attempted on a Flash block that was under a Flash command operation.1 The SFDIF flag is cleared by writing a 1 to SFDIF. Writing a 0 to SFDIF has no effect on SFDIF. 0 No single bit fault detected 1 Single bit fault detected and corrected or an invalid Flash array read operation attempted 1. The single bit fault and double bit fault flags are mutually exclusive for parity errors (an ECC fault occurrence can be either single fault or double fault but never both). A simultaneous access collision (read attempted while command running) is indicated when both SFDIF and DFDIF flags are high.
0 SFDIF
13.3.2.9
P-Flash Protection Register (FPROT)
The FPROT register defines which P-Flash sectors are protected against program and erase operations.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 438 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Offset Module Base + 0x0008
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R FPOPEN W Reset F
RNV6 FPHDIS F F F FPHS[1:0] F FPLDIS F F FPLS[1:0] F
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-13. Flash Protection Register (FPROT)
The (unreserved) bits of the FPROT register are writable with the restriction that the size of the protected region can only be increased (see Section 13.3.2.9.1, "P-Flash Protection Restrictions," and Table 13-20). During the reset sequence, the FPROT register is loaded with the contents of the P-Flash protection byte in the Flash configuration field at global address 0x3_FF0C located in P-Flash memory (see Table 13-3) as indicated by reset condition `F' in Figure 13-13. To change the P-Flash protection that will be loaded during the reset sequence, the upper sector of the P-Flash memory must be unprotected, then the P-Flash protection byte must be reprogrammed. If a double bit fault is detected while reading the P-Flash phrase containing the P-Flash protection byte during the reset sequence, the FPOPEN bit will be cleared and remaining bits in the FPROT register will be set to leave the P-Flash memory fully protected. Trying to alter data in any protected area in the P-Flash memory will result in a protection violation error and the FPVIOL bit will be set in the FSTAT register. The block erase of a P-Flash block is not possible if any of the P-Flash sectors contained in the same P-Flash block are protected.
Table 13-16. FPROT Field Descriptions
Field 7 FPOPEN Description Flash Protection Operation Enable -- The FPOPEN bit determines the protection function for program or erase operations as shown in Table 13-17 for the P-Flash block. 0 When FPOPEN is clear, the FPHDIS and FPLDIS bits define unprotected address ranges as specified by the corresponding FPHS and FPLS bits 1 When FPOPEN is set, the FPHDIS and FPLDIS bits enable protection for the address range specified by the corresponding FPHS and FPLS bits Reserved Nonvolatile Bit -- The RNV bit should remain in the erased state for future enhancements. Flash Protection Higher Address Range Disable -- The FPHDIS bit determines whether there is a protected/unprotected area in a specific region of the P-Flash memory ending with global address 0x3_FFFF. 0 Protection/Unprotection enabled 1 Protection/Unprotection disabled Flash Protection Higher Address Size -- The FPHS bits determine the size of the protected/unprotected area in P-Flash memory as shown inTable 13-18. The FPHS bits can only be written to while the FPHDIS bit is set. Flash Protection Lower Address Range Disable -- The FPLDIS bit determines whether there is a protected/unprotected area in a specific region of the P-Flash memory beginning with global address 0x3_8000. 0 Protection/Unprotection enabled 1 Protection/Unprotection disabled Flash Protection Lower Address Size -- The FPLS bits determine the size of the protected/unprotected area in P-Flash memory as shown in Table 13-19. The FPLS bits can only be written to while the FPLDIS bit is set.
6 RNV[6] 5 FPHDIS
4-3 FPHS[1:0] 2 FPLDIS
1-0 FPLS[1:0]
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 439
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-17. P-Flash Protection Function
FPOPEN 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 FPHDIS 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 FPLDIS 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Function(1) No P-Flash Protection Protected Low Range Protected High Range Protected High and Low Ranges Full P-Flash Memory Protected Unprotected Low Range Unprotected High Range
0 0 0 Unprotected High and Low Ranges 1. For range sizes, refer to Table 13-18 and Table 13-19.
Table 13-18. P-Flash Protection Higher Address Range
FPHS[1:0] 00 01 10 11 Global Address Range 0x3_F800-0x3_FFFF 0x3_F000-0x3_FFFF 0x3_E000-0x3_FFFF 0x3_C000-0x3_FFFF Protected Size 2 Kbytes 4 Kbytes 8 Kbytes 16 Kbytes
Table 13-19. P-Flash Protection Lower Address Range
FPLS[1:0] 00 01 10 11 Global Address Range 0x3_8000-0x3_83FF 0x3_8000-0x3_87FF 0x3_8000-0x3_8FFF 0x3_8000-0x3_9FFF Protected Size 1 Kbyte 2 Kbytes 4 Kbytes 8 Kbytes
All possible P-Flash protection scenarios are shown in Figure 13-14. Although the protection scheme is loaded from the Flash memory at global address 0x3_FF0C during the reset sequence, it can be changed by the user. The P-Flash protection scheme can be used by applications requiring reprogramming in single chip mode while providing as much protection as possible if reprogramming is not required.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 440 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
FPHDIS = 1 FPLDIS = 1
FLASH START
FPHDIS = 1 FPLDIS = 0 6
FPHDIS = 0 FPLDIS = 1 5
FPHDIS = 0 FPLDIS = 0 4
Scenario
7
0x3_8000
0x3_FFFF
Scenario
FLASH START
3
2
1
0
FPHS[1:0] FPHS[1:0] FPLS[1:0] FPOPEN = 0
441
0x3_8000
0x3_FFFF
Unprotected region Protected region not defined by FPLS, FPHS
Protected region with size defined by FPLS Protected region with size defined by FPHS
Figure 13-14. P-Flash Protection Scenarios
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor
FPLS[1:0]
FPOPEN = 1
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
13.3.2.9.1
P-Flash Protection Restrictions
The general guideline is that P-Flash protection can only be added and not removed. Table 13-20 specifies all valid transitions between P-Flash protection scenarios. Any attempt to write an invalid scenario to the FPROT register will be ignored. The contents of the FPROT register reflect the active protection scenario. See the FPHS and FPLS bit descriptions for additional restrictions.
Table 13-20. P-Flash Protection Scenario Transitions
From Protection Scenario 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 X X To Protection Scenario(1) 0 X 1 X X X 2 X 3 X X X X X X X X X X X X 4 5 6 7
X X X X X X X X 7 1. Allowed transitions marked with X, see Figure 13-14 for a definition of the scenarios.
13.3.2.10 D-Flash Protection Register (DFPROT)
The DFPROT register defines which D-Flash sectors are protected against program and erase operations.
Offset Module Base + 0x0009
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R DPOPEN W Reset F
0
0
0 DPS[3:0]
0
0
0
F
F
F
F
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-15. D-Flash Protection Register (DFPROT)
The (unreserved) bits of the DFPROT register are writable with the restriction that protection can be added but not removed. Writes must increase the DPS value and the DPOPEN bit can only be written from 1 (protection disabled) to 0 (protection enabled). If the DPOPEN bit is set, the state of the DPS bits is irrelevant. During the reset sequence, the DFPROT register is loaded with the contents of the D-Flash protection byte in the Flash configuration field at global address 0x3_FF0D located in P-Flash memory (see Table 13-3) as indicated by reset condition F in Figure 13-15. To change the D-Flash protection that will be loaded during the reset sequence, the P-Flash sector containing the D-Flash protection byte must be unprotected, then the D-Flash protection byte must be programmed. If a double bit fault is detected while reading the
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 442 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
P-Flash phrase containing the D-Flash protection byte during the reset sequence, the DPOPEN bit will be cleared and DPS bits will be set to leave the D-Flash memory fully protected. Trying to alter data in any protected area in the D-Flash memory will result in a protection violation error and the FPVIOL bit will be set in the FSTAT register. Block erase of the D-Flash memory is not possible if any of the D-Flash sectors are protected.
Table 13-21. DFPROT Field Descriptions
Field 7 DPOPEN Description D-Flash Protection Control 0 Enables D-Flash memory protection from program and erase with protected address range defined by DPS bits 1 Disables D-Flash memory protection from program and erase D-Flash Protection Size -- The DPS[3:0] bits determine the size of the protected area in the D-Flash memory as shown in Table 13-22.
3-0 DPS[3:0]
Table 13-22. D-Flash Protection Address Range
DPS[3:0] 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 Global Address Range 0x0_4400 - 0x0_44FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_45FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_46FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_47FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_48FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_49FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_4AFF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_4BFF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_4CFF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_4DFF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_4EFF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_4FFF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_50FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_51FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_52FF 0x0_4400 - 0x0_53FF Protected Size 256 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1024 bytes 1280 bytes 1536 bytes 1792 bytes 2048 bytes 2304 bytes 2560 bytes 2816 bytes 3072 bytes 3328 bytes 3584 bytes 3840 bytes 4096 bytes
13.3.2.11 Flash Common Command Object Register (FCCOB)
The FCCOB is an array of six words addressed via the CCOBIX index found in the FCCOBIX register. Byte wide reads and writes are allowed to the FCCOB register.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 443
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Offset Module Base + 0x000A
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R CCOB[15:8] W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 13-16. Flash Common Command Object High Register (FCCOBHI)
Offset Module Base + 0x000B
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R CCOB[7:0] W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Figure 13-17. Flash Common Command Object Low Register (FCCOBLO)
13.3.2.11.1 FCCOB - NVM Command Mode NVM command mode uses the indexed FCCOB register to provide a command code and its relevant parameters to the Memory Controller. The user first sets up all required FCCOB fields and then initiates the command's execution by writing a 1 to the CCIF bit in the FSTAT register (a 1 written by the user clears the CCIF command completion flag to 0). When the user clears the CCIF bit in the FSTAT register all FCCOB parameter fields are locked and cannot be changed by the user until the command completes (as evidenced by the Memory Controller returning CCIF to 1). Some commands return information to the FCCOB register array. The generic format for the FCCOB parameter fields in NVM command mode is shown in Table 13-23. The return values are available for reading after the CCIF flag in the FSTAT register has been returned to 1 by the Memory Controller. Writes to the unimplemented parameter fields (CCOBIX = 110 and CCOBIX = 111) are ignored with reads from these fields returning 0x0000. Table 13-23 shows the generic Flash command format. The high byte of the first word in the CCOB array contains the command code, followed by the parameters for this specific Flash command. For details on the FCCOB settings required by each command, see the Flash command descriptions in Section 13.4.5.
Table 13-23. FCCOB - NVM Command Mode (Typical Usage)
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 LO HI 001 LO HI 010 LO Data 0 [7:0] Global address [7:0] Data 0 [15:8] 6'h0, Global address [17:16] Global address [15:8] Byte HI FCCOB Parameter Fields (NVM Command Mode) FCMD[7:0] defining Flash command
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 444 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-23. FCCOB - NVM Command Mode (Typical Usage)
CCOBIX[2:0] 011 LO HI 100 LO HI 101 LO Data 3 [7:0] Data 2 [7:0] Data 3 [15:8] Data 1 [7:0] Data 2 [15:8] Byte HI FCCOB Parameter Fields (NVM Command Mode) Data 1 [15:8]
13.3.2.12 Flash Reserved1 Register (FRSV1)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
Offset Module Base + 0x000C
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-18. Flash Reserved1 Register (FRSV1)
All bits in the FRSV1 register read 0 and are not writable.
13.3.2.13 Flash Reserved2 Register (FRSV2)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
Offset Module Base + 0x000D
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-19. Flash Reserved2 Register (FRSV2)
All bits in the FRSV2 register read 0 and are not writable.
13.3.2.14 Flash Reserved3 Register (FRSV3)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 445
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Offset Module Base + 0x000E
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-20. Flash Reserved3 Register (FRSV3)
All bits in the FRSV3 register read 0 and are not writable.
13.3.2.15 Flash Reserved4 Register (FRSV4)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
Offset Module Base + 0x000F
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-21. Flash Reserved4 Register (FRSV4)
All bits in the FRSV4 register read 0 and are not writable.
13.3.2.16 Flash Option Register (FOPT)
The FOPT register is the Flash option register.
Offset Module Base + 0x0010
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset F F F F
NV[7:0]
F
F
F
F
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-22. Flash Option Register (FOPT)
All bits in the FOPT register are readable but are not writable. During the reset sequence, the FOPT register is loaded from the Flash nonvolatile byte in the Flash configuration field at global address 0x3_FF0E located in P-Flash memory (see Table 13-3) as indicated by reset condition F in Figure 13-22. If a double bit fault is detected while reading the P-Flash phrase containing the Flash nonvolatile byte during the reset sequence, all bits in the FOPT register will be set.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 446 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-24. FOPT Field Descriptions
Field 7-0 NV[7:0] Description Nonvolatile Bits -- The NV[7:0] bits are available as nonvolatile bits. Refer to the device user guide for proper use of the NV bits.
13.3.2.17 Flash Reserved5 Register (FRSV5)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
Offset Module Base + 0x0011
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-23. Flash Reserved5 Register (FRSV5)
All bits in the FRSV5 register read 0 and are not writable.
13.3.2.18 Flash Reserved6 Register (FRSV6)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
Offset Module Base + 0x0012
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-24. Flash Reserved6 Register (FRSV6)
All bits in the FRSV6 register read 0 and are not writable.
13.3.2.19 Flash Reserved7 Register (FRSV7)
This Flash register is reserved for factory testing.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 447
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Offset Module Base + 0x0013
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 13-25. Flash Reserved7 Register (FRSV7)
All bits in the FRSV7 register read 0 and are not writable.
13.4
13.4.1
Functional Description
Modes of Operation
The FTMRC128K1 module provides the modes of operation shown in Table 13-25. The operating mode is determined by module-level inputs and affects the FCLKDIV, FCNFG, and DFPROT registers, Scratch RAM writes, and the command set availability (see Table 13-27).
Table 13-25. Modes and Mode Control Inputs
Operating Mode Normal: Special: FTMRC Input mmc_mode_ss_t2 0 1
13.4.2
IFR Version ID Word
The version ID word is stored in the IFR at address 0x0_40B6. The contents of the word are defined in Table 13-26.
Table 13-26. IFR Version ID Fields
[15:4] Reserved [3:0] VERNUM
*
VERNUM: Version number. The first version is number 0b_0001 with both 0b_0000 and 0b_1111 meaning `none'.
13.4.3
Flash Command Operations
Flash command operations are used to modify Flash memory contents. The next sections describe:
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 448 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
* * *
How to write the FCLKDIV register that is used to generate a time base (FCLK) derived from BUSCLK for Flash program and erase command operations The command write sequence used to set Flash command parameters and launch execution Valid Flash commands available for execution
13.4.3.1
Writing the FCLKDIV Register
Prior to issuing any Flash program or erase command after a reset, the user is required to write the FCLKDIV register to divide BUSCLK down to a target FCLK of 1 MHz. Table 13-7 shows recommended values for the FDIV field based on BUSCLK frequency. NOTE Programming or erasing the Flash memory cannot be performed if the bus clock runs at less than 0.8 MHz. Setting FDIV too high can destroy the Flash memory due to overstress. Setting FDIV too low can result in incomplete programming or erasure of the Flash memory cells. When the FCLKDIV register is written, the FDIVLD bit is set automatically. If the FDIVLD bit is 0, the FCLKDIV register has not been written since the last reset. If the FCLKDIV register has not been written, any Flash program or erase command loaded during a command write sequence will not execute and the ACCERR bit in the FSTAT register will set.
13.4.3.2
Command Write Sequence
The Memory Controller will launch all valid Flash commands entered using a command write sequence. Before launching a command, the ACCERR and FPVIOL bits in the FSTAT register must be clear (see Section 13.3.2.7) and the CCIF flag should be tested to determine the status of the current command write sequence. If CCIF is 0, the previous command write sequence is still active, a new command write sequence cannot be started, and all writes to the FCCOB register are ignored. CAUTION Writes to any Flash register must be avoided while a Flash command is active (CCIF=0) to prevent corruption of Flash register contents and Memory Controller behavior. 13.4.3.2.1 Define FCCOB Contents
The FCCOB parameter fields must be loaded with all required parameters for the Flash command being executed. Access to the FCCOB parameter fields is controlled via the CCOBIX bits in the FCCOBIX register (see Section 13.3.2.3). The contents of the FCCOB parameter fields are transferred to the Memory Controller when the user clears the CCIF command completion flag in the FSTAT register (writing 1 clears the CCIF to 0). The CCIF flag will remain clear until the Flash command has completed. Upon completion, the Memory Controller will return CCIF to 1 and the FCCOB register will be used to communicate any results. The flow for a generic command write sequence is shown in Figure 13-26.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 449
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
START
Read: FCLKDIV register Clock Divider Value Check
no no Read: FSTAT register CCIF Set? yes
FDIV Correct? yes
FCCOB Availability Check
Note: FCLKDIV must be set after each reset
Read: FSTAT register no CCIF Set? yes
Write: FCLKDIV register
Results from previous Command Access Error and Protection Violation Check ACCERR/ FPVIOL Set? no Write to FCCOBIX register to identify specific command parameter to load. yes Write: FSTAT register Clear ACCERR/FPVIOL 0x30
Write to FCCOB register to load required command parameter.
More Parameters? no
yes
Write: FSTAT register (to launch command) Clear CCIF 0x80 Read: FSTAT register Bit Polling for Command Completion Check
CCIF Set? yes EXIT
no
Figure 13-26. Generic Flash Command Write Sequence Flowchart
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 450 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
13.4.3.3
Valid Flash Module Commands
Table 13-27. Flash Commands by Mode
Unsecured FCMD Command NS
(1)
Secured NS
(3)
SS(2)
SS(4)
0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x10 0x11
Erase Verify All Blocks Erase Verify Block Erase Verify P-Flash Section Read Once Program P-Flash Program Once Erase All Blocks Erase Flash Block Erase P-Flash Sector Unsecure Flash Verify Backdoor Access Key Set User Margin Level Set Field Margin Level Erase Verify D-Flash Section Program D-Flash




0x12 Erase D-Flash Sector 1. Unsecured Normal Single Chip mode. 2. Unsecured Special Single Chip mode. 3. Secured Normal Single Chip mode. 4. Secured Special Single Chip mode.
13.4.3.4
P-Flash Commands
Table 13-28 summarizes the valid P-Flash commands along with the effects of the commands on the PFlash block and other resources within the Flash module.
Table 13-28. P-Flash Commands
FCMD 0x01 0x02 0x03 Command Erase Verify All Blocks Erase Verify Block Erase Verify PFlash Section Function on P-Flash Memory Verify that all P-Flash (and D-Flash) blocks are erased. Verify that a P-Flash block is erased. Verify that a given number of words starting at the address provided are erased.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 451
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-28. P-Flash Commands
FCMD 0x04 0x06 0x07 Command Read Once Program P-Flash Program Once Function on P-Flash Memory Read a dedicated 64 byte field in the nonvolatile information register in P-Flash block that was previously programmed using the Program Once command. Program a phrase in a P-Flash block. Program a dedicated 64 byte field in the nonvolatile information register in P-Flash block that is allowed to be programmed only once. Erase all P-Flash (and D-Flash) blocks. An erase of all Flash blocks is only possible when the FPLDIS, FPHDIS, and FPOPEN bits in the FPROT register and the DPOPEN bit in the DFPROT register are set prior to launching the command. Erase a P-Flash (or D-Flash) block. An erase of the full P-Flash block is only possible when FPLDIS, FPHDIS and FPOPEN bits in the FPROT register are set prior to launching the command. Erase all bytes in a P-Flash sector. Supports a method of releasing MCU security by erasing all P-Flash (and D-Flash) blocks and verifying that all P-Flash (and D-Flash) blocks are erased. Supports a method of releasing MCU security by verifying a set of security keys. Specifies a user margin read level for all P-Flash blocks. Specifies a field margin read level for all P-Flash blocks (special modes only).
0x08
Erase All Blocks
0x09
Erase Flash Block Erase P-Flash Sector Unsecure Flash Verify Backdoor Access Key Set User Margin Level Set Field Margin Level
0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E
13.4.3.5
D-Flash Commands
Table 13-29 summarizes the valid D-Flash commands along with the effects of the commands on the DFlash block.
Table 13-29. D-Flash Commands
FCMD 0x01 0x02 Command Erase Verify All Blocks Erase Verify Block Function on D-Flash Memory Verify that all D-Flash (and P-Flash) blocks are erased. Verify that the D-Flash block is erased. Erase all D-Flash (and P-Flash) blocks. An erase of all Flash blocks is only possible when the FPLDIS, FPHDIS, and FPOPEN bits in the FPROT register and the DPOPEN bit in the DFPROT register are set prior to launching the command. Erase a D-Flash (or P-Flash) block. An erase of the full D-Flash block is only possible when DPOPEN bit in the DFPROT register is set prior to launching the command. Supports a method of releasing MCU security by erasing all D-Flash (and P-Flash) blocks and verifying that all D-Flash (and P-Flash) blocks are erased. Specifies a user margin read level for the D-Flash block. Specifies a field margin read level for the D-Flash block (special modes only).
0x08
Erase All Blocks
0x09
Erase Flash Block
0x0B 0x0D 0x0E
Unsecure Flash Set User Margin Level Set Field Margin Level
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 452 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-29. D-Flash Commands
FCMD 0x10 0x11 0x12 Command Erase Verify DFlash Section Program D-Flash Erase D-Flash Sector Function on D-Flash Memory Verify that a given number of words starting at the address provided are erased. Program up to four words in the D-Flash block. Erase all bytes in a sector of the D-Flash block.
13.4.4
Allowed Simultaneous P-Flash and D-Flash Operations
Only the operations marked `OK' in Table 13-30 are permitted to be run simultaneously on the Program Flash and Data Flash blocks. Some operations cannot be executed simultaneously because certain hardware resources are shared by the two memories. The priority has been placed on permitting Program Flash reads while program and erase operations execute on the Data Flash, providing read (P-Flash) while write (D-Flash) functionality.
Table 13-30. Allowed P-Flash and D-Flash Simultaneous Operations
Data Flash Program Flash Read Margin Read(1) Program Sector Erase OK Read Margin Read1 OK OK(2) Program OK Sector Erase OK Mass Erase3
OK Mass Erase(3) 1. A `Margin Read' is any read after executing the margin setting commands `Set User Margin Level' or `Set Field Margin Level' with anything but the `normal' level specified. 2. See the Note on margin settings in Section 13.4.5.12 and Section 13.4.5.13. 3. The `Mass Erase' operations are commands `Erase All Blocks' and `Erase Flash Block'
13.4.5
Flash Command Description
This section provides details of all available Flash commands launched by a command write sequence. The ACCERR bit in the FSTAT register will be set during the command write sequence if any of the following illegal steps are performed, causing the command not to be processed by the Memory Controller: * Starting any command write sequence that programs or erases Flash memory before initializing the FCLKDIV register * Writing an invalid command as part of the command write sequence * For additional possible errors, refer to the error handling table provided for each command
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 453
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
If a Flash block is read during execution of an algorithm (CCIF = 0) on that same block, the read operation will return invalid data. If the SFDIF or DFDIF flags were not previously set when the invalid read operation occurred, both the SFDIF and DFDIF flags will be set. If the ACCERR or FPVIOL bits are set in the FSTAT register, the user must clear these bits before starting any command write sequence (see Section 13.3.2.7). CAUTION A Flash word or phrase must be in the erased state before being programmed. Cumulative programming of bits within a Flash word or phrase is not allowed.
13.4.5.1
Erase Verify All Blocks Command
Table 13-31. Erase Verify All Blocks Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 0x01 FCCOB Parameters Not required
The Erase Verify All Blocks command will verify that all P-Flash and D-Flash blocks have been erased.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Verify All Blocks command, the Memory Controller will verify that the entire Flash memory space is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Verify All Blocks operation has completed.
Table 13-32. Erase Verify All Blocks Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit ACCERR FPVIOL FSTAT MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if any errors have been encountered during the read Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 000 at command launch None
13.4.5.2
Erase Verify Block Command
The Erase Verify Block command allows the user to verify that an entire P-Flash or D-Flash block has been erased. The FCCOB upper global address bits determine which block must be verified.
Table 13-33. Erase Verify Block Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 0x02 FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] of the Flash block to be verified.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Verify Block command, the Memory Controller will verify that the selected P-Flash or D-Flash block is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Verify Block operation has completed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 454 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-34. Erase Verify Block Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit ACCERR Set if an invalid global address [17:16] is supplied FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 None Set if any errors have been encountered during the read Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 000 at command launch
13.4.5.3
Erase Verify P-Flash Section Command
The Erase Verify P-Flash Section command will verify that a section of code in the P-Flash memory is erased. The Erase Verify P-Flash Section command defines the starting point of the code to be verified and the number of phrases.
Table 13-35. Erase Verify P-Flash Section Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 010 0x03 FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] of a P-Flash block
Global address [15:0] of the first phrase to be verified Number of phrases to be verified
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Verify P-Flash Section command, the Memory Controller will verify the selected section of Flash memory is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Verify P-Flash Section operation has completed.
Table 13-36. Erase Verify P-Flash Section Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 010 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR FSTAT Set if the requested section crosses a 128 Kbyte boundary FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 None Set if any errors have been encountered during the read Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read Set if an invalid global address [17:0] is supplied Set if a misaligned phrase address is supplied (global address [2:0] != 000)
13.4.5.4
Read Once Command
The Read Once command provides read access to a reserved 64 byte field (8 phrases) located in the nonvolatile information register of P-Flash. The Read Once field is programmed using the Program Once
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 455
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
command described in Section 13.4.5.6. The Read Once command must not be executed from the Flash block containing the Program Once reserved field to avoid code runaway.
Table 13-37. Read Once Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 010 011 100 101 0x04 FCCOB Parameters Not Required
Read Once phrase index (0x0000 - 0x0007) Read Once word 0 value Read Once word 1 value Read Once word 2 value Read Once word 3 value
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Read Once command, a Read Once phrase is fetched and stored in the FCCOB indexed register. The CCIF flag will set after the Read Once operation has completed. Valid phrase index values for the Read Once command range from 0x0000 to 0x0007. During execution of the Read Once command, any attempt to read addresses within P-Flash block will return invalid data.
8
Table 13-38. Read Once Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch ACCERR FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 None Set if any errors have been encountered during the read Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) Set if an invalid phrase index is supplied
13.4.5.5
Program P-Flash Command
The Program P-Flash operation will program a previously erased phrase in the P-Flash memory using an embedded algorithm. CAUTION A P-Flash phrase must be in the erased state before being programmed. Cumulative programming of bits within a Flash phrase is not allowed.
Table 13-39. Program P-Flash Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 010 0x06 FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] to identify P-Flash block
Global address [15:0] of phrase location to be programmed(1) Word 0 program value
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 456 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-39. Program P-Flash Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 011 100 FCCOB Parameters Word 1 program value Word 2 program value
101 Word 3 program value 1. Global address [2:0] must be 000
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Program P-Flash command, the Memory Controller will program the data words to the supplied global address and will then proceed to verify the data words read back as expected. The CCIF flag will set after the Program P-Flash operation has completed.
Table 13-40. Program P-Flash Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 101 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR Set if an invalid global address [17:0] is supplied FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if a misaligned phrase address is supplied (global address [2:0] != 000) Set if the global address [17:0] points to a protected area Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify operation
13.4.5.6
Program Once Command
The Program Once command restricts programming to a reserved 64 byte field (8 phrases) in the nonvolatile information register located in P-Flash. The Program Once reserved field can be read using the Read Once command as described in Section 13.4.5.4. The Program Once command must only be issued once since the nonvolatile information register in P-Flash cannot be erased. The Program Once command must not be executed from the Flash block containing the Program Once reserved field to avoid code runaway.
Table 13-41. Program Once Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 010 011 100 101 0x07 FCCOB Parameters Not Required
Program Once phrase index (0x0000 - 0x0007) Program Once word 0 value Program Once word 1 value Program Once word 2 value Program Once word 3 value
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 457
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Program Once command, the Memory Controller first verifies that the selected phrase is erased. If erased, then the selected phrase will be programmed and then verified with read back. The CCIF flag will remain clear, setting only after the Program Once operation has completed. The reserved nonvolatile information register accessed by the Program Once command cannot be erased and any attempt to program one of these phrases a second time will not be allowed. Valid phrase index values for the Program Once command range from 0x0000 to 0x0007. During execution of the Program Once command, any attempt to read addresses within P-Flash will return invalid data.
Table 13-42. Program Once Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 101 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR Set if an invalid phrase index is supplied FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if the requested phrase has already been programmed(1) None Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation
Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify operation 1. If a Program Once phrase is initially programmed to 0xFFFF_FFFF_FFFF_FFFF, the Program Once command will be allowed to execute again on that same phrase.
13.4.5.7
Erase All Blocks Command
Table 13-43. Erase All Blocks Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 0x08 FCCOB Parameters Not required
The Erase All Blocks operation will erase the entire P-Flash and D-Flash memory space.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase All Blocks command, the Memory Controller will erase the entire Flash memory space and verify that it is erased. If the Memory Controller verifies that the entire Flash memory space was properly erased, security will be released. During the execution of this command (CCIF=0) the user must not write to any Flash module register. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase All Blocks operation has completed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 458 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-44. Erase All Blocks Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit ACCERR Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if any area of the P-Flash or D-Flash memory is protected Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify operation Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 000 at command launch
13.4.5.8
Erase Flash Block Command
Table 13-45. Erase Flash Block Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 0x09 FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] to identify Flash block
The Erase Flash Block operation will erase all addresses in a P-Flash or D-Flash block.
Global address [15:0] in Flash block to be erased
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Flash Block command, the Memory Controller will erase the selected Flash block and verify that it is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Flash Block operation has completed.
Table 13-46. Erase Flash Block Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR Set if an invalid global address [17:16] is supplied Set if the supplied P-Flash address is not phrase-aligned or if the D-Flash address is not word-aligned FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if an area of the selected Flash block is protected Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify operation
FSTAT
13.4.5.9
Erase P-Flash Sector Command
The Erase P-Flash Sector operation will erase all addresses in a P-Flash sector.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 459
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-47. Erase P-Flash Sector Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 0x0A FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] to identify P-Flash block to be erased
Global address [15:0] anywhere within the sector to be erased. Refer to Section 13.1.2.1 for the P-Flash sector size.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase P-Flash Sector command, the Memory Controller will erase the selected Flash sector and then verify that it is erased. The CCIF flag will be set after the Erase P-Flash Sector operation has completed.
Table 13-48. Erase P-Flash Sector Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR Set if an invalid global address [17:16] is supplied FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if a misaligned phrase address is supplied (global address [2:0] != 000) Set if the selected P-Flash sector is protected Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify operation
13.4.5.10 Unsecure Flash Command
The Unsecure Flash command will erase the entire P-Flash and D-Flash memory space and, if the erase is successful, will release security.
Table 13-49. Unsecure Flash Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 0x0B FCCOB Parameters Not required
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Unsecure Flash command, the Memory Controller will erase the entire P-Flash and D-Flash memory space and verify that it is erased. If the Memory Controller verifies that the entire Flash memory space was properly erased, security will be released. If the erase verify is not successful, the Unsecure Flash operation sets MGSTAT1 and terminates without changing the security state. During the execution of this command (CCIF=0) the user must not write to any Flash module register. The CCIF flag is set after the Unsecure Flash operation has completed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 460 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-50. Unsecure Flash Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit ACCERR Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if any area of the P-Flash or D-Flash memory is protected Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify operation Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 000 at command launch
13.4.5.11 Verify Backdoor Access Key Command
The Verify Backdoor Access Key command will only execute if it is enabled by the KEYEN bits in the FSEC register (see Table 13-9). The Verify Backdoor Access Key command releases security if usersupplied keys match those stored in the Flash security bytes of the Flash configuration field (see Table 133). The Verify Backdoor Access Key command must not be executed from the Flash block containing the backdoor comparison key to avoid code runaway.
Table 13-51. Verify Backdoor Access Key Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 010 011 100 0x0C Key 0 Key 1 Key 2 Key 3 FCCOB Parameters Not required
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Verify Backdoor Access Key command, the Memory Controller will check the FSEC KEYEN bits to verify that this command is enabled. If not enabled, the Memory Controller sets the ACCERR bit in the FSTAT register and terminates. If the command is enabled, the Memory Controller compares the key provided in FCCOB to the backdoor comparison key in the Flash configuration field with Key 0 compared to 0x3_FF00, etc. If the backdoor keys match, security will be released. If the backdoor keys do not match, security is not released and all future attempts to execute the Verify Backdoor Access Key command are aborted (set ACCERR) until a reset occurs. The CCIF flag is set after the Verify Backdoor Access Key operation has completed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 461
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-52. Verify Backdoor Access Key Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 100 at command launch Set if an incorrect backdoor key is supplied ACCERR FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if backdoor key access has not been enabled (KEYEN[1:0] != 10, see Section 13.3.2.2) Set if the backdoor key has mismatched since the last reset None None None
13.4.5.12 Set User Margin Level Command
The Set User Margin Level command causes the Memory Controller to set the margin level for future read operations of the P-Flash or D-Flash block.
Table 13-53. Set User Margin Level Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 0x0D FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] to identify the Flash block Margin level setting
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Set User Margin Level command, the Memory Controller will set the user margin level for the targeted block and then set the CCIF flag. NOTE When the D-Flash block is targeted, the D-Flash user margin levels are applied only to the D-Flash reads. However, when the P-Flash block is targeted, the P-Flash user margin levels are applied to both P-Flash and DFlash reads. It is not possible to apply user margin levels to the P-Flash block only. Valid margin level settings for the Set User Margin Level command are defined in Table 13-54.
Table 13-54. Valid Set User Margin Level Settings
CCOB (CCOBIX=001) 0x0000 0x0001 Level Description Return to Normal Level User Margin-1 Level(1)
0x0002 User Margin-0 Level(2) 1. Read margin to the erased state 2. Read margin to the programmed state
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 462 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-55. Set User Margin Level Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR Set if an invalid global address [17:16] is supplied FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if an invalid margin level setting is supplied None None None
NOTE User margin levels can be used to check that Flash memory contents have adequate margin for normal level read operations. If unexpected results are encountered when checking Flash memory contents at user margin levels, a potential loss of information has been detected.
13.4.5.13 Set Field Margin Level Command
The Set Field Margin Level command, valid in special modes only, causes the Memory Controller to set the margin level specified for future read operations of the P-Flash or D-Flash block.
Table 13-56. Set Field Margin Level Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 0x0E FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] to identify the Flash block Margin level setting
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Set Field Margin Level command, the Memory Controller will set the field margin level for the targeted block and then set the CCIF flag. NOTE When the D-Flash block is targeted, the D-Flash field margin levels are applied only to the D-Flash reads. However, when the P-Flash block is targeted, the P-Flash field margin levels are applied to both P-Flash and DFlash reads. It is not possible to apply field margin levels to the P-Flash block only.
Valid margin level settings for the Set Field Margin Level command are defined in Table 13-57.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 463
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-57. Valid Set Field Margin Level Settings
CCOB (CCOBIX=001) 0x0000 0x0001 0x0002 0x0003 Level Description Return to Normal Level User Margin-1 Level(1) User Margin-0 Level(2) Field Margin-1 Level1
0x0004 Field Margin-0 Level2 1. Read margin to the erased state 2. Read margin to the programmed state
Table 13-58. Set Field Margin Level Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR Set if an invalid global address [17:16] is supplied FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if an invalid margin level setting is supplied None None None
CAUTION Field margin levels must only be used during verify of the initial factory programming. NOTE Field margin levels can be used to check that Flash memory contents have adequate margin for data retention at the normal level setting. If unexpected results are encountered when checking Flash memory contents at field margin levels, the Flash memory contents should be erased and reprogrammed.
13.4.5.14 Erase Verify D-Flash Section Command
The Erase Verify D-Flash Section command will verify that a section of code in the D-Flash is erased. The Erase Verify D-Flash Section command defines the starting point of the data to be verified and the number of words.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 464 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-59. Erase Verify D-Flash Section Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 010 0x10 FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] to identify the D-Flash block
Global address [15:0] of the first word to be verified Number of words to be verified
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase Verify D-Flash Section command, the Memory Controller will verify the selected section of D-Flash memory is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase Verify DFlash Section operation has completed.
Table 13-60. Erase Verify D-Flash Section Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 010 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR FSTAT Set if the requested section breaches the end of the D-Flash block FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 None Set if any errors have been encountered during the read Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the read Set if an invalid global address [17:0] is supplied Set if a misaligned word address is supplied (global address [0] != 0)
13.4.5.15 Program D-Flash Command
The Program D-Flash operation programs one to four previously erased words in the D-Flash block. The Program D-Flash operation will confirm that the targeted location(s) were successfully programmed upon completion. CAUTION A Flash word must be in the erased state before being programmed. Cumulative programming of bits within a Flash word is not allowed.
Table 13-61. Program D-Flash Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 010 011 100 0x11 FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] to identify the D-Flash block
Global address [15:0] of word to be programmed Word 0 program value Word 1 program value, if desired Word 2 program value, if desired
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 465
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-61. Program D-Flash Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 101 FCCOB Parameters Word 3 program value, if desired
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Program D-Flash command, the user-supplied words will be transferred to the Memory Controller and be programmed if the area is unprotected. The CCOBIX index value at Program D-Flash command launch determines how many words will be programmed in the D-Flash block. The CCIF flag is set when the operation has completed.
Table 13-62. Program D-Flash Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] < 010 at command launch Set if CCOBIX[2:0] > 101 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR Set if an invalid global address [17:0] is supplied FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if a misaligned word address is supplied (global address [0] != 0) Set if the requested group of words breaches the end of the D-Flash block Set if the selected area of the D-Flash memory is protected Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify operation
13.4.5.16 Erase D-Flash Sector Command
The Erase D-Flash Sector operation will erase all addresses in a sector of the D-Flash block.
Table 13-63. Erase D-Flash Sector Command FCCOB Requirements
CCOBIX[2:0] 000 001 0x12 FCCOB Parameters Global address [17:16] to identify D-Flash block
Global address [15:0] anywhere within the sector to be erased. See Section 13.1.2.2 for D-Flash sector size.
Upon clearing CCIF to launch the Erase D-Flash Sector command, the Memory Controller will erase the selected Flash sector and verify that it is erased. The CCIF flag will set after the Erase D-Flash Sector operation has completed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 466 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
Table 13-64. Erase D-Flash Sector Command Error Handling
Register Error Bit Error Condition Set if CCOBIX[2:0] != 001 at command launch Set if command not available in current mode (see Table 13-27) ACCERR Set if an invalid global address [17:0] is supplied FSTAT FPVIOL MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0 Set if a misaligned word address is supplied (global address [0] != 0) Set if the selected area of the D-Flash memory is protected Set if any errors have been encountered during the verify operation Set if any non-correctable errors have been encountered during the verify operation
13.4.6
Interrupts
The Flash module can generate an interrupt when a Flash command operation has completed or when a Flash command operation has detected an ECC fault.
Table 13-65. Flash Interrupt Sources
Interrupt Source Flash Command Complete ECC Double Bit Fault on Flash Read ECC Single Bit Fault on Flash Read Interrupt Flag CCIF (FSTAT register) DFDIF (FERSTAT register) SFDIF (FERSTAT register) Local Enable CCIE (FCNFG register) DFDIE (FERCNFG register) SFDIE (FERCNFG register) Global (CCR) Mask I Bit I Bit I Bit
NOTE Vector addresses and their relative interrupt priority are determined at the MCU level.
13.4.6.1
Description of Flash Interrupt Operation
The Flash module uses the CCIF flag in combination with the CCIE interrupt enable bit to generate the Flash command interrupt request. The Flash module uses the DFDIF and SFDIF flags in combination with the DFDIE and SFDIE interrupt enable bits to generate the Flash error interrupt request. For a detailed description of the register bits involved, refer to Section 13.3.2.5, "Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG)", Section 13.3.2.6, "Flash Error Configuration Register (FERCNFG)", Section 13.3.2.7, "Flash Status Register (FSTAT)", and Section 13.3.2.8, "Flash Error Status Register (FERSTAT)". The logic used for generating the Flash module interrupts is shown in Figure 13-27.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 467
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
CCIE CCIF
Flash Command Interrupt Request
DFDIE DFDIF SFDIE SFDIF
Flash Error Interrupt Request
Figure 13-27. Flash Module Interrupts Implementation
13.4.7
Wait Mode
The Flash module is not affected if the MCU enters wait mode. The Flash module can recover the MCU from wait via the CCIF interrupt (see Section 13.4.6, "Interrupts").
13.4.8
Stop Mode
If a Flash command is active (CCIF = 0) when the MCU requests stop mode, the current Flash operation will be completed before the CPU is allowed to enter stop mode.
13.5
Security
The Flash module provides security information to the MCU. The Flash security state is defined by the SEC bits of the FSEC register (see Table 13-10). During reset, the Flash module initializes the FSEC register using data read from the security byte of the Flash configuration field at global address 0x3_FF0F. The security state out of reset can be permanently changed by programming the security byte assuming that the MCU is starting from a mode where the necessary P-Flash erase and program commands are available and that the upper region of the P-Flash is unprotected. If the Flash security byte is successfully programmed, its new value will take affect after the next MCU reset. The following subsections describe these security-related subjects: * Unsecuring the MCU using Backdoor Key Access * Unsecuring the MCU in Special Single Chip Mode using BDM * Mode and Security Effects on Flash Command Availability
13.5.1
Unsecuring the MCU using Backdoor Key Access
The MCU may be unsecured by using the backdoor key access feature which requires knowledge of the contents of the backdoor keys (four 16-bit words programmed at addresses 0x3_FF00-0x3_FF07). If the KEYEN[1:0] bits are in the enabled state (see Section 13.3.2.2), the Verify Backdoor Access Key command (see Section 13.4.5.11) allows the user to present four prospective keys for comparison to the keys stored in the Flash memory via the Memory Controller. If the keys presented in the Verify Backdoor Access Key command match the backdoor keys stored in the Flash memory, the SEC bits in the FSEC
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 468 Freescale Semiconductor
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
register (see Table 13-10) will be changed to unsecure the MCU. Key values of 0x0000 and 0xFFFF are not permitted as backdoor keys. While the Verify Backdoor Access Key command is active, P-Flash memory and D-Flash memory will not be available for read access and will return invalid data. The user code stored in the P-Flash memory must have a method of receiving the backdoor keys from an external stimulus. This external stimulus would typically be through one of the on-chip serial ports. If the KEYEN[1:0] bits are in the enabled state (see Section 13.3.2.2), the MCU can be unsecured by the backdoor key access sequence described below: 1. Follow the command sequence for the Verify Backdoor Access Key command as explained in Section 13.4.5.11 2. If the Verify Backdoor Access Key command is successful, the MCU is unsecured and the SEC[1:0] bits in the FSEC register are forced to the unsecure state of 10 The Verify Backdoor Access Key command is monitored by the Memory Controller and an illegal key will prohibit future use of the Verify Backdoor Access Key command. A reset of the MCU is the only method to re-enable the Verify Backdoor Access Key command. The security as defined in the Flash security byte (0x3_FF0F) is not changed by using the Verify Backdoor Access Key command sequence. The backdoor keys stored in addresses 0x3_FF00-0x3_FF07 are unaffected by the Verify Backdoor Access Key command sequence. The Verify Backdoor Access Key command sequence has no effect on the program and erase protections defined in the Flash protection register, FPROT. After the backdoor keys have been correctly matched, the MCU will be unsecured. After the MCU is unsecured, the sector containing the Flash security byte can be erased and the Flash security byte can be reprogrammed to the unsecure state, if desired. In the unsecure state, the user has full control of the contents of the backdoor keys by programming addresses 0x3_FF00-0x3_FF07 in the Flash configuration field.
13.5.2
Unsecuring the MCU in Special Single Chip Mode using BDM
A secured MCU can be unsecured in special single chip mode by using the following method to erase the P-Flash and D-Flash memory: 1. Reset the MCU into special single chip mode 2. Delay while the BDM executes the Erase Verify All Blocks command write sequence to check if the P-Flash and D-Flash memories are erased 3. Send BDM commands to disable protection in the P-Flash and D-Flash memory 4. Execute the Erase All Blocks command write sequence to erase the P-Flash and D-Flash memory 5. After the CCIF flag sets to indicate that the Erase All Blocks operation has completed, reset the MCU into special single chip mode 6. Delay while the BDM executes the Erase Verify All Blocks command write sequence to verify that the P-Flash and D-Flash memory are erased If the P-Flash and D-Flash memory are verified as erased, the MCU will be unsecured. All BDM commands will now be enabled and the Flash security byte may be programmed to the unsecure state by continuing with the following steps:
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 469
128 KByte Flash Module (S12FTMRC128K1V1)
7. Send BDM commands to execute the Program P-Flash command write sequence to program the Flash security byte to the unsecured state 8. Reset the MCU
13.5.3
Mode and Security Effects on Flash Command Availability
The availability of Flash module commands depends on the MCU operating mode and security state as shown in Table 13-27.
13.6
Initialization
On each system reset the Flash module executes a reset sequence which establishes initial values for the Flash Block Configuration Parameters, the FPROT and DFPROT protection registers, and the FOPT and FSEC registers. The Flash module reverts to using built-in default values that leave the module in a fully protected and secured state if errors are encountered during execution of the reset sequence. If a double bit fault is detected during the reset sequence, both MGSTAT bits in the FSTAT register will be set. CCIF remains clear throughout the reset sequence. The Flash module holds off all CPU access for the initial portion of the reset sequence. While Flash memory reads and access to most Flash registers are possible when the hold is removed, writes to the FCCOBIX, FCCOBHI, and FCCOBLO registers are ignored. Completion of the reset sequence is marked by setting CCIF high which enables writes to the FCCOBIX, FCCOBHI, and FCCOBLO registers to launch any available Flash command. If a reset occurs while any Flash command is in progress, that command will be immediately aborted. The state of the word being programmed or the sector/block being erased is not guaranteed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 470 Freescale Semiconductor
Chapter 14 Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Table 14-1. Revision History
Revision Number V02.00 Revision Date 15 Nov 2005 Sections Affected Description of Changes
14.3.2/14-476 - Moved OCPD from offset $2F to $2C. 14.3.2.3/14-479 - Updated OC7 diagram, memory map, and regsiter description location for OCPD 14.3.2/14-476 - Replaced TPORTE with OCPD in page 8, and added descriptionof OCPD - Removed redundant memory map table - Replaced typo OPCD with OCPD 14.3.2.12/14486 14.3.2.13/14486 14.3.2.16/14489 14.4.2/14-494 14.4.3/14-494 - Revised flag clearing procedure, whereby TEN bit must be set when clearing flags.
V02.01 V02.02 V02.03 V02.04
03 Aug 2006 03 Apr 2007 14 Sep 2007 1 Jul 2008
14.1
Introduction
The basic timer consists of a 16-bit, software-programmable counter driven by a enhanced programmable prescaler. This timer can be used for many purposes, including input waveform measurements while simultaneously generating an output waveform. Pulse widths can vary from microseconds to many seconds. This timer contains 8 complete input capture/output compare channels and one pulse accumulator. The input capture function is used to detect a selected transition edge and record the time. The output compare function is used for generating output signals or for timer software delays. The 16-bit pulse accumulator is used to operate as a simple event counter or a gated time accumulator. The pulse accumulator shares timer channel 7 when in event mode. A full access for the counter registers or the input capture/output compare registers should take place in one clock cycle. Accessing high byte and low byte separately for all of these registers may not yield the same result as accessing them in one word.
14.1.1
Features
The TIM16B8CV2 includes these distinctive features:
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 471
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
* * * *
Eight input capture/output compare channels. Clock prescaling. 16-bit counter. 16-bit pulse accumulator.
14.1.2
Stop: Freeze: Wait: Normal:
Modes of Operation
Timer is off because clocks are stopped. Timer counter keep on running, unless TSFRZ in TSCR (0x0006) is set to 1. Counters keep on running, unless TSWAI in TSCR (0x0006) is set to 1. Timer counter keep on running, unless TEN in TSCR (0x0006) is cleared to 0.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 472 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.1.3
Block Diagrams
Channel 0 Input capture Output compare Channel 1 Input capture Output compare Channel 2 Input capture Output compare Channel 3 Input capture Output compare Registers Channel 4 Input capture Output compare Channel 5 Input capture Output compare
Bus clock
Prescaler
IOC0
16-bit Counter
IOC1
Timer overflow interrupt Timer channel 0 interrupt
IOC2
IOC3
IOC4
IOC5
Timer channel 7 interrupt
Channel 6 Input capture Output compare 16-bit Pulse accumulator Channel 7 Input capture Output compare
IOC6
PA overflow interrupt PA input interrupt
IOC7
Figure 14-1. TIM16B8CV2 Block Diagram
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 473
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
TIMCLK (Timer clock)
CLK1 CLK0
4:1 MUX
PACLK / 256
Prescaled clock (PCLK)
PACLK / 65536
Clock select (PAMOD) PACLK
Edge detector
PT7
Intermodule Bus
Interrupt
PACNT
MUX
Divide by 64
M clock
Figure 14-2. 16-Bit Pulse Accumulator Block Diagram
16-bit Main Timer
PTn
Edge detector
Set CnF Interrupt
TCn Input Capture Reg.
Figure 14-3. Interrupt Flag Setting
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 474 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
PULSE ACCUMULATOR CHANNEL 7 OUTPUT COMPARE OCPD TEN TIOS7
PAD
Figure 14-4. Channel 7 Output Compare/Pulse Accumulator Logic
14.2
External Signal Description
The TIM16B8CV2 module has a total of eight external pins.
14.2.1
IOC7 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 7 Pin
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 7. This can also be configured as pulse accumulator input.
14.2.2
IOC6 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 6 Pin
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 6.
14.2.3
IOC5 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 5 Pin
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 5.
14.2.4
IOC4 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 4 Pin
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 4. Pin
14.2.5
IOC3 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 3 Pin
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 3.
14.2.6
IOC2 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 2 Pin
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 2.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 475
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.2.7
IOC1 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 1 Pin
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 1.
14.2.8
IOC0 -- Input Capture and Output Compare Channel 0 Pin
NOTE For the description of interrupts see Section 14.6, "Interrupts".
This pin serves as input capture or output compare for channel 0.
14.3
Memory Map and Register Definition
This section provides a detailed description of all memory and registers.
14.3.1
Module Memory Map
The memory map for the TIM16B8CV2 module is given below in Figure 14-5. The address listed for each register is the address offset. The total address for each register is the sum of the base address for the TIM16B8CV2 module and the address offset for each register.
14.3.2
Register Descriptions
This section consists of register descriptions in address order. Each description includes a standard register diagram with an associated figure number. Details of register bit and field function follow the register diagrams, in bit order.
Register Name 0x0000 TIOS 0x0001 CFORC 0x0002 OC7M 0x0003 OC7D 0x0004 TCNTH 0x0005 TCNTL R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0
IOS7
IOS6
IOS5
IOS4
IOS3
IOS2
IOS1
IOS0
0 FOC7 OC7M7
0 FOC6 OC7M6
0 FOC5 OC7M5
0 FOC4 OC7M4
0 FOC3 OC7M3
0 FOC2 OC7M2
0 FOC1 OC7M1
0 FOC0 OC7M0
OC7D7
OC7D6
OC7D5
OC7D4
OC7D3
OC7D2
OC7D1
OC7D0
TCNT15
TCNT14
TCNT13
TCNT12
TCNT11
TCNT10
TCNT9
TCNT8
TCNT7
TCNT6
TCNT5
TCNT4
TCNT3
TCNT2
TCNT1
TCNT0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-5. TIM16B8CV2 Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 476 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Register Name 0x0006 TSCR1 0x0007 TTOV 0x0008 TCTL1 0x0009 TCTL2 0x000A TCTL3 0x000B TCTL4 0x000C TIE 0x000D TSCR2 0x000E TFLG1 0x000F TFLG2 R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
Bit 7 TEN
6 TSWAI
5 TSFRZ
4 TFFCA
3 PRNT
2 0
1 0
Bit 0 0
TOV7
TOV6
TOV5
TOV4
TOV3
TOV2
TOV1
TOV0
OM7
OL7
OM6
OL6
OM5
OL5
OM4
OL4
OM3
OL3
OM2
OL2
OM1
OL1
OM0
OL0
EDG7B
EDG7A
EDG6B
EDG6A
EDG5B
EDG5A
EDG4B
EDG4A
EDG3B
EDG3A
EDG2B
EDG2A
EDG1B
EDG1A
EDG0B
EDG0A
C7I
C6I 0
C5I 0
C4I 0
C3I
C2I
C1I
C0I
TOI
TCRE
PR2
PR1
PR0
C7F
C6F 0
C5F 0
C4F 0
C3F 0
C2F 0
C1F 0
C0F 0
TOF
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0x0010-0x001F TCxH-TCxL
Bit 7 0
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0x0020 PACTL 0x0021 PAFLG 0x0022 PACNTH 0x0023 PACNTL 0x0024-0x002B Reserved
PAEN 0
PAMOD 0
PEDGE 0
CLK1 0
CLK0 0
PAOVI
PAI
0
PAOVF
PAIF
R PACNT15 W R W R W PACNT7
PACNT14
PACNT13
PACNT12
PACNT11
PACNT10
PACNT9
PACNT8
PACNT6
PACNT5
PACNT4
PACNT3
PACNT2
PACNT1
PACNT0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-5. TIM16B8CV2 Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 477
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Register Name 0x002C OCPD 0x002D Reserved 0x002E PTPSR 0x002F Reserved R W R
Bit 7 OCPD7
6 OCPD6
5 OCPD5
4 OCPD4
3 OCPD3
2 OCPD2
1 OCPD1
Bit 0 OCPD0
R W R W
PTPS7
PTPS6
PTPS5
PTPS4
PTPS3
PTPS2
PTPS1
PTPS0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-5. TIM16B8CV2 Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3)
14.3.2.1
Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Select (TIOS)
Module Base + 0x0000
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R IOS7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 IOS6 IOS5 IOS4 IOS3 IOS2 IOS1 IOS0
Figure 14-6. Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Select (TIOS)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 14-2. TIOS Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 IOS[7:0] Description Input Capture or Output Compare Channel Configuration 0 The corresponding channel acts as an input capture. 1 The corresponding channel acts as an output compare.
14.3.2.2
Timer Compare Force Register (CFORC)
Module Base + 0x0001
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 FOC7 0
0 FOC6 0
0 FOC5 0
0 FOC4 0
0 FOC3 0
0 FOC2 0
0 FOC1 0
0 FOC0 0
Figure 14-7. Timer Compare Force Register (CFORC)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 478 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Read: Anytime but will always return 0x0000 (1 state is transient) Write: Anytime
Table 14-3. CFORC Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 FOC[7:0] Description Force Output Compare Action for Channel 7:0 -- A write to this register with the corresponding data bit(s) set causes the action which is programmed for output compare "x" to occur immediately. The action taken is the same as if a successful comparison had just taken place with the TCx register except the interrupt flag does not get set. Note: A successful channel 7 output compare overrides any channel 6:0 compares. If forced output compare on any channel occurs at the same time as the successful output compare then forced output compare action will take precedence and interrupt flag won't get set.
14.3.2.3
Output Compare 7 Mask Register (OC7M)
Module Base + 0x0002
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R OC7M7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 OC7M6 OC7M5 OC7M4 OC7M3 OC7M2 OC7M1 OC7M0
Figure 14-8. Output Compare 7 Mask Register (OC7M)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 14-4. OC7M Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 OC7M[7:0] Description Output Compare 7 Mask -- Setting the OC7Mx (x ranges from 0 to 6) will set the corresponding port to be an output port when the corresponding TIOSx (x ranges from 0 to 6) bit is set to be an output compare and the corresponding OCPDx (x ranges from 0 to 6) bit is set to zero to enable the timer port. A successful channel 7 output compare overrides any channel 6:0 compares. For each OC7M bit that is set, the output compare action reflects the corresponding OC7D bit.
14.3.2.4
Output Compare 7 Data Register (OC7D)
Module Base + 0x0003
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R OC7D7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 OC7D6 OC7D5 OC7D4 OC7D3 OC7D2 OC7D1 OC7D0
Figure 14-9. Output Compare 7 Data Register (OC7D)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 479
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 14-5. OC7D Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 OC7D[7:0] Description Output Compare 7 Data -- A channel 7 output compare can cause bits in the output compare 7 data register to transfer to the timer port data register depending on the output compare 7 mask register.
14.3.2.5
Timer Count Register (TCNT)
Module Base + 0x0004
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 9
R TCNT15 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TCNT14 TCNT13 TCNT12 TCNT11 TCNT10 TCNT9 TCNT8
Figure 14-10. Timer Count Register High (TCNTH)
Module Base + 0x0005
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R TCNT7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TCNT6 TCNT5 TCNT4 TCNT3 TCNT2 TCNT1 TCNT0
Figure 14-11. Timer Count Register Low (TCNTL)
The 16-bit main timer is an up counter. A full access for the counter register should take place in one clock cycle. A separate read/write for high byte and low byte will give a different result than accessing them as a word. Read: Anytime Write: Has no meaning or effect in the normal mode; only writable in special modes (test_mode = 1). The period of the first count after a write to the TCNT registers may be a different size because the write is not synchronized with the prescaler clock.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 480 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.3.2.6
Timer System Control Register 1 (TSCR1)
Module Base + 0x0006
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R TEN W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 TSWAI TSFRZ TFFCA PRNT
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-12. Timer System Control Register 1 (TSCR2)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 14-6. TSCR1 Field Descriptions
Field 7 TEN Description Timer Enable 0 Disables the main timer, including the counter. Can be used for reducing power consumption. 1 Allows the timer to function normally. If for any reason the timer is not active, there is no /64 clock for the pulse accumulator because the /64 is generated by the timer prescaler. Timer Module Stops While in Wait 0 Allows the timer module to continue running during wait. 1 Disables the timer module when the MCU is in the wait mode. Timer interrupts cannot be used to get the MCU out of wait. TSWAI also affects pulse accumulator. Timer Stops While in Freeze Mode 0 Allows the timer counter to continue running while in freeze mode. 1 Disables the timer counter whenever the MCU is in freeze mode. This is useful for emulation. TSFRZ does not stop the pulse accumulator. Timer Fast Flag Clear All 0 Allows the timer flag clearing to function normally. 1 For TFLG1(0x000E), a read from an input capture or a write to the output compare channel (0x0010-0x001F) causes the corresponding channel flag, CnF, to be cleared. For TFLG2 (0x000F), any access to the TCNT register (0x0004, 0x0005) clears the TOF flag. Any access to the PACNT registers (0x0022, 0x0023) clears the PAOVF and PAIF flags in the PAFLG register (0x0021). This has the advantage of eliminating software overhead in a separate clear sequence. Extra care is required to avoid accidental flag clearing due to unintended accesses. Precision Timer 0 Enables legacy timer. PR0, PR1, and PR2 bits of the TSCR2 register are used for timer counter prescaler selection. 1 Enables precision timer. All bits of the PTPSR register are used for Precision Timer Prescaler Selection, and all bits. This bit is writable only once out of reset.
6 TSWAI
5 TSFRZ
4 TFFCA
3 PRNT
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 481
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.3.2.7
Timer Toggle On Overflow Register 1 (TTOV)
Module Base + 0x0007
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R TOV7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TOV6 TOV5 TOV4 TOV3 TOV2 TOV1 TOV0
Figure 14-13. Timer Toggle On Overflow Register 1 (TTOV)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
Table 14-7. TTOV Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 TOV[7:0] Description Toggle On Overflow Bits -- TOVx toggles output compare pin on overflow. This feature only takes effect when in output compare mode. When set, it takes precedence over forced output compare but not channel 7 override events. 0 Toggle output compare pin on overflow feature disabled. 1 Toggle output compare pin on overflow feature enabled.
14.3.2.8
Timer Control Register 1/Timer Control Register 2 (TCTL1/TCTL2)
Module Base + 0x0008
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R OM7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 OL7 OM6 OL6 OM5 OL5 OM4 OL4
Figure 14-14. Timer Control Register 1 (TCTL1)
Module Base + 0x0009
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R OM3 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 OL3 OM2 OL2 OM1 OL1 OM0 OL0
Figure 14-15. Timer Control Register 2 (TCTL2)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 482 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Table 14-8. TCTL1/TCTL2 Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 OMx Description Output Mode -- These eight pairs of control bits are encoded to specify the output action to be taken as a result of a successful OCx compare. When either OMx or OLx is 1, the pin associated with OCx becomes an output tied to OCx. Note: To enable output action by OMx bits on timer port, the corresponding bit in OC7M should be cleared. For an output line to be driven by an OCx the OCPDx must be cleared. Output Level -- These eight pairs of control bits are encoded to specify the output action to be taken as a result of a successful OCx compare. When either OMx or OLx is 1, the pin associated with OCx becomes an output tied to OCx. Note: To enable output action by OLx bits on timer port, the corresponding bit in OC7M should be cleared. For an output line to be driven by an OCx the OCPDx must be cleared.
7:0 OLx
Table 14-9. Compare Result Output Action
OMx 0 0 1 1 OLx 0 1 0 1 Action No output compare action on the timer output signal Toggle OCx output line Clear OCx output line to zero Set OCx output line to one
To operate the 16-bit pulse accumulator independently of input capture or output compare 7 and 0 respectively the user must set the corresponding bits IOSx = 1, OMx = 0 and OLx = 0. OC7M7 in the OC7M register must also be cleared.
14.3.2.9
Timer Control Register 3/Timer Control Register 4 (TCTL3 and TCTL4)
Module Base + 0x000A
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R EDG7B W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 EDG7A EDG6B EDG6A EDG5B EDG5A EDG4B EDG4A
Figure 14-16. Timer Control Register 3 (TCTL3)
Module Base + 0x000B
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R EDG3B W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 EDG3A EDG2B EDG2A EDG1B EDG1A EDG0B EDG0A
Figure 14-17. Timer Control Register 4 (TCTL4)
Read: Anytime
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 483
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Write: Anytime.
Table 14-10. TCTL3/TCTL4 Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 EDGnB EDGnA Description Input Capture Edge Control -- These eight pairs of control bits configure the input capture edge detector circuits.
Table 14-11. Edge Detector Circuit Configuration
EDGnB 0 0 1 1 EDGnA 0 1 0 1 Configuration Capture disabled Capture on rising edges only Capture on falling edges only Capture on any edge (rising or falling)
14.3.2.10 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIE)
Module Base + 0x000C
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R C7I W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 C6I C5I C4I C3I C2I C1I C0I
Figure 14-18. Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIE)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime.
Table 14-12. TIE Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 C7I:C0I Description Input Capture/Output Compare "x" Interrupt Enable -- The bits in TIE correspond bit-for-bit with the bits in the TFLG1 status register. If cleared, the corresponding flag is disabled from causing a hardware interrupt. If set, the corresponding flag is enabled to cause a interrupt.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 484 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.3.2.11 Timer System Control Register 2 (TSCR2)
Module Base + 0x000D
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R TOI W Reset 0
0
0
0 TCRE PR2 0 PR1 0 PR0 0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-19. Timer System Control Register 2 (TSCR2)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime.
Table 14-13. TSCR2 Field Descriptions
Field 7 TOI 3 TCRE Description Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable 0 Interrupt inhibited. 1 Hardware interrupt requested when TOF flag set. Timer Counter Reset Enable -- This bit allows the timer counter to be reset by a successful output compare 7 event. This mode of operation is similar to an up-counting modulus counter. 0 Counter reset inhibited and counter free runs. 1 Counter reset by a successful output compare 7. If TC7 = 0x0000 and TCRE = 1, TCNT will stay at 0x0000 continuously. If TC7 = 0xFFFF and TCRE = 1, TOF will never be set when TCNT is reset from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. Timer Prescaler Select -- These three bits select the frequency of the timer prescaler clock derived from the Bus Clock as shown in Table 14-14.
2 PR[2:0]
Table 14-14. Timer Clock Selection
PR2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PR1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 PR0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Timer Clock Bus Clock / 1 Bus Clock / 2 Bus Clock / 4 Bus Clock / 8 Bus Clock / 16 Bus Clock / 32 Bus Clock / 64 Bus Clock / 128
NOTE The newly selected prescale factor will not take effect until the next synchronized edge where all prescale counter stages equal zero.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 485
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.3.2.12 Main Timer Interrupt Flag 1 (TFLG1)
Module Base + 0x000E
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R C7F W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 C6F C5F C4F C3F C2F C1F C0F
Figure 14-20. Main Timer Interrupt Flag 1 (TFLG1)
Read: Anytime Write: Used in the clearing mechanism (set bits cause corresponding bits to be cleared). Writing a zero will not affect current status of the bit.
Table 14-15. TRLG1 Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 C[7:0]F Description Input Capture/Output Compare Channel "x" Flag -- These flags are set when an input capture or output compare event occurs. Clearing requires writing a one to the corresponding flag bit while TEN is set to one. When TFFCA bit in TSCR register is set, a read from an input capture or a write into an output compare channel (0x0010-0x001F) will cause the corresponding channel flag CxF to be cleared.
14.3.2.13 Main Timer Interrupt Flag 2 (TFLG2)
Module Base + 0x000F
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R TOF W Reset 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-21. Main Timer Interrupt Flag 2 (TFLG2)
TFLG2 indicates when interrupt conditions have occurred. To clear a bit in the flag register, write the bit to one while TEN bit of TSCR1 is set to one. Read: Anytime Write: Used in clearing mechanism (set bits cause corresponding bits to be cleared). Any access to TCNT will clear TFLG2 register if the TFFCA bit in TSCR register is set.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 486 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Table 14-16. TRLG2 Field Descriptions
Field 7 TOF Description Timer Overflow Flag -- Set when 16-bit free-running timer overflows from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. Clearing this bit requires writing a one to bit 7 of TFLG2 register while the TEN bit of TSCR1 is set to one (See also TCRE control bit explanation.)
14.3.2.14 Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Registers High and Low 0-7 (TCxH and TCxL)
Module Base + 0x0010 = TC0H 0x0012 = TC1H 0x0014 = TC2H 0x0016 = TC3H
15 14
0x0018 = TC4H 0x001A = TC5H 0x001C = TC6H 0x001E = TC7H
13 12 11 10 9 0
R Bit 15 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8
Figure 14-22. Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Register x High (TCxH)
Module Base + 0x0011 = TC0L 0x0013 = TC1L 0x0015 = TC2L 0x0017 = TC3L
7 6
0x0019 = TC4L 0x001B = TC5L 0x001D = TC6L 0x001F = TC7L
5 4 3 2 1 0
R Bit 7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
Figure 14-23. Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Register x Low (TCxL)
Depending on the TIOS bit for the corresponding channel, these registers are used to latch the value of the free-running counter when a defined transition is sensed by the corresponding input capture edge detector or to trigger an output action for output compare. Read: Anytime Write: Anytime for output compare function.Writes to these registers have no meaning or effect during input capture. All timer input capture/output compare registers are reset to 0x0000. NOTE Read/Write access in byte mode for high byte should takes place before low byte otherwise it will give a different result.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 487
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.3.2.15 16-Bit Pulse Accumulator Control Register (PACTL)
Module Base + 0x0020
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0 PAEN 0 0 PAMOD 0 PEDGE 0 CLK1 0 CLK0 0 PAOVI 0 PAI 0
Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-24. 16-Bit Pulse Accumulator Control Register (PACTL)
When PAEN is set, the PACT is enabled.The PACT shares the input pin with IOC7. Read: Any time Write: Any time
Table 14-17. PACTL Field Descriptions
Field 6 PAEN Description Pulse Accumulator System Enable -- PAEN is independent from TEN. With timer disabled, the pulse accumulator can function unless pulse accumulator is disabled. 0 16-Bit Pulse Accumulator system disabled. 1 Pulse Accumulator system enabled. Pulse Accumulator Mode -- This bit is active only when the Pulse Accumulator is enabled (PAEN = 1). See Table 14-18. 0 Event counter mode. 1 Gated time accumulation mode. Pulse Accumulator Edge Control -- This bit is active only when the Pulse Accumulator is enabled (PAEN = 1). For PAMOD bit = 0 (event counter mode). See Table 14-18. 0 Falling edges on IOC7 pin cause the count to be incremented. 1 Rising edges on IOC7 pin cause the count to be incremented. For PAMOD bit = 1 (gated time accumulation mode). 0 IOC7 input pin high enables M (bus clock) divided by 64 clock to Pulse Accumulator and the trailing falling edge on IOC7 sets the PAIF flag. 1 IOC7 input pin low enables M (bus clock) divided by 64 clock to Pulse Accumulator and the trailing rising edge on IOC7 sets the PAIF flag. Clock Select Bits -- Refer to Table 14-19. Pulse Accumulator Overflow Interrupt Enable 0 Interrupt inhibited. 1 Interrupt requested if PAOVF is set. Pulse Accumulator Input Interrupt Enable 0 Interrupt inhibited. 1 Interrupt requested if PAIF is set.
5 PAMOD
4 PEDGE
3:2 CLK[1:0] 1 PAOVI 0 PAI
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 488 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Table 14-18. Pin Action
PAMOD 0 0 1 1 PEDGE 0 1 0 1 Pin Action Falling edge Rising edge Div. by 64 clock enabled with pin high level Div. by 64 clock enabled with pin low level
NOTE If the timer is not active (TEN = 0 in TSCR), there is no divide-by-64 because the /64 clock is generated by the timer prescaler.
Table 14-19. Timer Clock Selection
CLK1 0 0 1 1 CLK0 0 1 0 1 Timer Clock Use timer prescaler clock as timer counter clock Use PACLK as input to timer counter clock Use PACLK/256 as timer counter clock frequency Use PACLK/65536 as timer counter clock frequency
For the description of PACLK please refer Figure 14-24. If the pulse accumulator is disabled (PAEN = 0), the prescaler clock from the timer is always used as an input clock to the timer counter. The change from one selected clock to the other happens immediately after these bits are written.
14.3.2.16 Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (PAFLG)
Module Base + 0x0021
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R W Reset
0
0
0
0
0
0 PAOVF PAIF 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Unimplemented or Reserved
Figure 14-25. Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (PAFLG)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime When the TFFCA bit in the TSCR register is set, any access to the PACNT register will clear all the flags in the PAFLG register. Timer module must stay enabled (TEN=1) while clearing these bits.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 489
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Table 14-20. PAFLG Field Descriptions
Field 1 PAOVF Description Pulse Accumulator Overflow Flag -- Set when the 16-bit pulse accumulator overflows from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. Clearing this bit requires writing a one to this bit in the PAFLG register while TEN bit of TSCR1 register is set to one. Pulse Accumulator Input edge Flag -- Set when the selected edge is detected at the IOC7 input pin.In event mode the event edge triggers PAIF and in gated time accumulation mode the trailing edge of the gate signal at the IOC7 input pin triggers PAIF. Clearing this bit requires writing a one to this bit in the PAFLG register while TEN bit of TSCR1 register is set to one. Any access to the PACNT register will clear all the flags in this register when TFFCA bit in register TSCR(0x0006) is set.
0 PAIF
14.3.2.17 Pulse Accumulators Count Registers (PACNT)
Module Base + 0x0022
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 0
R PACNT15 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PACNT14 PACNT13 PACNT12 PACNT11 PACNT10 PACNT9 PACNT8
Figure 14-26. Pulse Accumulator Count Register High (PACNTH)
Module Base + 0x0023
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R PACNT7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PACNT6 PACNT5 PACNT4 PACNT3 PACNT2 PACNT1 PACNT0
Figure 14-27. Pulse Accumulator Count Register Low (PACNTL)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime These registers contain the number of active input edges on its input pin since the last reset. When PACNT overflows from 0xFFFF to 0x0000, the Interrupt flag PAOVF in PAFLG (0x0021) is set. Full count register access should take place in one clock cycle. A separate read/write for high byte and low byte will give a different result than accessing them as a word. NOTE Reading the pulse accumulator counter registers immediately after an active edge on the pulse accumulator input pin may miss the last count because the input has to be synchronized with the bus clock first.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 490 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.3.2.18 Output Compare Pin Disconnect Register(OCPD)
Module Base + 0x002C
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R OCPD7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 OCPD6 OCPD5 OCPD4 OCPD3 OCPD2 OCPD1 OCPD0
Figure 14-28. Ouput Compare Pin Disconnect Register (OCPD)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime All bits reset to zero.
Table 14-21. OCPD Field Description
Field Description Output Compare Pin Disconnect Bits 0 Enables the timer channel port. Ouptut Compare action will occur on the channel pin. These bits do not affect the input capture or pulse accumulator functions 1 Disables the timer channel port. Output Compare action will not occur on the channel pin, but the output compare flag still become set .
OCPD[7:0}
14.3.2.19 Precision Timer Prescaler Select Register (PTPSR)
Module Base + 0x002E
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
R PTPS7 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PTPS6 PTPS5 PTPS4 PTPS3 PTPS2 PTPS1 PTPS0
Figure 14-29. Precision Timer Prescaler Select Register (PTPSR)
Read: Anytime Write: Anytime All bits reset to zero.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 491
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Table 14-22. PTPSR Field Descriptions
Field 7:0 PTPS[7:0] Description Precision Timer Prescaler Select Bits -- These eight bits specify the division rate of the main Timer prescaler. These are effective only when the PRNT bit of TSCR1 is set to 1. Table 14-23 shows some selection examples in this case. The newly selected prescale factor will not take effect until the next synchronized edge where all prescale counter stages equal zero.
Table 14-23. Precision Timer Prescaler Selection Examples when PRNT = 1
PTPS7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 PTPS6 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 PTPS5 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 PTPS4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PTPS3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 PTPS2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PTPS1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PTPS0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 Prescale Factor 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 16 32 64 128 256
14.4
Functional Description
This section provides a complete functional description of the timer TIM16B8CV2 block. Please refer to the detailed timer block diagram in Figure 14-30 as necessary.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 492 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
Bus Clock
CLK[1:0] PR[2:1:0] PACLK PACLK/256 PACLK/65536
channel 7 output compare
MUX TCRE CxI CxF
PRESCALER
TCNT(hi):TCNT(lo) CLEAR COUNTER 16-BIT COUNTER TE CHANNEL 0 16-BIT COMPARATOR TC0 EDG0A EDG0B EDGE DETECT C0F OM:OL0 TOV0
TOF TOI
INTERRUPT LOGIC
TOF
C0F
CH. 0 CAPTURE
IOC0 PIN LOGIC CH. 0COMPARE
IOC0 PIN
IOC0 C1F
OM:OL1 TOV1 CH. 1 CAPTURE IOC1 PIN LOGIC CH. 1 COMPARE IOC1 PIN
CHANNEL 1 16-BIT COMPARATOR TC1 EDG1A EDG1B EDGE DETECT C1F
CHANNEL2
IOC1
CHANNEL7 16-BIT COMPARATOR TC7 EDG7A EDG7B EDGE DETECT C7F OM:OL7 TOV7
C7F
CH.7 CAPTURE IOC7 PIN PA INPUT LOGIC CH. 7 COMPARE IOC7 PIN
IOC7
PAOVF
PACNT(hi):PACNT(lo)
PEDGE PAE
EDGE DETECT
PACLK/65536 PACLK/256 INTERRUPT REQUEST PAOVI PAOVF
16-BIT COUNTER PACLK PAMOD INTERRUPT LOGIC DIVIDE-BY-64 PAI PAIF PAIF
Bus Clock
PAOVF PAOVI
Figure 14-30. Detailed Timer Block Diagram
14.4.1
Prescaler
The prescaler divides the bus clock by 1,2,4,8,16,32,64 or 128. The prescaler select bits, PR[2:0], select the prescaler divisor. PR[2:0] are in timer system control register 2 (TSCR2).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 493
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
The prescaler divides the bus clock by a prescalar value. Prescaler select bits PR[2:0] of in timer system control register 2 (TSCR2) are set to define a prescalar value that generates a divide by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64 and 128 when the PRNT bit in TSCR1 is disabled. By enabling the PRNT bit of the TSCR1 register, the performance of the timer can be enhanced. In this case, it is possible to set additional prescaler settings for the main timer counter in the present timer by using PTPSR[7:0] bits of PTPSR register.
14.4.2
Input Capture
Clearing the I/O (input/output) select bit, IOSx, configures channel x as an input capture channel. The input capture function captures the time at which an external event occurs. When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input capture channel, the timer transfers the value in the timer counter into the timer channel registers, TCx. The minimum pulse width for the input capture input is greater than two bus clocks. An input capture on channel x sets the CxF flag. The CxI bit enables the CxF flag to generate interrupt requests. Timer module must stay enabled (TEN bit of TSCR1 regsiter must be set to one) while clearing CxF (writing one to CxF).
14.4.3
Output Compare
Setting the I/O select bit, IOSx, configures channel x as an output compare channel. The output compare function can generate a periodic pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the timer counter reaches the value in the channel registers of an output compare channel, the timer can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin if the corresponding OCPDx bit is set to zero. An output compare on channel x sets the CxF flag. The CxI bit enables the CxF flag to generate interrupt requests. Timer module must stay enabled (TEN bit of TSCR1 regsiter must be set to one) while clearing CxF (writing one to CxF). The output mode and level bits, OMx and OLx, select set, clear, toggle on output compare. Clearing both OMx and OLx results in no output compare action on the output compare channel pin. Setting a force output compare bit, FOCx, causes an output compare on channel x. A forced output compare does not set the channel flag. A successful output compare on channel 7 overrides output compares on all other output compare channels. The output compare 7 mask register masks the bits in the output compare 7 data register. The timer counter reset enable bit, TCRE, enables channel 7 output compares to reset the timer counter. A channel 7 output compare can reset the timer counter even if the IOC7 pin is being used as the pulse accumulator input. Writing to the timer port bit of an output compare pin does not affect the pin state. The value written is stored in an internal latch. When the pin becomes available for general-purpose output, the last value written to the bit appears at the pin.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 494 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.4.3.1
OC Channel Initialization
Internal register whose output drives OCx can be programmed before timer drives OCx. The desired state can be programmed to this Internal register by writing a one to CFORCx bit with TIOSx, OCPDx and TEN bits set to one. Setting OCPDx to zero allows Interal register to drive the programmed state to OCx. This allows a glitch free switch over of port from general purpose I/O to timer output once the OCPDx bit is set to zero.
14.4.4
Pulse Accumulator
The pulse accumulator (PACNT) is a 16-bit counter that can operate in two modes: Event counter mode -- Counting edges of selected polarity on the pulse accumulator input pin, PAI. Gated time accumulation mode -- Counting pulses from a divide-by-64 clock. The PAMOD bit selects the mode of operation. The minimum pulse width for the PAI input is greater than two bus clocks.
14.4.5
Event Counter Mode
Clearing the PAMOD bit configures the PACNT for event counter operation. An active edge on the IOC7 pin increments the pulse accumulator counter. The PEDGE bit selects falling edges or rising edges to increment the count. NOTE The PACNT input and timer channel 7 use the same pin IOC7. To use the IOC7, disconnect it from the output logic by clearing the channel 7 output mode and output level bits, OM7 and OL7. Also clear the channel 7 output compare 7 mask bit, OC7M7. The Pulse Accumulator counter register reflect the number of active input edges on the PACNT input pin since the last reset. The PAOVF bit is set when the accumulator rolls over from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. The pulse accumulator overflow interrupt enable bit, PAOVI, enables the PAOVF flag to generate interrupt requests. NOTE The pulse accumulator counter can operate in event counter mode even when the timer enable bit, TEN, is clear.
14.4.6
Gated Time Accumulation Mode
Setting the PAMOD bit configures the pulse accumulator for gated time accumulation operation. An active level on the PACNT input pin enables a divided-by-64 clock to drive the pulse accumulator. The PEDGE bit selects low levels or high levels to enable the divided-by-64 clock. The trailing edge of the active level at the IOC7 pin sets the PAIF. The PAI bit enables the PAIF flag to generate interrupt requests.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 495
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
The pulse accumulator counter register reflect the number of pulses from the divided-by-64 clock since the last reset. NOTE The timer prescaler generates the divided-by-64 clock. If the timer is not active, there is no divided-by-64 clock.
14.5
Resets
The reset state of each individual bit is listed within Section 14.3, "Memory Map and Register Definition" which details the registers and their bit fields.
14.6
Interrupts
This section describes interrupts originated by the TIM16B8CV2 block. Table 14-24 lists the interrupts generated by the TIM16B8CV2 to communicate with the MCU.
Table 14-24. TIM16B8CV1 Interrupts
Interrupt C[7:0]F PAOVI PAOVF TOF 1. Chip Dependent. Offset
(1)
Vector1 -- -- -- --
Priority1 -- -- -- --
Source Timer Channel 7-0 Pulse Accumulator Input Pulse Accumulator Overflow Timer Overflow
Description Active high timer channel interrupts 7-0 Active high pulse accumulator input interrupt Pulse accumulator overflow interrupt Timer Overflow interrupt
-- -- -- --
The TIM16B8CV2 uses a total of 11 interrupt vectors. The interrupt vector offsets and interrupt numbers are chip dependent.
14.6.1
Channel [7:0] Interrupt (C[7:0]F)
This active high outputs will be asserted by the module to request a timer channel 7 - 0 interrupt to be serviced by the system controller.
14.6.2
Pulse Accumulator Input Interrupt (PAOVI)
This active high output will be asserted by the module to request a timer pulse accumulator input interrupt to be serviced by the system controller.
14.6.3
Pulse Accumulator Overflow Interrupt (PAOVF)
This active high output will be asserted by the module to request a timer pulse accumulator overflow interrupt to be serviced by the system controller.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 496 Freescale Semiconductor
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
14.6.4
Timer Overflow Interrupt (TOF)
This active high output will be asserted by the module to request a timer overflow interrupt to be serviced by the system controller.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 497
Timer Module (TIM16B8CV2) Block Description
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 498 Freescale Semiconductor
Appendix A Electrical Characteristics
A.1 General
This supplement contains the most accurate electrical information for the MC9S12P-Family microcontroller available at the time of publication. This introduction is intended to give an overview on several common topics like power supply, current injection etc.
A.1.1
Parameter Classification
The electrical parameters shown in this supplement are guaranteed by various methods. To give the customer a better understanding the following classification is used and the parameters are tagged accordingly in the tables where appropriate. NOTE This classification is shown in the column labeled "C" in the parameter tables where appropriate. P: C: T: Those parameters are guaranteed during production testing on each individual device. Those parameters are achieved by the design characterization by measuring a statistically relevant sample size across process variations. Those parameters are achieved by design characterization on a small sample size from typical devices under typical conditions unless otherwise noted. All values shown in the typical column are within this category. Those parameters are derived mainly from simulations.
D:
A.1.2
Power Supply
The VDDA, VSSA pin pairs supply the A/D converter and parts of the internal voltage regulator. The VDDX, VSSX pin pairs [2:1] supply the I/O pins. VDDR supplies the internal voltage regulator. All VDDX pins are internally connected by metal. All VSSX pins are internally connected by metal. VDDA, VDDX and VSSA, VSSX are connected by diodes for ESD protection.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 499
Electrical Characteristics
NOTE In the following context VDD35 is used for either VDDA, VDDR, and VDDX; VSS35 is used for either VSSA and VSSX unless otherwise noted. IDD35 denotes the sum of the currents flowing into the VDDA, VDDX and VDDR pins.
A.1.3
Pins
There are four groups of functional pins.
A.1.3.1
I/O Pins
The I/O pins have a level in the range of 3.15V to 5.5V. This class of pins is comprised of all port I/O pins, the analog inputs, BKGD and the RESET pins. Some functionality may be disabled.
A.1.3.2
Analog Reference
This group is made up by the VRH and VRL pins.
A.1.3.3
Oscillator
The pins EXTAL, XTAL dedicated to the oscillator have a nominal 1.8V level.
A.1.3.4
TEST
This pin is used for production testing only. The TEST pin must be tied to ground in all applications.
A.1.4
Current Injection
Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDD35 or VDD range during instantaneous and operating maximum current conditions. If positive injection current (Vin > VDD35) is greater than IDD35, the injection current may flow out of VDD35 and could result in external power supply going out of regulation. Ensure external VDD35 load will shunt current greater than maximum injection current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU is not consuming power; e.g., if no system clock is present, or if clock rate is very low which would reduce overall power consumption.
A.1.5
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Absolute maximum ratings are stress ratings only. A functional operation under or outside those maxima is not guaranteed. Stress beyond those limits may affect the reliability or cause permanent damage of the device. This device contains circuitry protecting against damage due to high static voltage or electrical fields; however, it is advised that normal precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltages higher than maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused inputs are tied to an appropriate logic voltage level (e.g., either VSS35 or VDD35).
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 500 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
Table A-1. Absolute Maximum Ratings(1)
Num 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Rating I/O, regulator and analog supply voltage Voltage difference VDDX to VDDA Voltage difference VSSX to VSSA Digital I/O input voltage Analog reference EXTAL, XTAL Instantaneous maximum current Single pin limit for all digital I/O pins(2) Instantaneous maximum current Single pin limit for EXTAL, XTAL Symbol VDD35 VDDX VSSX VIN VRH, VRL VILV I I
D
Min -0.3 -6.0 -0.3 -0.3 -0.3 -0.3 -25 -25 -65
Max 6.0 0.3 0.3 6.0 6.0 2.16 +25 +25 155
Unit V V V V V V mA mA C
DL
9 Storage temperature range Tstg 1. Beyond absolute maximum ratings device might be damaged. 2. All digital I/O pins are internally clamped to VSSX and VDDX, or VSSA and VDDA.
A.1.6
ESD Protection and Latch-up Immunity
All ESD testing is in conformity with CDF-AEC-Q100 stress test qualification for automotive grade integrated circuits. During the device qualification ESD stresses were performed for the Human Body Model (HBM) and the Charge Device Model. A device will be defined as a failure if after exposure to ESD pulses the device no longer meets the device specification. Complete DC parametric and functional testing is performed per the applicable device specification at room temperature followed by hot temperature, unless specified otherwise in the device specification.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 501
Electrical Characteristics
Table A-2. ESD and Latch-up Test Conditions
Model Human Body Series resistance Storage capacitance Number of pulse per pin Positive Negative Latch-up Minimum input voltage limit Maximum input voltage limit Description Symbol R1 C -- -- -- -- Value 1500 100 3 3 -2.5 7.5 V V Unit Ohm pF
Table A-3. ESD and Latch-Up Protection Characteristics
Num 1 2 3 C C C C Rating Human Body Model (HBM) Charge Device Model (CDM) Latch-up current at TA = 125C Positive Negative Latch-up current at TA = 27C Positive Negative Symbol VHBM VCDM ILAT +100 -100 ILAT +200 -200 -- -- -- -- mA Min 2000 500 Max -- -- Unit V V mA
4
C
A.1.7
Operating Conditions
This section describes the operating conditions of the device. Unless otherwise noted those conditions apply to all the following data. NOTE Please refer to the temperature rating of the device (C, V, M) with regards to the ambient temperature TA and the junction temperature TJ. For power dissipation calculations refer to Section A.1.8, "Power Dissipation and Thermal Characteristics".
Table A-4. Operating Conditions
Rating I/O, regulator and analog supply voltage Voltage difference VDDX to VDDA Voltage difference VDDR to VDDX Voltage difference VSSX to VSSA Voltage difference VSS3 , VSSPLL to VSSX Digital logic supply voltage Symbol VDD35 VDDX VDDR VSSX VSS VDD -0.1 1.72 -0.1 Min 3.13 Typ 5 Max 5.5 Unit V
refer to Table A-14 0 0.1 V
refer to Table A-14 0 1.8 0.1 1.98 V V
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 502 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
Table A-4. Operating Conditions
Oscillator Bus frequency Temperature Option C Operating junction temperature range Operating ambient temperature range(1) Temperature Option V Operating junction temperature range Operating ambient temperature range1 fosc fbus TJ TA TJ TA 4 0.5 -40 -40 -40 -40 -- -- -- 27 -- 27 16 32 105 85 C 125 105 MHz MHz C
Temperature Option M C Operating junction temperature range TJ -40 -- 150 Operating ambient temperature range1 TA -40 27 125 1. Please refer to Section A.1.8, "Power Dissipation and Thermal Characteristics" for more details about the relation between ambient temperature TA and device junction temperature TJ.
NOTE Operation is guaranteed when powering down until low voltage reset assertion.
A.1.8
Power Dissipation and Thermal Characteristics
Power dissipation and thermal characteristics are closely related. The user must assure that the maximum operating junction temperature is not exceeded. The average chip-junction temperature (TJ) in C can be obtained from:
T T T J A D = Junction Temperature, [C ] = Ambient Temperature, [C ] = Total Chip Power Dissipation, [W] = Package Thermal Resistance, [C/W] J = T + (P * ) A D JA
P
JA
The total power dissipation can be calculated from:
P P D =P INT +P IO
INT
= Chip Internal Power Dissipation, [W] 2 P = R I IO DSON IO i i
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 503
Electrical Characteristics
PIO is the sum of all output currents on I/O ports associated with VDDX, whereby
R V OL = ----------- ;for outputs driven low DSON I OL
R
V -V DD35 OH = -------------------------------------- ;for outputs driven high DSON I OH P INT =I DDR V DDR +I DDA V DDA
Table A-5. Thermal Package Characteristics(1)
Num C Rating QFN 48 1 2 3 4 5 D D D D D Thermal resistance QFN 48, single sided PCB(2) Thermal resistance QFN 48, double sided PCB with 2 internal planes(3) Junction to Board QFN 48 Junction to Case QFN 48
4 5
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
JA JA JB JC JT
-- -- -- -- --
-- -- -- -- --
82 28 11 1.4 4
C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W
Junction to Case (Bottom) QFN 48
QFP 80 6 7 8 9 10 D D D D D Thermal resistance QFP 80, single sided PCB
2
JA JA JB JC JT
-- -- -- -- --
-- -- -- -- --
56 43 28 19 5
Thermal resistance QFP 80, double sided PCB with 2 internal planes3 Junction to Board QFP 80 Junction to Case QFP 80
(4)
Junction to Package Top QFP 80(5) LQFP 64
11 12 13 14
D D D D
Thermal resistance LQFP 64, single sided PCB2 Thermal resistance LQFP 64, double sided PCB with 2 internal planes3 Junction to Board LQFP 64 Junction to Case LQFP 64(6)
(7)
JA JA JB JC
-- -- -- --
-- -- -- --
70 52 35 17
JT -- -- 3 C/W 15 D Junction to Package Top LQFP 64 1. The values for thermal resistance are achieved by package simulations 2. Junction to ambient thermal resistance, JA was simulated to be equivalent to the JEDEC specification JESD51-2 in a horizontal configuration in natural convection. 3. Junction to ambient thermal resistance, JA was simulated to be equivalent to the JEDEC specification JESD51-7 in a horizontal configuration in natural convection.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 504 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
4. Junction to case thermal resistance was simulated to be equivalent to the measured values using the cold plate technique with the cold plate temperature used as the "case" temperature. This basic cold plate measurement technique is described by MILSTD 883D, Method 1012.1. This is the correct thermal metric to use to calculate thermal performance when the package is being used with a heat sink. 5. Thermal characterization parameter JT is the "resistance" from junction to reference point thermocouple on top center of the case as defined in JESD51-2. JT is a useful value to use to estimate junction temperature in a steady state customer enviroment. 6. Junction to case thermal resistance was simulated to be equivalent to the measured values using the cold plate technique with the cold plate temperature used as the "case" temperature. This basic cold plate measurement technique is described by MILSTD 883D, Method 1012.1. This is the correct thermal metric to use to calculate thermal performance when the package is being used with a heat sink. 7. Thermal characterization parameter JT is the "resistance" from junction to reference point thermocouple on top center of the case as defined in JESD51-2. JT is a useful value to use to estimate junction temperature in a steady state customer enviroment.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 505
Electrical Characteristics
A.1.9
I/O Characteristics
This section describes the characteristics of all I/O pins except EXTAL, XTAL, TEST and supply pins.
Table A-6. 3.3-V I/O Characteristics ALL 3.3V RANGE I/O PARAMETERS ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE FOLLOWING CHARACTERIZATION
Conditions are 3.15 V < VDD35 < 3.6 V junction temperature from -40C to +150C, unless otherwise noted I/O Characteristics for all I/O pins except EXTAL, XTAL,TEST and supply pins. Num C 1 P Input high voltage T Input high voltage 2 P Input low voltage T Input low voltage 3 4 C Input hysteresis Input leakage current (pins in high impedance input mode)(1) Vin = VDD35 or VSS35 P M temperature range -40C to +150C C V temperature range -40C to +125C C C temperature range -40C to +105C C Output high voltage (pins in output mode) Partial drive IOH = -0.75 mA P Output high voltage (pins in output mode) Full drive IOH = -4 mA C Output low voltage (pins in output mode) Partial Drive IOL = +0.9 mA P Output low voltage (pins in output mode) Full Drive IOL = +4.75 mA P Internal pull up resistance VIH min > input voltage > VIL max P Internal pull down resistance VIH min > input voltage > VIL max D Input capacitance T Injection current(2) Single pin limit Total device limit, sum of all injected currents P Port J, P interrupt input pulse filtered (STOP)(3) P Port J, P interrupt input pulse passed (STOP)3 D Port J, P interrupt input pulse filtered (STOP) D Port J, P interrupt input pulse passed (STOP) Rating Symbol VIH VIH VIL VIL VHYS I
in
Min 0.65*VDD35 -- -- VSS35 - 0.3
Typ -- -- -- -- 250
Max -- VDD35 + 0.3 0.35*VDD35 --
Unit V V V V mV A
-1.00 -0.75 -0.50 V
OH
-- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 6 --
1.00 0.75 0.50 -- -- 0.4 0.4 50 50 -- 2.5 25 V V V V K K pF mA
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
VDD35 - 0.4 VDD35 - 0.4 -- -- 25 25 -- -2.5 -25 -- 10 -- 4
VOH VOL V
OL
RPUL RPDH Cin IICS IICP tPULSE tPULSE tPULSE tPULSE
13 14 15 16
-- -- -- --
3 -- 3 --
s s tcyc tcyc
PWIRQ 1 -- -- tcyc 17 D IRQ pulse width, edge-sensitive mode (STOP) 1. Maximum leakage current occurs at maximum operating temperature. Current decreases by approximately one-half for each 8C to 12 C in the temperature range from 50C to 125C. 2. Refer to Section A.1.4, "Current Injection" for more details 3. Parameter only applies in stop or pseudo stop mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 506 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
Table A-7. 5-V I/O Characteristics
Conditions are 4.5 V < VDD35 < 5.5 V junction temperature from -40C to +150C, unless otherwise noted I/O Characteristics for all I/O pins except EXTAL, XTAL,TEST and supply pins. Num C 1 P Input high voltage T Input high voltage 2 P Input low voltage T Input low voltage 3 4 C Input hysteresis Input leakage current (pins in high impedance input mode)(1) Vin = VDD35 or VSS35 P M temperature range -40C to +150C C V temperature range -40C to +125C C C temperature range -40C to +105C C Output high voltage (pins in output mode) Partial drive IOH = -2 mA P Output high voltage (pins in output mode) Full drive IOH = -10 mA C Output low voltage (pins in output mode) Partial drive IOL = +2 mA P Output low voltage (pins in output mode) Full drive IOL = +10 mA P Internal pull up resistance VIH min > input voltage > VIL max P Internal pull down resistance VIH min > input voltage > VIL max D Input capacitance T Injection current Single pin limit Total device Limit, sum of all injected currents P Port J, P interrupt input pulse filtered (STOP)(3) P Port J, P interrupt input pulse passed (STOP) D Port J, P interrupt input pulse filtered (STOP) D Port J, P interrupt input pulse passed (STOP)
3 (2)
Rating
Symbol V
IH
Min 0.65*VDD35 -- -- VSS35 - 0.3
Typ -- -- -- -- 250
Max -- VDD35 + 0.3 0.35*VDD35 -- --
Unit V V V V mV A
VIH VIL VIL VHYS I
in
-1.00 -0.75 -0.50 V
OH
-- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 6 --
1.00 0.75 0.50 -- -- 0.8 0.8 50 50 -- 2.5 25 V V V V K K pF mA
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
VDD35 - 0.8 VDD35 - 0.8 -- -- 25 25 -- -2.5 -25 -- 10 -- 4
VOH VOL V
OL
RPUL RPDH Cin IICS IICP tPULSE tPULSE tPULSE tPULSE
13 14 15 16
-- -- -- --
3 -- 3 --
s s tcyc tcyc
PWIRQ 1 -- -- tcyc 17 D IRQ pulse width, edge-sensitive mode (STOP) 1. Maximum leakage current occurs at maximum operating temperature. Current decreases by approximately one-half for each 8C to 12 C in the temperature range from 50C to 125C. 2. Refer to Section A.1.4, "Current Injection" for more details 3. Parameter only applies in stop or pseudo stop mode.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 507
Electrical Characteristics
A.1.10
Supply Currents
This section describes the current consumption characteristics of the device as well as the conditions for the measurements.
A.1.10.1
Measurement Conditions
Run current is measured on VDDR pin. It does not include the current to drive external loads. Unless otherwise noted the currents are measured in special single chip mode and the CPU code is executed from RAM. For Run and Wait current measurements PLL is on and the reference clock is the IRC1M trimmed to 1MHz. The bus frequency is 32MHz and the CPU frequency is 64MHz. Table A-8., Table A-9. and Table A-10. show the configuration of the CPMU module and the peripherals for Run, Wait and Stop current measurement.
Table A-8. CPMU Configuration for Pseudo Stop Current Measurement CPMU REGISTER CPMUCLKS CPMUOSC CPMURTI CPMUCOP Bit settings/Conditions PLLSEL=0, PSTP=1, PRE=PCE=RTIOSCSEL=COPOSCSEL=1 OSCE=1, External Square wave on EXTAL fEXTAL=16MHz, VIH= 1.8V, VIL=0V RTDEC=0, RTR[6:4]=111, RTR[3:0]=1111; WCOP=1, CR[2:0]=111
Table A-9. CPUM Configuration for Run/Wait and Full Stop Current Measurement CPMU REGISTER CPMUSYNR CPMUPOSTDIV CPMUCLKS CPMUOSC Bit settings/Conditions VCOFRQ[1:0]=01,SYNDIV[5:0] = 32 POSTDIV[4:0]=0, PLLSEL=1 OSCE=0, Reference clock for PLL is fref=firc1m trimmed to 1MHz API settings for STOP current measurement CPMUAPICTL CPMUAPITR CPMUAPIRH/RL APIEA=0, APIFE=1, APIE=0 trimmed to 10Khz set to $FFFF
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 508 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
Table A-10. Peripheral Configurations for Run & Wait Current Measurement Peripheral MSCAN SPI SCI PWM ATD Configuration configured to loop-back mode using a bit rate of 1Mbit/s configured to master mode, continously transmit data (0x55 or 0xAA) at 1Mbit/s configured into loop mode, continously transmit data (0x55) at speed of 57600 baud configured to toggle its pins at the rate of 40kHz the peripheral is configured to operate at its maximum specified frequency and to continuously convert voltages on all input channels in sequence. the module is enabled and the comparators are configured to trigger in outside range.The range covers all the code executed by the core. the peripheral shall be configured to output compare mode, pulse accumulator and modulus counter enabled. enabled
DBG
TIM COP & RTI
Table A-11. Run and Wait Current Characteristics
Conditions are: VDDR=5.5V, TA=125C, see Table A-9. and Table A-10. Num 1 2 C P P IDD Run Current IDD Wait Current Rating Symbol IDDR IDDW Min Typ 18 11 Max 20 12 Unit mA mA
Table A-12. Full Stop Current Characteristics
Conditions are: VDDR=5.5V, API see Table A-9. Num C Rating Symbol Stop Current API disabled 1 2 3 4 5 6 P P P C C C 150C -40C 25C, 150C, -40C 25C IDDS IDDS IDDS Stop Current API enabled IDDS IDDS IDDS 270 20 40 A A A 250 15 25 1100 35 50 A A A Min Typ Max Unit
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 509
Electrical Characteristics
Table A-13. Pseudo Stop Current Characteristics
Conditions are: VDDR=5.5V, RTI and COP and API enabled, see Table A-8. Num 1 2 3 C C C C 150C -40C 25C Rating Symbol IDDPS IDDPS IDDPS Min Typ 450 175 200 Max Unit A A A
A.2
ATD Characteristics
This section describes the characteristics of the analog-to-digital converter.
A.2.1
ATD Operating Characteristics
The Table A-14 and Table A-15 show conditions under which the ATD operates. The following constraints exist to obtain full-scale, full range results: VSSA VRL VIN VRH VDDA. This constraint exists since the sample buffer amplifier can not drive beyond the power supply levels that it ties to. If the input level goes outside of this range it will effectively be clipped.
Table A-14. ATD Operating Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table A-4 unless otherwise noted, supply voltage 3.13 V < VDDA < 5.5 V Num C 1 D Reference potential Low High D Voltage difference VDDX to VDDA D Voltage difference VSSX to VSSA C Differential reference voltage(1) C ATD Clock Frequency (derived from bus clock via the prescaler bus) P ATD Clock Frequency in Stop mode (internal generated temperature and voltage dependent clock, ICLK) D ADC conversion in stop, recovery time(2) ATD Conversion Period(3) 12 bit resolution: D 10 bit resolution: 8 bit resolution: tATDSTPRC
V
Rating
Symbol VRL VRH VDDX VSSX VRH-VRL fATDCLk
Min VSSA VDDA/2 -2.35 -0.1 3.13 0.25 0.6 --
Typ -- -- 0 0 5.0
Max VDDA/2 VDDA 0.1 0.1 5.5 8.0
Unit V V V V V MHz MHz us
2 3 4 5 6 7
1 --
1.7 1.5
8
NCONV12 NCONV10 NCONV8
20 19 17
42 41 39
ATD clock Cycles
1. Full accuracy is not guaranteed when differential voltage is less than 4.50 V 2. When converting in Stop Mode (ICLKSTP=1) an ATD Stop Recovery time tATDSTPRCV is required to switch back to bus clock based ATDCLK when leaving Stop Mode. Do not access ATD registers during this time. 3. The minimum time assumes a sample time of 4 ATD clock cycles. The maximum time assumes a sample time of 24 ATD clock cycles and the discharge feature (SMP_DIS) enabled, which adds 2 ATD clock cycles.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 510 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
A.2.2
Factors Influencing Accuracy
Source resistance, source capacitance and current injection have an influence on the accuracy of the ATD. A further factor is that PortAD pins that are configured as output drivers switching.
A.2.2.1
Port AD Output Drivers Switching
PortAD output drivers switching can adversely affect the ATD accuracy whilst converting the analog voltage on other PortAD pins because the output drivers are supplied from the VDDA/VSSA ATD supply pins. Although internal design measures are implemented to minimize the affect of output driver noise, it is recommended to configure PortAD pins as outputs only for low frequency, low load outputs. The impact on ATD accuracy is load dependent and not specified. The values specified are valid under condition that no PortAD output drivers switch during conversion.
A.2.2.2
Source Resistance
Due to the input pin leakage current as specified in Table A-6 and Table A-7 in conjunction with the source resistance there will be a voltage drop from the signal source to the ATD input. The maximum source resistance RS specifies results in an error (10-bit resolution) of less than 1/2 LSB (2.5 mV) at the maximum leakage current. If device or operating conditions are less than worst case or leakage-induced error is acceptable, larger values of source resistance of up to 10Kohm are allowed.
A.2.2.3
Source Capacitance
When sampling an additional internal capacitor is switched to the input. This can cause a voltage drop due to charge sharing with the external and the pin capacitance. For a maximum sampling error of the input voltage 1LSB (10-bit resilution), then the external filter capacitor, Cf 1024 * (CINS-CINN).
A.2.2.4
Current Injection
There are two cases to consider. 1. A current is injected into the channel being converted. The channel being stressed has conversion values of $3FF (in 10-bit mode) for analog inputs greater than VRH and $000 for values less than VRL unless the current is higher than specified as disruptive condition. 2. Current is injected into pins in the neighborhood of the channel being converted. A portion of this current is picked up by the channel (coupling ratio K), This additional current impacts the accuracy of the conversion depending on the source resistance. The additional input voltage error on the converted channel can be calculated as: VERR = K * RS * IINJ with IINJ being the sum of the currents injected into the two pins adjacent to the converted channel.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 511
Electrical Characteristics
Table A-15. ATD Electrical Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table A-4 unless otherwise noted Num C 1 2 3 4 5 Rating Symbol RS CINN CINS RINA INA Kp Min -- -- -- -2.5 -- -- Typ -- -- -- 5 -- -- -- Max 1 10 16 15 2.5 1E-4 5E-3 Unit K pF k mA A/A A/A
C Max input source resistance(1) D Total input capacitance Non sampling Total input capacitance Sampling D Input internal Resistance C Disruptive analog input current C Coupling ratio positive current injection
6 C Coupling ratio negative current injection Kn 1. 1 Refer to A.2.2.2 for further information concerning source resistance
A.2.3
ATD Accuracy
Table A-16. and Table A-17. specifies the ATD conversion performance excluding any errors due to current injection, input capacitance and source resistance.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 512 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
A.2.3.1
ATD Accuracy Definitions
For the following definitions see also Figure A-1. Differential non-linearity (DNL) is defined as the difference between two adjacent switching steps.
V -V i i-1 DNL ( i ) = -------------------------- - 1 1LSB
The integral non-linearity (INL) is defined as the sum of all DNLs:
INL ( n ) =
i=1
n
V -V n 0 DNL ( i ) = -------------------- - n 1LSB
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 513
Electrical Characteristics
DNL
Vi-1
$3FF $3FE $3FD $3FC $3FB $3FA $3F9 $3F8 $3F7 $3F6 $3F5 $3F4 10-Bit Resolution $3F3
LSB
10-Bit Absolute Error Boundary Vi
8-Bit Absolute Error Boundary
$FF
$FE
$FD 8-Bit Resolution
Vin mV
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 55 60
Ideal Transfer Curve 2
10-Bit Transfer Curve
1
8-Bit Transfer Curve
65
70
75
80
85
90
95 100 105 110 115 120
5000 +
Figure A-1. ATD Accuracy Definitions
NOTE Figure A-1 shows only definitions, for specification values refer to Table A16 and Table A-17.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 514 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
Table A-16. ATD Conversion Performance 5V range
Conditions are shown in Table A-4. unless otherwise noted. VREF = VRH - VRL = 5.12V. fATDCLK = 8.0MHz The values are tested to be valid with no PortAD output drivers switching simultaneous with conversions. Num C 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 P Resolution P Differential Nonlinearity P Integral Nonlinearity P Absolute Error(2) C Resolution C Differential Nonlinearity C Integral Nonlinearity C Absolute Error2. C Resolution C Differential Nonlinearity C Integral Nonlinearity Rating(1) 12-Bit 12-Bit 12-Bit 12-Bit 10-Bit 10-Bit 10-Bit 10-Bit 8-Bit 8-Bit 8-Bit Symbol LSB DNL INL AE LSB DNL INL AE LSB DNL INL -0.5 -1 -1 -2 -3 -4 -5 -7 Min Typ 1.25 2 2.5 4 5 0.5 1 2 20 0.3 0.5 0.5 1 1 2 3 4 5 7 Max Unit mV counts counts counts mV counts counts counts mV counts counts
8-Bit AE -1.5 1 1.5 counts 12 C Absolute Error2. 1. The 8-bit and 10-bit mode operation is structurally tested in production test. Absolute values are tested in 12-bit mode. 2. These values include the quantization error which is inherently 1/2 count for any A/D converter.
Table A-17. ATD Conversion Performance 3.3V range
Conditions are shown in Table A-4. unless otherwise noted. VREF = VRH - VRL = 3.3V. fATDCLK = 8.0MHz The values are tested to be valid with no PortAD output drivers switching simultaneous with conversions. Num C 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 P Resolution P Differential Nonlinearity P Integral Nonlinearity P Absolute Error(2) C Resolution C Differential Nonlinearity C Integral Nonlinearity C Absolute Error2. C Resolution C Differential Nonlinearity C Integral Nonlinearity Rating(1) 12-Bit 12-Bit 12-Bit 12-Bit 10-Bit 10-Bit 10-Bit 10-Bit 8-Bit 8-Bit 8-Bit Symbol LSB DNL INL AE LSB DNL INL AE LSB DNL INL -0.5 -1 -1.5 -2 -3 -6 -7 -8 Min Typ 0.80 3 3 4 3.22 1 1 2 12.89 0.3 0.5 0.5 1 1.5 2 3 6 7 8 Max Unit mV counts counts counts mV counts counts counts mV counts counts
8-Bit AE -1.5 1 1.5 counts 12 C Absolute Error2. 1. The 8-bit and 10-bit mode operation is structurally tested in production test. Absolute values are tested in 12-bit mode. 2. These values include the quantization error which is inherently 1/2 count for any A/D converter.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 515
Electrical Characteristics
A.3
A.3.1
NVM
Timing Parameters
The time base for all NVM program or erase operations is derived from the bus clock using the FCLKDIV register. The frequency of this derived clock must be set within the limits specified as fNVMOP. The NVM module does not have any means to monitor the frequency and will not prevent program or erase operation at frequencies above or below the specified minimum. When attempting to program or erase the NVM module at a lower frequency, a full program or erase transition is not assured. The following sections provide equations which can be used to determine the time required to execute specific flash commands. All timing parameters are a function of the bus clock frequency, fNVMBUS. All program and erase times are also a function of the NVM operating frequency, fNVMOP. A summary of key timing parameters can be found in Table A-18.
A.3.1.1
Erase Verify All Blocks (Blank Check) (FCMD=0x01)
The time required to perform a blank check on all blocks is dependent on the location of the first non-blank word starting at relative address zero. It takes one bus cycle per phrase to verify plus a setup of the command. Assuming that no non-blank location is found, then the time to erase verify all blocks is given by:
1 t check = 35500 -------------------f NVMBUS
A.3.1.2
Erase Verify Block (Blank Check) (FCMD=0x02)
The time required to perform a blank check is dependent on the location of the first non-blank word starting at relative address zero. It takes one bus cycle per phrase to verify plus a setup of the command. Assuming that no non-blank location is found, then the time to erase verify a P-Flash block is given by:
1 t pcheck = 33500 -------------------f NVMBUS
Assuming that no non-blank location is found, then the time to erase verify a D-Flash block is given by:
1 t dcheck = 2800 -------------------f NVMBUS
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 516 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
A.3.1.3
Erase Verify P-Flash Section (FCMD=0x03)
The maximum time to erase verify a section of P-Flash depends on the number of phrases being verified (NVP) and is given by:
1 t ( 450 + N VP ) -------------------f NVMBUS
A.3.1.4
Read Once (FCMD=0x04)
The maximum read once time is given by:
1 t = 400 -------------------f NVMBUS
A.3.1.5
Program P-Flash (FCMD=0x06)
The programming time for a single phrase of four P-Flash words and the two seven-bit ECC fields is dependent on the bus frequency, fNVMBUS, as well as on the NVM operating frequency, fNVMOP. The typical phrase programming time is given by:
1 1 t ppgm 164 ------------------ + 2000 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
The maximum phrase programming time is given by:
1 1 t ppgm 164 ------------------ + 2500 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
A.3.1.6
Program Once (FCMD=0x07)
The maximum time required to program a P-Flash Program Once field is given by:
1 1 t 164 ------------------ + 2150 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
A.3.1.7
Erase All Blocks (FCMD=0x08)
The time required to erase all blocks is given by:
1 1 t mass 100100 ------------------ + 70000 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 517
Electrical Characteristics
A.3.1.8
Erase P-Flash Block (FCMD=0x09)
The time required to erase the P-Flash block is given by:
1 1 t pmass 100100 ------------------ + 67000 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
A.3.1.9
Erase P-Flash Sector (FCMD=0x0A)
The typical time to erase a 512-byte P-Flash sector is given by:
1 1 t pera 20020 ------------------ + 700 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
The maximum time to erase a 512-byte P-Flash sector is given by:
1 1 t pera 20020 ------------------ + 1400 -------------------f NVMOP f NVMBUS
A.3.1.10
Unsecure Flash (FCMD=0x0B)
The maximum time required to erase and unsecure the Flash is given by: for 128 Kbyte P-Flash and 4 Kbyte D-Flash
1 1 t uns 100100 ------------------ + 70000 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
A.3.1.11
Verify Backdoor Access Key (FCMD=0x0C)
The maximum verify backdoor access key time is given by:
1 t = 400 -------------------f NVMBUS
A.3.1.12
Set User Margin Level (FCMD=0x0D)
The maximum set user margin level time is given by:
1 t = 350 -------------------f NVMBUS
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 518 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
A.3.1.13
Set Field Margin Level (FCMD=0x0E)
The maximum set field margin level time is given by:
1 t = 350 -------------------f NVMBUS
A.3.1.14
Erase Verify D-Flash Section (FCMD=0x10)
The time required to Erase Verify D-Flash for a given number of words NW is given by:
1 t dcheck ( 450 + N W ) -------------------f NVMBUS
A.3.1.15
Program D-Flash (FCMD=0x11)
D-Flash programming time is dependent on the number of words being programmed and their location with respect to a row boundary since programming across a row boundary requires extra steps. The DFlash programming time is specified for different cases: 1,2,3,4 words and 4 words across a row boundary. The typical D-Flash programming time is given by the following equation, where NW denotes the number of words; BC=0 if no row boundary is crossed and BC=1 if a row boundary is crossed:
1 1 t dpgm ( 14 + ( 54 N W ) + ( 14 BC ) ) ------------------ + ( 500 + ( 525 N W ) + ( 100 BC ) ) -------------------- f NVMOP f NVMBUS
The maximum D-Flash programming time is given by:
1 1 t dpgm ( 14 + ( 54 N W ) + ( 14 BC ) ) ------------------ + ( 500 + ( 750 N W ) + ( 100 BC ) ) -------------------- f NVMOP f NVMBUS
A.3.1.16
Erase D-Flash Sector (FCMD=0x12)
Typical D-Flash sector erase times, expected on a new device where no margin verify fails occur, is given by:
1 1 t dera 5025 ------------------ + 700 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
Maximum D-Flash sector erase times is given by:
1 1 t dera 20100 ------------------ + 3400 -------------------f NVMBUS f NVMOP
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 519
Electrical Characteristics
The D-Flash sector erase time is ~5ms on a new device and can extend to ~20ms as the flash is cycled.
Table A-18. NVM Timing Characteristics (FTMRC)
Num C 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12a 12b 12c 12d 12e Bus frequency Operating frequency
Rating
Symbol fNVMBUS fNVMOP tmass tcheck tuns tpmass tpcheck tpera tppgm tdera tdcheck tdpgm1 tdpgm2 tdpgm3 tdpgm4
Min 1 0.8 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
Typ(1) -- 1.0 100 -- 100 100 -- 20 226 5
(4)
Max(2) 32 1.05 130 35500 130 130 33500 26 285 26 2800 107 185 262 339 357
Unit(3) MHz MHz ms tcyc ms ms tcyc ms s ms tcyc s s s s s
D Erase all blocks (mass erase) time D Erase verify all blocks (blank check) time D Unsecure Flash time D P-Flash block erase time D P-Flash erase verify (blank check) time D P-Flash sector erase time D P-Flash phrase programming time D D-Flash sector erase time D D-Flash erase verify (blank check) time D D-Flash one word programming time D D-Flash two word programming time D D-Flash three word programming time D D-Flash four word programming time
-- 100 170 241 311 328
-- D D-Flash four word programming time crossing row tdpgm4c boundary 1. Typical program and erase times are based on typical fNVMOP and maximum fNVMBUS 2. Maximum program and erase times are based on minimum fNVMOP and maximum fNVMBUS 3. tcyc = 1 / fNVMBUS 4. Typical value for a new device
A.3.2
NVM Reliability Parameters
The reliability of the NVM blocks is guaranteed by stress test during qualification, constant process monitors and burn-in to screen early life failures. The data retention and program/erase cycling failure rates are specified at the operating conditions noted. The program/erase cycle count on the sector is incremented every time a sector or mass erase event is executed.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 520 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
NOTE All values shown in Table A-19 are preliminary and subject to further characterization.
Table A-19. NVM Reliability Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table A-4 unless otherwise noted Num C Rating Program Flash Arrays 1 2 C Data retention at an average junction temperature of TJavg = 85C(1) after up to 10,000 program/erase cycles C Program Flash number of program/erase cycles (-40C tj 150C) Data Flash Array 3 4 5 C Data retention at an average junction temperature of TJavg = 85C1 after up to 50,000 program/erase cycles C Data retention at an average junction temperature of TJavg = 85C1 after up to 10,000 program/erase cycles C Data retention at an average junction temperature of TJavg = 85C1 after less than 100 program/erase cycles tNVMRET tNVMRET tNVMRET 5 10 20 1002 1002 1002 -- -- -- Years Years Years tNVMRET nFLPE 20 10K 100(2) 100K(3) -- -- Years Cycles Symbol Min Typ Max Unit
6 C Data Flash number of program/erase cycles (-40C tj 150C) nFLPE 50K 500K3 -- Cycles 1. TJavg does not exceed 85C in a typical temperature profile over the lifetime of a consumer, industrial or automotive application. 2. Typical data retention values are based on intrinsic capability of the technology measured at high temperature and de-rated to 25C using the Arrhenius equation. For additional information on how Freescale defines Typical Data Retention, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB618 3. Spec table quotes typical endurance evaluated at 25C for this product family. For additional information on how Freescale defines Typical Endurance, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB619.
A.4
A.4.1
Phase Locked Loop
Jitter Definitions
With each transition of the feedback clock, the deviation from the reference clock is measured and input voltage to the VCO is adjusted accordingly.The adjustment is done continuously with no abrupt changes in the VCOCLK frequency. Noise, voltage, temperature and other factors cause slight variations in the control loop resulting in a clock jitter. This jitter affects the real minimum and maximum clock periods as illustrated in Figure A-2.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 521
Electrical Characteristics
0
1
2
3
N-1
N
tmin1 tnom tmax1 tminN tmaxN
Figure A-2. Jitter Definitions
The relative deviation of tnom is at its maximum for one clock period, and decreases towards zero for larger number of clock periods (N). Defining the jitter as:
t (N) t (N) max min J ( N ) = max 1 - ---------------------- , 1 - ---------------------- Nt Nt nom nom
For N < 100, the following equation is a good fit for the maximum jitter:
j 1 J ( N ) = ------N
J(N)
1
5
10
20
N
Figure A-3. Maximum Bus Clock Jitter Approximation
NOTE On timers and serial modules a prescaler will eliminate the effect of the jitter to a large extent.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 522 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
A.4.2
Electrical Characteristics for the PLL
Table A-20. PLL Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table A-4 unless otherwise noted Num C 1 2 3 4 6 7 Rating Symbol fVCORST fVCO fREF |Lock| |unl| tlock Min 8 32 1 0 0.5 1.5 2.5 150 + 256/fREF Typ Max 32 64 Unit MHz MHz MHz %(1) %1 s
D VCO frequency during system reset C VCO locking range C Reference Clock D Lock Detection D Un-Lock Detection C Time to lock
j1 8 C Jitter fit parameter 1(2) 1.4 % 1. % deviation from target frequency 2. fREF = 4MHz oscillator, fBUS = 32MHz equivalent fPLL = 64MHz, CPMUREFDIV=$40, CPMUSYNR=$47, CPMUPOSTDIV=$00
A.5
Electrical Characteristics for the IRC1M
Table A-21. IRC1M Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table A-4 unless otherwise noted Num C 1 Rating Symbol fIRC1M_TRIM Min 0.985 Typ 1 Max 1.015 Unit MHz
P Junction Temperature -40C to 150C Internal Reference Frequency, factory trimmed
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 523
Electrical Characteristics
A.6
Electrical Characteristics for the Oscillator (OSCLCP)
Table A-22. OSCLCP Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table A-4 unless otherwise noted
Num C
1 2 3a 3b 3c 4 5 6 7
Rating
Symbol
fOSC iOSC tUPOSC tUPOSC tUPOSC fCMFA CIN VHYS,EXTAL
Min
4.0 100 -- -- -- 200
Typ
Max
16
Unit
MHz A
C Crystal oscillator range P Startup Current C Oscillator start-up time (LCP, 4MHz)(1) C Oscillator start-up time (LCP, 8MHz)1 C Oscillator start-up time (LCP, 16MHz)1 P Clock Monitor Failure Assert Frequency D Input Capacitance (EXTAL, XTAL pins) C EXTAL Pin Input Hysteresis C
2 1.6 1 400 7
10 8 5 1000
ms ms ms KHz pF
--
180
--
mV
EXTAL Pin oscillation amplitude (loop -- -- VPP,EXTAL 0.9 V controlled Pierce) 1. These values apply for carefully designed PCB layouts with capacitors that match the crystal/resonator requirements.
A.7
Reset Characteristics
Table A-23. Reset and Stop & Startup Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table A-4 unless otherwise noted Num C 1 2 3 Rating Symbol PWRSTL nRST tSTP_REC Min 2 768 50 Typ Max Unit tVCORS
T
C Reset input pulse width, minimum input time C Startup from Reset C STOP recovery time
tVCORS
T
s
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 524 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
A.8
Electrical Specification for Voltage Regulator
Table A-24. IVREG Characteristics
Num
1 2 3 4 5
C
P P P T C
Characteristic
Input Voltages VDDA Low Voltage Interrupt Assert Level (1) VDDA Low Voltage Interrupt Deassert Level VDDX Low Voltage Reset Deassert (2) (3) API ACLK frequency (APITR[5:0] = %000000) Trimmed API internal clock(4) f / fnominal The first period after enabling the counter by APIFE might be reduced by API start up delay Temperature Sensor Slope
Symbol
VVDDR,A VLVIA VLVID VLVRXD fACLK dfACLK tsdel
Min
3.13 4.04 4.19 -- -- - 5%
Typical
-- 4.23 4.38 -- 10 --
Max
5.5 4.40 4.49 3.13 -- + 5%
Unit
V V V V KHz --
6
D
--
--
100
us mV/ oC
7
T
dVTS
4.0
5.5
6.5
High Temperature Interrupt Assert THTIA 125 oC (CPMUHTTR=$88)(5) 105 8 T THTID High Temperature Interrupt Deassert (CPMUHTTR=$88) 1. Monitors VDDA, active only in Full Performance Mode. Indicates I/O & ADC performance degradation due to low supply voltage. 2. Device functionality is guaranteed on power down to the LVR assert level 3. Monitors VDDX, active only in Full Performance Mode. MCU is monitored by the POR in RPM (see Figure A-4) 4. The API Trimming APITR[5:0] bits must be set so that fACLK=10KHz. 5. A hysteresis is guaranteed by design
NOTE The LVR monitors the voltages VDD, VDDF and VDDX. As soon as voltage drops on these supplies which would prohibit the correct function of the microcontroller, the LVR is triggering a reset.
A.9
Chip Power-up and Voltage Drops
LVI (low voltage interrupt), POR (power-on reset) and LVRs (low voltage reset) handle chip power-up or drops of the supply voltage.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 525
Electrical Characteristics
Figure A-4. MC9S12P-Family - Chip Power-up and Voltage Drops (not scaled)
V
VLVID VLVIA VLVRD VLVRA
VDDA/VDDX
VDD
VPORD
t
LVI
LVI enabled
POR
LVI disabled due to LVR
LVR
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 526 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
A.10
MSCAN
Table A-25. MSCAN Wake-up Pulse Characteristics
Conditions are shown in Table A-4 unless otherwise noted Num C 1 2 Rating Symbol tWUP tWUP Min -- 5 Typ -- -- Max 1.5 -- Unit s s
P MSCAN wakeup dominant pulse filtered P MSCAN wakeup dominant pulse pass
A.11
SPI Timing
This section provides electrical parametrics and ratings for the SPI. In Table A-26 the measurement conditions are listed.
Table A-26. Measurement Conditions
Description Drive mode Load capacitance CLOAD(1), on all outputs Thresholds for delay measurement points 1. Timing specified for equal load on all SPI output pins. Avoid asymmetric load. Value Full drive mode 50 (20% / 80%) VDDX Unit -- pF V
A.11.1
Master Mode
In Figure A-5 the timing diagram for master mode with transmission format CPHA = 0 is depicted.
SS (Output) 2 SCK (CPOL = 0) (Output) SCK (CPOL = 1) (Output) 5 MISO (Input) 6 Bit MSB-1. . . 1 9 Bit MSB-1. . . 1 LSB OUT LSB IN 11 1 4 4 12 13 12 13 3
MSB IN2 10
MOSI (Output)
MSB OUT2
1. If configured as an output. 2. LSBF = 0. For LSBF = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, bit 2... MSB.
Figure A-5. SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 0)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 527
Electrical Characteristics
In Figure A-6 the timing diagram for master mode with transmission format CPHA=1 is depicted.
SS (Output) 1 2 SCK (CPOL = 0) (Output) 4 SCK (CPOL = 1) (Output) 5 MISO (Input) 9 MOSI (Output) Port Data Master MSB OUT2 6 Bit MSB-1. . . 1 11 Bit MSB-1. . . 1 Master LSB OUT Port Data LSB IN MSB IN2 4 12 13 12 13 3
1.If configured as output 2. LSBF = 0. For LSBF = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1,bit 2... MSB.
Figure A-6. SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 1)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 528 Freescale Semiconductor
Electrical Characteristics
In Table A-27 the timing characteristics for master mode are listed.
Table A-27. SPI Master Mode Timing Characteristics
Num 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 9 10 11 12 13 C D D D D D D D D D D D D SCK period Enable lead time Enable lag time Clock (SCK) high or low time Data setup time (inputs) Data hold time (inputs) Data valid after SCK edge Data valid after SS fall (CPHA = 0) Data hold time (outputs) Rise and fall time inputs Rise and fall time outputs Characteristic SCK frequency Symbol fsck tsck tlead tlag twsck tsu thi tvsck tvss tho trfi trfo Min 1/2048 2 -- -- -- 8 8 -- -- 20 -- -- Typ -- -- 1/2 1/2 1/2 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Max 1/2 2048 -- -- -- -- -- 29 15 -- 8 8 Unit fbus tbus tsck tsck tsck ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
A.11.2
Slave Mode
In Figure A-7 the timing diagram for slave mode with transmission format CPHA = 0 is depicted.
SS (Input) 1 SCK (CPOL = 0) (Input) 2 SCK (CPOL = 1) (Input) 10 7 MISO (Output) See Note 5 MOSI (Input) NOTE: Not defined MSB IN Slave MSB 6 Bit MSB-1. . . 1 LSB IN 9 Bit MSB-1 . . . 1 4 4 12 13 8 11 11 See Note 12 13 3
Slave LSB OUT
Figure A-7. SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 0)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 529
Electrical Characteristics
In Figure A-8 the timing diagram for slave mode with transmission format CPHA = 1 is depicted.
SS (Input) 1 2 SCK (CPOL = 0) (Input) 4 SCK (CPOL = 1) (Input) 9 MISO (Output) See Note 7 MOSI (Input) NOTE: Not defined Slave 5 MSB OUT 6 MSB IN Bit MSB-1 . . . 1 LSB IN 4 12 13 12 13 3
11 Bit MSB-1 . . . 1 Slave LSB OUT
8
Figure A-8. SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 1)
In Table A-28 the timing characteristics for slave mode are listed.
Table A-28. SPI Slave Mode Timing Characteristics
Num 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 C D D D D D D D D D D D D D Characteristic SCK frequency SCK period Enable lead time Enable lag time Clock (SCK) high or low time Data setup time (inputs) Data hold time (inputs) Slave access time (time to data active) Slave MISO disable time Data valid after SCK edge Data valid after SS fall Data hold time (outputs) Rise and fall time inputs Symbol fsck tsck tlead tlag twsck tsu thi ta tdis tvsck tvss tho trfi trfo Min DC 4 4 4 4 8 8 -- -- -- -- 20 -- -- Typ -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Max 1/4 -- -- -- -- -- 20 22 29 + 0.5 tbus(1) 29 + 0.5 -- 8 8 tbus1 Unit fbus tbus tbus tbus tbus ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
13 D Rise and fall time outputs 1. 0.5 tbus added due to internal synchronization delay
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 530 Freescale Semiconductor
Ordering Information
Appendix B Ordering Information
The following figure provides an ordering partnumber example for the devices covered by this data book. There are two options when ordering a device. Customers must choose between ordering either the maskspecific partnumber or the generic / mask-independent partnumber. Ordering the mask-specific partnumber enables the customer to specify which particular maskset they will receive whereas ordering the generic maskset means that FSL will ship the currently preferred maskset (which may change over time). In either case, the marking on the device will always show the generic / mask-independent partnumber and the mask set number. NOTE The mask identifier suffix and the Tape & Reel suffix are always both omitted from the partnumber which is actually marked on the device. For specific partnumbers to order, please contact your local sales office. The below figure illustrates the structure of a typical mask-specific ordering number for the MC9S12P-Family devices
S 9 S12 P128
J0 M FT R
Tape & Reel:
R = Tape & Reel No R = No Tape & Reel
Package Option:
FT = 48 QFN LH = 64 LQFP QK = 80 QFP
Temperature Option:
C = -40C to 85C V = -40C to 105C M = -40C to 125C
Maskset identifier Suffix:
First digit usually references wafer fab Second digit usually differentiates mask rev (This suffix is omitted in generic partnumbers)
Device Title Controller Family Main Memory Type:
9 = Flash 3 = ROM (if available)
Status / Partnumber type:
S or SC = Maskset specific partnumber MC = Generic / mask-independent partnumber P or PC = prototype status (pre qualification)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 531
Ordering Information
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 532 Freescale Semiconductor
Package Information
Appendix C Package Information
This section provides the physical dimensions of the MC9S12P-Family packages. NOTE The exposed pad of the 48 QFN package should be attached to Vss ground plane.
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 533
Package Information
C.1
80 QFP Package Mechanical Outline
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 534 Freescale Semiconductor
Package Information
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 535
Package Information
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 536 Freescale Semiconductor
Package Information
C.2
48 QFN Package Mechanical Outline
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 537
Package Information
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 538 Freescale Semiconductor
Package Information
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 539
Package Information
C.3
64 LQFP Package Mechanical Outline
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 540 Freescale Semiconductor
Package Information
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 541
Package Information
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 542 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
Appendix D Detailed Register Address Map
D.1 Detailed Register Map
The following tables show the detailed register map of the MC9S12P-Family. 0x0000-0x0009 Port Integration Module (PIM) Map 1 of 4
Address 0x0000 0x0001 0x0002 0x0003 0x0004 0x0005 0x0006 0x0007 0x0008 0x0009 Name PORTA PORTB DDRA DDRB Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved PORTE DDRE R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 PA7 PB7 DDRA7 DDRB7 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 PA6 PB6 DDRA6 DDRB6 0 0 0 0 Bit 5 PA5 PB5 DDRA5 DDRB5 0 0 0 0 Bit 4 PA4 PB4 DDRA4 DDRB4 0 0 0 0 Bit 3 PA3 PB3 DDRA3 DDRB3 0 0 0 0 Bit 2 PA2 PB2 DDRA2 DDRB2 0 0 0 0 Bit 1 PA1 PB1 DDRA1 DDRB1 0 0 0 0 PE1 0 Bit 0 PA0 PB0 DDRA0 DDRB0 0 0 0 0 PE0 0
PE7 DDRE7
PE6 DDRE6
PE5 DDRE5
PE4 DDRE4
PE3 DDRE3
PE2 DDRE2
0x000A-0x000B Module Mapping Conrol (MMC) Map 1 of 2
Address 0x000A 0x000B Name Reserved MODE R W R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 0 Bit 5 0 0 Bit 4 0 0 Bit 3 0 0 Bit 2 0 0 Bit 1 0 0 Bit 0 0 0
MODC
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 543
Detailed Register Address Map
0x000C-0x000D Port Integration Module (PIM) Map 2 of 4
Address 0x000C 0x000D Name PUCR RDRIV R W R W Bit 7 0 0 Bit 6 BKPUE 0 Bit 5 0 0 Bit 4 PUPEE RDPE Bit 3 0 0 Bit 2 0 0 Bit 1 PUPBE RDPB Bit 0 PUPAE RDPA
0x000E-0x000F Reserved
Address 0x000E 0x000F Name Reserved Reserved R W R W Bit 7 0 0 Bit 6 0 0 Bit 5 0 0 Bit 4 0 0 Bit 3 0 0 Bit 2 0 0 Bit 1 0 0 Bit 0 0 0
0x0010-0x0017 Module Mapping Control (MMC) Map 2 of 2
Address 0x0010 0x0011 0x0012 0x0013 0x0014 0x0015 0x0016 0x0017 Name Reserved DIRECT Reserved Reserved Reserved PPAGE Reserved Reserved R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0
DP15 0 0 0
DP14 0 0 0
DP13 0 0 0
DP12 0 0 0
DP11 0 0 0
DP10 0 0 0
DP9 0 0 0
DP8 0 0 0
PIX7 0 0
PIX6 0 0
PIX5 0 0
PIX4 0 0
PIX3 0 0
PIX2 0 0
PIX1 0 0
PIX0 0 0
0x0018-0x0019 Reserved
Address 0x0018 0x0019 Name Reserved Reserved R W R W Bit 7 0 0 Bit 6 0 0 Bit 5 0 0 Bit 4 0 0 Bit 3 0 0 Bit 2 0 0 Bit 1 0 0 Bit 0 0 0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 544 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
0x001A-0x001B Part ID Registers
Address 0x001A 0x001B Name PARTIDH PARTIDL R W R W Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 PARTIDH PARTIDL
0x001C-0x001F Port Intergartion Module (PIM) Map 3 of 4
Address 0x001C 0x001D Name ECLKCTL Reserved R W R W R W R W Bit 7 NECLK 0 Bit 6 NCLKX2 0 Bit 5 DIV16 0 0 0 Bit 4 EDIV4 0 0 0 Bit 3 EDIV3 0 0 0 Bit 2 EDIV2 0 0 0 Bit 1 EDIV1 0 0 0 Bit 0 EDIV0 0 0 0
0x001E 0x001F
IRQCR Reserved
IRQE 0
IRQEN 0
0x0020-0x002F Debug Module (S12SDBG) Map
Address 0x0020 0x0021 0x0022 0x0023 0x0024 0x0025 0x0026 0x0027 0x0027 0x0028
(1)
Name DBGC1 DBGSR DBGTCR DBGC2 DBGTBH DBGTBL DBGCNT DBGSCRX DBGMFR DBGACTL DBGBCTL R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W
Bit 7 ARM TBF 0 0 Bit 15 Bit 7 TBF 0 0
Bit 6 0 TRIG 0
Bit 5 0 0 0 0 Bit 13 Bit 5
Bit 4 BDM 0 0 0 Bit 12 Bit 4
Bit 3 DBGBRK 0
Bit 2 0 SSF2
Bit 1
Bit 0
COMRV SSF1 0 SSF0
TSOURCE 0 Bit 14 Bit 6 0 0 0
TRCMOD 0 Bit 11 Bit 3 CNT 0 Bit 10 Bit 2
TALIGN ABCM
Bit 9 Bit 1
Bit 8 Bit 0
0 0
0 0
SC3 0
SC2 MC2
SC1 MC1 0 0
SC0 MC0
SZE SZE
SZ SZ
TAG TAG
BRK BRK
RW RW
RWE RWE
COMPE COMPE
0x0028
(2)
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 545
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0020-0x002F Debug Module (S12SDBG) Map
Address 0x0028
(3)
Name DBGCCTL
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1 0
Bit 0 COMPE Bit 16 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0
R 0 0 TAG BRK RW RWE W R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0x0029 DBGXAH W R 0x002A DBGXAM Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 W R 0x002B DBGXAL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 W R 0x002C DBGADH Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 W R 0x002D DBGADL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 W R 0x002E DBGADHM Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 W R 0x002F DBGADLM Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 W 1. This represents the contents if the Comparator A or C control register is blended into this address 2. This represents the contents if the Comparator B or D control register is blended into this address 3. This represents the contents if the Comparator B or D control register is blended into this address
17 9 1 9 1 9 1
0x0030-0x0033 Reserved
Address 0x0030 0x0031 0x0032 0x0033 Name Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved R W R W R W R W Bit 7 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 0 0 0 0 Bit 5 0 0 0 0 Bit 4 0 0 0 0 Bit 3 0 0 0 0 Bit 2 0 0 0 0 Bit 1 0 0 0 0 Bit 0 0 0 0 0
0x0034-0x003F Clock Reset and Power Management (CPMU) Map
Address 0x0034 Name CPMUSYNR Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 R W R 0x0035 CPMUREFDIV W CPMUPOSTDI R 0x0036 V W R 0x0037 CPMUFLG W
VCOFRQ[1:0] REFFRQ[1:0] 0 0 0 0 0
SYNDIV[5:0] REFDIV[3:0] POSTDIV[4:0] LOCKIF LOCK ILAF OSCIF UPOSC
RTIF
PORF
LVRF
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 546 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0034-0x003F Clock Reset and Power Management (CPMU) Map
Address 0x0038 0x0039 0x003A 0x003B Name CPMUINT CPMUCLKS CPMUPLL CPMURTI Bit 7 R RTIE W R PLLSEL W R 0 W R W R W R W R W R W RTDEC Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 0 Bit 4 LOCKIE 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 OSCIE RTIOSCS EL 0 Bit 0 0 COPOSC SEL 0
PSTP 0
PRE 0
PCE 0
FM1 RTR5 0 WRTMAS K 0 0 0 5
FM0 RTR4 0
RTR6
RTR3 0
RTR2
RTR1
RTR0
0x003C
CPMUCOP
WCOP 0 0 0 Bit 7
RSBCK 0 0 0 6
CR2 0 0 Reserved For Factory Test 0 Reserved For Factory Test 0 0 4 3 0 0 0 2
CR1 0 0 0 1
CR0 0 0 0 Bit 0
0x003D 0x003E 0x003F
Reserved Reserved CPMU ARMCOP
0x0040-0x006F Timer Module (TIM) Map
Address 0x0040 0x0041 0x0042 0x0043 0x0044 0x0045 0x0046 0x0047 0x0048 0x0049 0x004A 0x004B Name TIOS CFORC OC7M OC7D TCNTH TCNTL TSCR1 TTOV TCTL1 TCTL2 TCTL3 TCTL4 R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 IOS7 0 FOC7 OC7M7 OC7D7 Bit 15 Bit 7 Bit 6 IOS6 0 FOC6 OC7M6 OC7D6 14 6 Bit 5 IOS5 0 FOC5 OC7M5 OC7D5 13 5 Bit 4 IOS4 0 FOC4 OC7M4 OC7D4 12 4 Bit 3 IOS3 0 FOC3 OC7M3 OC7D3 11 3 Bit 2 IOS2 0 FOC2 OC7M2 OC7D2 10 2 0 Bit 1 IOS1 0 FOC1 OC7M1 OC7D1 9 1 0 Bit 0 IOS0 0 FOC0 OC7M0 OC7D0 Bit 8 Bit 0 0
TEN TOV7 OM7 OM3 EDG7B EDG3B
TSWAI TOV6 OL7 OL3 EDG7A EDG3A
TSFRZ TOV5 OM6 OM2 EDG6B EDG2B
TFFCA TOV4 OL6 OL2 EDG6A EDG2A
PRNT TOV3 OM5 OM1 EDG5B EDG1B
TOV2 OL5 OL1 EDG5A EDG1A
TOV1 OM4 OM0 EDG4B EDG0B
TOV0 OL4 OL0 EDG4A EDG0A
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 547
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0040-0x006F Timer Module (TIM) Map
Address 0x004C 0x004D 0x004E 0x004F 0x0050 0x0051 0x0052 0x0053 0x0054 0x0055 0x0056 0x0057 0x0058 0x0059 0x005A 0x005B 0x005C 0x005D 0x005E 0x005F 0x0060 0x0061 0x0062 Name TIE TSCR2 TFLG1 TFLG2 TC0H TC0L TC1H TC1L TC2H TC2L TC3H TC3L TC4H TC4L TC5H TC5L TC6H TC6L TC7H TC7L PACTL PAFLG PACNTH Bit 7 R C7I W R TOI W R C7F W R TOF W R Bit 15 W R Bit 7 W R Bit 15 W R Bit 7 W R Bit 15 W R Bit 7 W R Bit 15 W R Bit 7 W R Bit 15 W R Bit 7 W R Bit 15 W R Bit 7 W R Bit 15 W R Bit 7 W R Bit 15 W R Bit 7 W R 0 W R 0 W R PACNT15 W Bit 6 C6I 0 Bit 5 C5I 0 Bit 4 C4I 0 Bit 3 C3I TCRE C3F 0 Bit 2 C2I PR2 C2F 0 Bit 1 C1I PR1 C1F 0 Bit 0 C0I PR0 C0F 0
C6F 0
C5F 0
C4F 0
Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 Bit 14 Bit 6 PAEN 0
Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 Bit 13 Bit 5 PAMOD 0
Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 Bit 12 Bit 4 PEDGE 0
Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 Bit 11 Bit 3 CLK1 0
Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 Bit 10 Bit 2 CLK0 0
Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 Bit 9 Bit 1 PAOVI PAOVF PACNT9
Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 Bit 8 Bit 0 PAI PAIF PACNT8
PACNT14
PACNT13
PACNT12
PACNT11
PACNT10
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 548 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0040-0x006F Timer Module (TIM) Map
Address 0x0063 0x0064- 0x006B 0x006C 0x006D 0x006E 0x006F Name PACNTL Reserved OCPD Reserved PTPSR Reserved Bit 7 R PACNT7 W R 0 W R OCPD7 W R W R PTPS7 W R 0 W Bit 6 PACNT6 0 Bit 5 PACNT5 0 Bit 4 PACNT4 0 Bit 3 PACNT3 0 Bit 2 PACNT2 0 Bit 1 PACNT1 0 Bit 0 PACNT0 0
OCPD6
OCPD5
OCPD4
OCPD3
OCPD2
OCPD1
OCPD0
PTPS6 0
PTPS5 0
PTPS4 0
PTPS3 0
PTPS2 0
PTPS1 0
PTPS0 0
0x0070-0x009F Analog to Digital Converter 12-Bit 10-Channel (ATD) Map
Address 0x0070 0x0071 0x0072 0x0073 0x0074 0x0075 0x0076 0x0077 0x0078 0x0079 0x007A 0x007B 0x007C 0x007D Name ATDCTL0 ATDCTL1 ATDCTL2 ATDCTL3 ATDCTL4 ATDCTL5 ATDSTAT0 Reserved ATDCMPEH ATDCMPEL ATDSTAT2H ATDSTAT2L ATDDIENH ATDDIENL R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 0 ETRIG SEL 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 WRAP3 ETRIG CH3 ETRIGP S1C PRS3 CD CC3 0 0 Bit 2 WRAP2 ETRIG CH2 ETRIGE FIFO PRS2 CC CC2 0 0 Bit 1 WRAP1 ETRIG CH1 ASCIE FRZ1 PRS1 CB CC1 0 Bit 0 WRAP0 ETRIG CH0 ACMPIE FRZ0 PRS0 CA CC0 0
SRES1 AFFC S8C SMP1 SC 0 0 0
SRES0 ICLKSTP S4C SMP0 SCAN ETORF 0 0
SMP_DIS ETRIGLE S2C PRS4 MULT FIFOR 0 0
DJM SMP2 0
SCF 0 0
CMPE[9:8]
CMPE[7:0] CCF[9:8] CCF[7:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0
IEN[9:8]
IEN[7:0]
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 549
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0070-0x009F Analog to Digital Converter 12-Bit 10-Channel (ATD) Map
Address 0x007E 0x007F 0x0080 0x0081 0x0082 0x0083 0x0084 0x0085 0x0086 0x0087 0x0088 0x0089 0x008A 0x008B 0x008C 0x008D 0x008E 0x008F 0x090 0x091 0x092 0x093 0x094 Name ATDCMPHTH R W R ATDCMPHTL W R ATDDR0H W R ATDDR0L W R ATDDR1H W R ATDDR1L W R ATDDR2H W R ATDDR2L W R ATDDR3H W R ATDDR3L W R ATDDR4H W R ATDDR4L W R ATDDR5H W R ATDDR5L W R ATDDR6H W R ATDDR6L W R ATDDR7H W R ATDDR7L W R ATDDR8H W R ATDDR8L W R ATDDR9H W R ATDDR9L W R ATDDR10H W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 Bit 0
CMPHT[9:8]
CMPHT[7:0] Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 550 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0070-0x009F Analog to Digital Converter 12-Bit 10-Channel (ATD) Map
Address 0x095 0x096 0x097 0x098 0x099 0x09A 0x09B 0x09C 0x09D 0x09E 0x009F Name ATDDR10L ATDDR11H ATDDR11L ATDDR12H ATDDR12L ATDDR13H ATDDR13L ATDDR14H ATDDR14L ATDDR15H ATDDR15L R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit15 Bit7 Bit 6 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 14 Bit6 Bit 5 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 13 0 Bit 4 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0 Bit 3 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 11 0 Bit 2 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 10 0 Bit 1 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 9 0 Bit 0 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0 Bit8 0
0x00A0-0x00C7 Pulse Width Modulator 6-Channels (PWM) Map
Address 0x00A0 0x00A1 0x00A2 0x00A3 0x00A4 0x00A5 0x00A6 0x00A7 0x00A8 Name PWME PWMPOL PWMCLK PWMPRCLK PWMCAE PWMCTL PWMTST Test Only PWMPRSC PWMSCLA R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 0 0 Bit 5 PWME5 PPOL5 PCLK5 PCKB1 CAE5 CON23 0 0 Bit 4 PWME4 PPOL4 PCLK4 PCKB0 CAE4 CON01 0 0 Bit 3 PWME3 PPOL3 PCLK3 0 Bit 2 PWME2 PPOL2 PCLK2 PCKA2 CAE2 PFRZ 0 0 Bit 1 PWME1 PPOL1 PCLK1 PCKA1 CAE1 0 0 0 Bit 0 PWME0 PPOL0 PCLK0 PCKA0 CAE0 0 0 0
PCKB2 0
CAE3 PSWAI 0 0
CON45 0 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 551
Detailed Register Address Map
0x00A0-0x00C7 Pulse Width Modulator 6-Channels (PWM) Map
Address 0x00A9 0x00AA 0x00AB 0x00AC 0x00AD 0x00AE 0x00AF 0x00B0 0x00B1 0x00B2 0x00B3 0x00B4 0x00B5 0x00B6 0x00B7 0x00B8 0x00B9 0x00BA 0x00BB 0x00BC 0x00BD 0x00BE 0x00BF0x00C7 Name R W R PWMSCNTA W R PWMSCNTB W R PWMCNT0 W R PWMCNT1 W R PWMCNT2 W R PWMCNT3 W R PWMCNT4 W R PWMCNT5 W R PWMPER0 W R PWMPER1 W R PWMPER2 W R PWMPER3 W R PWMPER4 W R PWMPER5 W R PWMDTY0 W R PWMDTY1 W R PWMDTY2 W R PWMDTY3 W R PWMDTY4 W R PWMDTY5 W R PWMSDN W R Reserved W PWMSCLB Bit 7 Bit 7 0 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 Bit 7 PWMIF 0 Bit 6 6 0 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 PWMIE 0 Bit 5 5 0 0 5 0 5 0 5 0 5 0 5 0 5 0 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 Bit 4 4 0 0 4 0 4 0 4 0 4 0 4 0 4 0 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 Bit 3 3 0 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 0 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 0 0 Bit 2 2 0 0 2 0 2 0 2 0 2 0 2 0 2 0 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 PWM5IN 0 Bit 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 PWM5INL 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 PWM5 ENA 0
0 PWMLVL PWRSTRT 0 0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 552 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
0x00C8-0x00CF Serial Communication Interface (SCI) Map
Address 0x00C8 Name SCIBDH(1) Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 SBR10 SBR2 ILT BERRV 0 Bit 1 SBR9 SBR1 PE BERRIF BERRIE BERRM0 RWU FE Bit 0 SBR8 SBR0 PT BKDIF BKDIE BKDFE SBK PF RAF 0 R0 T0 R IREN TNP1 TNP0 SBR12 SBR11 W R SBR7 SBR6 SBR5 SBR4 SBR3 0x00C9 SCIBDL1 W R LOOPS SCISWAI RSRC M WAKE 0x00CA SCICR11 W R 0 0 0 0 RXEDGIF 0x00C8 SCIASR1(2) W R 0 0 0 0 RXEDGIE 0x00C9 SCIACR12 W R 0 0 0 0 0 0x00CA SCIACR22 W R 0x00CB SCICR2 TIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE W R TDRE TC RDRF IDLE OR 0x00CC SCISR1 W R 0 0 0x00CD SCISR2 AMAP TXPOL RXPOL W R R8 0 0 0 0x00CE SCIDRH T8 W R R7 R6 R5 R4 R3 0x00CF SCIDRL W T7 T6 T5 T4 T3 1. Those registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCI0SR2 register is set to zero 2. Those registers are accessible if the AMAP bit in the SCI0SR2 register is set to one
BERRM1 RE NF
BRK13 0 R2 T2
TXDIR 0 R1 T1
0x00D0-0x00D7 Reserved
Address 0x00D00x00D7 Name Reseved R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0
0x00D8-0x00DF Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Map
Address 0x00D8 0x00D9 0x00DA 0x00DB Name SPICR1 SPICR2 SPIBR SPISR R W R W R W R W Bit 7 SPIE 0 0 SPIF Bit 6 SPE XFRW SPPR2 0 Bit 5 SPTIE 0 Bit 4 MSTR MODFEN SPPR0 MODF Bit 3 CPOL BIDIROE 0 0 Bit 2 CPHA 0 Bit 1 SSOE SPISWAI SPR1 0 Bit 0 LSBFE SPC0 SPR0 0
SPPR1 SPTEF
SPR2 0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 553
Detailed Register Address Map
0x00D8-0x00DF Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Map
Address 0x00DC 0x00DD 0x00DE 0x00DF Name SPIDRH SPI0DRL Reserved Reserved R W R W R W R W Bit 7 R15 T15 R7 T7 0 0 Bit 6 R14 T14 R6 T6 0 0 Bit 5 R13 T13 R5 T5 0 0 Bit 4 R12 T12 R4 T4 0 0 Bit 3 R11 T11 R3 T3 0 0 Bit 2 R10 T10 R2 T2 0 0 Bit 1 R9 T9 R1 T1 0 0 Bit 0 R8 T8 R0 T0 0 0
0x00E0-0x00FF Reserved
Address 0x00E00x00FF Name Reserved R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0
0x0100-0x0113 NVM Contol Register (FTMRC) Map
Address 0x0100 0x0101 0x0102 0x0103 0x0104 0x0105 0x0106 0x0107 0x0108 0x0109 0x010A 0x010B 0x010C Name FCLKDIV FSEC FCCOBIX FRSV0 FCNFG FERCNFG FSTAT FERSTAT FPROT DFPROT FCCOBHI FCCOBLO FRSV1 R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 FDIVLD KEYEN1 0 0 Bit 6 FDIV6 KEYEN0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RNV6 0 Bit 5 FDIV5 RNV5 0 0 0 0 Bit 4 FDIV4 RNV4 0 0 Bit 3 FDIV3 RNV3 0 0 0 0 MGBUSY 0 Bit 2 FDIV2 RNV2 Bit 1 FDIV1 SEC1 Bit 0 FDIV0 SEC0
CCOBIX2 0 0 0 RSVD 0
CCOBIX1 0
CCOBIX0 0
CCIE 0
IGNSF 0
FDFD DFDIE
FSFD SFDIE
CCIF 0
ACCERR 0
FPVIOL 0
MGSTAT1 MGSTAT0
DFDIF FPLS1 DPS1 CCOB9 CCOB1 0
SFDIF FPLS0 DPS0 CCOB8 CCOB0 0
FPOPEN DPOPEN CCOB15 CCOB7 0
FPHDIS 0
FPHS1 0
FPHS0 DPS3 CCOB11 CCOB3 0
FPLDIS DPS2 CCOB10 CCOB2 0
CCOB14 CCOB6 0
CCOB13 CCOB5 0
CCOB12 CCOB4 0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 554 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0100-0x0113 NVM Contol Register (FTMRC) Map
Address 0x010D 0x010E 0x010F 0x0110 0x0111 0x0112 0x0113 Name FRSV2 FRSC3 FRSV4 FOPT FRSV5 FRSV6 FRSV7 R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 0 0 0 NV7 0 0 0 Bit 6 0 0 0 NV6 0 0 0 Bit 5 0 0 0 NV5 0 0 0 Bit 4 0 0 0 NV4 0 0 0 Bit 3 0 0 0 NV3 0 0 0 Bit 2 0 0 0 NV2 0 0 0 Bit 1 0 0 0 NV1 0 0 0 Bit 0 0 0 0 NV0 0 0 0
0x0114-0x011F Reserved
Address 0x01140x011F Name Reserved R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0
0x0120 Interrupt Vector Base Register
Address 0x0120 Name IVBR R W Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
IVB_ADDR[7:0]
0x0121-0x013F Reserved
Address 0x01140x011F Name Reserved R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0
0x0140-0x017F MSCAN Map
Address 0x0140 0x0141 0x0142 Name CAN0CTL0 CAN0CTL1 CAN0BTR0 Bit 7 R RXFRM W R CANE W R SJW1 W Bit 6 RXACT Bit 5 CSWAI LOOPB BRP5 Bit 4 SYNCH Bit 3 TIME BORM BRP3 Bit 2 WUPE WUPM BRP2 Bit 1 SLPRQ SLPAK Bit 0 INITRQ INITAK
CLKSRC SJW0
LISTEN BRP4
BRP1
BRP0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 555
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0140-0x017F MSCAN Map
Address 0x0143 0x0144 0x0145 0x0146 0x0147 0x0148 0x0149 0x014A 0x014B 0x014C 0x014D 0x014E 0x014F 0x01500x0153 Name CAN0BTR1 CAN0RFLG CAN0RIER CAN0TFLG CAN0TIER CAN0TARQ CAN0TAAK CAN0TBSEL CAN0IDAC Reserved CAN0MISC CAN0RXERR CAN0TXERR CAN0IDAR0CAN0IDAR3 Bit 7 R SAMP W R WUPIF W R WUPIE W R 0 W R 0 W R 0 W R 0 W R 0 W R 0 W R 0 W R 0 W R RXERR7 W R TXERR7 W R AC7 W R AM7 W R AC7 W R AM7 W R W R W Bit 6 TSEG22 CSCIF CSCIE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RXERR6 TXERR6 Bit 5 TSEG21 RSTAT1 Bit 4 TSEG20 RSTAT0 Bit 3 TSEG13 TSTAT1 Bit 2 TSEG12 TSTAT0 Bit 1 TSEG11 OVRIF OVRIE TXE1 TXEIE1 ABTRQ1 ABTAK1 Bit 0 TSEG10 RXF RXFIE TXE0 TXEIE0 ABTRQ0 ABTAK0
RSTATE1 0 0 0 0 0
RSTATE0 0 0 0 0 0
TSTATE1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RXERR3 TXERR3
TSTATE0 TXE2 TXEIE2 ABTRQ2 ABTAK2
TX2 IDHIT2 0 0 RXERR2 TXERR2
TX1 IDHIT1 0 0 RXERR1 TXERR1
TX0 IDHIT0 0
IDAM1 0 0 RXERR5 TXERR5
IDAM0 0 0 RXERR4 TXERR4
BOHOLD RXERR0 TXERR0
AC6 AM6 AC6 AM6
AC5 AM5 AC5 AM5
AC4 AM4 AC4 AM4
AC3 AM3 AC3 AM3
AC2 AM2 AC2 AM2
AC1 AM1 AC1 AM1
AC0 AM0 AC0 AM0
0x0154- CAN0IDMR00x0157 CAN0IDMR3 0x01580x015B CAN0IDAR4CAN0IDAR7
0x015C- CAN0IDMR40x015F CAN0IDMR7 0x01600x016F 0x01700x017F CAN0RXFG
FOREGROUND RECEIVE BUFFER (SeeTable ) FOREGROUND TRANSMIT BUFFER (SeeTable )
CAN0TXFG
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 556 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
MSCAN Foreground Receive and Transmit Buffer Layout
Address 0xXXX0 Name Extended ID Standard ID CANxRIDR0 Extended ID Standard ID CANxRIDR1 Extended ID Standard ID CANxRIDR2 Extended ID Standard ID CANxRIDR3 R R W R R W R R W R R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 ID28 ID10 ID20 ID2 ID14 Bit 6 ID27 ID9 ID19 ID1 ID13 Bit 5 ID26 ID8 ID18 ID0 ID12 Bit 4 ID25 ID7 SRR=1 RTR ID11 Bit 3 ID24 ID6 IDE=1 IDE=0 ID10 Bit 2 ID23 ID5 ID17 Bit 1 ID22 ID4 ID16 Bit 0 ID21 ID3 ID15
0xXXX1
ID9
ID8
ID7
0xXXX2
ID6
ID5
ID4
ID3
ID2
ID1
ID0
RTR
0xXXX3
0xXXX4- CANxRDSR00xXXXB CANxRDSR7 0xXXXC 0xXXXD CANRxDLR Reserved
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3 DLC3
DB2 DLC2
DB1 DLC1
DB0 DLC0
0xXXXE CANxRTSRH 0xXXXF CANxRTSRL Extended ID CANxTIDR0 Standard ID Extended ID CANxTIDR1 Standard ID Extended ID CANxTIDR2 Standard ID Extended ID CANxTIDR3 Standard ID
TSR15 TSR7
TSR14 TSR6
TSR13 TSR5
TSR12 TSR4
TSR11 TSR3
TSR10 TSR2
TSR9 TSR1
TSR8 TSR0
ID28 ID10 ID20 ID2 ID14
ID27 ID9 ID19 ID1 ID13
ID26 ID8 ID18 ID0 ID12
ID25 ID7 SRR=1 RTR ID11
ID24 ID6 IDE=1 IDE=0 ID10
ID23 ID5 ID17
ID22 ID4 ID16
ID21 ID3 ID15
0xXX10
0xXX0x XX10
ID9
ID8
ID7
0xXX12
ID6
ID5
ID4
ID3
ID2
ID1
ID0
RTR
0xXX13
0xXX14- CANxTDSR0- 0xXX1B CANxTDSR7 0xXX1C 0xXX1D CANxTDLR CANxTTBPR
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3 DLC3
DB2 DLC2 PRIO2
DB1 DLC1 PRIO1
DB0 DLC0 PRIO0
PRIO7
PRIO6
PRIO5
PRIO4
PRIO3
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 557
Detailed Register Address Map
MSCAN Foreground Receive and Transmit Buffer Layout
Address 0xXX1E 0xXX1F Name CANxTTSRH R W R CANxTTSRL W Bit 7 TSR15 TSR7 Bit 6 TSR14 TSR6 Bit 5 TSR13 TSR5 Bit 4 TSR12 TSR4 Bit 3 TSR11 TSR3 Bit 2 TSR10 TSR2 Bit 1 TSR9 TSR1 Bit 0 TSR8 TSR0
0x0180-023F Reserved
Address 0x01800x023F Name Reserved R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0
0x0240 -0x027F Port Integration Module (PIM) Map 4 of 4
Address 0x0240 0x0241 0x0242 0x0243 0x0244 0x0245 0x0246 0x0247 Name PTT PTIT DDRT RDRT PERT PPST Reserved PTTRR Bit 7 R PTT7 W R PTIT7 W R DDRT7 W R RDRT7 W R PERT7 W R PPST7 W R 0 W R PTTRR7 W Bit 6 PTT6 PTIT6 Bit 5 PTT5 PTIT5 Bit 4 PTT4 PTIT4 Bit 3 PTT3 PTIT3 Bit 2 PTT2 PTIT2 Bit 1 PTT1 PTIT1 Bit 0 PTT0 PTIT0
DDRT6 RDRT6 PERT6 PPST6 0
DDRT5 RDRT5 PERT5 PPST5 0
DDRT4 RDRT4 PERT4 PPST4 0
DDRT3 RDRT3 PERT3 PPST3 0 0
DDRT2 RDRT2 PERT2 PPST2 0
DDRT1 RDRT1 PERT1 PPST1 0
DDRT0 RDRT0 PERT0 PPST0 0
PTTRR6
PTTRR5
PTTRR4
PTTRR2
PTTRR1
PTTRR0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 558 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0240 -0x027F Port Integration Module (PIM) Map 4 of 4
Address 0x0248 0x0249 0x024A 0x024B 0x024C 0x024D 0x024E 0x024F 0x0250 0x0251 0x0252 0x0253 0x0254 0x0255 0x0256 0x0257 0x0258 0x0259 0x025A 0x025B 0x025C 0x025D 0x025E 0x025F Name PTS PTIS DDRS RDRS PERS PPSS WOMS Reserved PTM PTIM DDRM RDRM PERM PPSM WOMM MODRR PTP PTIP DDRP RDRP PERP PPSP PIEP PIFP R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 PTS7 PTIS7 Bit 6 PTS6 PTIS6 Bit 5 PTS5 PTIS5 Bit 4 PTS4 PTIS4 Bit 3 PTS3 PTIS3 Bit 2 PTS2 PTIS2 Bit 1 PTS1 PTIS1 Bit 0 PTS0 PTIS0
DDRS7 RDRS7 PERS7 PPSS7 WOMS7 0
DDRS6 RDRS6 PERS6 PPSS6 WOMS6 0
DDRS5 RDRS5 PERS5 PPSS5 WOMS5 0
DDRS4 RDRS4 PERS4 PPSS4 WOMS4 0
DDRS3 RDRS3 PERS3 PPSS3 WOMS3 0
DDRS2 RDRS2 PERS2 PPSS2 WOMS2 0
DDRS1 RDRS1 PERS1 PPSS1 WOMS1 0
DDRS0 RDRS0 PERS0 PPSS0 WOMS0 0
PTM7 PTIM7
PTM6 PTIM6
PTM5 PTIM5
PTM4 PTIM4
PTM3 PTIM3
PTM2 PTIM2
PTM1 PTIM1
PTM0 PTIM0
DDRM7 RDRM7 PERM7 PPSM7 WOMM7 MODRR7 PTP7 PTIP7
DDRM6 RDRM6 PERM6 PPSM6 WOMM6 MODRR6 PTP6 PTIP6
DDRM5 RDRM5 PERM5 PPSM5 WOMM5 0
DDRM4 RDRM4 PERM4 PPSM4 WOMM4 MODRR4 PTP4 PTIP4
DDRM3 RDRM3 PERM3 PPSM3 WOMM3 0
DDRM2 RDRM2 PERM2 PPSM2 WOMM2 0
DDRM1 RDRM1 PERM1 PPSM1 WOMM1 0
DDRM0 RDRM0 PERM0 PPSM0 WOMM0 0
PTP5 PTIP5
PTP3 PTIP3
PTP2 PTIP2
PTP1 PTIP1
PTP0 PTIP0
DDRP7 RDRP7 PERP7 PPSP7 PIEP7 PIFP7
DDRP6 RDRP6 PERP6 PPSP6 PIEP6 PIFP6
DDRP5 RDRP5 PERP5 PPSP5 PIEP5 PIFP5
DDRP4 RDRP4 PERP4 PPSP4 PIEP4 PIFP4
DDRP3 RDRP3 PERP3 PPSP3 PIEP3 PIFP3
DDRP2 RDRP2 PERP2 PPSP2 PIEP2 PIFP2
DDRP1 RDRP1 PERP1 PPSP1 PIEP1 PIFP1
DDRP0 RDRP0 PERP0 PPSS0 PIEP0 PIFP0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 559
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0240 -0x027F Port Integration Module (PIM) Map 4 of 4
Address 0x0260 0x0261 0x0262 0x0263 0x0264 0x0265 0x0266 0x0267 0x0268 0x0269 0x026A 0x026B 0x026C 0x026D 0x026E 0x026f 0x0270 0x0271 0x0272 0x0273 0x0274 0x0275 Name Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved PTJ PTIJ DDRJ RDRJ PERJ PPSJ PIEJ PIFJ PT0AD0 PT1AD0 DDR0AD0 DDR1AD0 RDR0AD0 RDR1AD0 R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W R W Bit 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 0 00 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 5 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PT0AD0 5 PT1AD0 5 Bit 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PT0AD0 4 PT1AD0 4 Bit 3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PT0AD0 3 PT1AD0 3 Bit 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
PTJ7 PTIJ7
PTJ6 PTIJ6
PTJ2 PTIJ12
PTJ1 PTIJ1
PTJ0 PTIJ0
DDRJ7 RDRJ7 PERJ7 PPSJ7 PIEJ7 PIFJ7 PT0AD0 7 PT1AD0 7
DDRJ6 RDRJ6 PERJ6 PPSJ6 PIEJ6 PIFJ6 PT0AD0 6 PT1AD0 6
DDRJ2 RDRJ2 PERJ2 PPSJ2 PIEJ2 PIFJ2 PT0AD0 2 PT1AD0 2
DDRJ1 RDRJ1 PERJ1 PPSJ1 PIEJ1 PIFJ1 PT0AD0 1 PT1AD0 1
DDRJ0 RDRJ0 PERJ0 PPSJ0 PIEJ0 PIFJ0 PT0AD0 0 PT1AD0 0
DDR0AD0 DDR0AD0 DDR0AD0 DDR0AD0 DDR0AD0 DDR0AD0 DDR0AD0 DDR0AD0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DDR1AD0 DDR1AD0 DDR1AD0 DDR1AD0 DDR1AD0 DDR1AD0 DDR1AD0 DDR1AD0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RDR0AD0 RDR0AD0 RDR0AD0 RDR0AD0 RDR0AD0 RDR0AD0 RDR0AD0 RDR0AD0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RDR1AD0 RDR1AD0 RDR1AD0 RDR1AD0 RDR1AD0 RDR1AD0 RDR1AD0 RDR1AD0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 560 Freescale Semiconductor
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0240 -0x027F Port Integration Module (PIM) Map 4 of 4
Address 0x0276 0x0277 0x02780x027F Name PER0AD0 PER1AD0 Reserved Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 R PER0AD0 PER0AD0 PER0AD0 PER0AD0 PER0AD0 PER0AD0 PER0AD0 PER0AD0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 W R PER1AD0 PER1AD0 PER1AD0 PER1AD0 PER1AD0 PER1AD0 PER1AD0 PER1AD0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 W R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W
0x0280-0x02EF Reserved
Address 0x02800x02EF Name Reserved R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0
0x02F0-0x02FF Clock and Power Management Unit (CPMU) Map 2 of 2
Address 0x02F0 0x02F1 Name CPMUHTCL CPMULVCTL Bit 7 R 0 W R 0 W R APICLK W R APITR5 W R APIR15 W R APIR7 W R 0 W R HTOEN W R W R W R OSCE W R 0 W R 0 W Bit 6 0 0 0 Bit 5 VSEL 0 0 Bit 4 0 0 Bit 3 HTEN 0 Bit 2 HTDS LVDS Bit 1 HTIE LVIE APIE 0 Bit 0 HTIF LVIF APIF 0
0x02F2 CPMUAPICTL 0x02F3 0x02F4 0x02F5 0x02F6 0x02F7 0x02F8 0x02F9 0x02FA 0x02FB 0x02FC VREGAPITR CPMUAPIRH CPMUAPIRL Reserved CPMUHTTR CPMU IRCTRIMH CPMU IRCTRIML CPMUOSC CPMUPROT Reserved
APIFES APITR2 APIR12 APIR4 0 0
APIEA APITR1 APIR11 APIR3 0
APIFE APITR0 APIR10 APIR2 0
APITR4 APIR14 APIR6 0 0
APITR3 APIR13 APIR5 0 0
APIR9 APIR1 0
APIR8 APIR0 0
HTTR3 0
HTTR2 0
HTTR1
HTTR0
TCTRIM[3:0]
IRCTRIM[9:8]
IRCTRIM[7:0] OSCBW 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 OSCFILT[4:0] 0 0 0 0 PROT 0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 Freescale Semiconductor 561
Detailed Register Address Map
0x0300-0x03FF Reserved
Address 0x03000x03FF Name Reserved R W Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0
S12P-Family Reference Manual, Rev. 1.12 562 Freescale Semiconductor
How to Reach Us:
USA/Europe/Locations not listed: Freescale Semiconductor Literature Distribution P.O. Box 5405, Denver, Colorado 80217 1-800-521-6274 or 480-768-2130 Japan: Freescale Semiconductor Japan Ltd. SPS, Technical Information Center 3-20-1, Minami-Azabu Minato-ku Tokyo 106-8573, Japan 81-3-3440-3569 Asia/Pacific: Freescale Semiconductor H.K. Ltd. 2 Dai King Street Tai Po Industrial Estate Tai Po, N.T. Hong Kong 852-26668334 Learn More: For more information about Freescale Semiconductor products, please visit http://www.freescale.com
Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software implementers to use Freescale Semiconductor products. There are no express or implied copyright licenses granted hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits or integrated circuits based on the information in this document. Freescale Semiconductor reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Freescale Semiconductor makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Freescale Semiconductor assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. "Typical" parameters which may be provided in Freescale Semiconductor data sheets and/or specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual performance may vary over time. All operating parameters, including "Typicals" must be validated for each customer application by customer's technical experts. Freescale Semiconductor does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Freescale Semiconductor products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Freescale Semiconductor product could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Freescale Semiconductor products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Freescale Semiconductor and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Freescale Semiconductor was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part. FreescaleTM and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. All other product or service names are the property of their respective owners. (c) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 2009


▲Up To Search▲   

 
Price & Availability of PC9S12P128J0CFT

All Rights Reserved © IC-ON-LINE 2003 - 2022  

[Add Bookmark] [Contact Us] [Link exchange] [Privacy policy]
Mirror Sites :  [www.datasheet.hk]   [www.maxim4u.com]  [www.ic-on-line.cn] [www.ic-on-line.com] [www.ic-on-line.net] [www.alldatasheet.com.cn] [www.gdcy.com]  [www.gdcy.net]


 . . . . .
  We use cookies to deliver the best possible web experience and assist with our advertising efforts. By continuing to use this site, you consent to the use of cookies. For more information on cookies, please take a look at our Privacy Policy. X